Selling under the Swastika: Advertising and Commercial Culture in Nazi Germany 9780804788830

The first in-depth study of the role played by advertisements and commercial culture in legitimizing and stabilizing the

256 103 4MB

English Pages 360 [354] Year 2013

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD PDF FILE

Recommend Papers

Selling under the Swastika: Advertising and Commercial Culture in Nazi Germany
 9780804788830

  • 0 0 0
  • Like this paper and download? You can publish your own PDF file online for free in a few minutes! Sign Up
File loading please wait...
Citation preview

Selling under the Swastika

selling under the

Swasika advertising and commercial culture in nazi germany PamEla E. Swett

stanford university press Stanford, California

Stanford University Press Stanford, California © 2014 by the Board of Trustees of the Leland Stanford Junior University All rights reserved No part of this book may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or mechanical, including photocopying and recording, or in any information storage or retrieval system without the prior written permission of Stanford University Press. Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data Swett, Pamela E., author. Selling under the swastika : advertising and commercial culture in Nazi Germany / Pamela E. Swett. pages   cm. Includes bibliographical references and index. isbn 978-0-8047-7355-3 (cloth : alk. paper) 1. Advertising—Germany—History—20th century.  2. Advertising—Political aspects—Germany—History— 20th century.  3. Germany—History—1933–1945. I. Title. hf5813.g4s94   2013 659.10943'09043—dc23 2013021445 isbn 978-0-8047-8883-0 (electronic) Printed in the United States of America on acid-free, archival-quality paper Typeset at Stanford University Press in 10/13 Galliard

For Matt Yb

Acknowledgments

Throughout the research and writing of this book, I have often looked forward to this moment. It is very satisfying to be able to thank all those who helped me arrive at this point. Let me begin with the institutions and individuals that made the research possible. The John W. Kluge Center at the Library of Congress was the first institution to support this project; I am particularly grateful for their early interest. The Social Science and Humanities Research Council of Canada provided me with three years of research funding, including one term of teaching release. This generous grant covered numerous forays into the archives and provided some uninterrupted time to write, a precious commodity indeed. The Alexander von Humboldt Foundation also provided welcome funds for two research stays in Germany and should be commended for recognizing the desire of scholars to have their families with them while abroad. Among the many archivists who helped push this project toward completion, special thanks are owed to Petra Secunde (Daimler), Sonja Nilson (Henkel), Thorsten Finke (Beiersdorf), and Birgit Nachtwey (Bahlsen). Dr. Henrich Hunke was also kind enough to welcome me into his home and share his personal collection of his father’s writings. I very much appreciated his openness and hospitality. McMaster University, my institutional home, and its Arts Research Board also deserve thanks for supporting this project financially as well as for offering a stimulating environment in which to work. Not least of the perks of being on faculty at McMaster is the ability to access the McMaster Children’s Centre. The staff at the Centre has been a part of my family’s life for more than a decade and has contributed in important ways to any success I have enjoyed.

viii

Acknowledgments

Thanks also goes to those who invited me to present my research over the last few years, including Hartmut Berghoff of the German Historical Institute, Washington, DC; Peter C. Caldwell of Rice University; Till van Rahden, Université de Montreal; Thomas Schaarschmidt of the Zentrum für Zeithistorische Forschung, Potsdam; and Annette Timm, University of Calgary. My editor at Stanford, Norris Pope, was patient while I wrote and a pleasure to work with through the production process. The two reviewers for the press were equally collegial and suggested improvements that I readily incorporated. Tim Mueller, Katrina Espanol-Miller, and Gerulf Hirt provided me with some key technical assistance down the stretch. I thank them for their help. Wendy Benedetti and Debbie Lobban also deserve mention for their administrative skills, without which my job as department chair would be much more time consuming. I also owe much to those friends and colleagues whose wise counsel and timely pep talks were instrumental in the completion of the project. At McMaster, Stephen Heathorn and Martin Horn have been trusted friends for many years and came to my rescue in a variety of ways during the writing of this book. I am grateful to Justin Powell, who continues to provide me a most welcoming home in Berlin. In addition, I must also thank Richard Bessel, Belinda Davis, Peter Fritzsche, Jeff Hayton, Claudia Koonz, Lisa Heineman, and Jonathan Wiesen for their input in discussions of this material. My deepest gratitude goes to those who read whole sections of the manuscript: Frank Biess, Paul Lerner, Corey Ross, and Jonathan Zatlin. Their criticism and enthusiasm were invaluable. In the final inning H. V. Nelles willingly stepped up to the plate and read the entire book. I am very lucky to know so many generous scholars. Lastly, I thank my family. My boys, Jack, Nathaniel, and Paul, to my continued bewilderment show an interest in my work that reminds me on a daily basis of the connections between historical scholarship, teaching, and a healthy civil society. Happily, my husband, Matt Leighninger, looks forward to time in Berlin’s Staatsbibliothek as much as I do. He was probably less excited to edit this manuscript, but he did so willingly nonetheless. I dedicate this book to him.

Contents

Abbreviations  xiii

Introduction  1

part i: From Internationalism to “German Advertising” 1. Advertising in the Weimar Republic  17

2. Coordination from Above and Below  47

part ii: Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

3. Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime  91



4. Buyers and Sellers

  136

part iii: Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

5. Advertising in the First Half of the War   185



6. Ads amid Ashes

  227

Notes  269 Works Cited  323 Index  338

Illustrations

1.1 Advertisement for ad space in the Nazi press 41 2.1 The boycott of Jewish businesses, April 1, 1933 49 2.2 Heinrich Hunke, 1935 55 2.3 Proper and improper femininity in advertisements 76–77 2.4 Advertisement with women smoking 78 2.5 Sex still sells in the illustrated press 79 2.6 New state advertising school on KuDamm in Berlin 81 2.7 Cooperative advertisement for barbers 82 3.1 Boys watching Henkel film outdoors 95 3.2 Dreaming of Henkel products 96 3.3 Publicity for Henkel’s whaling expedition 107 3.4 BMW Blätter image 117 3.5 Weimar-era Mercedes-Benz advertisement 119 3.6–7 Mercedes-Benz advertisements, mid-1930s 121–22 3.8 Osram image of city and country unified 126 3.9–10 Osram mimics Nazi propaganda 127–28 3.11 Osram campaign for “better light” 131 4.1–2 Siemens brochure images 137–38 4.3 Camelia in the illustrated press 146 4.4 Fear of infection, Bayer advertisement 148 4.5–6 Competing toothpaste ads from Chlorodont and Nivea 149–50 4.7 Entrepreneur as advertiser 156 4.8 Controversial Fewa advertisement 158 4.9 Caricature of untrustworthy salesmanship 162 4.10 Traveling salesman for Henkel walking above flooded streets 163

xii

Illustrations

5.1 Adman standing strong in war 5.2–4 Advertisements to help Germans cope with war 5.5 Agfa and the separation of war 5.6 Humor in war 5.7–8 Nivea ads—normal life in abnormal times 5.9–10 Dr. Oetker recipes 5.11 Henkel on Hygiene 5.12 1938 RVA washing primer which encourages the use of Persil 5.13 “Johanna is going—but she’ll be back” 5.14 Daimler-Benz stands behind the war 5.15 Henkel products on sale in the Sudetengau 5.16 Signal cover 5.17 Zeiss binoculars advertisement in Dutch 5.18 Reich lottery tickets 6.1 BMW merchandise 6.2 BMW wartime advertisements in multiple languages 6.3 BMW Blätter cover image 6.4 BMW French poster 6.5 Nivea canisters 6.6 Hansaplast on the home front 6.7 Bahlsen’s abstract aesthetic 6.8–9 Bahlsen packaging and classified, 1944 6.10–12 The hope for resurrection: Maggi, Bayer, and a soldier’s obituary 6.13 Nivea postwar advertisement 6.14 Mercedes-Benz and empire

190 192–95 196 198 199 203 206 210 211 216 218 220 221 222 228 231 232 235 238 239 240 242–43 244–45 257 258

Abbreviations

The following abbreviations are used in the text: AFE Working Association for the Advancement of the ElectricEconomy BFC Böhme Fettchemie BIZ Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung DAF German Labor Front DRV German Advertising Association DW Die Deutsche Werbung GfK Society for Consumer Research JWT J. Walter Thompson Advertising Agency NSDAP National Socialist Party of Germany NSRDW National Socialist Reich Association of German Advertisers RMVP Reich Ministry for the People’s Enlightenment and Propaganda RVA Reich Board for Economic Enlightenment Sopade Social Democratic Party of Germany in Exile Werberat Ad Council for the German Economy

Selling under the Swastika

Introduction It serves nothing to depend on past economic forms and social relationships. If we, as a people, do not want to decline, we must become comfortable with the new and emerging world. Advertising is a language of this world.1

This plea, made in 1929, neatly encapsulates the starting point for this book. It comes from the pen of Hans Luther, the deliberately party-less, former chancellor of the Weimar Republic and soon-to-be head of the Reichsbank and ambassador to the United States until 1937. Typical of his entire political career, which included roles in the republic, Nazi dictatorship, and the early Federal Republic, this statement is one that encourages adaptation. The details of how Germans were to “become comfortable with the new and emerging world” and what that world might look like were yet to be determined. What was certain, according to Luther, was that advertising would be a key component of this emerging world, a medium for participating in this transformative process. Men and women working in ads-related jobs certainly welcomed the social and economic significance attributed to their work. Others were more wary of any world in which advertising was to be a central form of expression, and yet even they agreed that the modern advertisement—at once arresting in form or content and banal in its ubiquitous presence—was here to stay. This book takes Luther’s entreaty seriously by examining what advertising in the two decades following this statement can tell us about the ways Germans came to terms with the “new and emerging world.” This process was not a passive one: individuals in a variety of fields championed their own visions of reform or revolution in Germany after the First World War; after 1933 Nazi ideologues and supporters began to implement their utopian blueprint; and the victorious Allies entered the stage with new ideals

2

Introduction

and plans in 1945. With its focus on the Third Reich, this book attempts on one level to tease out the complex relationships between corporations and the regime. These relationships were not equal, but neither was the power of the dictatorship absolute. Rather a bounded relative autonomy characterized the relationship between the National Socialist regime and the commercial sector, including the aspiring advertising profession in the 1930s. Bounded because the regime set certain non-negotiable parameters: anti-Semitic, nationalist, and regenerative, which ad professionals accepted largely without complaint. Relatively autonomous in the sense that both parties wished to maintain a degree of separation, recognized some mutuality of interest, and preferred self-discipline to command and control. At the same time, Selling under the Swastika seeks to go beyond decisions made by corporate elites and the regime’s bureaucrats. By examining the production and circulation of promotional materials, evaluating sales strategies and consumer feedback, the book offers a new perspective on life in National Socialist Germany. I demonstrate that companies and their consumers were fully engaged in the market even into the war years: companies fought to continue advertising, selling, and preparing for expansion, while consumers continued to purchase many products (particularly lowpriced items) they had come to rely on. The book discusses the strategies employed by commercial actors that created ties for consumers between their own material lives and “the new order,” thereby assisting the regime in gaining and maintaining mass support. However, thinking about National Socialism as a “political response to the problems created by consumption” is a more complicated task than simply outlining policies of control and coercion from above, or resistance to those policies from below.2 Instead, the book maintains that the promotion of commerce and a certain Nazi vision of business ethics were intrinsic to the ideological goals of the regime and the dreams of empire after the onset of war. In other words, the regime’s attempts to reach out to those working in the commercial sector and their customers were not driven solely by the need to achieve legitimacy for the dictatorship; consumers and commercial actors had active roles to play in the Nazi utopia.3 In exploring this territory, this study offers three correctives to the existing literature on social cohesion, consumption, and business in the Third Reich. While recent scholarship has convincingly demonstrated that in the mid-1930s most members of the racial community [Volksgemeinschaft] responded positively to the calls for participation in building the new Germany, and experienced this period as a time of pleasure and optimism, this



Introduction

book offers evidence that appeals to community and other Nazi goals came also from the private sector—appeals that were perhaps more persuasive coming from respected national corporations or local employers. 4 It also challenges the dominance of the “virtual consumption” model that emphasizes the importance of state promises of future plenty, by focusing on the actual buying and selling that continued to shape daily life.5 In this way the book uses advertisements to examine the ways brand name goods “became a favorite repository of new Nazi myths and fantasies.”6 Finally, in arguing that the mechanics of individual consumption and the advertising industry that lubricated it were more than just a means of stabilizing the Nazi government, the book redresses our understanding of the legacy of Nazi-era reforms for postwar German developments. Twenty years ago Michael Geyer issued his provocative statement that “the social contract for an acquisitive [German] society was formed in the consuming passions of the 1930s and 1940s rather than in the postwar years.”7 Selling under the Swastika puts Geyer’s declaration to the test. By exploring the mechanisms of German commercial culture between the end of the 1920s and the early 1950s, the book confirms that the language of buying and selling triumphed, despite the war, and re-emerged after 1945 in a position to supersede the language of politics as a unifying force.

consumer culture, commercial culture Nazi Germany was not a mass-consumer society, but it was closer to being one than we often presume. If we apply John Brewer’s six criteria characteristic of mass-consumer societies, Nazi Germany passes easily on all but two, and even those two shortcomings are debatable. This book demonstrates that there were “communication systems that attach[ed] meaningful images to certain goods” and that there was “a shared recognition of commodities as conveyors of meaning.” It is also clear that consumers were viewed as “economic players” and that some citizens had “an ambivalence toward the phenomenon of consumption.”8 What is perhaps missing is the availability of a broad range of products and the emphasis on leisure found in a mass-consumer society.9 The chief sticking point for most scholars with regard to the former point is that the majority of German households were unable to afford consumer durables, such as cars and large household appliances, until the late 1950s. Durables are considered the benchmark in judging the significance of individual consumption in any economy because of

3

4

Introduction

the complexity of these purchases, involving lay-away schemes, credit, or personal savings, and the significance of the manufacturing process, which involves heavy investment of labor and material resources.10 Despite the absence of durables in the majority of German households, individuals did experience a wide range of consumer goods. The wealthy certainly enjoyed a broad spectrum of luxury and daily use items, but the middle and even the working classes also saw their lives changed by a growing range of less expensive products in these decades.11 The issue of leisure is also a tricky one. Hitler’s government certainly prioritized war readiness, which led to a productionist mentality generally, but the labor involved was always coupled with incentives, including greater leisure opportunities for members of the Volk at least until the war began. Despite this proximity to Brewer’s definition and the interest scholars have taken in investigating West German consumer culture, the focus of the historical literature of the Third Reich has been on the production side of the economy. Studies of national recovery and rearmament policies, heavy industry, finance, cartelization, and the use of slave labor during the war years are plentiful. The fact that purchasing power remained low in the 1930s has served as sufficient reason to continue the focus on the economic conditions for waging war.12 However, Albrecht Ritschl maintains that the worst of the Depression was over by 1932, and that the upswing that followed cannot be chiefly attributed to deficit spending in the form of building projects, state employment schemes, or rearmament policies of the new Nazi-led government.13 “With or without Hitler,” Ritschl insists, recovery was “on the doorstep,” and long-term unemployment was becoming less and less of a threat.14 While the debate remains alive and others give much more credit to the “military Keynesianism” of the regime, oral history evidence seems to corroborate Ritschl’s statistical findings that stress improvement in the private sector.15 From these sources, we learn that compared with the upheavals of the 1920s and the Depression years of the early 1930s, many individuals (at least, those not targeted by the regime) developed a sense of optimism about their financial futures in the middle part of the decade.16 André Steiner concurs with this evaluation. Despite the fact that the average real income among workers continued to worsen from 1932 until 1935, only improving thereafter, Steiner emphasizes the psychological significance of stable employment. In other words, even if living standards were only marginally better in 1938 than they had been in 1932, given higher prices and intermittent shortages, family incomes were more secure,



Introduction

and that in itself went far in providing emotional relief for weary Germans and ultimately support for the regime.17 This optimism did not extend to the purchase of large-ticket items; household appliances and cars remained beyond the reach of the vast majority of Germans until the post-1945 period. The “virtual consumption” of such items, however, relied on this optimism—the confidence that ownership was just around the corner. In the meantime, men and women were able to take pleasure in an array of relatively inexpensive nonessential consumer products and leisure activities that were available until the early 1940s.18 This relative contentment among members of the Volk had its political dimensions as well. It appeared that the regime was making good on its promise to stabilize the economy. This real consumption of affordable goods had tangible consequences for the growth and maintenance of support for the dictatorship. Just as heroic images of productive laboring “Aryans” aided the mission of drawing the racial community together,19 certain visions of consuming Aryans also bound the nation more tightly and made it easier to cleave off others from economic and social life. Missing from the debates about the Third Reich has been an examination of the territory that mediates between production and consumption: commercial culture, or “the historically specific and reciprocal interactions of economic and cultural capital.”20 Despite the limits on individual consumption effected by economic policies that prioritized the coming war, commercial culture remained an active and meaningful sphere in which ideological claims about gender, race, the nation, urbanization, consumption, business, health, morality, and pleasure were tested. Advertising, the practice of making others aware of goods and services for sale, is one realm in which these and other historically contingent themes were publicly contested in Nazi Germany. Hitler, Goebbels, and other leaders recognized the importance of reforming practices around buying and selling; this created key opportunities for the advocates of commerce, from advertisers and sales staffs to marketing scientists and even some state and party officials. These individuals worked under very unfavorable conditions in the 1930s and 1940s to make sales and consumption respectable pursuits. Their motivations were manifold. Some advertisers, corporate managers, and sales staff were undoubtedly principled National Socialists.21 Others were likely more motivated by their willingness to further their own careers or bolster the status of their professions or the brands they represented. Corporate leaders also sought to protect their shares of the market and profitability in potentially difficult

5

6

Introduction

financial times. This study does not operate at the level of individual motivations, but what is clear is that those in the private sector who worked to normalize commercial relations during the Third Reich did much to bolster the dictatorship and its policies. They embraced buying and selling as a hallmark of the modern age. Indeed, for some it served as an essential way to participate in the life of the Volk. Moreover, while the postwar Germany that emerged after 1945 was unlike anything they imagined, their actions helped lay the foundations for the consumer desires and demands of the 1950s. Finally, in addition to relying on state and business archives, contemporary theoretical writings, and the trade press, this study contributes to the growing body of historical scholarship that employs visual sources as evidentiary matter. While scholars have already used visual representation to examine the ideology and brutality of the regime, this book argues that advertisements from some of Germany’s most popular brand-name products, then and today, also offer a lens through which to explore the relationships between businesses and the Nazi state, and between members of the Volk and Germany’s political and commercial powers. There was no tremendous rupture in ad culture between the Weimar and Nazi eras, but the changes that did take place were generally welcomed. The resulting mixture of continuity and reform led to a visual culture that was both reassuring in its familiarity and encouraging in its portrayal of Germany’s present path.

advertising and german history Scholars have begun turning to advertisements as key sources for analyzing needs and desires at a particular historical moment. This statement is most true for the United States, where a number of important texts on advertising have become essential reading for making sense of American culture.22 The same cannot be said for Germany. Historians of early twentieth-century Germany have generally stayed away from advertising as either an important subject in its own right or as a way to get at other questions about German society, politics, culture, or economic development.23 Most scholars have concluded that Germany did not have a consumer culture until the 1950s or later, and so issues related to consumption in earlier periods have appeared less significant, particularly given the two world wars that dominated the experiences of Germans in these decades and scholarship since. Historians who might have turned to commercial advertising out



Introduction

of individual interest in visual culture may have chosen to study the vast political propaganda that marked Germany’s tumultuous past with revolution, wars, and dictatorships.24 Finally, there is still some hesitation about what to do with advertisements as historical sources.25 At various conferences, for example, I have been asked how I deal with the “reception problem”—the fact that it is largely impossible to evaluate how individual consumers interpreted the ads they saw. Judging how advertising messages were received is particularly difficult in the pre-1945 era, before consumer surveys and other forms of testing “success” became common in Europe. However, we should not see this point as a major stumbling block to working closely with ads. Instead, as David Ciarlo entreats, we need to look for “a pattern in a downpour.” In other words, by viewing large numbers of images we can begin to see certain patterns that reflect common ways of “crafting and of seeing imagery” in a given time period. Surely there are always individuals (among advertisers and among consumers) who interpreted imagery in wholly unique ways, but we can also presume by looking at the coherence among ads for different products that there were patterns of representation that became so common they constituted a “visual hegemony.”26 By the late nineteenth century, the industrialization and urbanization of Germany meant that more and more products competed for attention in the marketplace. While signage and ads were not new, the vast proliferation of advertising materials around the turn of the century marked a new era in the relationship between sellers and buyers. The ubiquitous nature of ads in the twentieth century, far more prevalent than state-sponsored propaganda even under National Socialism, forces us to examine their relevance in this society. Advertisements are important cultural artifacts that gave shape to the anxieties and aspirations prevalent at this time. Advertisements do not reflect social reality, but they do allow us to consider what ideas circulated under this regime alongside the messages delivered by state and party propaganda, and to what extent they reinforced or diverged from Nazi ideology. While I encourage others to consider how advertisements might aid their own research, let me make a few comments about how I approached the research for this project. It was surprisingly difficult to get access to corporate archives.27 The nature of that reluctance was not always clear, but the two most common answers are somewhat telling of advertising’s lowly status. Some companies had clearly chosen not to save any materials related to advertising. Others had prioritized the archiving of packaging and other

7

8

Introduction

ephemera for their aesthetic value, but had not saved any references to the planning or production of those designs. Clearly the historical worth of ads, beyond their artistic merit, has often gone unrecognized. Moreover, records that might have shed light on how in-house ad departments functioned or about the employees within those departments were generally nonexistent. As a result, beyond a few individuals I am not able to make more than the broadest generalizations about the social backgrounds of Germany’s ad writers and designers. There is also the chance that some companies did not want their brands represented in this book, and other collections were destroyed in the war. Without the luxury of picking and choosing, I examined the papers of any company that welcomed me. A number of these are well known to the scholarly community because they have been willing in the past to allow scholars access: Beiersdorf, Bayer, Henkel, and others. My luck changed somewhat when I realized that the archival holdings of companies nationalized by the East German government had become public materials and were housed since reunification in Germany’s system of state archives. Some key collections came to me in this way, chief among them Osram and Böhme Fettchemie. Regardless of the generosity of some firms and the fortuitousness of GDR policy, the source base for this study may appear haphazard. Another strategy would have been to build the source base from a chosen set of newspapers or illustrated magazines, but I did not want to draw my analysis solely or primarily from published advertisements. Instead I have chosen to rely on companies for which advertisements could be found in the national press and read in conjunction with textual documents left by the ad designers or sales departments. The biggest disappointment of the research stage of this project was that it was nearly impossible to find records from any of the independent ad agencies or placement services that existed in this period. As discussed in the next chapter, there is one very practical reason for this gap. Ad agencies, as we think of them in North America, were quite rare in Nazi-era Germany. The J. Walter Thompson collection at Duke University is an incredible resource, but the American agency was already selling off its Berlin office in 1932 to its German manager. The story at Duke ends with this acrimonious deal, though the new owner continued to operate the agency through the 1930s. German branches of British agencies were also shuttered during the Depression. There are some references in subsequent chapters to the Dorland agency, which quite amazingly survived the war, despite serving as a friendly home to former Bauhaus artists, including most famously Herbert



Introduction

Bayer. Dorland is still open for business in Berlin today and its managers were kind enough to let me look at their historical collection, but it is quite limited in scope particularly for the years of this study. Other agencies and placement services either disappeared altogether during the war years or were bought up by large international firms in the postwar period, and their archives did not survive these transitions. Readers, it is hoped, will agree that the collection of consumer brands presented here, though in no way exhaustive, offers a useful sample of the major brand-name consumer product manufacturers of the day.28 The ads for these products are in part interesting to today’s readers because many of the brands they represent are still available.29 Of course, these big national, and even international, brand-name manufacturers were but a very small percentage of the total number of corporations that placed ads in these years. But as David Ciarlo so clearly demonstrates in his work on the Wilhelmine era, imitation was the name of the game.30 If I were to compile ads for hand crème from a dozen different brands, many would mimic each other in terms of the images and textual tropes used. Each company kept files of competitors’ ads from around Germany and abroad and attempted to incorporate what were thought to be winning ideas in their own promotional materials. Although the more prominent brands had styles that would be recognizable to consumers, this cross pollination does lead to the question: to what extent can any advertisement of this era be considered German or more significantly “Nazi”? As is shown in the first chapter, German ad designers traveled abroad, reviewed ads from other countries, attended international conferences and trade shows, and read foreign professional journals and manuals even after the republican era came to an end. Manufacturers of big brand-name products often had significant export sales and sought efficiencies by using artwork and sometimes text too (albeit in translation) in more than one national market. Commercial culture in the Third Reich was, in Jonathan Wiesen’s formulation, “flexible enough to accommodate publicity norms that were not, as such, ‘German’ and that could be effective beyond the borders of the Reich.”31 Yet there were national peculiarities that resisted dilution. While many of the artistic and conceptual trends should be seen in a larger international context, German advertising also had to remain in sync with its audience at home—and that was an audience that by and large supported the regime and its racist worldview. Designers, copy writers, and sales staff could not make their work relevant if they completely ignored these facts. Nor is it likely that these corporate actors wanted to undercut the regime’s popular-

9

10

Introduction

ity, or run afoul of its authority in any way. Many managers cheered the ascension of the Nazi Party; others directly benefited from the new state’s racist policies that led to the removal of Jews from their positions. For all these reasons, advertisers sought to align the brands they represented with the challenges and “achievements” of the day. In so doing, company directors demonstrated that they were “on board” with the regime, thereby legitimizing the direction of policy and aiding in the establishment of a Nazi lifestyle.32 As one cigarette ad triumphantly announced, “We have learned to see anew, think and feel anew—we also want now to learn to smoke [in a new way]!”33 What does this say about the depth of National Socialist support? Renewed scholarly interest in the concept of a Nazi Volksgemeinschaft has led to a more complete understanding of how the racial community operated at an everyday level.34 John Connelly’s work on Eisenach was an early contribution to the new wave of debate. He argued that a Volksgemeinschaft was never achieved “in the way the party leadership intended,” but that the concept still had significance in Nazi society. Rather than “internalizing” the ideology, Connelly asserted that at the very least many Germans “externalized” it—using the concept of racial community, and the catchwords issued by the state and party, to serve their own individual needs. This book confirms these findings by presenting instances in which commercial and corporate actors mobilized the language of Volksgemeinschaft to suit their own interests. Time and again we are confronted with examples in which advertisers anticipated the regime in its enacting of Volksgemeinschaft. As Connelly explained, this “dynamic of anticipatory compliance gave National Socialism its tenacity and radicalism.”35 From 1933 until 1942, companies used their advertisements in ways that both implicitly and explicitly supported the regime. Consumers sought products to fulfill needs and desires, but consumption was easily reconciled with the ideology. While there were obvious limits in this economy, hobbled first by international financial crisis and then wage freezes and expenditures for war, consumer items could be easily marketed as beneficial to the material or spiritual well-being of members of the Volk. As long as such items existed, the regime was doing what it promised and ads served as a daily reminder of that claim. By 1943, it was impossible to maintain this link between goods and the promises of Volksgemeinschaft, and the production of new ads ceased. Memories of products gone from the shelves inevitably lost their identification with the dreams of the Third Reich, making it possible to resurrect seemingly “untainted” goods in the postwar period as hallmarks of a new consumer society.



Introduction

selling under the swastika The first chapter of the book sets the stage by describing the advertising industry in the Weimar Republic, charting its development in the 1920s and its search for recognition as a valuable and upstanding profession. While German advertisements were well respected throughout Europe and North America for their aesthetic value, at home the industry was still plagued by self-doubt about its economic and social worth. Some Germans remained distrustful of the messages contained in ads, and debate continued about the suitability of the Anglo-American model, in which full-service agencies managed the design and placement of all promotional materials for a brand as part of a concerted effort based on research and planning.36 The chapter, therefore, also touches on the growing interest in the science of marketing, which coincided with the emergence of sophisticated mass media and hotly contested election campaigns in the unfolding crisis of the republic.37 In this shifting climate, we see evidence of changing ad content and new innovations, including the adoption of text-laden ads and the more frequent use of photographs and “scientific proof.” Debate continued, however, and intensified after 1929 as the Depression and political turmoil led some advertisers and other observers to question whether the path of internationalization was the correct one for the industry. The appointment of the Hitler-led government in early 1933 changed the nature of these discussions. The new regime acted quickly. Chapter 2 examines the establishment of the Werberat der Deutschen Wirtschaft, the Ad Council for the German Economy. The minimal scholarship that exists on this body dismisses it as insignificant.38 However, I argue that the Ad Council’s legacy has been largely misunderstood by scholars, who expected heavy censorship of ads and a wholly new and uniform Nazi ad style. Most of the men involved in the Werberat came from the business world; they saw the organization as more akin to a lobbying group positioned to defend advertising from its detractors and improve the industry’s reputation with the public, businesses, and the state. Of course the council’s idea of reform included the purging of thousands of ad professionals who were unable to obtain licenses to practice in the field, according to racial and political/professional criteria. However, this “cleansing” combined with changes to the business side of the industry, including new sizing and pricing, the promotion of systematized training, and the support of marketing science to make a lasting impact on German commercial culture.

11

12

Introduction

Chapter 3 begins a new section that describes the commercial culture of the prewar years. The chapter begins with a discussion of ads in the new media of radio and film. These were innovations introduced well before 1933, but the regime did make its mark. Although Goebbels had outlawed the use of radio as an inappropriate platform for commercial messages, advertisers did hold on to film as a relatively new and exciting platform. Yet print ads remained by far the most popular method for promoting goods throughout this period. In their films, print ads, and other promotional venues, companies sought ways to tap into the Zeitgeist, producing ads that combined national socialist priorities with trends that can be seen in other national contexts in this period. After the Four-Year Plan (1936) began to squeeze manufacturers with shortages of raw materials, restrictions on trade, and war-readiness became a constant refrain, advertisers sought new and better ways to indicate their products’ worth to the Volk. Leaving advertisers behind for the moment, Chapter 4 highlights consumers and salesmen as essential actors in this commercial culture. As other scholars have found, it is very difficult to uncover the experiences of the largely female consumer population, except as mediated by others, such as state representatives or party officials.39 In this case, I turn largely to the writings of advertisers and other corporate staff to argue that manufacturers and retailers had more respect for women’s “power of the pocketbook” and decision-making skills than is commonly recognized. Of course, not all consumers can be lumped together. Although I have tried to stay away from brands seen as luxury goods, the very nature of brand-name products, which represented uniform quality and an investment in promotional efforts to showcase that reliability, meant that these products were generally out of reach for poor Germans. Nonetheless, it is worth noting that unlike in the United States, where purveyors of consumer goods downplayed class differentiation as they sought to create mass markets, advertisers in Germany did not replace all peasants and workers with ideal middleclass families.40 The National Socialist glorification of physical labor and the masculine Aryan body meant that heroic male workers and farmers remained staples in German ad culture, appearing sometimes even in ads that featured plainly middle-class goods, such as the expensive decaffeinated coffee brand Kaffee Hag. Nazi Germany was not a classless society, and this book considers the ways class and gender norms were complicated by racial narratives. Darcy Buerkle has noted, for example, that advertisements in the popular magazine Die Dame in the 1920s regularly depicted feminine traits that are “Jewish-enough” so as to include the possibility of



Introduction

a Jewish-German female shopper. This potential disappears, she argues, by the mid-1930s.41 Perhaps it goes without saying that racial “others” did not play a significant role in advertising in Nazi Germany. Yet hate-filled caricatures of Jews, blacks, and Slavs were common staples of Nazi-era political propaganda, and images of black servants in particular had a long history in Germany’s visual landscape.42 The absence of non-Aryan figures, caricatured or otherwise, is in itself meaningful. While minorities had always been marginalized in German society, their ostracism became state policy after 1933. The “purification” of “German ads” was just one of the myriad ways in which racism was interwoven into the fabric of daily life in Nazi Germany. Moreover, in terms of business ethics, the rejection of an allegedly “Jewish” sales style was implied in every reform. “Honest” business practices were by definition racially circumscribed. With this point in mind, Chapter 4 turns to sales representatives to ask how these commercial actors hoped to fit in to the new marketplace and whether they had a role in the Aryanization of the economy before the war. A discussion of commercial culture during the Second World War is sorely lacking from the vast historiography of the conflict. This lack of attention to advertising, and the efforts of consumer products industries to retain promotional links to consumers at home and abroad, means that we have missed an important part of daily life in Germany and a link between the empire-building goals of the Third Reich and the emergence of West Germany, in particular, as an economic power. While the war led to sharp cuts in manpower and material resources for consumer products industries and prompted some to insist that ads had no place in a war economy, there were others in industry and with links to the government who were concerned about morale on the home front, and fought to maintain some minimum level of consumer satisfaction. Chapter 5 examines this renewed debate over the value of advertisements and asks how individual consumption was thought to fit in with the visions of empire circulating during the euphoric years of military victory. The final chapter of Selling under the Swastika carries the story through defeat and discusses briefly the re-establishment of a German ads industry in West and East Germany. Although conditions on the home front did not completely deteriorate until late 1944, the collapse of the consumer market after 1942 meant that the visual partnership between brand-name products and the Third Reich began to falter. Chapter 6 suggests that this uncoupling of individual consumption and the Nazi worldview in the second

13

14

Introduction

half of the war was instrumental to the postwar rehabilitation of Germany’s consumer goods industries. Messages that linked consumer goods and the regime were largely absent from the landscape, thanks to paper shortages and Allied bombings. In homes ersatz goods had replaced brand names. Long lines, the black market, and going without marked the consumer’s world in the last half of the war, and these experiences only became more desperate in the first postwar years. Manufacturers of brand-name goods, and the commercial sphere more generally, thus escaped the taint of defeat. Ultimately, Selling under the Swastika argues that German companies and the Nazi Werberat were able to save advertising from itself. They convinced Germans that buying and selling were not foreign imports or threats to unity, but in fact ways to belong to the community. Even during the war, ads played a reassuring role by reminding Germans of products they associated with peacetime and by offering strategies to deal with hardship. Though, fortunately, the German empire imagined by these advocates of advertising never came to pass, commercial culture was ready to step forward in postwar Germany as a unifying project that could take the place of a disgraced political culture.

chapter one

Advertising in the Weimar Republic Advertise and don’t despair!1

Writing in the first months of the Third Reich, Hanns F. J. Kropff, a leading German researcher in the science of advertising, began his book: “In a time in which the word ‘rational’ shines as a beacon of light on every wall, it is astounding that German ads in many cases are still ‘driven by emotions.’ The recognition of the utility of a system—in the highest sense of the orderly distribution and design of the advertisement—is still far from commonplace among all those who work [in the industry].”2 Kropff ’s analysis, which began a treatise on the importance of psychology in effective ad design, went on to praise the work of American and British ad designers and included their work time and again in his 1934 text as examples of best practice for understanding human desires and motivations, for incorporating effective use of color and type, and researching market trends.3 Kropff serves as a useful example of the modernist strain in National Socialism. The best way to understand culture in Hitler’s society is not as a “beautiful illusion”—a mirage of light and color that bewitched the spectator, an orderly surface that masked irrationality.4 Rather, someone like Kropff speaks to the ease with which some thinkers moved from the rationalization of the Weimar era to the Nazi period, hopeful that Hitler’s regime would fulfill the promises of reform that had been in the air throughout the 1920s. Kropff was certainly no friend of Weimar, but he believed the call for rationalization that marked the 1920s to be a path to economic success and professional standing for his discipline.5 Like others, he embraced the “experimenting, reordering, reconstructing” mission of National Socialism. It is this “spirit of renovation” that we see emerge out of debates in the republican era and develop more fully after 1933.6 We begin, therefore, with an analysis of German advertising and commercial culture in the 1920s and

18

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

the sometimes collaborative, sometimes competitive, relationship between German advertisers and their Anglo-American counterparts, who led the way designing the “rational” ads that attracted Kropff. Most important, however, the chapter highlights the manner in which commercial actors debated the way forward during the Depression and the political turbulence that accompanied it. In addition to its uses righting the economy, some hoped that what they saw as an international language of ads could promote an understanding between nations that would cement the peace. Others became more protectionist at the end of 1920s and insisted that product promotion should not only highlight the importance of buying home-grown goods but should also represent “national character” in form and content. The chapter discusses these debates and concludes with the offensive of German advertisers like Kropff who adopted the nationalist line as a way to withstand the tumultuous 1920s and prepare a niche for their industry in the coming National Socialist era.

advertising in the 1920s: supporters and critics Germany had a long tradition of commercial advertising. The biannual Leipzig fair had been held since the Middle Ages, drawing exhibitors and attendees from all over the world. Of course, the fair predated the emergence of a German state by several hundred years, but the Germans claimed it as their own, and even boasted of hosting the European marketplace.7 By the second half of the 1920s, the Leipzig fair could in fact be seen, according to Victoria de Grazia, as the center of a new global economy—with regularly sponsored stands representing countries from all corners of the earth.8 But as de Grazia also argues, commercial fairs constituted only one of a growing number of advertising methods by the end of the nineteenth century. Posters, print advertisements and classifieds, shop window displays, branded collectibles such as match books and trading cards, and the verbal advertisements and demonstrations offered by company representatives, retailers, and door-to-door salespeople were taken for granted by most as part of daily life. As radio and film became popular media outlets, advertisements found their ways to those venues as well. In many of these areas, German advertisers and businessmen were not world leaders. The sales tools that most Germans still upheld as the most respectable and dependable were those that had maintained the Leipzig



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

fair as a potent force for hundreds of years: face-to-face meetings between manufacturers, wholesalers, and retailers, the ability to demonstrate the quality of wares and production methods in person, and contracts that were negotiated and signed on the spot. These strategies were far removed from the new mass marketing techniques that focused on investigations of consumer desires increasingly practiced in the United States, and to a lesser extent in Britain. In the years following the First World War, German businesses did not readily embrace change. There were both practical (the ailing economy) and principled reasons (a distrust of imported practices) working against the adoption of new strategies, such as the introduction of customer surveys, the psychological study of consumer behavior, and the growth of full-service ad agencies to handle all aspects of the branding process. In fact, beyond the handful of branches of American and British agencies that opened in the mid- and late 1920s, the concept of the full-service advertising campaign handled by external experts did not really take hold until the 1960s. In the interwar period most German companies continued to handle their advertisements in-house. In 1930, a large retailer with five hundred men and women on its payroll was likely to employ twenty-five to thirty of them in the advertising of its wares.9 Indeed, only a handful of the most established brands had a well-developed image around which they could base an entire promotional program. Ideas for advertisements, according to Alexander Schug, simply flowed from the owners and sales staff to the office in charge of design, or were simply stolen from the advertisements of competitors.10 Satisfied customers were also fond of sending in letters with personal stories, poems, slogans, photographs, and jingles they recommended for use in ads. The motivations behind these suggestions seem to range from real emotional attachment to the brand, and a desire to see it thrive, to the hope that contributing a well-rhymed jingle might lead to remuneration. If the business did not have its own in-house ad department and did not work with a full-service agency or an independent ad designer, a draft of an idea would be sent directly to a graphic artist or printer. In all cases where full-service agencies were not employed, the company or retailer then relied on one of the many placement services [AnnoncenExpeditionen] to handle the business side of seeking out sites and placing advertisements.11 Unlike the American ad agencies that would handle the placement of ads in all media, German placement services tended to specialize in one format, such as print, radio, film, building exteriors, or billboards. Pay-

19

20

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

ment systems were also different in the respective countries. The ad agencies handled the whole account, charging one fee for the production of all materials plus an additional 15 percent for consultation and planning. German businesses seeking to advertise their wares and services were charged in a piecemeal fashion, but the total costs were far lower than working with one of the transplanted Anglo-American full-service agencies. The German businessman paid the graphic artists and printers individually for the advertisements they readied for placement, and then the placement services (of which a business might use several) received a commission for the number of ads “sold” to publishers or other media outlets, deals that often included rebates for the quantity of ad space purchased.12 There were a variety of reasons for the reluctance of some Germans to adopt new advertising methods. First, the whole concept of Propaganda, which was still often used interchangeably with the word for advertising [Reklame], had an unfavorable reputation throughout Europe, owing largely to the deceptions of state and military propagandists during the First World War. These negative connotations combined with older concerns that advertising was an unethical, almost shameful sales strategy— one that would only hurt the company’s reputation in the long run. A company’s goods should win new customers on word-of-mouth reputation alone; quality didn’t need to shout to gain attention.13 Second, per capita income in Germany showed no clear signs of growth between 1913 and 1947.14 Under such circumstances, it was hard for many business owners to invest heavily in new sales methods or even the old ones. The financial instability of the republic not only made it less likely for new investment in large-scale promotional efforts; some consumers also believed that advertising did little more than increase the price of the goods. Creating a brand-name product was therefore risky, not only because of the expense but also because it had the possibility of actually turning away some potential buyers. Third, some advertisers and business owners accepted advertising as a strategy but wanted to conserve the uniquely German style of poster design. Before the war, prominent graphic artists such as Lucien Bernhard and Ludwig Hohlwein had created stark imagery that helped cement the logos and names of some of Germany’s first branded goods in the minds of consumers. Their eye-catching posters, characterized by brilliant colors, minimal text (often just the brand name), and stark imagery were internationally respected. And while this Plakatstil was on the decline in the 1920s, increasingly crowded out by cheaply made and placed print ads, many ad-



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

vertisers in Germany (and other parts of Europe) were unwilling to abandon the poster and its brash style completely out of respect for its aesthetic value and tradition of commercial success. Moreover, the international admiration enjoyed by German artists, including Oskar Kokoschka, Heinrich Zille, and Kurt Schwitters, who worked intermittently for advertisers to make ends meet in the unstable economic climate, reinforced the long-held belief among German business leaders that advertising was best left to the creative genius of the artist. It is also worth remembering that advertising as a profession was less developed than we might expect in Germany in the 1920s, certainly in comparison with the United States. In addition to highly skilled artists that came and went, there was also an influx of young men and women entering advertising and related professions after the war. During the period of relative economic stability in the mid-1920s, and the concomitant growth of mass media and individual consumption, there were new jobs to be had in this sector. Either classroom training or workplace experience in sales, decorating, journalism, or graphic arts could lead someone toward a career in advertising. Without formalized professional standards of training, advertising was wide open to young urbanites from a variety of backgrounds.15 In Erich Kästner’s sardonic 1931 novel Fabian: The Story of a Moralist, the university-trained protagonist describes himself in the opening scene as “Fabian, Jacob, aged thirty-two, profession variable, at present advertising copywriter.” Later in the novel, when he is asked by a colleague what will happen if he loses his job writing advertisements for a cigarette company, he answers: “Do you think I’ve spent my life since the day I was confirmed making good publicity for bad cigarettes? When these people kick me out, I shall look for a new profession. One more won’t make much difference to me.”16 This lack of a uniform path into advertising meant that disseminating the theories of scientific selling was a slow process, but it also meant that marginalized groups, chiefly women and Jews, had a chance of making inroads into these new fields. Women first took up positions in store window decorating, for which their domestic skills were thought to be a useful foundation. They also had success entering ad departments as entrylevel artists, creating sketches or painting in the final image according to a male artist’s directions.17 Over time some women moved up within ad departments or chose to work independently. Likewise, Jews did not find anti-Semitic barriers to be as difficult to hurdle as in more established professions. Jews from retailing families, in particular, likely found this an easy

21

22

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

step to take. Youthful advertisers may have also had a slight advantage in their work. Other white-collar professions were also expanding, leading to greater purchasing power among this sector of young consumers, including the so-called new women. Employers of advertisers needed to take this fact seriously, one expert warned: “[The advertiser] will only hit the mark with these new, young consumers, if his ad speaks to them in a youthful tone!”18 While the poster tradition continued to find supporters in 1920s Germany, practitioners did incrementally turn their attention to the technical side of selling, thinking ever more seriously about the impact of color, lighting, size, and other aspects of form and content in their posters rather than artistic merit alone.19 The professional journal founded in 1921, Das Plakat [The Poster], changed its name in 1924 to Gebrauchsgraphik [Graphic Art], signaling the shifting emphasis toward a wider variety of media and more psychologically savvy design methods, even if the business side of advertising remained fairly constant.20 Alongside these financial, professional, and aesthetic challenges of the 1920s, anti-advertising sentiment was also fed by much older anti-Semitic stereotypes of the conniving, swindling Jewish merchant.21 While a prejudicial association between Jews and less-thanhonorable sales practices was well ingrained throughout Europe, it gained renewed legitimacy at the start of the twentieth century when revived by leading German intellectuals who feared new forms of capitalism, which included mass production, department and chain stores, and, of course, ads. In his 1911 treatise The Jews and Modern Capitalism, the sociologist Werner Sombart claimed that the eighteenth-century practice of Jewish clothiers who “seized the passer-by by the arm and tried to force him to make purchases” had developed into the contemporary sales aim “to get hold of the customers.” Sombart targeted the sales practices of large brand-name firms such as AEG, a company that happened to have been founded by the Jewish Berlin patrician Emil Rathenau in 1883. The older, “disorderly” attempt to grab hold of potential customers, explained Sombart, was first “systematized when advertising was resorted to.” While Sombart admitted to having no “conclusive evidence,” he was clearly comfortable (and influential) connecting the dots, concluding that “their [Jews’] claims to be the fathers of modern advertising are equally well established.”22 Before the First World War, therefore, those German business elites who did see an economic benefit in advertising still felt it necessary to write pleading commentaries on the value of product promotion for the national economy. Christian Adalbert Kupferberg was one of the earliest



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

and most vocal businessmen to make the case for the value of ads, as well as the need to study the topic systematically in order to develop the most effective advertising possible. The scion of the eponymous sparkling wine producers from Mainz, C. A. Kupferberg started an ad department in his family’s business in 1909, allegedly causing a great rift between himself and his scandalized uncle, who eventually sold off his share of the family firm.23 The young Kupferberg traveled frequently to the United States, and was an honorary member of the Advertising Club of Baltimore. He wrote in 1914: “Those who are not close to the sales profession and the advertising work that is connected to it will seldom realize what extraordinarily high significance advertising has for our economic life today.” It was astounding, he continued, given the “millions and millions” that the ad industry generated in terms of employment and profits that there was really no professional training or systematic study of the “scientific discipline.” Further, he bemoaned the fact that in Germany the “sales profession” did not enjoy the esteem that it deserved as the most important “factor in purchasing [Erwerbsfaktor] in the nation.”24 His recipe for improving the situation was fairly simple, calling for uniform training and closer attention to the study of psychology. He also advocated for the most rudimentary market research, such as gaining a profile of the readership of a newspaper or magazine before making choices about where to place advertisements. Kupferberg recognized the difficulty of convincing Germans that advertising worked. He concluded with a reminder (in a rather transparent reference to some of the biggest brand-name products of his day) that fifty years prior there had been no serious market for mouthwash, facial creams, and other cosmetics, but ads had “first taught us to use these things.”25 The number of people who, like Kupferberg’s uncle, rejected advertising altogether became smaller and smaller in the early 1920s, while the debate about how best to advertise grew more intense, as evidenced by the burgeoning number of journals devoted to the topic. Kupferberg remained adamant that Germany suffered because of the lack of respect and attention given to advertising. In comparison to American magazines, he noted in 1921, German advertisement sections lacked order and taste and therefore efficacy. They could be compared, he insisted in a metaphor that demonstrated his fervent nationalism, with “a Polish parliament, the assemblies of which were characterized by everyone clamoring at once rather than an orderly assembly.” Without proper regulations and planning, he implied, all voices were lost in the din.26 On one hand there were reasons to be hopeful for men like Kupferberg. The postwar urban environment was

23

24

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

awash in new advertising opportunities.27 Only ten to fifteen years prior, an advertiser had only three major choices for placement: newspaper classifieds, poster columns, or hoardings—there were only a handful of lighted ad signs in all of Germany in 1914. By the 1920s, Kupferberg could rejoice that “the railways, street car companies, the postal service, shipping lines, as well as countless landlords, and owners of gardens and fencing hoped to rent out surfaces to advertisers.” These public spaces joined the fray alongside other emerging alternatives: “address book inserts, newspaper binders, mobile loudspeakers, table lampshades, match stands and more.” Berlin alone had three thousand lighted advertisements in 1929, and the use of color in neon displays would continue to expand after 1933.28 On the other hand, Kupferberg harbored the fear that the results of this “ad-flood” would be increasing immunity to the messages among consumers, leading to greater and greater expenditures on ads that held less and less value in the crowded marketplace. The danger mirrored the snowballing effects of the inflationary monetary situation that Germany was experiencing as Kupferberg penned his essay.29 The sensory onslaught of advertisements brought with it other dangers, according to some medical officials. As early as the eighteenth century, doctors had claimed that individual consumption was linked with intoxication and hysteria among women.30 Throughout the nineteenth century, cultural critics and medical professionals continued to characterize female shoppers as particularly susceptible to the chicanery of unscrupulous retailers and ad men.31 The ever-expanding world of consumption and the new media forms that promoted it intensified concerns about the masses, particularly women, becoming overwrought with emotion. As Paul Lerner notes, criminologists continued to insist into the early twentieth century that the desire to consume among female shoppers could become uncontrollable in the presence of elaborate displays of goods, leading to unwise purchases and even kleptomania.32 For those as convinced as Kupferberg of the potential of advertisements to power the economy, this flood was no real obstacle. Rather the vast quantity had the potential to push advertising to achieve higher standards of quality. Advertisers would seek out the best sites and reject the old chaotic “shrieking” that seemed to echo off the hoardings. Furthermore, Kupferberg claimed that more rational, effective forms of advertising had the potential to beautify the city by bringing art to the streets. Surely it was a matter of opinion, he admitted, whether one felt “the undecorated streetcars of the old type looked better than the streetcars of today with their



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

new, colorful, in many cases artistically pleasing pictures.” But it was clear where he stood on the matter: “A metropolis is no idyllic countryside. The advertisement belongs in its goings-on [treiben], like the crowd, the blare of the automobile horn and the dust of the streets.”33 With this kind of declaration, advocates of advertising were confronting head-on another set of detractors: those who decried advertisements as unsightly. As Thomas Lekan explains, the German Homeland Protection Society, which led the Heimatschutz movement, has been rehabilitated in recent years by environmental historians who now see the organization’s conservation work between 1880 and 1914 as akin to later attempts to create an “environmentally sensitive modernity.” However, Lekan thinks we have overlooked the subject of advertising in our revisionist understanding of Wilhelmine Heimatschutz.34 To these protoenvironmental activists, perhaps the biggest defiler of Germany’s pristine landscape was not industry or changes to infrastructure, but advertisements, particularly those posters and billboards geared toward tourists en route through the countryside. To the cultural elites involved in the Heimatschutz movement, all the signage for inns, pubs, and tourist sites also signaled the birth of a mass tourism that challenged class boundaries and bourgeois understandings of leisure and consumption.35 After a hiatus during the First World War, the Heimatschutz movement continued to fight for legislation against advertisements in rural communities and along country roadways. Even in the urban context, many supporters of this movement thought that ads were fundamentally bothersome and should face strict regulation. As one commentator insisted, “The home, not only in the narrow sense but also in the broader sense of the word, should offer complete peace and relaxation after all the confinement and disquiet of the workday; therefore all residential streets should also be kept free of unnecessary noise and also from the pestering disturbances to the eyes [caused by ads].”36 Many German cities ultimately established successful commissions in the 1920s that brought together citizens, city officials, and representatives of industry to find ways to integrate advertising in a manner acceptable to all stakeholders.37 There was, however, no national solution, and the debate would begin anew in the National Socialist era.38 Beyond the important issues of preservation versus commercialization, the controversy also reminds us of the divisions that still existed between city and country in the interwar years.39 The differences between life in the metropolis and life in the village, however, did not always lead to a rejection of ads in the countryside. While there was an increasing acceptance of ads as central to the modern

25

26

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

cityscape, some far away from Germany’s bustling metropolises also came to recognize the significance that advertisements might hold for their own economic and cultural futures. Provincial retailers on occasion felt compelled to remind the big companies whose products they sold not to forget them—they too deserved the most up-to-date promotional efforts from which urban retailers presumably benefited.40 The urban marketplace was also becoming more complex. The country’s cities were not just larger than ever before, they were far more diverse. As one observer put it in 1929, Berlin had completely changed in the last fifty years, owing to an annual influx of 100,000 newcomers from around Germany and beyond. According to one practitioner, those who wanted to get their messages across to consumers had to recognize that the “native Berliner” [Urberliner] of old, who would have understood a classified that reminded the reader simply to “buy chocolate at Hildebrandt’s” or a “hat at Reiser’s on King Street” was “nearly extinct.”41

encounters with british and american ads and advertisers This criticism was mainly reserved for the classifieds placed by smaller, local companies and retailers, who had failed to update their sales methods or think seriously about their copy in the 1920s. For larger firms who marketed popular brand-name items throughout Germany, the stabilization of the economy in the second half of the decade allowed for greater investment and even experimentation with design and copy. While the debates about how to advertise effectively continued, the discussion became more international, just as the number of international institutions (business, political and cultural) and brands was also growing. Like German businessmen who were drawn to the United States for study tours of cutting-edge production facilities, German advertisers traveled to the U.S. to visit the big full-service ad agencies, listen to experts, and meet with professional associations and chambers of commerce.42 Even the most widely read illustrated magazine of the era, Die Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung (BIZ), joined in the game by commissioning Arthur Rundt, who in 1926 had written a popular travel book on the United States called America Is Different [Amerika ist anders], to return to America and report back on that nation’s “highly developed, to us still somewhat foreign methods to advertise wares and ideas.”43



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

Although the U.S. consumer-driven economy was the success story to many, scholars agree that attempts to import American promotional methods were integrated only partially, and none were quick to take hold during the 1920s.44 At the start of the decade, Christian Kupferberg pointed out that German advertisers were too prescriptive in their methods compared with the creativity of the Americans, who thought about how to foreground the “appeal” (English in the original) of the commodity first, and then began convincing the reader that brand x was the best version. And yet he too recognized that this style of advertising could not simply be dropped into German print ads. American designers downplayed the artwork in favor of argument and the ability to reach a diverse consumer market; German readers simply did not view the advertisement sections in the press “as an educational or valuable extension of the news section” and so would miss the instructions provided.45 Rundt’s 1928 article made clear in its very title, “The Controllable USA-mind,” that the popular vision of American consumption and marketing was not necessarily one Germans valued, and that their advertisers and public relations experts represented a very different breed of commercial actor—they even worked with their office doors open.46 In 1930, an author in Die Reklame still insisted that using as few words as possible in advertisements was what fit the German consumer best. American consumers were frequently forced to read “novellas, biographies, cultural history essays” that would simply bore the “adindifferent or ad-resistant” German reader.47 While they debated the efficacy of “teaching ads” from the United States, German ad men and their business colleagues also remained keenly interested in what their European neighbors were up to in terms of advancements in branding and artistry.48 Particularly after the 1922 fascist takeover in Italy, for example, congratulatory articles in leading journals of the German trade press, such as Die Reklame and Seidels Reklame, about the modernization of media and design in that country became common. In other words, we should not forget that practitioners were also open to innovations from other European countries and still reasoned that in the end each country’s advertisers needed to determine what worked best among its own population. Nonetheless, German advertisers and their employers were confronted most squarely by the alternative model of the AngloAmerican full-service agency, because a number of the largest agencies in the United States and Britain decided to try their hand at breaking into the German market around 1927, shortly before the Depression brought those ventures to a halt.

27

28

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

The most prominent firm to expand into Europe was the largest American ad agency, J. Walter Thompson (JWT).49 Sam Meek, who had been working for a small New York ad agency, was brought over to JWT in order to be shipped to London and from there to plan and direct Continental expansion. By the beginning of 1926, Meek and Stanley Resor, working together in London, had decided to extend their services “to any client in any part of the world where there was enough business to warrant them.” Mainly representing American companies abroad, JWT’s decisions about where to open branch offices were typically dictated by the firm’s largest client, General Motors. By 1927 James Webb Young had arrived in London, accompanied by “seven men, three wives, one baby and a cat,” with the mandate to establish an office in every country where GM had a manufacturing plant.50 JWT could boast thirty-three offices around the world by 1930.51 The Berlin office, which opened in 1927, was among the first and in 1930 was still predicted by the agency “to become the most important office in Europe.”52 In the short period that the office was open, the staff tried convincing German firms to invest in JWT’s full-service strategy. To do so, they worked with a largely German staff, though the office manager, Kennett Hinks, was an American and the art director, George Butler, hailed from Britain.53 What they were offering, of course, was still quite foreign (and expensive) to the Germans.54 And there was a certain mutual lack of enthusiasm. Butler, for one, considered German ads rather “brutal and ponderous” and believed there to be “subtler and more effective ways of instilling positive interest in the public concerning a commodity than by shouting.”55 As a more diplomatic JWT research report put it in January 1928: “The mechanics of advertising receive much more attention [in Germany] than the message. Art is apparently desired that attracts attention as ‘clever art.’ . . . This emphasis on catching attention by extraordinary appearance has the natural result of reducing both the amount, the conception of the importance, and the quality of the copy.”56 The JWT style, in contrast, depended far less on imagery, and was often limited to “little line drawings” dwarfed by a great deal of instructional text. The copywriter (who in the case of JWT was often female) tried to convince consumers to change their habits in ways that would lead to new or greater numbers of purchases: changing shirts more regularly and therefore using more detergent, trying a Pyrex cooking pot and eventually buying a whole set of new cookware.57 The JWT style also differed in the amount of research that was conducted in advance of the campaign’s design.58 For example, media research done by JWT in the United States found that the only section of the news-



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

paper that all family members read was the comics. And so JWT began writing comic strip advertisements, often with the same humorous narrative style as a noncommercial strip.59 This method, and humor more generally, was slow to be adopted in Germany, but it did make some inroads into ad culture throughout the interwar period.60 JWT also immediately undertook its own market research in Europe. In the summer of 1928, Sam Meek reported proudly that “222 different investigations” had been conducted in the past eighteen months, encompassing “37,076 consumers and 7,010 dealers—a total of 44,086 interviews in 13 different countries. There were 83 investigations on food products, 31 on drugs, 55 on motor cars and 14 on media. . . . All these investigations are done by natives of the countries in which they are conducted.”61 Summing up the differences between American and German advertising, the JWT researcher writing in 1928 concluded arrogantly that it represented a gap of about “30 years.”62 The tension between German businesses and the American and British agencies that arrived in the late 1920s, such as JWT, Dorland, W. S. Crawford, and Erwin, Wasey, never truly subsided. We might speculate that in time and under different economic and political circumstances, these firms would have had greater success winning German clients to complement their largely American and British brand portfolios, but when the Depression hit, a number of the major accounts that served as anchors to these recently founded branch offices pulled out of the German market. It was not, therefore, the rise of National Socialism that led to the departure of the Anglo-American full-service agencies, but rather the economic collapse. One agency with American origins, Dorland, was able to benefit from the exodus of its competitors.63 By 1929 Dorland’s Berlin bureau was directed by the experienced German ad man Walter Matthess, who moved quickly to take over the remaining accounts of Erwin, Wasey and then W. S. Crawford when both agencies liquidated their Berlin offices in the early 1930s. Dorland had already gobbled up the well-known local agency Deutscher Reklamedienst, extending its reach and reputation among native German brands. When Matthess then bought out all of the remaining Dorland shares held in New York by Condé Nast, the agency became solely German; Mathess’s prescience positioned Dorland to thrive through the 1930s and, with only a relatively short interruption during the war, into the postwar period.64 By the early 1930s JWT, on the other hand, had lost the all-important General Motors account—a result of the slumping market for passenger vehicles and the fact that the German GM subsidiary did not like having

29

30

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

its artwork come from London. The departure of GM was a major blow to the Berlin office. In 1931, Ken Hinks returned to the United States, having never felt at home in Berlin. According to his colleague, Butler, Hinks had been unable (or unwilling) to learn the language and “didn’t like the German way of doing business either; none of us did. . . . Cheating was universal.”65 Allegations of underhanded practices plagued the industry in the 1920s, causing concern not only among foreigners like Butler and Hinks but among German ad men as well.66 Although ad agencies and placement firms were also criticized for their own lack of transparency with regard to their services and pricing, the most common charge was that publishers were unwilling to make public accurate and up-to-date circulation figures, so advertisers (and their customers) never knew for certain how many readers they were reaching. The publishers’ practice of awarding rebates to advertisers for the size of their orders was also targeted as unfair. Rebate levels were totally arbitrary, negotiated case by case, leaving many suspicious that competitors got better deals. It also meant that owners of small businesses, in particular, were vulnerable to untruths from placement service firms about the actual costs of their inserts. The handful of full-service agencies like JWT believed that by avoiding these middle men and dealing directly with the publishers, they would develop more transparent relationships that would pay off down the road. They sought to convince German customers that as newcomers they might not get the best rebates at the start, but would be in a better position to negotiate in the future.67 It was hard for some local clients to understand this approach. In 1932, JWT reported that a number of accounts held by European branch offices were pressing to treat the ad giant like a placing service, and trying to pay “lower commission rates based on the grounds either that our own campaigns are mere adaptations of those prepared in London or Paris, or that they would be satisfied with mere translations of those being used in America.”68 JWT headquarters was unwilling to budge on its full-service mantra and local attention, reasoning that even during the Depression the company would rather lose smaller accounts than give up on its successful American formula. And yet it was clear that if JWT Berlin was to survive in this form, it would need to acquire more domestic German clients. With this goal in mind, the decision was made to replace Hinks with the office’s first German manager, the young Fritz Solm, educated at Columbia University and trained at the London JWT office before moving back to his native country to work in the Berlin office. Solm kept the agency going in the capital throughout the 1930s. At first the firm was



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

operated under the J. Walter Thompson name, but Solm soon had a falling out with his former employers over the conditions of his purchase of the agency. Despite, or perhaps because of, the acrimonious parting of ways between JWT and its first German manager, Solm become a significant figure in the German ad world after 1933. While the American and British ad agencies retreated from the Continent in the early 1930s, leaving most companies to continue handling their advertising in-house, the scientific selling promoted by the large agencies, among others, had put down roots that had taken hold. As the Reichardt Cocoa Company told its sales staff at the end of 1932, it would be a mistake to reject market analysis, even though, “like many buzzwords,” it had “become banal and been misused.” “We must, if we want to have further success be attentive to the signs of the times.”69 However, while German advertisers remained interested in the design innovations around Europe and the market research and instructional copy coming out of the United States and Britain, what most occupied their thoughts as the economic conditions worsened was the more fundamental quandary of escaping the mistrust of their work and salesmanship more broadly defined. This challenge seemed increasingly difficult, despite the fact that the slump had scared off much of their foreign competition.

the challenge of the depression To improve the image of the ad industry many German advertisers at the end of the 1920s favored the adoption of reforms in education and professional development. Despite a few programs at various business colleges, there was no uniform training for advertisers. In degree-conscious Germany, this was a major disadvantage to working in an ads-related job. The fact that no comprehensive exams had been passed, and no diploma awarded, only fueled the public stereotype of the ad man as huckster. The tradition of respecting artistic genius—a quality that transcended the practicalities of classroom teaching—had added to the difficulties of coming to consensus about a proper curriculum that could bestow professional status. But by the late 1920s, influenced also by the Anglo-American advertisers, who Germans (perhaps mistakenly) believed enjoyed greater respect in their home countries and by the growing Continental interest in psychology, psychoanalysis, and even sociology, most German advertisers had concluded that it was time to set some standards.

31

32

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

When the members of the German Advertising Association (DRV), an umbrella group encompassing everyone from window dressers to independent ad consultants and graphic artists, gathered to discuss their collective future in 1928, they drew also on a certain level of injured national pride to fuel the enthusiasm for reform. Many German advertisers had had enough of articles like the one in the chief American professional journal, Advertising and Selling, that had been reprinted in Die Reklame and began: The German mentality is strange. [Germans] understand better than other nations the most dense and complicated things. Yet they don’t understand the simplest things. Perhaps this explains the fact that German industrialists still have not fully grasped the fact that advertising is a force that deserves respect. If Germany finally recognizes that advertising is lucrative, it will take greater steps on the path to leadership [Führerschaft] than ever before. I bought a product in Munich that appears to render the analogous American commodity worthless. Was it being advertised? Of course not!70

In the hope of overcoming this criticism, the DRV set three goals for 1929: the “unity and recognition” of all those working in the field; the “creation of systematic, practical and, theoretical training” for everyone in advertising; and the creation of an “office for the assessment of ad materials [Werbsachenprüfamt].” Those planning for the industry’s future also believed that the high percentage of “untrained” professionals hurt the entire ad industry, remarking that virtually no one was prevented from taking a job in advertising or kept out of the professional associations. Not only were there calls for standards among each professional grouping, but also demands for the establishment of city and state advertising schools. Once such uniform training was available, the DRV would be in the position to insist that it be a requirement for admission to the appropriate professional associations. “If the German ad industry makes these changes in 1929,” concluded the author for the DRV, “German businessmen will be convinced more than ever before of the work of advertising, and those abroad will not be able to deny it its due.”71 Regardless of the apparent self-doubt among Germany’s ad professionals, the country could boast an extensive academic and professional literature beyond the trade journals. Dating back to the start of the century, books by Paul Ruben, Viktor Mataja, Rudolf Seyffert, Hans Weidenmueller, and even Christian Kupferberg (from the corporate side) were respected for their serious technical and theoretical contributions.72 There were also institutes in Cologne, Mannheim, Berlin, and Düsseldorf that continued this academic research. Some local and regional associations of-



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

fered continuing education courses and lecture series for men and women already working in the field. What was missing, according to the DRV, was midlevel specialized professional training to bring together the scientific and the practical.73 Once again the DRV highlighted the progress the United States had made in this area years earlier. In a long 1930 article written by the American ad man William Ingersoll, readers of Die Reklame learned how after years of similar struggle, members of New York’s Advertising Men’s Club had stumbled upon the work of Frank Parsons, the former professor of psychology and founder of the New York School of Fine and Applied Arts, who helped them establish the foundations of a unified curriculum.74 It is worth noting, however, that while German advertisers seeking greater status for their field turned to the United States for examples, the debate about professionalization was actually far from over in the United States in the 1920s. Roland Marchand highlights two sides of the American debate. Some advertisers expected that the new degrees and awards handed out by universities such as Harvard should and would lead to greater recognition, putting them on par with doctors and lawyers as providing an important social service through their work. There were others, however, who rejected such lofty goals, and insisted that advertising be accepted for what it was—a supremely useful way to increase profits. In this view, worrying about contributing to the social good, or meeting artistic goals, only fed doubts among businessmen that advertising was not crucial to the corporate bottom line. Emphasizing the role that ads could play in sales was the only sensible strategy.75 German advertisers do not appear to have split down these lines, believing instead that their service to society was to bolster the economy through the education of consumers. Despite the declining economic outlook, the industry did have cause for celebration as 1929 arrived. The decision to hold the annual International Advertising Association Congress in Berlin was confirmed.76 This announcement seemed likely to aid all the goals set by the DRV: fostering unity within the association, developing further training opportunities and standards, and advancing their position as a respected profession among business leaders and the public both at home and abroad. The congress had been hosted by American cities in all previous years, except 1924 when London enjoyed the honor. Being granted the same opportunity was a hopeful sign to German advertisers that their contributions to the field were beginning to be noticed among their colleagues abroad. And when news arrived in late 1928 that the Americans

33

34

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

planned to send a contingent to Berlin larger than the twenty-five hundred who had attended the London congress, members of the DRV grew giddy with anticipation.77 The congress opened on 11 August 1929 and was visited by five thousand advertisers from more than twenty countries. The delegates were busy over the four days with much “speech-applauding, back-patting, beer-quaffing, [and] sightseeing,” according to the reporter for the American news magazine Time. In addition to the four thousand bottles of wine consumed by the twenty-five hundred banquet attendees, there were a variety of serious issues considered, including the role advertising could play for churches and, once again, whether billboards were ruining the German countryside—a criticism raised this time by an American speaker.78 The overriding message of the congress was to convince those watching that advertising, “with all its possibilities of development, studied and investigated by the most able intellects, will introduce a new factor into World Trade, will become the key to universal prosperity.” But this confidence that advertisers could right the economic decline was not the only conclusion that the congress organizers wanted to resonate beyond the walls of the banquet halls. Meeting a decade after the conclusion of the First World War, and with fascism on the rise in Europe, the German hosts also advocated for “peaceful competition” among nations. Advertising, they explained, served as “a free outlet for those forces that formerly led to discord and trouble, [as] the active self-assertion of nations towards the outside world by means of no other weapon than peaceful trade.”79 On the occasion of the meeting, Hanns Brose, one of the most prolific and successful German ad men of his age, who got his start at the Berlin branch of the American firm Dorland, took the opportunity to evaluate what Germany could learn from other countries and vice versa.80 He began by admitting the influence that other nations—namely, the United States— had had on German advertising in the previous decade, largely owing to the political and economic context of postwar reconstruction. The Germans were just getting started, but the “others” had already built “a house with a strong foundation, well lighted rooms, sensible and comfortable, hygienic and aesthetically pleasing . . . . [On] the pediment of the house “The New Advertising” we read the word truth [italicized words are English in the original]. . . . We have learned to love these others as one loves an older and successful brother.” Brose was completely convinced that the American-built house was the model to emulate, and “though [it was] still under debate,” he implored his German colleagues to “recognize that the



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

basis for effective advertising is not the aesthetic, rather the psychological, that advertising is not designed with artistic methods as much as persuasive ones.” Brose also pointed out that those outside of Germany must respect the give-and-take nature of the relationship—that they would not always hold the lucky hand. Dropping “American text” into German ads would meet with little success. Just as novels and films from abroad did not always speak to “the German psyche,” neither would advertisements that were not created with a German audience in mind. The transatlantic collaboration via study tours and the work of international associations over the last several years had shown Brose, as the World Congress organizers also claimed, that advertisements could contribute to understanding between nations through the economic trade and cultural contact they represented. And as each side learned about the “psychological conditions” of the other, they could become “equal rivals—and partners in a common cause.”81 Men like Brose did not just pin their hopes on advertising’s potential to encourage international peace and prosperity. They also quite sincerely believed that advertising, and their own roles as purveyors of these messages, had a significant role to play in improving the quality of life of their countrymen. Brose would go so far as to say, at the very end of 1929, “Advertising is the only truly democratic manifestation of public life today.” For if everyone was still beholden to various higher authorities, “in our economic decisions we are free.” In fact, Brose hailed, there was “no power on earth” that could force an individual to make a purchase he did not choose to make.82 In the early 1930s, against all evidence to the contrary, advertisers like Brose held on to the image of friendly international collaboration, the idealistic vision of individual consumption as democratic, and the belief that their work was essential to both domestic and international peace and prosperity. The worsening economic crisis led supporters of advertising, such as Alfred Knapp, to press more energetically for a comprehensive training site for ad men and women. In April 1931 he once again insisted that individual consumption was as essential to economic health as production. “It is a clear duty of the government and Germany business community,” Knapp explained, “to provide the necessary means to establish [the German Institute for Advertising Science], the success of which will benefit the entire economy.” Knapp referred specifically to the research monies enjoyed by the Association of German Engineers, and drew on the words of experts who had argued recently in the press and parliament that scientific research was a critical investment during these economically difficult times. Knapp

35

36

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

also highlighted the Empire Marketing Board of Britain, which spent a majority of its budget on research.83 A similar body in Berlin would be well placed to collaborate with the Handelshochschule, and the research institutes for the press [Deutsches Institut für Zeitungskunde] and for economics and business [Institut für Konjunkturforschung]. The institute would serve as a clearinghouse for all literature produced on advertising, including the various professional journals, and house an archive of current and historical advertising materials. It would gather statistical information about the German market, frame the big theoretical questions about efficacy, provide practical advice to those in the field, and explore noncommercial promotional efforts—what Knapp called “Idea-Advertising” for politics, religion, and public welfare.84 It was an ambitious proposal, and with the economy in a nosedive, Knapp’s vision was not to be realized. The amount of advertising appearing in newspapers and magazines was shrinking, according to one Hamburg newspaper, at a faster rate than purchasing power was dwindling. As consumers became more cautious with their remaining funds, companies anticipated the drop in sales and withdrew their ads from the press to minimize their own losses. Naturally, this retraction weakened the financial health of the press, as well as the advertisers and consumer goods industries more generally. In what appeared as a rather bold and unusual move, the Hamburger Fremdenblatt took out its own ads in its publication—not encouraging people to buy the paper, but explaining to readers that the economy would not improve with such pessimism and fear, reminding business owners that investment in the future was still necessary, and warning everyone that all sectors of the economy were dependent on one another.85 Articles like this one became more and more prevalent. Politics too became more evident in the public discussions of the industry. Some authors said outright that the spirit of the times was one that encouraged “collectivism” in response to financial expediency. Gemeinschaftswerbungen, ads that promote a whole sector, such as the milk industry, became more common and helped businesses pool their dwindling funds. While this response to the economic crisis was acceptable to most advertisers, anxiety grew that the trend away from competition might lead to a future in which ads were wholly superfluous.86 As the DRV planned its “Advertising Day” for 1932, they selected the rather desperate-sounding slogan “Advertise and Don’t Despair!” to promote the event. The meeting’s organizers emphasized that their work was not self-indulgent, and reiterated that without ads there are no sales. At



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

the same time, however, there was also a greater connection than ever to the dire political context and the deepening influence of the right. On the meeting’s agenda were speeches on “Advertising and the State” and “Advertising and Politics,”87 presented by conservative dignitaries who stressed the importance of advertising for German-made products. Germany’s weaknesses in foreign policy since 1918, explained one orator, could also be traced back to the fact that “our enemies have held the upper hand, because they mastered the art of [political] advertising.”88 The overlap between propaganda of the political sort and propaganda of the commercial sort was never far from the minds of advertisers during the republican period. The Weimar era was marked by growing political discord accompanied by extensive political propaganda in daily life—from election posters and speeches, to articles in the politicized press, and uniformed marches and mass rallies, which were often followed by violence in the final years of the republic. By the summer of 1932, the American and British agencies were gone from German soil, and nationalist messages were common. One speaker during the DRV’s “Advertising Day” charged Britain’s Empire Marketing Board of serving as a well-coordinated cover for that nation’s own policies of further weakening Germany’s economic health by dampening the desire in Britain for German imports. Others criticized what they saw as the “disfigurement” of the German landscape “almost without exception” caused by the ads of “foreign companies . . . , which would never be tolerated in their own countries.”89 In such a climate, it was hard to see any hope for transnational commercial cooperation as a conduit for international peace, as Brose and others had championed only three years earlier.90 After the onset of the Depression, the German Housewives Association, with the assistance of German manufacturers, began promoting “buy German” campaigns that rejected imports in order to save jobs at home. This nationalist work, supported by propaganda that declared “Germany’s fate lies in the hands of the German housewife,”91 recognized the political and economic power of the female consumer, who was responsible (according to oft-cited statistics) for between 66 and 80 percent of all purchases.92 The campaigns also made women’s lives more complicated by encouraging them to forgo foreign products that might have made their domestic labor easier or more pleasant.93 In addition to buying German products, some advertisers sought ways to “help” German women preserve the goods they already owned. Henkel, the leading manufacturer of brand-name soaps and detergents for the household, pinpointed the hardness of German water as

37

38

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

a “problem of our time” in 1930. While rain water collection was a quaint relic of the past for the now largely urban German population, Paul Mundhenke (Henkel’s advertising director) noted that the mineral deposits in the tap and pump water of Germany’s cities required the overuse of detergents and soaps, which drained the economy and led to the deterioration of clothing and household linens. Henkel’s executives were happy to promote two products, Henko and Sil, to soften hard water, and the company used lectures and advertisements to convince women that the benefits reached beyond their families. Buying Henkel products was in “the best sense of the words service to the national economy.”94 Just as Britain’s Empire Marketing Board had amplified the rationale to “buy British,” German ad professionals also made the argument that Germany should not be left behind in the promotion, through advertisements, of public health [Volksgesundheit]. Walter Friedrich, writing in Die Reklame, criticized medical doctors for seeing any connection to the world of advertising as dishonorable. Public health, according to Friedrich, was “one of the greatest concerns a nation can have,” and doctors elsewhere— namely, in the United States—had found a way to partner with corporations to promote good health through ads. Using the example of print ads by Mead Johnson (makers of Enfamil infant formulas today) in the United States, Friedrich called on German doctors to make it possible to do the same—adding their seal of approval to certain products that could aid in the “medical education of the nation.”95 While German doctors needed to be persuaded to work with advertisers, corporate leaders needed no arm-twisting to believe that “national health” was a slogan they could run with. The Lingner-Werke of Dresden, maker of Odol antiseptic mouthwash, already marketed its product with a missionary zeal, promoting preventative dental care as a moral responsibility and “service to the nation.” Beginning in 1928 with a journal circulated to public school teachers called The Health Service: A Newsletter for Teachers and Educators, the company was reaching out to parents, via their children, about the importance of dental hygiene. When the company heard in 1930 from teachers that its efforts were lost on children (and families) who did not own toothbrushes, Lingner set out to right this “regrettable failing of our culture” by “bringing inexpensive children’s toothbrushes to the market.” Though some shops boycotted Lingner when public health offices began distributing the toothbrushes, thereby undercutting shop owners’ chances to make their own sales, the company simply noted to retailers that families with toothbrushes, a new “mass consumer item [Volksgebr-



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

auchsartikel],” would soon be in regular need of toothpaste.96 The company continued to use scientific arguments to assert that “it was no fantasy to see the human body as a fortress that on a daily, even hourly, basis was under attack by invisible enemies attempting to force their way in.” Lingner’s publicity department remained adamant through the last years of the republic that scientific truths had to remain paramount in Lingner ads if the company was to overcome the persistent public mistrust of brand-name products.97 Despite this emphasis on scientific argumentation, the firm also drew on growing nationalism in the defense of its aggressive ad campaigns, as the only way to compete with “mostly foreign” competition.98 Persil’s manufacturers, Henkel, also turned to national health as a selling point for its products during the Depression. Paul Mundhenke argued in 1931 that while everyone agreed that the health of a nation, like the health of an individual, is of the utmost importance, “when the state protects this good through health insurance and clinics that is a more expensive path and certainly not the right one.” He too concluded that “prevention is better than healing.” Raising hygienic standards through the washing of clothes and homes (with Henkel products, of course) was the “only easy and widely applicable means to protect health and prevent the spread of disease!” By the early 1930s, the company had opened sites in Düsseldorf, Berlin, Hannover, and Hamburg designed to offer training courses, lectures, and films to promote the Henkel message, which was also carried around the country via traditional advertising methods and door-to-door “ad ladies” [Werbedamen].99 In each encounter the company encouraged its customers not only to wash more frequently but also to cleanse properly—using the “modern hygienic fundamentals” that the “Persil-method” offered. Their work to promote such a change in consumer habits, Mundhenke insisted, was a “lofty and beautiful goal: the health of our nation and the true progress of humanity.”100 At the 1932 DRV annual meeting, which was vastly scaled back owing to the economic crisis, the concluding words were spoken by the association’s director, Otto Ernst Sutter, who held on to the promise of continued service by ad men and women for Volk, Vaterland und Menschheit [Nation, Fatherland, and Humanity].101 And yet, in the coming months, some ad professionals began to profess a more radical view of how advertising could save Germany. They too hoped for greater recognition of advertising’s potential to generate economic growth and foster national rejuvenation, but they insisted that the trends of the last years had failed Germany in that regard. Instead they rejected not only adoption but also adaptation of what

39

40

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

they considered to be foreign design methods and styles, and looked to a home-grown political movement and its propaganda for inspiration and leadership.

national socialists and advertising The first explicit reference to the National Socialist Party (NSDAP) in the main organ of the advertising industry was itself an ad—a full-page ad that quite skillfully promoted both the party and the various NSDAP magazines as smart bets for the placement of other advertisements. It was quite common for regional newspapers to advertise themselves in Die Reklame as a way to encourage those who bought ad space to consider their titles. This advertisement for the value of placing classifieds in the Nazi publications Der Völkischer Beobachter, Der Illustrierter Beobachter, Der SA-Mann, Die Brennessel, and NS-Landpost is striking in that it used the party’s skyrocketing electoral support, which had shot up from 890,000 votes in 1928 to 13,700,000 in the July 1932 parliamentary elections, as evidence “that the German people have placed their personal fate in the hands of the national socialist movement. . . . The depth of the faith of the millions in our movement is the basis for the size and significance of the party press.” The copy went further in its boastful praise of the reach of the party’s press: “The Führer speaks to the German people through the national socialist central press! Never before has there been such an ideal medium for advertisements!”102 In fact, this claim was far from the truth in 1932. The readership of the party press came nowhere near to reaching the electoral support the party enjoyed.103 While the text belied the movement’s own call for “truth in advertising,” the imagery and prose selling both the party and its press shows many hallmarks of Nazi political propaganda: the stark black and white artwork, the antiquated “Gothic” typeface, the prominent eagle and swastika, the use of numerical data as “evidence,” and the rhetoric of German unity behind the Führer and his party. It also shows the commercial savvy of the movement, its desire to profit from ad placements and depict itself as a friend to the German business community and the advertising industry. Of course, Germans had been following the party’s innovative propaganda efforts for some time. Hitler had devoted a whole chapter in his semi-autobiographical political manifesto, Mein Kampf, to the topic of propaganda and spent a great deal of time practicing his public speaking tech-

fig. 1.1. The Nazi Party press as advertiser, Die Reklame, September 1932. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.

42

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

niques, hand gestures, and facial expressions in order to achieve the greatest effect among his audiences.104 It would not be going too far to say that the efforts of the party’s propaganda chief, Joseph Goebbels, to package the image of Hitler equaled or bettered the most sophisticated branding campaigns of the world’s best-known consumer products of the era.105 The point here is not to discuss the accolades Nazi propaganda received at the time or since, for it is a subject well covered in the existing scholarly literature. But it is clear that a movement that respected the power of persuasion via visual imagery, and emotionally charged political messages, was likely to draw the attention, even envy, of some men and women whose related work in the commercial sector seemed to garner little respect.106 It is not surprising, therefore, that in the first months of 1933 the DRV created a committee to undertake the task of designing a proposal to help the newly installed chancellor with job creation. As the editors reasoned just days before Hitler took over his new position: “A task so fundamentally dependent on psychological factors . . . as work creation can simply not go without well-planned advertising! It needs the spice of fantasy of a well trained ad man, it needs the tested apparatus of contemporary ad design, and it needs all the possibilities for viewing, messaging, and recognition that are at the service of goods and companies.”107 The DRV’s proposal for a Reich advertising council to promote the nation and its economy was ready by March, but before its authors had a chance to present their plan, the new NSDAP-led government announced on March 15 the creation of the Reich Ministry for National Enlightenment and Propaganda (RMVP) to be led by Reichsminister Joseph Goebbels with Walter Funk as second in command. While there must have been some disappointment that the announcement rendered their proposal obsolete, the DRV had to admit that the mandate of the RMVP “went much further than the[ir own] recommendations.”108 They never envisioned a cabinet-level portfolio to deal with these issues. Regardless of the potential political implications of such a body, the editors at Die Reklame announced that “one can greet the creation of the RMVP with wholehearted joy, for with it the necessity of well trained advertising [in the task] of national recovery has been recognized.”109 Goebbels’s reputation was well known, and many advertisers were willing to adopt him as one of their own. The journal referred to him as a “qualified ad man” [berufener Werber] and noted that he had shown “without a doubt what goal-conscious, psychologically savvy and well executed political propaganda can achieve. Nothing would be more absurd than to argue against



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

the fact that every ad man, no matter where he stands, can learn something from it.”110 The editors at Die Reklame acknowledged that it would take some time before they would know what the new ministry would set as its tasks. Some even thought that the DRV’s recommendation to establish a Reich Ad Council [Reichswerberat] might be implemented. Whatever the future held, however, they were pleased (at least publicly) to see that in Goebbels, the new government had a man at the top who believed “propaganda is a much abused and misunderstood word”—a man who was willing to let them demonstrate their willingness and ability “to answer the questions of state-advertising for the rebuilding of the Reich and the Volksgemeinschaft.”111 Germany’s advertisers did not have to wait long to see what Goebbels had in mind for the leading professional organization of German advertisers. Two weeks after the announcement of the new Propaganda Ministry, the board of directors of the Berlin DRV branch stepped down, proving that not all members of the DRV had been as excited by the announcement of Goebbels’s new authority as Die Reklame had claimed. Three days later the “National Group” was officially founded, though undoubtedly this changing of the guard had been in the works for some months. The group’s call for change was simple: “Foreign, snobbish, and intellectual, as [advertising] has been, it may no longer be.”112 The upstart National Group staked its bid for leadership on members’ allegiance to the new regime. Quickly adopting language that was being used in other professional contexts, the National Group proclaimed that “the labor involved in the coordination of the industry [Gleichschaltung] would be great. The significance of the goal, however, meant that all difficulties would be overcome.” In the earliest discussion of a new manifesto for the industry, the group highlighted the goal of promoting “truth in advertising” as well as the ideological slogans of the new dictatorship: “The common good before self-interest. Everything for the nation.”113 The National Group held its first mass rally on April 30 in Berlin under the banner “German Advertising for German Work!” The assembly attracted an audience of two thousand, including representatives of two national housewives associations, who listened to speeches by state and party officials, including the new leader of the National Group within the DRV, Wilhelm Stephan. The first speaker was Richard Wagner, the new executive director of the DRV; he stressed that Gleichschaltung was needed more quickly in the advertising industry than elsewhere, because of its central importance to the economy “and the renewal of the nation”—the number one

43

44

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

priority of the new regime.114 Wagner went further in discussing the “social work” that advertising would undertake in the new Germany—“turning capital over from the economically strong to the economically weak national comrades.”115 While Wagner emphasized the advantages of Gleichschaltung, Hans Hinkel aimed his words directly at those in the audience who remained unconvinced: “There will be more than a few of you, who take offense by the presence of us National Socialists, and particularly me, as the head of the Prussian Battle League for German Culture, at your meeting to speak to you clearly and openly . . . about what we promise German advertising, what we demand of it and what we indicate as the proper direction [for the future].” If advertising were to serve the causes of securing “the future of the nation and its people, the future of German land, the German homeland, and German labor,” then certain changes to the industry and among its practitioners were necessary. Hinkel elaborated in a rant about advertising that summed up everything that cultural conservatives found wrong with Weimar culture. “We want to leave what has heretofore been understood as advertising [Reklame] to the foreign Asians,” exclaimed Hinkel. “We Germans know only advertising [Werbung] in the German sense, with German feelings, in German style.” Hinkel outlined three aims for the immediate future: first, he called for the rejection of what people thought of as “American ad methods,” which he admitted without a hint of selfreflection “are anyway as little American as they are English, or French or German.” While disapproving of such cosmopolitanism, Hinkel was sophisticated enough to accept that Germans had played a significant role in the development of advertising in the 1920s. “American ad methods” was, instead, a catch-all phrase for trends that originated largely but not solely in the United States. Such recognition that advancements in the industry were not wholly “foreign” would unintentionally play to the advantage of advertisers after 1933. Hinkel also warned against the use of “patriotic kitsch” to sell goods, which would only demean the significance of national and Nazi symbols, and he reminded his listeners not to sully the German rural landscape, or even the country’s cities, with a cacophony of ads that undermined the contributions that the creative powers of advertisers might make.116 While not everyone ran to the Nazi colors, everyone could agree with Stephan and Hinkel when they argued that advertising had a critical role to play at the nexus between industry and consumer, production and consumption. The difference this time, exclaimed the new cadre of leaders, was



Advertising in the Weimar Republic

that high-ranking officials, the very highest in fact—Goebbels and Hitler— and the worldview they professed offered a real hope of achieving the longheld goals of professional status and economic prosperity. During the republican era, the DRV had failed to rationalize the industry, set up national training standards, or make advertisers feel more appreciated by business or the public. In the first ninety days of its mandate, the new national government had devoted a whole ministry to the powers of persuasion—a set of skills these men and women already possessed. For many, this was a very fine start indeed. The National Group was now ready to “fight all vermin and everything that does not belong to us.” While it would work to gain industry’s trust, he continued, the National Group “would also be responsible for [combating] the liars and charlatans, who only seek to line their own pockets.”117 There were those who foresaw the dangers of National Socialist coordination. Even the National Group admitted, at the meeting of the Association of German Window Decorators in May 1933: “This word [Gleichschaltung] still has for many a somewhat bitter, political aftertaste.” The speaker noted that this suspicion was particularly common among “intellectual professions, who have been estranged from politics and the natural nationalist feelings of our people.”118 But the window dressers were reassured that in “creative and economic life . . . Gleichschaltung can never mean uniformity. Ad designers are purposeful artists. They are path breakers for applied art, which serves the economy.”119 Most individuals suffering this bitter aftertaste took a wait-and-see attitude toward the new situation. At the very least, the new government seemed to support investment by private industry in advertising, and promised to offer opportunities to work directly for the state on projects related to job creation and national imagemaking. Beyond that, it remained unclear how their everyday working conditions might change. As in other professional sectors, there was a rush to show support for the new regime by some individuals either out of sincere hope for its success or in order to secure a place in the new order. A June cover story in Seidels Reklame began with a quotation from Goebbels decrying those newly minted party members who claimed the right to set the pace of change. “These were not real revolutionaries,” taunted Goebbels, but only “excited philistines.” Eugen Johannes Maecker warned his colleagues of making the same mistake, and lampooned those ad men and sales consultants who suddenly called themselves “leader trainers” [Führerausbilder] and left a copy of Mein Kampf on the table in the office foyer for all to see. “It was perfectly

45

46

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

understandable,” explained Maecker, “to hold back from showing what they welcomed in their hearts as the current developments.” He did not want anyone to pretend to be a “knight for economic activity” [Konjunkturritter], but asked his colleagues to be willing to “let the new spirit work on and in oneself.”120 Maecker’s article is evidence that not all advertisers were onside with the “new Germany” from its beginnings. Many practitioners had reservations but in time were persuaded by the arguments put forward by colleagues like Maecker. As in German society more generally, there was a process of self-reflection and eventual conversion, as described by Peter Fritzsche in his work on the early Nazi years. Many ad men and women came to agree with Maecker that the “good elements” in the field, who were not necessarily Nazi Party members, must come forward so as not to squander the opportunities that the regime seemed to be offering—“a new, improved version of national life,”121 and, even closer to home, a much improved version of professional life. If they did not, they were likely “to be pushed aside” by the more aggressive philistines, to use Goebbels’s formulation, to the detriment of the entire field of advertising and Germany as a whole.122

chapter two

Coordination from Above and Below Advertising is the face of the economy and that should be a German face: distinguished and varied, homespun and prudent.1

By mid-June 1933, the German Advertising Association (DRV) had been officially dissolved and replaced by the Reichsbund deutsche Werbung und Organisation eV as the main professional association. The “coordination,” or Gleichschaltung, of advertising was moving so quickly, in fact, that this new name was almost immediately abandoned for one that more clearly marked it as a Nazi-led institution, resembling the other “coordinated” professional associations emerging throughout the country for doctors, lawyers, teachers, and others.2 The National Socialist Reich Association of German Advertisers (NSRDW) would remain the chief organization of ad men and women “to serve the German fatherland, the state, the party, and the German economy,”3 until 1945. At the head of the NSRDW was Hugo Fischer, an “old fighter” who had joined the party in 1922. He had worked in the party’s propaganda apparatus under Goebbels, and by 1930 he led the National Socialist publishing offices. Since April 1933 he had served as an advisor to Goebbels in the new Propaganda Ministry, taking on the NSRDW appointment in July.4 Second in command was Richard Künzler of Munich. From the very first “call up” to join the NSRDW, it was clear that something new was expected of advertisements: “German advertising must in the future be led and carried by higher principles. While economic necessities should have far reaching consideration, German advertising must no longer represent anything that could work against the National Socialist worldview, the German race and culture.” NSRDW membership would be restricted to NSDAP members and “friends of the party of German blood.” Without membership in the NSRDW, practitioners would no

48

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

longer be permitted to use the title “ad professional” [Werbefachmann].5 For the time being, most nonmembers were still able to carry on with their work, assuming they were already well situated with steady employment and personal contacts. However, for those young people hoping to enter the field from mid-1933 on, refusing to join this party-sanctioned body probably made it more difficult to get established. The August 1933 DRV annual gathering in Berlin served double duty— as the final wrap up of the old organization, and as the first national conference of the NSRDW. Yet many questions still lingered. The first would be how to reconcile the National Socialist worldview, which claimed to prioritize a racial community built on sacrifice and public welfare over individual desires and satisfaction, with the world of advertising—a world that was largely geared toward creating or encouraging the fulfillment of personal desires through consumption. The other question that remained was how the new government would implement its own pledges of change. Künzler had called on each practitioner to take the responsibility to “transform himself, not only outwardly, but above all things inwardly, so that he is fully prepared to handle the extensive and great work of the future that will be demanded of him.”6 In order to bring an end finally to the “hostility toward ads,”7 the Nazi ad man was to accept a strict code of ethics, prioritize national economic health over the prosperity of his client, and foster consumption deemed healthy to the Volk. But no one, least of all the officials in Goebbels’s ministry and the Reich Chancellery, expected that ad men and women would transform the industry on their own. How would the Propaganda Ministry implement the thorough reforms of advertising that all agreed were needed? The NSRDW would have some authority over its own members and those excluded from membership, particularly as time wore on. But the NSRDW needed to be guided along the right path, and business owners and even consumers would need to buy in to change if a new National Socialist commercial culture was to develop.8 The aim of this chapter, therefore, is to examine the organization established to direct advertising for the regime, the Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft (Ad Council for the German Economy), and thereby demonstrate how the state and its partners in business reformed the industry in order to fit with the “new order.” In particular, they worked to free advertising from its shady reputation once and for all, encouraged advertisements and consumption deemed suitable for the Volksgemeinschaft, and worked to keep individual shoppers content as the government began shifting the economy toward its own expansionist aims.



Coordination from Above and Below

commerce, consumption, and calls for nazi reform The way forward for those working in consumer products industries was not at all clear. During the Depression, ad budgets had fallen and consumers and their governments had become more protectionist. Age-old concerns about the ability of ads to manipulate the consumer with lies and cheap tricks were compounded by critiques of foreign influence on design and strategy. Complaints about aggressive salesmanship also became more openly anti-Semitic. Even the regime’s leaders struggled to walk the line between promoting commerce and demonizing Jewish businesspeople and business practices coded as Jewish, or non-German. While the overall public response to the national boycott of Jewish businesses on 1 April 1933 was disappointing to the party, some citizens readily accepted the link between Jews and a failing economy, and sporadic violence was reported.9 As

fig. 2.1. NSDAP boycott of Jewish businesses, 1933. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/ Bildarchiv Preussischer Kulturbesitz/Art Resource, NY.

49

50

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

one author cheered in the Nazi daily newspaper Völkischer Beobachter (VB), there was great joy in fighting the “Jewish salesmania.” He continued: “We National Socialists welcome the fact that consumer goods production has fallen” . . . and are pleased “to combat the suggestion by Jews that every member of the community must consume as much as possible.”10 The damage done by the boycott to German financial markets, and to public opinion at home and abroad, however, convinced the new government that such actions would have to be held in check, at least for the time being. For many National Socialists, like this one, the promotion and fulfillment of “selfish” individual desires were symptoms of racial ill health. The calls for a higher standard of living—coming even from the Führer himself—were at times overshadowed by rhetoric that championed the attainment of racial unity through sacrifice and classlessness, spirituality over materialism.11 The pre-existing doubts about advertising and the consumption it presumed to generate, therefore, were voiced in some circles more loudly after 1933. Werner Sombart, for one, returned to his old bugbear in 1934, pleading, “Will there now be more understanding of the tastelessness [of advertisements]? Will one finally see that it is not for cultured peoples [Kulturvölker] to let themselves be tormented—step by step, at home and on the streets—by brash and chatty profit-hunters . . . ?”12 This distaste for advertising and salesmanship, which for people like Sombart was clearly linked to their anti-Semitism, could also easily be employed to mobilize support for belt-tightening and eventually for rationing as the decade wore on. This debate over consumption would never be put to rest during the life of the regime, but the proconsumption forces within the regime and the business world fared better than most scholars have assumed, in part because of historical trends that predated national socialism and in part because those who supported buying and selling worked hard throughout the Third Reich, even under the pressures of war preparations and after 1939, to make both pursuits acceptable within the ideology. Preparing for and sustaining the war effort were always the top priorities of the regime and its supporters in the business community, but those priorities cannot be entirely disassociated from Hitler’s goals of raising the standard of living for members of the Volk, despite the antimaterialism of some of his supporters.13 For many diehard Nazis it only made sense that if the decadent, racially mixed Americans had achieved a high standard of living, the racially superior Germans should certainly enjoy the same. Many businessmen with links to the civilian economy before and after 1939 were clearly motivated by self-interest to safeguard profits and maintain market share



Coordination from Above and Below

wherever possible. Commercial interests were also aided by Nazi leaders who worried about the impact of totally dismantling the civilian economy; most remained convinced that deprivation on the home front had been the chief cause of defeat in 1918.14 The goal, then, was to encourage virtual consumption and sustain some level of real consumption under controlled conditions. This assertion does not mean that opportunities to consume grew unabated throughout the Third Reich, or existed much at all in the last years of the war, as I explain in greater detail later in the book. It does mean that convincing arguments were made in favor of individual participation in the market, persuading many Germans that consumption was good not only for their families and the economy but also for the Volksgemeinschaft as a whole. In some ways, the economic crisis of the early 1930s made it easier to sell consumption to Germans. Just as today, individuals were reminded that buying goods would fuel the economy and lead to jobs and greater prosperity for all. Advertisers, among others, had been making this argument since 1929, but after 1933 the same point took on new meaning: [W]hoever buys something should not be viewed solely as a money-spender, rather he has a right as a supporter of the whole economy through his purchase to have his psychological wish fulfilled. . . . In the moment that an object is taken out of the milieu of the shop or the factory and into the personal sphere of the consumer, the object becomes a part of the life of the consumer. The psychological component lies in the recognition that every object has a spiritual meaning, that each object helps decidedly to influence the cultural picture of the individual’s life as well as the life of the whole nation.15

While the consumer was needed to pump money into the economy to help create jobs for her national comrades, her purchases were reimbued in the new era with a communal and spiritual value that had allegedly been lost in the previous decades. And whereas the old Reklame had simply shouted “buy me,” the new German Werbung would, in theory, present the cultural value of the goods.16 That message would assist the shopper in making rational decisions about how that item would fit into her life, the life of her family and nation. Of course, there were limits. The proper consumer should be able to identify decadent luxury and learn to live within one’s means. However, as the light bulb manufacturer Osram explained in a promotional essay that circulated in the nation’s newspapers, “[No] one should deny oneself joy through false frugality . . . . One can combine honest daily work with enjoyable recreation.”17 Others argued that the mass consumption of affordable

51

52

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

products generated by ads for popular brand-name goods also had the desired effect of overcoming class differences, a worthy step toward the realization of the Volksgemeinschaft.18 Goebbels too chimed in on the necessity of individual consumption. He reminded individuals that “every need ignored left new people without bread . . . every new suit not worn left fabric mills and tailors without work.” Goebbels reserved his sharpest criticism for those who abstained from consuming out of the incorrect belief that doing so was proper National Socialist behavior. “Are we living in a pietistic state or in the age of life-affirming national socialism? . . . We don’t want to put joy to the side, rather to let as many as possible take part. That is why we encourage people into the theaters and give workers the opportunity to dress up for special occasions.” Pleasure, Goebbels indicated, would also sustain the nation through hard work and struggle. And those who rejected the joys of life, he warned, hindered the recovery and “brought shame to the national socialist state in front of the world.”19 Product promotion as a means to economic health and, not unimportantly, greater international respect, was a strategy supported by Goebbels from the start.20 These comments from Goebbels betray a certain urgency to his demands for more consumption; the economic recovery was still in its infancy at the time of his remarks in early 1934—unemployment remained high, yet falling. Although Goebbels and others recognized the role advertising could play in stimulating buying, reforming commercial advertising was probably not at the top of Goebbels’s to-do list in his first year as minister. There was still the matter of directing political propaganda. As other scholars have discussed, the Propaganda Ministry was already busy creating new mass spectacles, or refashioning existing ones like the annual May Day celebrations, establishing control over the mass media, including radio and the sprawling world of the German press—never mind the work that was undertaken to “coordinate” the arts and cultivate the “Hitler myth.” However, there were three separate developments taking place beyond the walls of the minister’s offices with regard to advertising that demanded his attention: the removal of outdoor ads by local party and municipal authorities, the cooptation of party and national symbols for use in advertisements, and the use of explicitly racial attacks against competitors in promotional material. These local initiatives indicate the significance people attached to what we sometimes think of as apolitical, potentially meaningless texts and images, given their ubiquitous presence in the visual landscape. Seeing their own wishes reflected in the Reich government’s vocal defense of “German heritage” and landscape, members of the Heimatschutz



Coordination from Above and Below

movement in villages, towns, and even larger municipalities began tearing down commercial signs and ads in the name of German beauty. Others called on their local officials to order the removal of outdoor ads, much to the displeasure of business owners who also turned to the local police for protection of their private property. The reactions varied considerably town by town. Some local authorities supported the Heimatschutz activists or even led the way in removal themselves; most were not sure who was right. It quickly became apparent that some national legislation was needed to clarify the issue. In fact, in the first cover story praising the establishment of the RMVP, written 14 March 1933, the editor of Seidels Reklame, M. C. Schreiber, pleaded that “above all, we hope that the RMVP will be successful at freeing advertising from unnecessary bureaucratic limitations and will take a consistent position based on advertising principles in the debate ‘Outdoor Advertising and Heimatschutz.’ ”21 While Schreiber went on to mention some of the other problems that were plaguing the industry, such as the need to standardize professional designations, it is significant that he led his wish list with a hoped-for solution to the contentious topic of who had the right to sanction commercial signs, posters, and billboards. In this sentiment we get a glimpse not only of the desire for a strong centralized government, but also the rather paradoxical belief among some advertisers (and among other professional groups as well) that such a government signaled new opportunities, freedom even, for their own work.22 A second issue that needed immediate attention was the use in advertisements (or misuse, according to the party) of National Socialist images such as the swastika, terminology like “storm trooper,” and likenesses of the party’s leading personalities. With all of the fervor surrounding the rise to power and Germany’s national “rebirth,” it is no surprise that small and large business owners were looking for ways to link their products and services to the success of the NSDAP. However, leaders of a movement that was so careful to sculpt its own image feared that having the slogans and faces of their luminaries commoditized via ads or Nazi-themed merchandise would dilute their symbolic power. Certainly, the baker who fashioned swastika-shaped pretzels and the butcher who artfully crafted Hitler busts out of pork fat for their shop windows needed to be reined in.23 However, Goebbels’s ministry was more concerned with those businesses that appeared to make the claim, either through text or imagery, that their products were actually sanctioned or sponsored by the party or new national government. For example, in 1935 a jewelry shop that advertised “MotherHonor Rings” as the perfect gift for husbands looking to show their wives

53

54

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

respect “as carriers of the Fatherland’s rebirth” were forced to remove the product because the ring was falsely promoted as a “publicly recognized medal of honor.”24 In other words, the regime wanted control over how the image of the movement was used. The party and its representatives in the government sought to shape consumer decisions and, as such, officials were not above handing out “seals of approval” or backing products under certain conditions. The party’s Office of Public Health, for example, issued stamps that were incorporated into advertisements for certain food products, such as wholegrain bread, and beverage labels that noted some drinks as suitable (like fruit juice) or unsuitable (like caffeinated cola) for children.25 The high-quality ceramics manufacturer Meissen was sanctioned to produce busts of Hitler and Göring, small sculptures of Hitler Youth, and the like.26 And the stories of the “People’s Products,” including the Volkswagen and Volksempfänger [People’s Radio] are well known.27 Nonetheless, these were programs tightly controlled by the government—private corporations using Nazi slogans and imagery of their own accord was a different matter. Finally, the use of negative advertisements by rival firms based on the alleged “Jewishness” of the competition also demanded some attention from officials in the new government. Negative ads, which criticized rival products as opposed to championing one’s own, had been illegal for some time in Germany,28 but there were individuals after January 1933 who assumed that targeting a rival company or its wares as “Jewish” would be permissible, in fact encouraged by a regime that itself had spearheaded boycotts of Jewish-owned businesses and criticized “Jewish capital” as the downfall of the nation. Yet once again the issue of whether such ads should be allowed and, if so, under what conditions was a complicated matter. The pressure was coming, therefore, from a variety of directions—municipal administrators, police and the judiciary, business owners, advertisers, consumer organizations, and antiadvertisement activists—for answers on a whole host of issues. With such demands for action, advertising fairly quickly moved up the pecking order on Goebbels’s to-do list.

the establishment of the werberat In response to these pressing issues and Goebbels’s own long-range goals to control the media and visual arts, the RMVP established a new agency under its authority to coordinate the reform of Germany’s advertis-



Coordination from Above and Below

ing industry. On 12 September 1933 the Law on Commercial Advertising was announced. The legislation placed the uniform and effective design of all public and private advertisements, classifieds, exhibitions, fairs, and other ads-related issues under the oversight of the Reich, the authority of which was to be exercised through the Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft (Werberat or Ad Council). The members of the Ad Council would be selected by the Reich minister for propaganda, in agreement with his advisors, and would report to Goebbels. It declared further that all those who practiced within the advertising field required a license from the new Ad Council.29 Ernst Reichard, a trained lawyer with no experience in advertising, was selected as president of the new body. A career civil servant, he worked in the administration of Alsace-Lorraine before the war; in 1919 he was a senior civil servant in the Reich Finance Ministry. In 1931 he was appointed deputy director of the Reichskommissariat für die Osthilfe. Fifty-seven years old in 1933, Reichard recruited the much younger Heinrich Hunke to serve as his deputy in the Ad Council. Born in 1902, Hunke joined the NSDAP in 1923 and served in the Reichstag from 1932 until 1945. Trained first as a primary school teacher, he was working for the military

fig. 2.2.  Heinrich Hunke, Seidels Reklame, October 1935.

55

56

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

when he was recruited in early 1933 by the Ministry of Propaganda to prepare an office for the coordination of German advertising. Hunke held the post of vice president of the Werberat from its inception and took over as president in 1939, following Reichard’s retirement. Hunke continued to serve in that capacity until the final days of the war. As such, Hunke was the single most powerful official in advertising throughout the Third Reich. Alongside his duties for the Werberat, he also served as founding editor of the leading Nazi economics journal Die Deutsche Volkswirtschaft (DDV) from its beginnings in 1932 until its dissolution in 1944. Indeed, some scholars consider Hunke the most influential economic theorist of his day.30 He delivered hundreds of speeches and wrote dozens of books and articles, in which he argued that consumption and advertising to spur consumption were economically and ideologically sound ventures and essential to his vision of a postwar, Nazi-led “new order” for Europe.31 Though Hunke had not previously worked in the commercial sector, he had served as the party’s Gauwirtschaftsberater for Berlin since the late 1920s, which undoubtedly helped prepare him for his new task coordinating advertising. He would stay on as Gauwirtschaftsberater and become a key figure in the Aryanization of Jewish businesses in the capital in the years before the war. He believed in Germany’s economic potential and supported the expansionist, racist war to reach that potential. Thinking about the domestic situation, he wrote in 1935: “One can, for example, neither expect that we as National Socialists buy from a Jew, nor insist that we accept Jews as managers. Throughout time it has always been the first sign of victory for a people to free their comrades from bondage.”32 When Jews were officially prohibited from participating in the economy three years later, the journal he edited celebrated the measure with a cover story that explained: “With the liquidation of Jewish influence in the German economy, the national solution to the Jewish question nears its end. Its final solution, however, is a matter that is beyond our total control. It is an international issue.”33 Goebbels would reward his hard-working and loyal ally with the post of head of the Foreign Department of the Ministry of Propaganda in 1940, and he was named to the board of directors of Deutsche Bank in 1944.34 It is significant that even though the Werberat relied on Goebbels’s patronage, it was a nongovernmental body that existed outside of the Reich Chamber of Culture. While this put the Ad Council in a vulnerable position in relation to other state ministries, its semiofficial status allowed for business leaders and party officials without portfolio to sit as members



Coordination from Above and Below

of the council. Having industry on side in this venture was essential, and Reichard was quick to reassure industry leaders that the Ad Council’s goal was not to undermine the ability of companies to advertise their wares. As Dirk Reinhardt notes, the new Werberat president’s promise not to set up a large bureaucratic structure to carry out its work, but rather to rely heavily on the associations that already existed, went far to mollify the business community in the fall of 1933.35 There were forty-nine members of the Werberat’s advisory board at its inception. The vast majority were elite members of German industry and high-ranking representatives of trade organizations. Less than one-quarter consisted of national and local government officials. Among those included on the board were the Nazi press chief Max Amann,36 Persil’s Hugo Henkel, Jacob Herle of the Reich Association of German Industry, Mayor Friedrich Krebs of Frankfurt am Main, the sparkling wine scion Christian Kupferberg, Richard Künzler of the NSRDW, Staatsrat Wilhelm Meinberg of the Reich agriculture regulatory body (Reichsnährstand), and Ludwig Roselius of the decaffeinated coffee giant Kaffee Hag.37 Reichard and Hunke kept their promise not to grow the Werberat into a bureaucratic behemoth. The total number employed by the Ad Council only rose to as many as 189 staff members in 1941, before falling back to just a skeletal staff by the end of the war. Though the body reported to Goebbels, the council enjoyed a fair level of independence, owing to the fact that it controlled its own budget, which was raised by a 2 percent tax on all ads to be paid by the advertiser, known as the Werbeabgabe.38 The downside to this system from the point of view of the Ad Council was twofold. First, it made an instant enemy of the powerful Nazi press chief, Max Amann, who sat on the council but resented the tax, which made advertising in the newspapers he controlled more expensive. Besides Amann, the Werberat had to go through a protracted struggle with a number of party organizations that presumed they should be granted the privilege of not paying. Hunke and Reichard stood firm in these cases and pushed to have their funds turned over. Even Hermann Göring, in his role as Reichsjägermeister, wrote to the Reich Ministry of Economics that the Werbeabgabe charged for the 1.2 million RM spent on advertisements for the International Hunting Exhibition of 1937 should be waived, because the exhibition “had no economic goals.” The request was passed on to the RMVP, which recommended to the Werberat that a compromise be struck and Göring’s bill be lowered. Heinrich Hunke disagreed with his boss, ironically citing “equality before the law” and reminding Goebbels’s office that the federal states, the Reichsbahn,

57

58

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

and Reichspost all had to pay. In the end, the Propaganda Ministry was won over and Göring’s request was denied.39 The second disadvantage to having its budget originate independently was that while the Ad Council saw its own income rise throughout the 1930s to a highpoint of 7.34 million RM in 1939, it quickly saw its funds plummet during the war with decreasing ad sales, to a low point of 1.35 million RM in 1944.40 Before venturing any further, it is worth emphasizing that the mandate and activities of the Werberat were far more complex than any monolithic views of the Propaganda Ministry and its units that may exist.41 Uwe Westphal and Matthias Ruecker, in particular, have imagined the Ad Council as an instrument of state power with wide-ranging censorship authority and a broad mandate to make a clean sweep of the industry. While this characterization is true in theory, the evidence shows that those who ran the Ad Council, Reichard and Hunke, and their supporters from the business world never presumed it would function primarily as a tool for policing the industry. As with other cultural media, including the fine arts and the press, the Werberat sought productive ways to exercise its semiofficial authority, rather than rely on its censorship powers.42 In other words, Reichard and Hunke imagined a Werberat that focused more on creating trust in ads that could bolster Germany’s economic and ideological goals.43 There was a very practical reason to take this position. The members of the Ad Council, who represented some of Germany’s biggest and most profitable brandname products and had contacts with others like themselves, could see the difficulties looming in the discussion of autarchy. The first rationing of raw materials arrived in 1934 with limits placed on imported fats, affecting the production of everything from soap to butter; shortages of cocoa, leather, and other essentials for the production of a variety of goods were not far behind. These macroeconomic concerns, combined with the artificial depression of workers’ wages and price controls, as well as the pre-existing mistrust of advertising, meant that those linked to consumer products industries were well aware of their defensive position in the Third Reich. While we must not forget the purging of Jews and others who refused to follow along quietly, a subject that will be discussed further on, from the start members of the Ad Council saw their body as more akin to a lobbying group than an organ of censorship. Reforming the industry would demonstrate its value to state and society and help maintain or increase profits. This image of the Werberat as a lobby for advertising works only with regard to the council’s external relationships. Within the industry, the Werberat emphasized its role as leading the way in “self-regulation.”44 Sup-



Coordination from Above and Below

porters of the regime saw this decentralization of regulatory authority as empowering,45 but critics highlighted the infighting and corruption that intensified with such practices. The Werberat’s mandate was also one that from the beginning set its horizons far beyond Germany’s borders. As Hunke wrote in 1934 about National Socialist economic policy more generally, “[A]utarchy was for us never an antithesis to foreign export.”46 Foreign promotion of German goods and more generally the brand “Germany” [Außlandswerbung] was increasingly important as the decade wore on—economically critical, in fact, to a regime that was in dire need of foreign currency, and politically necessary to improve the image of the dictatorship abroad.47 For Heinrich Hunke personally, the Werberat afforded him the chance to work toward a realization of his vision of a National Socialist empire. As Hunke remembered in later years: “The Ad Council of the German Economy offered a unique opportunity to get to know leaders within the German and foreign economies, European statesmen, and brilliant economists and mayors, to hear their views and experiences, to develop new ideas, to offer trust and win trust.”48 While the war years will be discussed in detail in later chapters, it is worth a reminder here that Hunke and his colleagues and supporters in industry believed that the economic transformation they envisioned would not stop at Germany’s prewar borders. Consequently, in the early 1940s, with victory seemingly assured, they began in earnest to prepare for a postwar European economy led by Germany and based on Nazi principles rather than what they demonized as the “liberal economics” championed by Great Britain and its American ally. Consumption was particularly significant to National Socialists’ understanding of the differences between the British market economy and their own economic principles. Hunke and his associates admired the energy and productivity generated by liberal capitalism, but felt that it failed to manage the consumption side of the equation—“the allocation of goods.” It was natural, in fact, as one of IG Farben’s executives argued in Hunke’s journal, Die Deutsche Volkswirtschaft, that as economic thinking evolved, all theoretical and managerial efforts would turn away from the “solved” matter of production to issues of consumption. Rejecting the “JewishMarxist” solution of a planned economy, he and others set as their goal the “rational use of the powerful energy of production in the service of the Volksgemeinschaft.”49 While such talk of a “purposeful” Nazi-led European economy50 seems vague, particularly when it comes to matters of individual consumers, the policies implemented through the Werberat can be seen as

59

60

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

early steps in achieving this long-range goal. As a supporter of commerce, and advertising in particular, Hunke was careful to be explicit that the individual entrepreneur had a place in the new economic order. He emphasized the central role to be played by the entrepreneur as the bearer of innovation and creativity in assuring Europe’s economic future.51 In fact, a number of the Werberat’s key initiatives helped lay the groundwork for West Germany’s consumer economy by cleansing advertising of its disreputable image and promoting the sense that advertisements could be used in the service of the public good. Though theirs was not an easy task in a period of rearmament and war, with the help of large German consumer goods manufacturers, the rest of this chapter will demonstrate that the Ad Council helped legitimize buying and selling in the Third Reich—supporting a trend that anticipated and fueled the postwar abundance.52 Foreign observers initially viewed the establishment of the Ad Council in 1933 with suspicion, largely because they saw the move as an example of how “economic enterprise” would be “socialized by National Socialism.”53 But by May 1934 the leading British trade journal, Advertiser’s Weekly, reported, “Whatever the controversies aroused in other directions since the Nazis came into power there can be no contradicting the fact that advertising has improved vastly and has been purged of many imperfections previously existing.”54 The first task at hand was to develop a language about consumption that fit with the ideology of the racial community. While the new regime’s leaders were in favor of raising the standard of living and supporting the pursuit of pleasure and leisure, there was still a desire to differentiate “purposeful” consumption from that which had supposedly weakened the Volk in the past. Emil Endres wrote in Die Reklame just months after the takeover of power: “It is precisely the new Volksgemeinschaft that sweeps away both snobbish aestheticism on the one hand and crass materialism on the other, and which, by bridging class differences and therefore also distinctions of taste, works toward a grand and unambiguous appreciation for authenticity, beauty, and propriety that is held in common by all Germans.”55 This formulation allowed for individual consumption. Endres spoke of bridging class differences, rather than eliminating them. If buying and selling were acceptable pursuits, then, the role of the advertiser (and the Ad Council as reformer) was to represent what he believed were essential German tastes. As Christian Lebahn wrote in the relatively independent ad journal Seidels Reklame in 1936, “It is a matter of course that the greater the influence among the public achieved by advertisers, the greater the responsibility be-



Coordination from Above and Below

comes for the designer of advertisements in issues of culture and taste.” Rather than seeing potential consumers as blank slates or, more negatively, as uncultured lovers of kitsch, the Ad Council and those in the business world who supported its mission preferred to think of them as people who desired “tasteful” culture. According to the Nazi worldview, the racial superiority of the Germans meant that they were born with a natural appreciation of true culture, which they would recognize if advertisers presented it to them. As Lebahn put it, “The child has taste as long as his opinions are not influenced by his surroundings.” Even in cases where the desired “strivings toward simplicity and rationality” had been hampered by circumstances, Lebahn argued, these pure emotions could be reawakened. The influential advertiser Egon Juda, a non–party member who struggled with his surname after 1933, seemed to agree. Juda noted, however, that schools must also play a part in the “taste education” of the young generation.56 Endres put it most simply, and most self-servingly, in 1934 when he argued that the ad man had gone from a “sidekick of commercial interest groups to a bearer of culture, who is only responsible to the Volksgemeinschaft— with every stroke of his pen.”57 The Ad Council could support this goal in a variety of ways, though establishing a vast operation for censoring promotional material was not chief among them. In fact, one staff member for the Werberat set out to calm concerns when he insisted that “those spreading rumors” that “every classified, every poster, every direct ad letter, and every product brochure must appear before the Ad Council for evaluation” were wrong. Given the immeasurable quantity of promotional materials being produced in 1930s Germany, surely such oversight would have been impossible.58 However, the Werberat did implement a number of regulations in its first two years to encourage what they believed to be “good taste” in advertisements—ads that fostered a sense of national community and the value of individual participation within it. On 1 November 1933, the council issued its first set of reforms. They began by formalizing the various occupational categories within the industry as a first step in the coordination of the industry. They laid out in general terms the directions that ad designers “should” follow in their work: Advertisements are to be German in sensibility and expression. They may not injure the moral sensitivities of the German people, especially its religious, nationalist, and political feelings and desires. Advertising should be tasteful and appealingly designed. The defacement of buildings, localities, and landscapes must be prohibited. Who undertakes advertising must act as an honorable

61

62

From Internationalism to “German Advertising” salesman. All details [in ads] must be true and clear, and the possibilities of misleading [the consumer] should be avoided. Advertising may not reproduce official symbols and forms (for example, national emblems, bank notes, traffic signs, or official bulletins). Further they must not lure in a blatant way or by exaggeration, but rather should put forward the factual evidence for the advantages of [the product’s] own merits. The competition must not be belittled.59

This set of guidelines was not revolutionary. Certain points like the call for “truth in advertising” were common throughout Europe and North America in the interwar years, and others like the rejection of ads that criticize competitors had a long tradition in Germany.60 And yet the focus on the economic protection of the Volk (no manipulation of consumers), its physical health (no false ads that could endanger), and spiritual well-being (no ads that dilute the comforting powers of the German landscape or challenge moral norms) lends it a decidedly National Socialist tone. 61 These standards received further fine-tuning through essays and examples provided in a number of venues, particularly through the trade journal Die Deutsche Werbung (previously Die Reklame), which all members of the NSRDW received free of charge starting in 1934, but also via the internal administrative bodies assigned the task of overseeing promotional efforts within each of the country’s (increasingly cartelized) economic sectors from retail to heavy industry. Even so, practitioners often had to make determinations for themselves about what “exaggeration” meant and how to protect “the moral sensitivities of the German people.” We will see in the coming chapters how companies and their ad departments tried to negotiate this vision of “German advertising,” while retaining customers and profits. In contrast to the somewhat vague recommendations above, we see a greater level of intervention from the Werberat on the more pressing matters concerning nation and race, which had erupted in controversies over national symbols in advertisements, outdoor advertising, and anti-Semitic ad copy.

reform and self-discipline: the werberat, citizens, and businessmen The decision to prohibit the use of national symbols in advertisements predated the Werberat by some months. Coming into effect on 19 May 1933, the federal Law for the Protection of National Symbols62 prohibited



Coordination from Above and Below

opportunistically nationalistic promotional efforts. Even small retailers could run afoul of this law, such as the packing labels of one firm that included a photograph of the company’s delivery truck in front of the Tannenberg memorial commemorating victory against the Russians in 1914, or the ad copy for a cigar brand that read: “No longer ‘name less,’ my new first-rate cigar goes by the name ‘Greater Germany.’ ”63 The Werberat was the watchdog on this matter and was expected to force companies to comply with the law in company names, logos, ad copy, and imagery. Even color scheme (black, white, red) was to be monitored. National brands, with extensive ad exposure, followed these prescribed limits fairly easily. In contrast, even though the ban came in very early and had the weight of national law behind it, small companies frequently ignored the legislation out of possible ignorance or the belief that no government body would waste time prosecuting a small business that was only showing its pride in and support for the regime. The likelihood of getting caught was not great for a business that advertised only in the provincial press, and the penalty was minor—a recall of the offending promotional material. The advertisers responsible for depicting the delivery truck with the Tannenberg memorial and presenting “Greater Germany” cigars were caught in late 1938. These specific themes of empire and military victory may have crept in at that moment because of Austrian annexation, the Sudeten crisis, and the general sense that Germany had regained its military strength. However, for some companies promotional material including the words “national” or “German” dated back to the Wilhelmine era. The same goes for color combinations: company letterhead in red and black, perhaps sporting an eagle as part of the company logo, was as much in style before 1918, as it may have become after 1933. I suspect that most companies in this position carried on without drawing any unwanted attention. When advertisers were deemed in violation of the law, it was not uncommon for owners to balk at the idea of giving up a “national look” that had in some cases represented the business for generations. Refusal to change the slogan, image, or layout could lead to Werberat threats to revoke the firm’s license to promote its wares, but only in rare instances was that authority invoked.64 As was usually the case for Aryans in Nazi Germany, one minor offense did not lead to severe punishment. However, a pattern of misbehavior in the eyes of state authorities could have different results.65 For example, one businessman who refused to change the name of his firm, which the Werberat found misleading because it sounded like a governmental office rather than a private business, was eventually investigated by the Gestapo.

63

64

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

The fact that the secret police was called in on the matter was likely driven by the fact that this business owner was already known as a troublesome party member who also allegedly frequented “Jewish-friendly” pubs. His neighbors added to his woes by reporting to Gestapo officers that his wife was a “hysterical cow” known for her worrisome “non–National Socialist” behaviors.66 Though cases like this one were atypical, Hunke and Reichard took the law seriously. As Hunke explained in 1936, the words “German” and “national” had taken on symbolic meaning “since the national socialist ascent . . . , making it impossible to use them in advertising for self-serving aims. Such use in today’s context is morally offensive to the German people.”67 As Kristin Semmens points out, the mass production of most Nazi kitsch (such as playing cards with the faces of Nazi leaders) was successfully eliminated by the May law.68 The same goes for the “Storm Cigarettes” produced by the company Trommler in Dresden as a business venture to fund the SA in the late Weimar period. Advertised with explicit textual reference and images of storm troopers and swastikas, the product went out of production some time in 1933.69 More often than not, however, the Werberat defended businesses that violated the statute, if the company’s name, slogans, or logos predated the law. In 1937, for example, the Reichsrundfunkkammer (the bureau within Goebbels’s ministry to deal with radio matters) decided that all privately held businesses using the word “Rundfunk” in their names should be forced to change, since radio was now in the hands of the state. Reichard responded to the RMVP that the dozens of small firms using the word “radio,” such as the Hamburg brand “Radio Coffee,” would face “extraordinary losses” if forced to change their brand names.70 Though the RMVP eventually sided with its Rundfunkkammer, the Ad Council was responsible for enacting the decision, which left it some leeway in applying the ruling. A razorblade brand, “Rundfunk,” from Solingen was given five years from December 1938 to make the transition to a new name. In 1940, with three years to go, a two-year extension was granted by the Ad Council. Hunke refused outright to force the makers of “Radio Coffee” to rebrand their product in 1939, until he was able also to lift the sectorwide limits on coffee advertising (which never happened during the Third Reich).71 The Law for the Protection of National Symbols also led to unforeseen consequences related to the issue of color. The decree prohibiting any red, white, and black posters, for example, was put forth as a way to avoid ads that had an official appearance. This position was supported by the Interior Ministry, which feared that increased traffic on motorways could lead



Coordination from Above and Below

to accidents if drivers mistook commercial signage for traffic signs. The Association of Ad Poster and Sign Designers appealed to the Ad Council. Hunke’s office defended these commercial interests by reminding the RMVP that the entire NSDAP press violated the law with its black, white, and red advertisements.72 The Ad Council’s argument was enough to force a compromise: only posters and painted advertisements resembling traffic signs in color and form would be prohibited.73 This dispute, however, was just one small, relatively easy wrinkle to iron out. As Reichard and Hunke were to learn, the matter of Aussenwerbung (outdoor advertising) was a much harder nut to crack, even though Goebbels called on the Werberat to make a judgment on the matter as early as October 1933.74 Throughout the entire life of the Werberat, the council continued to battle with various party and government offices over outdoor advertisements. Knowing there was pressing demand from businesses who were finding their advertisements and signs disappearing from roadsides, Reichard announced on 25 November 1933, in a finely worded statement to all party Gauleiter and state governments within the Reich, that his Ad Council was the only body that had the right to make determinations about the posting of advertisements outdoors. He explained that he received “daily requests for protection from the acts of local governments and party offices . . . which were in blatant contradiction to Reich law . . . and included the official encouragement of the population [to remove ads] and praise for those involved in doing so.” He went on to promise confidently that steps would be taken by his office to protect the landscape while removing roadblocks to outdoor advertising that had emerged under the guise of local ordinances.75 Though this statement of Werberat authority on the matter was only addressed to government and party offices, it also turns up in the archival holdings of major corporations, like Osram light bulbs, which presumably cheered its arrival.76 The Ad Council’s 9th Decree went into effect on 1 June 1934, laying out rather strict rules for the use of outdoor posters, banners, and billboards. The erection of the iconic Litfaßsäule, or ad columns, were limited to one per every thousand inhabitants, except at tourist destinations where the number of visitors was taken into account. Beyond town limits, all signs and billboards were to be removed, except for those individual signs to denote gas stations and inns. Posters were made uniform in size and the regulations for painting ads on building facades were tightened.77 The company newsletter for Henkel, the maker of Persil, iMi, and ATA cleaners, and heavy user of building facades, buses, and other public transporta-

65

66

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

tion vehicles, as well as the advertising columns that often hosted Persil’s “Weisse Dame,” reported with satisfaction that the Werberat’s new ruling “[h]as avoided throwing the baby out with the bathwater.”78 Nonetheless, Henkel found over the coming months that the problem of police officers removing newly hung banners and signs persisted.79 Company headquarters reminded its traveling representatives that the loss of signage not only hurt sales but also necessitated the purchase of costly replacements and encouraged the men to teach each retailer “to fight for his posters, which will only happen when he respects the advertisements and thinks about how much they cost.”80 Reichard’s confidence that the Werberat’s 9th Decree would bring an end to controversies surrounding outdoor ads was shown to be ill placed.81 While individual companies continued to struggle with local authorities who failed to recognize the RMVP- and Werberat-sanctioned outdoor advertising, Reichard sought additional support at the Reich level. In September 1935 he addressed the Ministry of Economics, noting that despite the new measures, which had been devised in consultation with both business leaders and members of the Heimatschutz movement, local activists continued to vandalize and remove outdoor postings. At the heart of the matter was the fact that there were overlapping spheres of authority in the dictatorship—the product of a complicated system that prized both national hierarchy and local initiative. On the one hand, the Ad Council had the power via the RMVP to regulate outdoor advertising according to national economic needs and concerns. However, Reichard admitted that municipal authorities had the power to strike local ordinances for the protection of town- and landscape.82 And since “National Socialism strove to awaken a sense of Heimat and its value” in members of the Volk, local statutes against signage abounded. Reichard estimated “at least 3000” statutes were on the books throughout the country, and most left room “for further discretion on the part of local administrators and police to define the concept of defacement.” While he applauded the ideological desire to protect Germany’s natural beauty, he appealed to the Ministry of Economics for assistance against “this monstrous fragmentation of the law,” demanding that more be done to safeguard the “use of this old and well-tested tool of advertising.”83 The controversy expanded into a battle over “authentic” advertising methods. During a period of renewed attacks on outdoor advertisements in 1935, President Reichard fumed, “[T]he struggle against brand-name product signs has taken on particularly crass forms. The influence of the



Coordination from Above and Below

Heimatschutz movement is unmistakable here, many of whose members take the position that such signs—factory-made products—are replacing the individually handcrafted signs, a view that is hard to beat in its irrationality and which can only be supported by a side that is totally lacking in economic judgment.”84 In Reichard’s opinion, the Heimatschutz activists were not only upset about the impact of advertising on the German countryside generally, but targeted mass-produced brand-name product endorsements as particularly foreign (and hence dangerous) to German culture.85 The big consumer brands responded more aggressively than they had previously. The Düsseldorf-based makers of Persil contacted their rival Böhme Fettchemie in 1937 to inform the firm that they were planning to bring suit against the police in Zittau, Saxony, for their continued removal of signage. Henkel even sent its Saxon competitors a copy of the legal briefs, a statement by Goebbels on the economic importance of outdoor advertising, and some samples of recent suits by brand-name companies who had succeeded in challenging police authority. Looking for allies in the region, the author from Henkel explained that he hoped BFC found the material useful and offered “further assistance if needed.”86 One such successful suit was filed by Zeiss Ikon, the lens manufacturer based in Jena, against the municipal authorities in Frankfurt (Oder) in 1937. The case centered on the opticians Gebrüder Bescheerer, who had been refused permission by the local Landrat to hang a Zeiss Ikon sign outside their shop. Speaking for the local opticians, Zeiss had appealed the decision but to no avail. The subsequent legal suit argued that the advertisements in question neither defamed the building nor the street, which was known as a shopping area “without significant historical importance and already the site of many advertisements.” The lens manufacturers insisted that their customer (the opticians) be treated like all other business owners on the street, and noted that the glass-plated sign was in “good taste and fit with present-day building style.” While the court upheld the 1907 and 1930 laws that the building inspectors had turned to when making the original decision, the advertisements by Zeiss were not found to be “ugly and repellent” or to “detract from the character of the town or streetscape,” which opened the way for the promotional display.87 Large companies, like Zeiss, had the resources to persevere despite the limits and public suspicion from some quarters. In 1938, BMW also sent around a list of “10 Tips for Outdoor Advertising” to its representatives. Headquarters recommended that when choosing to place ads or signs outdoors, “you must consider your company, your customers, and also the

67

68

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

general interest.” BMW also reminded its sales staff that hanging a sign or poster amid others was a poor choice and likely to fall afoul of the local police. And while historical buildings and streets may seem a good bet for attracting passersby, choosing those sites required “particular care and tact.” No one should act, the memo concluded, without first understanding the Ad Council’s 9th decree and knowing whether the town had any by-laws for the placing of ads.88 Henkel too addressed the issue again at the end of the 1930s, by including an essay on the topic in its internal company newsletter from a staff attorney at the Ad Council. The lawyer explained that while local police will always have the right to act, he insisted that “[t] he interests of advertisers must not always retreat before the aim of Heimatschutz. Often leaving the advertisement in its original form outweighs the wish to avoid a change or disturbance to the local- or landscape. Only when the police come to realize this will they be fulfilling their task of protecting the Heimat . . . and also allocating a fitting place for ads in German living space [Lebensraum].”89 While the debate about outdoor advertising was fueled in part by worries about the consequences for Germany’s landscape, these conservationist concerns cannot be separated entirely from suspicions that this expanding commercial culture was simply un-German. Could individual consumption and its mass-produced signs and billboards be reconciled with the Nazi new order? A third factor that forced the regime, and the Werberat in particular, to respond to this larger question was racist activism within the business community. As we know from the extensive literature on the Aryanization of Jewish businesses in the Third Reich, it was exceedingly common for Jewish business owners to be bankrupted by wholesalers and customers who refused to pay their bills, and by party zealots and officials who harassed customers of Jewish firms or taxed their owners into insolvency. Those Jewish-owned businesses that managed to stay afloat until November 1938 were forced after the Kristallnacht pogrom to sell to Aryan businessmen at criminally low prices on Göring’s order as plenipotentiary of the Four-Year Plan. His quest to make the German economy Judenfrei was one goal he would see realized, but in the meantime there was much to be sorted out about advertisements and “Jewish firms.” For Jews working in advertising, the coordination of the industry under the auspices of the Werberat had meant that by the end of 1933 only those who qualified for a license issued by the Ad Council retained official permission to work in this very broadly defined field. The actual policing of licensing, however, took time, and it was not until 1936 that the mass



Coordination from Above and Below

purging of the industry began. By 1937, the NSRDW newsletter Ruf der Werbung was regularly printing the names of those welcomed into the ranks of the profession and those who had been struck from the mandatory association, according to Werberat regulations. In March of that year, the newsletter boasted that three thousand men and women had already been excluded because of “inadequate professional achievement or because of their foreignness to the profession [Berufsfremdheit], for example their ancestry.”90 The periodic printing of names and addresses of advertisers kicked out of the profession should be read as an indication of the willingness of advertisers to undertake their own “necessary sorting and cleansing” of the industry.91 Alongside such examples of anti-Semitic policies, anti-Semitism became a sales strategy all its own.92 The intimidation of Jewish shop owners and would-be customers had become increasingly common after 1933, and promotional signs to remind shoppers to buy only “German wares” from “German shopkeepers” appeared frequently. Although larger firms with connections to the export market were spared some of this anti-Semitic aggression, here too competitors tried to tarnish rival brands as non-Aryan. The best known case of the “denunciation business” is the offensive against Beiersdorf ’s products—namely, those sold under the brand Nivea, by its competitors in the cosmetics sector.93 As also described by Frank Bajohr and Joachim Szodrzynski, in early 1933 the company was accused publicly of having non-Aryan directors.94 Wanting to provide sales staff with information to counter these charges, company executives sent a letter to sales representatives in April 1933 with the title: “Is our firm a purely German company in the National Socialist sense?” The authors admitted that they did not know the answer to this all-important question, but they promised staff that as soon as they got an answer from Göring’s office they would act so as to bring Beiersdorf in line, if necessary. By the end of April, five members of the managing board had been asked to step down, and the house bank, M. M. Warburg and Co., had relinquished its controlling stake in the company. This led to a declaration in mid-May from the NSDAP’s Alliance of Middle-Class Businessmen that Beiersdorf could be considered a “German firm.”95 That month, armed with this assurance from the NSDAP, Beiersdorf sent a letter to all its commercial customers. The company’s leaders accused Beiersdorf ’s detractors of trying “to line their pockets with cheap means and see to the loss of employment for 1500 German workers and managers” (Beiersdorf ’s total estimated workforce). Employing language often used by party and state propagandists, the letter claimed that denun-

69

70

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

ciations should be uncovered as the “self-serving” [eigennützig] strategies that they were. Legal papers were drawn up by Beiersdorf against two competitors, Mouson AG and Queisser and Co., for circulating the claims that Beiersdorf ’s leading brand should be rejected as “Jewish skin cream,” but the matter was eventually settled out of court. Similar denunciations surfaced in August, however, when a story about Nivea’s “Jewishness” was carried by the sensationalist anti-Semitic newspaper Der Stürmer, a key venue for such accusations. The company turned to the municipal authorities in Munich, the home of Julius Streicher’s tabloid, for assistance. In a long letter, Beiersdorf recounted its contribution to the economy, detailing again the size of the company workforce, the low percentage of raw materials imported for use in the manufacturing process, the high dividends and tax payments. And the company presented once more the details of the personnel and financial restructuring it had undergone in the spring.96 Beiersdorf also turned to its ads as proof of the firm’s Aryan spirit. Der Stürmer had specifically charged the company with producing “Jewish ads, which had so conquered the German market that next to [them] there is hardly room for any other German firm.” To the contrary, Beiersdorf insisted, Nivea brand products were known in the marketplace as representing a particularly German sensibility and style. The letter offered a citation from the leading ad trade journal, Die Reklame, in the previous month’s issue that professed “Nivea has long used deliberately German motifs for its ads” in contrast to those firms that relied on “the pervasive use of film stars and well groomed dolls with shaved eyebrows and pouty lips, who were posed in the most grotesque ways with limbs askew and clothed as little as possible.”97 Beiersdorf went a step further to prove that this style was not adopted recently to win favor with the new regime, recalling an article from late 1932 that also lauded the company’s use of “rosy, healthy Hamburg girls” who have a “fresh, natural trimness.”98 In a letter that same week sent to the minister of economics, the company noted that while the denunciations were easy to overcome among hospitals and pharmacies, with which they enjoyed long-standing relationships, the consuming public was a much more fickle audience. Beiersdorf feared that at the level of the individual consumer, the damage done by the Stürmer article and other anti-Nivea publicity would be more significant.99 In the following years the company requested written statements from a variety of offices, including the Ministry of Propaganda, looking for support against its critics. Although the intensity of the attacks dwindled after 1933, the company was right that among a certain fanatical sector of the



Coordination from Above and Below

population, the slander would not cease entirely. Beiersdorf recorded the anecdotal evidence that filtered back to the home office, via its sales representatives. In early 1934 Beiersdorf was charged anew with a lack of patriotism for representing its brand as German in domestic ads, while omitting this information in ads that circulated abroad. Foreign spots highlighted the local manufacture of Beiersdorf products, as was common among German firms hoping to avoid anti-German sentiment abroad after 1933.100 In 1935 one report found its way to company headquarters that Hitler Youth boys were not allowed to bring Nivea products on trips, and another described how SS men confiscated Nivea toothpaste before it could reach individuals in police custody, even though Hamburg police assured the company that no ban on the brand existed.101 Frank Bajohr is correct in his assessment that the early voluntary restructuring of the company and the timing of the attacks kept the fallout from being much worse. Calling for a boycott of a major employer with a track record of export success in 1933, reasons Bajohr, was not likely to receive a great deal of support from a government intent on dealing with the economic woes of the country. I would add, however, that the popularity of Nivea brand products, bolstered by a beloved, well-established visual image of German beauty, also served it well in this crisis, and kept the renewed attacks of the mid- and late 1930s from gaining steam. As its corporate officers repeated at every turn, Nivea was a darling of advertisement watchers in the corporate world and in the Nazi Ad Council alike. Beiersdorf was careful to cultivate this image throughout the Third Reich, as we will see, making it difficult for its detractors to convince many that this firm was in any way “un-German.” Although the Beiersdorf case is particularly well documented, the strategy of anti-Semitic slander against business competitors was common in the early days of the Third Reich. At the end of April 1933, Jacobs coffee of Bremen, the first producers of brand-name roasted coffee in Germany,102 circulated fifteen hundred flyers to wholesalers in defense of its reputation, which was also being tarnished by rivals who claimed that Jacobs had “Jewish roots.” Hoping to turn this negative publicity into a positive, Jacobs contrasted this underhanded sales strategy by “the dear competition” to its own “Hanseatic spirit” and “lower Saxon perseverance” in the face of hardship. As in the Beiersdorf example, by using this language Jacobs implicitly legitimized the critique of Jewish businesses—its managers just refused to be considered among them. Jacobs also included in the flyer the confirmation by Bremen’s Alliance of Middle-Class Businessmen of the fam-

71

72

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

ily’s agrarian background and centuries of land ownership in the region, as proof of racial purity.103 Two weeks later, Jacobs sent another letter to wholesalers offering lower prices on its products. Without mentioning the earlier uproar, the company sought to strengthen ties with its distributors by promising them higher profits.104 Even a company with close links to the military had to be concerned about such attacks. In 1938, BMW faced charges in the magazine Das Schwarze Korps that the firm continued to work with non-Aryan business partners in Brazil, Holland, Hungary, and Latvia. In the first two cases the company’s directors denied having connections to the Jewish firms, and in the third instance they announced publicly that all connections to the targeted firm had been suspended in 1936. In a rather twisted defense that actually undermined Nazi racism, BMW stressed that the new Aryan representation in Budapest was far less profitable than its former Jewish connections had been, but that BMW was willing to sacrifice its own success, because of its “positive stance toward the national socialist state and its economic program.” With regard to the fourth company, based in Riga, not only did BMW publish a sworn statement from the owner that confirmed his Aryan heritage, the Munich manufacturer also issued a letter of support from the armaments giant Krupp in Essen that defended the Riga firm as a suitable business partner.105 Beyond denouncing competitors, some firms sought to tout their own racial credentials as a selling point. The print ad slogan of Eduard Lingel Schuhfabrik AG in Erfurt was “Lingel—Germany’s most renowned pure Aryan men’s shoe manufacturer,” hinting that perhaps some of their competitors were less “pure” in this regard.106 As we will see in a later chapter, Salamander shoes, Germany’s largest shoe manufacturer, may have been concerned that Lingel was trying to attach this stigma to its brand. Salamander managers kept the offensive Lingel advertisement on file and quietly reassured sales reps of Salamander’s Aryan heritage. It would be the responsibility of the salesmen to pass this message on to any concerned distributors or retailers. While the sales staff at Salamander was working to shore up faith in the company’s racial credentials, those at Auto Union headquarters in Chemnitz were eagerly digesting the definition of a “German company” as it appeared in Hunke’s journal Die Deutsche Volkswirtschaft in 1935. After two years of wrangling over the definition, the pronouncement was made that “a company can be described as German, when its headquarters are in Germany, managers and employees are overwhelmingly German [ausschlaggebend], and its capital is held predominantly in German hands.” This



Coordination from Above and Below

news was of great interest to Auto Union, the maker of multiple car brands, including Horch, Wanderer, and Audi, precisely because it offered evidence that AU’s rival, Opel, “could not, according to this official party statement, be considered German,” a fact that Auto Union believed its sales staff could now “justifiably point to” in promotional efforts.107 Hunke and his colleagues at the journal and Werberat were certainly in favor of the Aryanization of the marketplace and restructurings like the one that took place at Beiersdorf. They were less enamored of these wild denunciations, which they saw as disruptive to business and, ironically, not befitting honorable sales practices. Until 1935, however, there was little clarity on the subject, largely because racial definitions had still hung in the air, affecting business matters as well. The Nuremberg Laws, announced first at the 1935 party rally in August and followed up with greater detail in the fall, led to a number of statements like the one above, on “German” businesses and advertising in late 1935. Among a series of essays on the topic by Werberat members was one article that began “[N]ot too long ago economic competition was thought of as a war, the goal of which was the annihilation of the enemy.” But this was no longer the case. Surely, the author admitted, “struggle” remained central to the market, but the fitting comparison was no longer the struggle of the battlefield.108 The proper comparison for market competition in the new era was that of sport, “in which each competitor gives his all—not with the goal of annihilating his enemy but instead with the aim of besting him in his level of achievement.” This analogy served as the lead-in to a stern reminder that “negative” advertisements were prohibited. Personal or business-related claims about rivals, and critiques of others’ goods and services remained off limits—as they had been for some time, despite the author’s characterization of commerce as a battlefield in the Weimar era. What needed further emphasis, however, was that the list of advertising taboos now also included “the indication of foreign state- or racial-belonging of competitors, former membership in earlier [now prohibited] political parties, or religious affiliation.” These matters were not to be ignored, of course, but “it must be left to the state leadership to make decisions based on the facts about the exclusion of individuals from participation in the market, and in no way may these questions be decided in the advertisements of trade rivals.”109 While denunciations in print would remain the exception, notices like the one circulated by Auto Union in 1935 indicate that “verbal advertising”—sales floor discussions with customers, suppliers, and others—that included damning “personal facts” about the competition became

73

74

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

the norm until Germany’s “un-German” businesses were completely forced from the market.110 For retailers, too, it was increasingly important to be able to advertise one’s business as “German.” During 1933, local SA authorities had made their own determinations of who should receive signs that read “German shop” to be hung on storefronts. In early 1934, however, this process was centralized under the Werberat’s authority, and the old signs could be exchanged free of charge for the new. The Werberat did not have the manpower to evaluate all of those wishing such a sign, and so they agreed to pay the NS-Hago, successor to the Nazi Alliance of Middle-Class Businessmen, up to 200,000 RM annually for the service. In 1936, however, the Ad Council complained that other local party officials were also still issuing their own “German shop” signs.111 Discussions also continued about the status of Aryanized businesses with new “German” owners. While Aryanized firms were able to get the “German shop” signs, authorities (and business owners alike) wondered whether it was acceptable to advertise the company’s “forty years of service,” if thirty-seven of those years had been under Jewish ownership? Hunke requested a report to settle the matter in May 1938. Its findings demonstrate a cautious willingness to overlook the Jewish past in order to recognize the long-term success of a business or its brand. If desired, explained the author, one could prohibit the practice of counting the years a company was “in Jewish hands” as “not in line with honorable business practices.” It was hard to say, however, if it made “economic-political” sense “to lay down such a strict benchmark.”112 While the Werberat was responding to activism among party enthusiasts, business owners, and consumers, it was also busy implementing some of the practical reforms it had promised from the start.113 The Ad Council’s 3rd Decree of 21 November 1933 rationalized the industry in terms of the sizing and pricing of ads and demanded far more transparency from presses about their circulation numbers.114 While these were not glamorous changes, they did serve as an effective response to some of the criticisms of the industry from within Germany and without. The reforms were even praised by Britain’s Advertiser’s Weekly, which joked that those trying to push through similar reforms at home “must be sighing for the mantle of Herr Hitler,” and ended on the more serious note that Germany’s new rate cards “serve to remind British publishers of the desirability of this useful reform.”115



Coordination from Above and Below

Other mid-decade reforms included the prohibition of foreign, mainly English and French, words and phrases from ad copy, and the reintroduction of Gothic script in place of the “international” sans-serif typefaces of the republican era.116 Two of the other more significant changes were the limits placed on sexually explicit ads and ads for tobacco products.117 In Figure 2.3, ad designers are shown the proper way to advertise women’s lingerie. Though such “before and after” comparisons of improper Reklame vs. acceptable “German” advertising were common in trade journals after 1933, discussions of how to represent acceptable feminine style and comportment appeared particularly frequently, providing evidence for Irene Guenther’s claims that these remained unresolved issues in Hitler’s Germany.118 To provide two examples, images such as that in Figure 2.4 depicting women smoking cigarettes over coffee continued to appear in illustrated magazines from time to time, as did alluring models (Figure 2.5).119 As is clear from the persistence of images such as these, not all reforms were popular; enthusiasm for Gothic type faded quickly, and even the Werberat was inconsistent in its use of the antiquated typefaces. The ban on radio ads that emanated from the Propaganda Ministry and went into effect at the end of 1935 was met with great concern and then resignation by the business community. Other measures, which purported to protect consumers from deceptive ads, such as restrictions on offering premiums and the use of celebrity endorsements as well as the insistence that all potentially dangerous ingredients in food or pharmaceutical products be labeled as such, were generally welcomed by consumers and their advocates.120 Despite these relatively significant changes to the industry, no radical aesthetic departure can be identified in the ads of the era. The move toward ad designs that incorporated larger amounts of text to convince the reader of a product’s usefulness, though preferred by the regime as more educational and less reliant on the emotional lure of the art posters that had been the mainstay of the German ads industry in previous decades, will be discussed in greater detail in the following chapter.121 However, a variety of aesthetic forms can be found in ads during the dictatorship; there was no sustained effort by the Ad Council to push for a single Nazi style. Instead the Werberat concentrated its efforts elsewhere, including the opening of the Höhere Reichswerbeschule—an integrated training institute jointly administered by the Werberat and the NSRDW that began admitting students in the summer of 1936. As explained in the previous chapter, the lack of a unified training program for would-be advertisers had been a major source of discontent. The ability to drop into a job in

75

fig. 2.3 (above and facing page). Improper (“Women’s Beauty is Women’s Power!”) and proper femininity in advertisements, Seidels Reklame, April 1936. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.

fig. 2.4. Women smoking in an advertisement for camera film. Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung, 1936. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.

fig. 2.5.  Sex still sells. Advertisement for Felina bras, Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung, 1936. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.

80

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

advertising without rigorous prerequisites meant that it was not always taken seriously as a profession by practitioners or their employers. The author of a study published in 1936 noted that a survey of men and women working in advertising turned up a “not insignificant number of cases” in which the respondent described his or her work in ads as a “sideline,” “supplemental work,” or “occasional work.”122 Not only had there been no recognized standards of education, the private schools that had dominated training in the past were considered by the National Socialists to be “by and large erected and directed by alien and racially foreign owners. There is not one known,” continued the head of the professional training bureau within the NSRDW, “which . . . has taken care to influence and orient the opinions and attitudes of its students actively and positively in the National Socialist sense.”123 Paradoxically, the new Reichswerbeschule curriculum, which was expected to combat this problem, was reminiscent of the one practiced at the most famous “alien” design school, the Bauhaus, in that its students were offered a holistic selection of courses. The founders of the Reichswerbeschule boasted that its students would graduate with the entire set of skills needed by the modern ad executive, copywriter, or graphic artist, from artistic training to law and psychology courses. The Berlin site for the school was planned as a model to be replicated in other cities, thereby creating a national curriculum that would support claims made by advertisers that they were well trained, upstanding professionals with degrees to prove it—members of the Bildungsbürgertum, not swindlers. While the images promoting the school chosen for Die Deutsche Werbung show the next generation of advertisers, young men and a handful of young women, busily learning a variety of new skills—from sketching and dressing mannequins to working with laboratory equipment for psychology experiments—the school also offered continuing education courses in the evenings for practitioners already holding positions in the field.124 The complicated nature of advertising in the Third Reich, speaking both of community and individuals, of public welfare and profit, was also captured in the Berlin school. On the one hand, the descriptions and images of the institute interior reflect its rustic “Bavarian” décor. On the other, the school was situated in the heart of the West End shopping district, enjoying a view of the famous KaDeWe department store. The location, therefore, implied a certain reconciliation with, even celebration of, bourgeois consumerism that was also not lost in the press coverage of the school’s opening.125

fig. 2.6.  Opening of the Reichswerbeschule in the heart of Berlin’s shopping district, 1936. Courtesy of Heinrich Hunke Nachlass, Staatsarchiv NordrheinWestfalen, Abteilung Ostwestfalen-Lippe.

fig. 2.7.  Cooperative advertisement for barbers, ca. 1935. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Bildarchiv Preussischer Kulturbesitz/Art Resource, NY.



Coordination from Above and Below

One form of advertising that was particularly encouraged by the Ad Council was the Gemeinschaftswerbungen, or advertisements that promoted an entire

economic sector or all producers of the same commodity. Though not new or unique to Germany, some National Socialists argued in the 1930s that this form of advertising, which downplayed competition, was the only ad strategy that fit the Nazi ethos.126 But the Ad Council, populated also by business leaders with their own brands to protect, was unwilling to go that far. Gemeinschaftswerbungen became more common in this period (as they did in Britain, the United States, and elsewhere), but mainly for commodities in which the German origins of the product served in a sense as the brand label. This was particularly true for the agricultural sector, leading to advertisements for German bread, eggs, milk, and the like, as we still see in many national contexts today. Representatives of regional specialty industries that did not have the funds to advertise on their own, particularly to a national or international audience, were also encouraged to produce Gemeinschaftswerbungen. Throughout the prewar era, the Ad Council offered large and small grants for the design and placement of these ads, particularly for traditional handicraft industries. For example, in 1936 the Werberat gave 20,000 RM for ads with the title “Art in German handicrafts”; 5,000 RM for a wine-tasting of German vintages at the Olympics; 129,500 RM for a film about German shipbuilding; 5,000 RM for a toy exhibition in Thuringia; and 20,000 RM for ads promoting the German porcelain industry. In some cases there were conditions put on the grants, especially as money grew tighter—for example, demands that the companies hoping to benefit from this assistance match or surpass the donation from the Ad Council. In 1937, the Ad Council promised 50,000 RM to the clock industry for Gemeinschaftswerbungen—on the condition that the members of the national clock association spend 100,000 RM of its own funds on individual, that is, competitive, print ads.127 In providing these funds to stimulate the placement of ads, Hunke, who seems to have personally signed off on all of these grants, was also insuring greater returns to the Council via the ad tax, or Werbeabgabe. Although the Werberat continued to promote the use of Gemeinschaftswerbungen, these sectorwide ads were never expected to replace individual advertisements. Hanns Brose was one leading advertiser who took the position that the Ad Council’s work to support this type of advertisement made sense, but that it was not a substitute for the promotion of brandname goods. For one thing, as he explained in 1937, consumers develop brand loyalty that is intimate and specific to the brand’s image built up

83

84

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

over years of promotional efforts. So while sectorwide advertisements, in which the companies of origin go unmentioned, may remind a consumer to purchase hand cream, they will never have the same power, for example, as a Nivea ad from the easily recognizable and trusted Beiersdorf AG. Its round blue and white canister had been a staple in German households for a generation. Its image of “German beauty” was embraced in both the Weimar and Nazi eras with little alteration. Moreover, Brose insisted, an ad for a brand name product did not rule out the sort of horizontal gains across a sector that the Gemeinschaftswerbung hoped to awaken. Using the example of Odol mouthwash, an account that Brose directed for a number of years, he reasoned that a consumer who read Odol’s enlightening text, linking mouth hygiene with overall good health, may decide that mouthwash and toothpaste were important purchases, but may choose another brand for its price or availability—meaning the one Odol ad helped other producers. In addition, that one Odol ad might have vertical consequences for buying habits as well. As our hypothetical consumer, Frau Schmidt, becomes convinced by the arguments made by the Lingner-Werke manufacturers of Odol that personal hygiene is linked to good health, she may also begin to spend more money on other hygiene products, such as shampoos, or higher quality foods for her whole family.128 In these ways, concluded Brose, the individual ad [Eigenwerbung] had great benefits for the national economy in ways that were less certain for the Gemeinschaftswerbung. What Brose chose to impress most upon his readers, however, was the need for market research to back up all advertising campaigns and break down any potential “sales resistance” [Absatzwiderstand]. As evidence that the German ad industry was not cut off either in thinking or personal contact from the Anglo-American ad world after 1933, Brose often drew on the writings of James Young, of JWT, as an early proponent of Gemeinschaftswerbung and of research and planning more generally. In his measured support for such ads, Brose offered both positive and negative examples of recent German Gemeinschafts-ad campaigns.129 Energy producers wanted to sell more electricity, but in order to do so they had to create the desire for electrical appliances. Vertical teamwork among utilities and the makers of electric consumer goods, in this instance, was required and succeeded in driving up demand for electricity in the mid-1930s. Brose also praised the work of Kupferberg, which had transformed German sparkling wine—previously a luxury item—into the “Celebratory drink of the German Family” after 1933, via this völkisch slogan and through the introduction of smaller, less expensive bottles that encouraged a whole new sector of the population



Coordination from Above and Below

to celebrate with a taste of “bubbly.”130 However, Brose added, sector ads for chocolate had been a complete failure in the late 1920s, because female consumers remained convinced that chocolate made them gain weight. In this case, chocolate producers had not done their homework. It was unlikely that chocolate manufacturers could convince fashion designers to give up the slim silhouette for women’s attire, he explained, but the chocolate industry should have worked together on a horizontal basis to develop less fattening chocolate options—and make such recipes an explicit selling point in their promotional efforts.131 In this and other writings, Brose mimicked the advice of his counterparts at JWT and other Anglo-American agencies when he sought to convince his colleagues and the Ad Council that in advertising “the plan, not the idea, leads to success.”132 A number of industries did develop such plans for coordinated advertising, despite—or perhaps owing to—the cartelization of the German economy that was taking place. The pharmaceutical industry, led by giants like IG Farben (the makers of Bayer aspirin and other consumer healthcare products), had been reorganized into the cartel Reichsfachschaft der Pharmazeutischen Industrie (Reipha), with its own committee to deal with advertising issues. Sectorwide pharmaceutical ads were discussed at length in the committee during May 1934. Some committee members welcomed the opportunity to clean up the image of the whole industry, which was under attack for exaggerated claims in promotional literature and for hiding or downplaying potentially dangerous side effects. But for others, such “neutral” ads in a competitive marketplace seemed disingenuous. One representative argued, “Aren’t there times within the pharmaceutical industry that are the exact opposite of community?” He voted against the idea of investing in such ads on the principle that “these things, which are useful to some, hurt the others.”133 Despite this dissenting voice, enthusiasm for Gemeinschaftswerbung carried the day and two subcommittees were struck: one for the development of domestic sectorwide ads, and one for the foreign promotion of German pharmaceuticals. The latter grew out of a particular concern about the level of French investment in advertisements aimed at the growing Balkan market. While the general tenor of the meeting remained supportive of Werberat measures, it was also decided that it would be wise to work toward having one Reipha representative appointed to the Ad Council to have future input on decisions that influenced the pharmaceutical industry.134 Other companies, including Böhme Fettchemie, also decided to cultivate the Ad Council as an ally. BFC’s enthusiasm for this relationship followed the council’s 1937 decision in its fa-

85

86

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

vor after charges were laid by rivals that a series of its ads were misleading. In fact, the Chemnitz firm reasoned that it might avoid similar headaches in the future if its publicity managers discussed promotional plans with Ad Council staff before going into production, particularly by speaking to one contact, who was judged to be “well informed about our situation and has a very good understanding of the needs of advertisers.”135 Of course, not everyone was willing to work with the Ad Council, or pleased with the reforms the council had implemented. In addition to those purged from their jobs, some advertisers and business owners found the regulations erected roadblocks to sales, and others simply disregarded the continual flood of new rules—which were presented in language that was considered Byzantine at best.136 The Werberat had its enemies within the state bureaucracy as well. The Justice Ministry mounted the most vociferous campaigns against the Werberat, charging that this nongovernmental body was encroaching on its territory—de facto writing law and prosecuting infractions. In February 1937, the Akademie für Deutsches Recht committee on competition and trademark law concluded that the Werberat’s extrajudicial authority [Neben-Gerichtsbarkeit] had to end. They insisted that the Werberat had no legal right to censure companies for unfair business practices by withholding their right to advertise. These legal minds were confident that the courts were perfectly able to monitor businesses, as they had always done, and concluded that without the power to enforce its regulations the Ad Council should be disbanded. One particularly combative member of the committee accurately captured Hunke’s enthusiasm, yet underestimated the tenacity of the Werberat’s leadership: “The overzealousness by which the Werberat has developed has been precisely the ground on which it has run ashore, and now only the timing of its burial is yet to be determined.”137 Such turf warfare was common within the dictatorship, and the debate about whether Werberat regulations were at all legally binding continued.138 But Hunke was not bent on deflecting criticism of the Werberat solely in order to defend his piece of the pie. He and his colleagues in business were also convinced that there were economic and ideological reasons to advocate for advertisers, manufacturers, and consumers vis-à-vis the government. Happily for them, Joseph Goebbels was on their side, and his support remained essential to the Werberat’s ability to fend off its adversaries. Despite the tangible reforms of the mid-1930s, the Werberat would not be able to maintain its place among the many offices jockeying for power in the regime, or retain its links to the business world, if it could not prove



Coordination from Above and Below

that its existence contributed positively to the Volkswirtschaft and Volksgemeinschaft (the people’s economy and people’s community). Happily for the council, most large consumer products companies, as we will see in the next chapter, embraced the reforms largely of their own accord. Given the tendency toward hyperbole in the Third Reich and advertising more generally, then, it is perhaps not surprising that the relatively independent trade journal Seidels Reklame would claim in 1936 that in three years the industry had been fundamentally transformed in its “general legal concepts, in terms of salesmanship ethics, in the methods of competition, in its social relations, in its artistic-cultural foundations, in its moral values, in its concept of beauty, [and] in the psychology of its appeals.”139 These are big claims for three years of work, and the “progress” was not as uniform as this article made it out to be.140 More important than the relative accuracy of this statement, however, is the fact that this list of achievements could easily have applied to reforms taking place in the United States or British contexts. While Hunke and those who worked with him proclaimed that advertising was getting a “German” makeover, one could fairly easily provide evidence that it was becoming more similar to advertising in the Anglo-American world, rather than less. Regardless of this comparison—one that Hunke certainly would have been reluctant to make (though many practitioners may have recognized)—the bravado does indicate a certain confidence among German advertisers that the industry was moving in the right direction. It appeared that advertising and the consumption it attempted to foster had found their feet in the new era. This task, however, would only become more difficult after the introduction of the Four-Year Plan for autarchy in 1936. Yet Heinrich Hunke boasted in 1938 of what he saw as five years of great success in his book The New Commercial Advertising [Die neue Wirtschaftswerbung]. He began by reiterating the need for competition and advertising in the Reich, arguing for a “synthesis between private and community initiative.” While competition should remain, the language of the marketplace as presented through advertisements was one of individual or national achievement, rather than cheap stunts or back-biting rivalry.141 He insisted that by mid-decade more than 50,000 Germans could be considered advertisers of one sort or another, and that did not count the 220,000 sales representatives and many thousands of others who were closely linked to advertising. He pointed out that over 1 billion RM was spent annually on advertising by German firms, happily interpreting this data as a sign that the advertising industry was as valuable to Germany as the comparatively sized automotive indus-

87

88

From Internationalism to “German Advertising”

try.142 In his annual reports, which meticulously detailed every program the Ad Council was involved in—from the Höhere Reichwerbeschule to the support of recipe booklets to promote fish consumption—Hunke cited the steady increase in the number of advertisements produced in Germany throughout the 1930s, and concluded that its influence and reforms were leading to growing confidence in the economic value of ads among business owners, and to greater trust in the claims made by ads among consumers.143 More work, however, was still needed. In particular, in his 1938 text Hunke emphasized the importance of using advertisements for German goods to improve Germany’s reputation abroad: “[T]he problem of the Jewish boycott in foreign countries, the hate of transnational powers, the Church question, the rejection of dictatorships and all the other local disruptive factors” made it hard for German companies to get a fair hearing beyond the nation’s borders. German ad men should rekindle the adventurous “Hanseatic”144 spirit of a bygone era, he suggested, for now they had a bigger task than ever before them. They were not simply representing “private business, rather they were advertising for understanding for all of Germany.”145 Though Hunke had visions of empire that would soon in part be realized, we must first look more closely at how companies responded to these calls for representing the new Germany through their advertisements. Did they feel as pleased and self-confident as Hunke by the end of the decade, and most important, did they foster a commercial culture that breathed life into the fantasies of Volksgemeinschaft?

chapter three

Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime Advertising is the bridge by which supply and demand perpetually encounter each other.1

The Werberat claimed that after its first five years in operation, it had increased public confidence in advertisements and created links between private industry and the state to the benefit of both. These reforms, according to the Ad Council, ensured that buying and selling would continue, thereby aiding in the dual long-term goals of creating jobs and achieving a higher standard of living for all members of the Volk. In such a community, rational consumers made purchases that suited their desires while supporting the overall health of the nation according to National Socialist ideology. This remained a somewhat tricky calculation—one that became more complicated as the preparations for war ramped up. The complex arithmetic that consumer goods manufacturers were faced with, however, had less to do with older images of the Nazi economy as one firmly coordinated and directed from above. Surely, anxieties about pricing and the availability of raw materials remained evident throughout the period. The self-professed aims of advertisers and salesmen, however, were not fundamentally altered during the dictatorship. Educating consumers to recognize and remain loyal to the tangible and intangible promises of a brand continued to be the goal of ad men and women everywhere. This chapter demonstrates, therefore, the relative independence by which companies operated, and argues that even after the Gleichschaltung of the industry German advertisers had little to fear in terms of censorship or strict regulation of ad content. To put it bluntly, the consumer goods sector was not as directed or coordinated by the state as we might expect. This statement does not discount racial policy that led to the exclusion by the end of 1938 of tens of thousands of German Jews who worked in consumer

92

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

goods–related industries (as company owners, executives, and managers, as well as those in wholesale and retail). Instead, my point is that such visible trends were the result of self-disciplining at the corporate level. Company managers hoping to stay profitable in an economy gearing up for war designed advertisements that supported the regime and its goals out of ideological conviction, out of their sense of good advertising strategy in this particular cultural moment, or some combination of the two. This chapter will examine the advertising strategies of a variety of leading German brands as they appeared from 1933 until the onset of war in 1939. Most of the examples will come from the nondurable goods sector. Durable goods, such as large household appliances, remained beyond the financial means of most Germans. Some examples from the automobile sector are present to offer perspective on the branding of luxury items in these years. The experiences of individual firms varied greatly. As noted in the last chapter, some companies found their products demonized for their links to “Jewish capital.” Others, such as the firms behind coffee and chocolate brands, faced difficulties owing to limits on imported foodstuffs, while still others found themselves perfectly situated to make significant gains in these years owing to regime goals like mass electrification. This variegated picture of the consumer economy should not surprise us. Capitalism relies on competitive forces, and while all the brands here turn out to be “winners” in the long run, their paths to success followed different trajectories. The chapter is built around three sections. The first section will highlight the opportunities afforded to advertisers by the new media, radio and film, before turning to print advertisements as the staple of the German ad industry in this era. Examples of other promotional efforts, such as trade exhibitions or window displays, will appear sporadically. The aim will be to characterize the advertising landscape in these years and to evaluate how companies negotiated their desire to remain fashionable with consumers with the call for reform by the Ad Council, taking advantage, when possible, of Nazi values in order to curry favor with both constituencies and remain profitable. The second section picks up on this theme via the consideration of “good corporate citizenship.” In the previous chapter we saw examples of how some firms targeted other brands as alien to the “new Germany.” Here we examine how companies positioned their brands as contributors to the construction of the Volksgemeinschaft. In the last section the chapter turns to Osram brand light bulbs, as a case study in which a number of forces aligned to situate this brand for success. Advertisements represented another venue to showcase Nazi ideology



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

and policy, and the ideals of racial unity. As we will see, creating “German advertising” [Deutsche Werbung] did not mean the wholesale rejection of Weimar-era or international styles. The Werberat did not insist on many major reforms to ad content until the shortages brought on by war, and company leaders would have shown far more concern if they thought the Ad Council’s regulation of advertisements were cutting into their bottom lines. This decision by Goebbels, and those who worked under him, not to propagandize advertisements overtly helped to sustain continuity in the visual commercial landscape. Advertising trends of the 1930s, where they can be differentiated from the pre-1933 period, were largely subtle and reassuring, which had the effect of sanctioning the changes taking place in Germany. Aryan Germans were left feeling confident about their futures, and less concerned about the loss of individual rights and freedoms.

the attractions of new media: radio and film ads It would be wrong not to emphasize the opportunities for growth that corporate leaders hoped would follow with the stabilization of the new regime. The same goes for the advertising sector. The future looked bright for those not targeted by the regime, given Hitler’s promises to right the economy in four years. As the economy slowly gained steam and companies began investing again in promotional efforts, advertisers had a plethora of venues to choose among. In addition to print advertisements, which appeared as product brochures and leaflets, posters, coupons, and large or small classifieds in the daily press, illustrated magazines, and specialized journals, there were secondary forms of product promotion, such as giveaways and other ephemera, window displays, and packaging, that were crucial in the development of brand recognition and loyalty.2 Trademarks too had already become an important part of some companies’ images in the nineteenth century, as discussed extensively by David Ciarlo, and many of the firms that are part of this study spent a great deal of time over the decades refining and updating their trademarked logos.3 Advertisers had also become increasingly enthusiastic about the use of radio for their work, starting in the 1920s, as more and more Germans were able to purchase wireless sets of their own or find them in public places. It was not long before radio jingles were recognized for their ability to lock a brand name in the mind of a consumer. The republican government

93

94

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

had also experimented with radio’s political potential in the 1920s, which led after 1933 to a struggle over the raison d’etre of the new medium.4 The new National Socialist government made the production of an affordable wireless set a priority, as a key propaganda tool and as a gesture toward greater consumer satisfaction. Goebbels’s ministry achieved this goal with the introduction of the most successful Volksprodukt [people’s product], the Volksempfänger, in August 1933. Substantial growth of family radio ownership among Germans, and the increased presence of radios in cafes, places of employment, and schools, followed in the 1930s. Though not the least expensive on the market in Europe, this basic wireless set was available initially for as little as 76 RM, and later models were offered at even lower prices. While much has been made of the fact that the Volksempfänger was designed to make it difficult to pick up foreign broadcasts, it was always more than just a means of indoctrination. The People’s Wireless also served the dictatorship well as a newly affordable mass consumer item—an early step in realizing the regime’s promises to bring prosperity. Most important, the radio became a focal point for community life. Germans could now participate in the “history-making” events of the dictatorship by listening to live broadcasts at home or in public places. Under Goebbels’s ministerial control, recent scholarship has illustrated the false starts of the RMVP in finding politically suitable, yet entertaining, fare for listeners. Speeches by Hitler and coverage of party spectacles grew tiresome to listeners quite quickly. Over time, however, Goebbels’s ministry made headway in pleasing audiences by offering a combination of feel-good popular music and radio-theater, combined with more serious classical music, news, and politics.5 Whether light fare or hard propaganda, a new national audience consumed together.6 What did disappear, however, from the radio waves was commercial advertising. Despite the efforts underway to “clean up” advertising, Goebbels was adamant that this commercial tool not sully the cultural and political value of radio. His insistence on the elimination of ads from German broadcasts was similar to the motivation behind the Law for the Protection of National Symbols, discussed in the previous chapter. Once again the state was demanding the separation of commercial propaganda from political propaganda. Both had a role to play in national rejuvenation, but at least for the time being, they were separate roles—and mixing them diluted and cheapened the latter. The plan to ban all ads for consumer products was first announced at



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

the beginning of 1934,7 but the idea faced resistance from corporations that believed they were finding success with radio ads in what were still difficult economic times. With the support of other leading manufacturers of consumer products that used radio ads, Paul Mundhenke, head of advertising at Henkel, made the case against the ban directly to the minister of economy, Hjalmar Schacht.8 Given the slowness of the economic recovery, Mundhenke’s arguments did carry some weight. In the end the ban was postponed more than once, as a way to give companies time to prepare new promotional strategies.9 Corporate leaders were ultimately unable to convince the Propaganda Ministry to reverse the ban, which went into effect at the end of 1935. With radio no longer at their disposal, larger companies that could afford the investment often turned to short advertising films as a substitute.10 Films were not entirely new to German advertising; a few companies had turned to film around the turn of the century. The use of film for propaganda purposes during the First World War marked a real breakthrough, and the medium became more popular during the Weimar Republic among advertisers, particularly to introduce the merits of new products.11 For example, Henkel invested in film in 1930 as a way to show consumers how

fig. 3.1.  Boys at an outdoor screening of a Henkel film, Henkel, Blätter vom Hause, 1930. Courtesy of Corporate Archive, Henkel AG & Co. KGaA.

95

fig. 3.2. Dreaming of Henkel products, Henkel, Blätter vom Hause, 1932, phot. Steffi Ludwig. Courtesy of Corporate Archive, Henkel AG & Co. KGaA.



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

they could save money by using their water softening agents, Henko and Sil, which kept laundry whiter longer with the use of less detergent.12 Companies that ventured into this new medium believed that films would have a greater impact on audience members than the still, silent images in print venues. Film was popular among manufacturers in heavy industry, because they could actually demonstrate their machines at work.13 Even consumer product firms recognized that film allowed them to create more complex stories with their product in the starring role. In Fig. 3.2, which appeared in the Henkel company newsletter in 1932, a young woman who had visited a screening of Henkel’s film “Laundry, Washing, Well-Being” now sleeps comfortably while images of Henkel products dance in her head, obscuring a recognizable icon of high culture, the Mona Lisa, hanging above her bed.14 It is unclear whether this shot from the film was intended to illustrate the effacement of high culture by the triumphal brand aesthetic, or to demonstrate that cultured young German women could also respect the more down-to-earth domestic beauty provided by Henkel’s products. In either case the growing cultural significance of consumer products, and the medium of film, too, as an engaging consumable cultural form that had the power to affect the subconscious of audience members is striking. By 1935 it was estimated that about half of the five thousand cinemas in Germany were showing advertising films or single-frame slides. Theaters that put on variety shows and operettas were also known to display ad films or slides during intermission. At first, animated shorts or a series of still shots were most common, but by the end of the decade some of the larger companies, such as Henkel, were making live action films that required more serious investment. For 1935 the total investment in this growing medium was thought to be 25.5 million RM, for the production and distribution of about a thousand films.15 Even more popular as an option for filling the gap left by radio was the use of slides. These were single-frame advertisements quite like a print advertisement—in fact many companies offered their local retailers the same exact national brand ad in various print sizes or prepared for projectors. The wholesaler or retailer could also order either to be customized with his name and address at the bottom as the best outlet to purchase the product, thereby linking local businesses to the national brand. Companies with larger budgets sometimes used slides with sound: background music, spoken text, or jingles. It was estimated in 1935 that 120,000 dias were shown daily in German theaters.16 Whatever the size of the investment, the potential advantages of the film ad were thought to be obvious: a captive audience that fit the desired de-

97

98

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

mographic of likely consumers of lower-priced daily use items, and the possibility of using sound and motion to create a more engaging experience for the viewer.17 For example, the 1933 ad film “Mehr Sonne” [More Sun] for iMi, an inexpensive all-purpose cleaner from Henkel, had only sixteen shots but presented a compelling look at the pleasures and drudgery of housewifery. As the film begins the female narrator, who refers to herself in the first person and addresses the audience directly, speaks of the good times of marriage, raising children, and caring for them—but it is the endless work involved that dampens these joys. As she explains: And this is not only true for Frau Schulze, but it is also the same for Frau Lehmann, Frau Müller, for me and for you, yes, everywhere in the world. And that is the dark side of life. Order becomes cluttered, clean becomes dirty, the beauty of things is lost. . . . resulting in tremendous disorder [followed by] the cleaning, the polishing, scrubbing and brushing, the washing and rinsing. . . . Every day: once—twice—three times, morning—afternoon—evenings, and not only at Frau Schulze’s, but also at Frau Lehmann’s, Frau Müller’s, at my house and yours, yes, as before—in the whole world.18

This dramatic text, spoken in a personal tone to the female members of the audience, had the potential to convince consumers that iMi could bring convenience and happiness—“more sun”—to their lives. On the one hand such language fit easily into National Socialist appeals for greater labor productivity and efficiency. With iMi, housecleaning was presumably easier and more effective. At the same time, however, this sort of gendered pitch can be found in 1930s ads for cleansers throughout Europe and North America as women struggled to balance the many pressures on their time and energy. What was more innovative, from Henkel’s point of view, was that the use of film provided the opportunity to show a variety of women, covering different ages and income brackets, in the hope of appealing to more female viewers than a print ad or poster. Ideally each woman in the audience would see “herself ” in the film at some point, thereby finding her own (albeit illusionary) personal emancipation from drudgery through Henkel’s iMi. These new media were not always easy for companies to exploit. It appears that Elly Heuss-Knapp, arguably the most successful independent female ad writer of the era and wife of the liberal journalist and former Democratic Party parliamentarian Theodor Heuss, may have been brought on board at Beiersdorf, the makers of Nivea brand products, to expand the firm’s offerings on radio, where it felt the competition had gained the early upper hand.19 No doubt the company was also hoping to use radio



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

to combat the attacks, discussed in the previous chapter, by competitors who branded its products “Jewish skin cream,” despite the firm’s self-Aryanization. Heuss-Knapp was a good choice for the assignment. Her first article on the topic of radio ads appeared in the professional journal Der Kaufmann ueberm Durchschnitt in November 1933—a rare occurrence for a woman author, particularly given that the subject was not solely about effective appeals to female consumers.20 In June 1934, Heuss-Knapp wrote to Beiersdorf with much enthusiasm about her new task, reporting excitedly that Nivea would be well suited for a radio jingle because of the “soft melodic” sound of the name. She imagined violins and perhaps a Vox Humana (an organ equipped with reeds to sound like human voices) playing in the background. On the same day, however, the head of the Nivea ad department, Juan Clausen, sent her a warning: “Nivea ads must have Niveau [class].” In fact, Clausen mused, “Nivea-Niveau might offer a useful play on words. Just remember we don’t care for rhymes. For God’s sake, please no Thea . . . Nivea, or anything like that.”21 A week later the in-house ad department lamented to HeussKnapp that Nivea’s closest competitor in toothpaste (likely Chlorodont) had already been advertising for some months on the radio. While her new colleagues advised her to make use of the same phrases currently employed in the company’s print advertisements, “mild, easy foaming, and terrific in taste,” they admitted rather drearily that “beyond that, our toothpaste does what every other toothpaste does—it keeps teeth white, clean and healthy. There is not really too much to say about toothpaste.”22 HeussKnapp was of a different mindset. Four days later she sent back six drafts of copy for Nivea toothpaste radio ads, and prompted her colleagues to read “more with their ears than their eyes.” Her plan was to use children’s voices, which, she insisted, were effective among all listeners but “irresistible to women.”23 While it is unclear from the archival evidence whether any of these six proposals were adopted, it is evident that Clausen quickly began to trust her abilities. Just two months later, Clausen needed only two days to sanction a radio jingle she penned to sell Beiersdorf ’s bandage brand, Hansaplast—and it even rhymed.24 Heuss-Knapp preferred musical ads for radio, because she thought listeners tired of them less quickly than conversational ads, which she described as “sounding good the first time, but by the third time, you turn off the radio.”25 Nonetheless, she wrote the texts for a number of radio dialogues, often between fictional family members. In little sketches a scene would play out that quickly demonstrated the value of the product, and

99

100

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

where possible she tried to create humorous scenarios for the audience. In one such sketch for Nivea crème that sought to illustrate the product’s worth against the raw winds and rain of spring, Heuss-Knapp rejected a straightforward scenario of the need to defend hands and faces from the effects of harsh weather. Instead she wrote the text for a humorous ad called “April Fool’s,” in which a teenage son claims in jest that he has used all his mother’s Nivea crème to shine the car and protect its tires.26 Though some practitioners had advocated since the 1920s for more ads that picked up on the American model of using laughter to sell, such ad copy was still uncommon in Germany. Companies were wary of coming across as “too American” or childish and unprofessional. And even those in the NSRDW who encouraged the integration of humorous scenarios into advertisements were quick to point out that if the brand name “came across as a clown, then it won’t be taken seriously.”27 It appears that Heuss-Knapp’s idea was accepted by her superiors at Beiersdorf, but her submission of the text included a defense of her choice: “Everyone in Germany hungers for humor! Why is advertising in general so terribly serious?”28 Throughout 1935, it was clear the days of radio ads were numbered. Despite the ban on radio ads within Germany, Beiersdorf among other exporters continued to produce ads for broadcast in other countries throughout the latter 1930s, and many of Heuss-Knapp’s texts were heard in Latin America and in other European countries in translation. From 1936 on, film ads took over within Germany as the most innovative method of product promotion. So much so, in fact, that in September 1938 Elly Heuss-Knapp complained that Ufa had warned her that a “flood of ad-film contracts” over the summer meant that it would be difficult to show Beiersdorf ’s newly completed film before the new year.29 The first Nivea film was already in the planning stages in 1935, and the two-minute film was ready for theaters by early 1936. The film, “Weiss in Blau” [White in Blue], was a double reference to Nivea crème’s famous round metal tin with the white Nivea brand name centered in the field of indigo blue, as well as the white crème within the blue container.30 There were four separate short films released under this title at intervals throughout 1936.31 The method of filming was to use cut-out white paper-profiled figures set against a dark background, creating a similar “white in blue” look. Though we have no substantial evidence about audience reception, Heuss-Knapp was disappointed with the final results, particularly the sound quality. After the film began hitting the theaters, she believed that some competitors’ ads had a higher production value, making the flaws in the Nivea film even more



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

evident. Heuss-Knapp and her colleagues spent two years readying their next foray into film. In 1938, “Katharine” arrived on screens. This short film used marionettes to perform the action of the story about the advantages of using Nivea crème to protect and tan the skin. Beiersdorf and Heuss-Knapp were more satisfied in the end, even though the dolls had to be remade before production in order to be considered suitable, including the selection of darker material for the main character who had “browned” with Nivea. Even then, Heuss-Knapp still found that some copies of the film were in better shape than others, and that once again the sound was disappointing. Traveling around to see “Katharine” in theaters and catch viewers’ responses, which she reported as generally positive, Heuss-Knapp continued to bemoan the fact that cinemas did not always have well-functioning equipment, which in her opinion decreased the effectiveness of all ad films.32 Nonetheless, “Katharine” was considered an important piece by other advertisers, and Heuss-Knapp’s work in this field was recognized by an article in Die Deutsche Werbung in 1939. After laying out the four important steps in the production of a film (planning, writing, collaboration, production), she emphasized that one had to remember the power of fantasy over rationality in creating film. If other practitioners followed her advice, Heuss-Knapp concluded, “there is hardly an advertising tool [better than film] to awaken desire and show the way to its fulfillment.”33 From an ideological point of view her comments are noteworthy. Though Heuss-Knapp was a respected liberal thinker in her own right, she constantly pushed Beiersdorf to take seriously the importance of the subconscious in the company’s advertising. Whether it was by promoting the use of rhyme and jingles that would “get stuck” in the listener’s head, or by employing humor in a sketch that jokes about using the product in a way not intended by the manufacturer, she was consistent (as in this article) in downplaying the efficacy of the “rational” education of the consumer to sell goods. We often associate such a turn to fantasy as central to the emotional impulses of National Socialism. Yet as we have seen elsewhere in this book, the Werberat and the NSRDW presented their reforms and campaigns for the profession more generally as a move toward the rational in advertising—“enlightenment” ads that would truthfully spell out the advantages of certain products. The complexities here force us to reconsider stark distinctions between Nazi appeals to the irrational and liberal appeals to the rational. Indeed what we have with the era’s advertising are two visions of the “science of

101

102

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

selling”—one that claimed to convince the rational decision-maker by focusing on the merits of the product, and one that sought to tap into subconscious desire—but how different were they? Certainly many ads tried to work with both strategies in mind: Odol mouthwash promised to kill oral bacteria, which scientists had proven led to bad breath. The fresh breath of the enlightened consumer, of course, was also eminently more kissable. To muddy the waters even further, rational copy-laden text that “taught” and humorous ads that entertained were both considered “American” innovations. Ad directors may have believed that fantasy was better suited for the medium than education. After all, the audience had arrived at the theater expecting to be swept away to another time or place by the feature film. While today we do not think of light bulbs as eliciting the strong emotions that fuel fantasy, Osram was an early proponent of film advertisements. The company’s first films were productions of its trade interest group. Die Arbeitsgemeinschaft zur Förderung der Elektrowirtschaft (AFE), or Working Association for the Advancement of the Electric-Economy, was funded by a number of companies, including Osram, and it produced many types of Gemeinschaftswerbungen, the cooperative ads discussed in Chapter 2. The AFE was already releasing its second film promoting electricity in October 1934, following what was believed to have been the great success of the first, which introduced the cartoon character “Little Electro-Man” (shaped like the stout German two-pronged/two-legged plug). The gnome-like superhero could save the day through the wonders of electricity. The first film had been shown for two years in all parts of the Reich, and the AFE had concluded that “there was no more effective means” than film to reach both “city and countryside,” and “all levels of the population,” making its new ambassador Electro-Man “well known and trusted.” A third film was in the works, in which a bride’s family without electricity tries desperately to prepare for her wedding day. When they hide their difficulties from the groom-to-be, misunderstandings ensue and it appears the wedding may be called off—until Strommänchen arrives on the scene with small electrical appliances that help the bride get to the altar on time.34 While clearly a work of fantasy—not only the superhero but also the accessibility of electrical appliances—Osram and others in related industries were well placed to take advantage of the regime’s call for electrification. Hitler was aware that Germans measured their own standard of living by the “yardstick” of “conditions of American life.”35 In terms of electrification, Germany was not far behind its rival. In 1933 a larger percentage of



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

Germans lived in areas serviced by electricity than Americans, but a higher percentage of Germany’s total consumption of electricity went to industry, as opposed to residential use, than in the American case.36 The consolidation of electricity production in the hands of a few megaproducers and greater state regulation that had begun in the Weimar era would be furthered after 1933 to promote efficiency and allow for greater intervention by Schacht’s Ministry of Economic Affairs.37 The goal was mass electrification, which was deemed critical to the preparations for war and in the domestic sphere as a symbol of the dictatorship’s modern worldview that promoted rationalized living, greater hygiene, and leisure opportunities for its people as readily as it built (electrified) prison camps.38 By 1936, 87 percent of German homes were wired for electric lighting, but the number of homes with wall outlets was much lower.39 Recognizing this propitious moment, Osram also considered producing ad films of its own.40 One possibility that excited company managers in 1935 was the development of films for Germany’s 11 million school children. Osram’s ad department had heard rumors that the Propaganda Ministry had proposed an investment of 50 million RM to equip all schools with film projectors that would work alongside radios as a further medium for bringing the Volk together to participate in the victories of the new era.41 Further details of the plan were unknown, but the Berlin firm Siemens & Halske had already received an order for eight hundred projectors. Osram was salivating over the estimated ten thousand projector bulbs that would be needed in the first year alone. Moreover, once projectors were installed there would be a shortage of appropriate films. The firm insisted that contributing its own educational films on Osram’s manufacturing process, and the significance of lighting for good health, was an opportunity not to be missed. Young people, the ad department mused, were both “more friendly to films than the older generation, and more open to the idea that more light is needed, since they are not familiar with times in which people got along fine with far less light.”42 Beyond schools, the firm also considered an investment in ad films for theaters to spread the message of more and better light. Here Osram had a couple of choices. If the company produced a “cultural film” on light, as judged by the censors in the Propaganda Ministry’s RKK for film, then the state film company Ufa would allow it to run in all cinemas free of charge. The other option would be to self-finance the production of short ad films, but then push the cost of screening the films onto the retailers and professional associations for those in electricity-related industries. This financial

103

104

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

burden would be made more “palatable” by including the retailer’s name at the end of the filmstrip.43 After some consideration, Osram decided against producing short Werbefilme for its own products. After viewing examples from other companies, Osram was left unimpressed by the quality and believed that for the investment involved, the return was not satisfactory—largely because such films “had a limited shelf life.” Instead the ad department came forward with a proposal for a Werkfilm in 1935. While the Werbefilm only promoted the product, the Werkfilm would leave the firm’s light bulbs in the background, while “the company, its development, achievements, its life” would take center stage. As a piece of industrial history, the ad department argued, such a film was a contribution to the cultural history of the nation. It would also be good for morale among the sixteen-thousand-strong Osram workforce. Finally, the film could remain current for a longer period. Indeed, the Werkfilm, unlike the ordinary ad film, “could live and even grow” over time. They hoped to have it ready to show employees during the company’s upcoming anniversary celebration. A selective release in Berlin theaters was planned, followed eventually by viewings throughout the Reich. The film would even be sent abroad and screened for the press. It would run permanently for visitors to the company museum and could be shown at private meetings of electricians, technical associations, Nazi mass organizations including the German Labor Front, and at schools. The plan was for thirty to forty-five minutes worth of film, beginning with a narrator describing the historical development of lighting, from oil, candles, and gas to Siemens’s dynamo and Edison’s laboratory—then on to the first Siemens and AEG factories, all before 1920. Moving quickly, the film would cover Osram’s own contributions, including images of employees and its research center. The educational demonstrations for consumers held at the Osram Museum and Lichthaus [House of Light] would be highlighted, as would the benefits of working at Osram (the canteen, the sports fields, and company orchestra). The film’s message was to be: “The individual, master of raw materials and machines, is the foundation of the whole enterprise.” The conclusion would center on present-day uses of Osram products and manufacturing sites under the title “Osram throughout the world,” capped off by an excerpt from the Führer’s recent greetings to mark the anniversary.44 While the use of national symbols, including likenesses of the regime’s leaders, had been prohibited in advertisements since May 1933, Osram’s commercial use of the Führer in the film had become de rigeur in Germany’s corporate culture by the mid-1930s. Beyond films,



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

company newsletters, press reports, and published company histories all made use of Hitler’s visits to factories, trade exhibition booths, ribbon-cutting ceremonies and the like as a way to show allegiance to the regime and to claim implicitly the Führer’s approval of corporate facilities and brands. Particularly worthy of public media fanfare was the designation of a company’s production facilities as a “National Socialist Model Factory.”45 Werkfilme became increasingly common in the last prewar years. They provided an obvious public relations service to companies, acted as subtle advertisements for brand-name products, and cast a very positive light on the government that supported these internationally respected employers. Ufa was willing to subsidize production of such films, as long as they educated viewers about historical and cultural developments and did not focus solely on the company’s achievements or products.46 In 1937, the decaffeinated coffee brand Kaffee Hag released its “teaching- and culture film” entitled “Coffee: How It Grows and How It Comes to Us.” Headquarters reported to sales representatives around the country that “association presidents, school principals” and others were relaying the interest their charges had in the film. One school principal in Württemberg had allegedly written to the firm: “I have also noticed that many of my teachers, whose nerves were well known for not always being in the best shape—have found their way to Kaffee Hag.” The report to sales staff added that the film was only twenty minutes in length, and also worked well at meetings of housewives’ and merchants’ associations. The company’s film (and its ad campaigns more generally) operated on two levels. On the one hand it appealed to the status-conscious middle class, since decaffeinated coffee was more expensive than caffeinated, and Kaffee Hag was the premiere decaffeinated brand, served only at higherend restaurants and inns in branded tableware. Kaffee Hag also claimed to offer health benefits (relative to drinking caffeinated beverages) that matched the needs of this same class’s busy professional lifestyle. Showing how to achieve a more restful night sleep and a calmer response to the hustle and bustle (or more pessimistically, the stresses of a society facing significant change) was presented as a service to party and professional leaders who needed to be at their best.47 In the spring of 1939 coffee followed butter and fat as rationed goods, and importers struggled to find the hard currency to pay for this import.48 In April 1939 the Hag-Post included three stories that captured the hurdles faced by the company and the small victories it still enjoyed. The lead story detailed the lack of available coffee in Germany. The second described the

105

106

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

jail sentence handed down to a cafe owner who had cut corners by serving inferior caffeinated coffee from a carafe emblazoned with the (decaffeinated) Kaffee Hag logo. This was a clear example of false advertising, and Kaffee Hag cheered the Ad Council ruling. Finally, the company reveled in the fact that its product featured prominently in scenes of two dramatic feature films that year—sure evidence that despite the tough times, the Kaffee Hag brand was still considered an icon of refinement and modern good taste.49 In 1939, Henkel too produced a Werkfilm that focused exclusively on what was termed the Henkelgeist, or spirit of the Henkel corporation.50 The company followed its release with a dramatic live-action portrayal of the history and re-emergence of whale hunting as a way to respond to fat shortages in the increasingly autarkic economy. The whale hunt film was not only a romantic look at the return of this “heroic” struggle between man and beast, a cultural film according to RMVP standards; it also represented a great political victory for Henkel, which had campaigned for years to reinstate the practice.51 Henkel desperately needed new sources of fat for its soaps and detergents to continue production under the limitations placed on imports. Henkel linked the rebirth of German whaling to the rebirth of the nation in its print ads as well.52 Some company films were major cinematic achievements, including the Henkel whale hunt film that was directed by Walter Ruttmann, who also directed a Werkfilm for Bayer in 1938 but was best known for his Weimar-era expressionist film “Berlin: Symphony of a Metropolis” (1927).53 The growth of ad films in the 1930s was not unique to Germany, but Ernst Reichard and Heinrich Hunke at the Ad Council were pleased nonetheless. They could count this development as a victory in their larger campaign to integrate German commerce more firmly into the cultural landscape, and build the public trust in German firms and the value of their promotional efforts. One of the Werberat’s long-term goals was thus to expand the visibility of German films abroad, including ad films and Werkfilme, and in 1937 they commissioned an extensive report on the Swiss film industry in the hopes of winning back some share of that market, which had slipped dramatically for Germany since 1933.54 The opportunities afforded by film were clear to all, even those companies that could not afford to produce their own. The Reichardt company of Hamburg, manufacturers of relatively low priced cocoa and chocolate products, reported with smug pleasure to company representatives that the firm had succeeded in placing still image ads for Reichardt in all of the

fig. 3.3.  “Revival of the German Whale Hunt,” Henkel publicity, ca. 1937. Courtesy of Heinrich Hunke Nachlass, Staatsarchiv Nordrhein-Westfalen, Abteilung Ostwestfalen-Lippe.

108

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

newsreels that would be showing the highlights of the Schmeling-Neusel boxing match in early September 1934. Even though the newsreels (including the frames for Reichardt chocolate and cocoa) were shown immediately after the fight only in the major theaters of the largest cities, the films then moved to “middle level cinemas and finally to the smallest of provincial theaters,” ensuring (according to Reichardt strategists) a very good return on the investment.55 As far as can be surmised from the archives, none of these companies had any real way of knowing if these films aided sales. Even if they had no effect whatsoever, Reichardt’s note to its sales staff indicates that the firm was proud of being associated with the prominent sporting event. Whether intentionally or not, this spot had the potential to boost morale among the Reichardt workforce, which might also pay dividends on the factory floor and on the sales beat. Ultimately all these companies were convinced of the potential to reach a more receptive audience through film. Unlike print ads that still tended to target specific segments of consumers, according to the distribution of the image or the limitations of the medium, radio (before 1935) and film were believed to have more potential for building a sense of national cohesion.56 Some film ads presented most viewers with a “virtual consumption” experience, such as those for electrical appliances that carried the audience into a Nazi dreamland of abundance. Others showed the hard work of housewives at home and laborers in factories faced with real present-day challenges. Surely, the ad films promised a solution, via the product or corporate brand more broadly, but by coupling drudgery and affordable products, hard work and gratification, community and progress—a popular culture emerged that also reinforced the ideals of the Volksgemeinschaft with language and imagery, creating a narrative that most Germans could buy into.

good corporate citizens Despite the fact that some corporate leaders believed that ad films had more of an impact on the viewer than a poster or magazine ad, the amount of printed material that brand-name companies and retailers produced each year continued to far outpace the number of film ads (of various types) in circulation. Print ads remained the mainstay of the German ad industry, and advertisers never lost faith in them, even during the war years. Over and over, brand-name product manufacturers stressed the importance of



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

the Anzeige [newspaper classified] as offering the best bang for the buck— cheap and ubiquitous. Part of this confidence came from the continued strength of the German newspaper industry. Company leaders believed that strong personal ties existed between readers and their newspapers—a trust that a brand could tap into.57 Though many daily papers and magazines disappeared after 1933, and others became vehicles for Nazi editorial teams, German consumer goods makers believed that even the Nazified press maintained the trust of its readership, and they never stopped relying on cheap press ads as their main source of exposure.58 Although German companies depended on the tried-and-true medium of print advertisements throughout this era, they were still keen to stay abreast of new strategies and methods pioneered abroad, particularly in the Anglo-American world. In 1936, one study trip to England afforded advertisers the chance to visit iconic brands, including Cadbury and Sunlight. They also made stops in London, Cambridge, Birmingham, Welsh mining villages, and Stratford-upon-Avon. In fact, the business acumen of the British and Americans remained a frequent topic of discussion in the professional journals of the Nazified ad industry until the beginning of the war (and even into 1940 for the Americans). When Christian Kupferberg encouraged the German press to assist in the “clean up” of the ad industry, he did so by suggesting that British dailies be used as a model.59 Meanwhile the professional journals also continued to run stories about European ad styles.60 The emphasis was placed on the differences found between the ads of each nation, differences that fit the general stereotypes Germans held about other countries and which warned against the “slavish” adoption of foreign styles, no matter how successful they were in the home country.61 For example, the French affinity for abstract graphic art affirmed that they were erratic and interested in art for art’s sake. French hoardings were particularly condemned as cluttered and disorderly, like the irrational ads that covered them. Even when a French artist might be applauded for his artistic skills, there was nothing here to be imported into German advertisements. Italian posters were praised for their fascist/futurist aesthetic, and the predominance of Gemeinschaftswerbung was viewed as a sign of progress within the Italian advertising industry. Yet even as these two countries were growing closer politically, German commentators still looked primarily to Britain and the United States for new ideas to bolster sales.62 In the 1935/36 yearbook of “model classifieds,” Alfons Brugger explained that “the chief difference” between German and American print ads was that “German ads want to show how nice something is; the American

109

110

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

want to show the product, how it is used and its advantages.” Brugger concluded that no foreign ads matched those from Germany in terms of “style and originality.” And yet Brugger admitted that the American “editorial” form was equally valuable.63 As explained in the previous chapter, most of the prewar Werberat reform measures had been implemented by 1936. The attempts by the Ad Council to halt the use of non-German terms in advertisements made some headway, perhaps because this trend had already begun before 1933. For example, Salamander shoe retailers were already asking for German-sounding names for all styles by 1931. The company’s practice had been to give female names to women’s styles [Helga rather than Penelope] and geographical sites for men’s styles [Bremen instead of Milan].64 Nonetheless, old habits die hard and companies and entire industries did not change commonuse terminology overnight, either internally or in their publicity efforts. In 1937, Kaffee Hag reminded its sales staff about German-speak in the article called “What Is a Telephone Called in German?”65 And in 1941, Elly HeussKnapp was told by her boss at Beiersdorf to change her draft of a print ad that included a girl named Marianne, because it sounded too French and might raise problems with “Über-patriots.”66 Heuss-Knapp had actually chosen the name because it belonged to her sister, but she bowed to her employers and settled on Annemarie.67 The debate over Gothic versus Roman typefaces had been around for decades in Germany, and many typographers worked in both styles before 1933. After the NSDAP came to power, the new regime did institute a somewhat porous policy of printing all official documents in fraktur, as more German, which led to the design of a number of new scripts such as the “Deutschland Typeface” of 1934.68 Unsurprisingly, a number of articles in the advertising trade journals appeared promoting Gothic scripts as more appropriate to the new era, but there was no wholesale adoption of the old-fashioned typefaces and their use fell off steadily after an early rush of enthusiasm. Among privately held firms, the most that can be said is that fraktur was used regularly but not uniformly in ad slogans and print ad headlines. In longer ad copy and product brochures, however, the “international” typefaces that Nazi ad men had sought to eliminate as foreign and hence inauthentic remained common. Neither the Ad Council nor any other commerce-related watchdog seemed bothered much by this resulting mix of styles.69 The onset of war brought Gothic script back into vogue for a short while, but it is often forgotten that it was actually banned in early 1941. Some scholars speculate that Nazi leaders decided that those under



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

occupation needed a typeface that was easier to read, though at the time Martin Bormann declared (in a complete about-face to earlier claims) that “in reality the so-called Gothic script consists of Schwabach Jew-letters.”70 Others seem to have believed that it was dropped because it was more costly to use.71 One could also speculate that businessmen and their ad designers may have worried that the older typefaces clashed with the modern brand-name goods and lifestyles they represented. Some Ad Council regulations did make a lasting impact on advertising content and strategy. In addition to the changes mentioned in the last chapter, one influential set of practical reforms were the restrictions on product endorsements by famous personalities. These had been extremely popular in the 1920s and early 1930s but were almost entirely eliminated after 1934 as misleading to the public.72 Even “ordinary” Germans who were real users of the product in question could no longer lend their support in print ads as “satisfied customers,” unless the person’s name, profession, and exact address were published as part of the promotional materials. In many cases people did not want such private information in mass circulation, and many companies chose not to jump through the hoops necessary to use it, so this practice too dwindled considerably. Expert opinions could be published, but again the name, address, and qualifications of the endorser needed to be included as a way to cut down on false claims, particularly in the health and hygiene sectors. The distribution of free samples (and other gifts) to retailers and customers was also significantly restricted by a 1935 ruling.73 Some of these measures had their origins in the regime’s own desires to fashion itself as the chief arbiter of healthful living for the racially pure.74 The Ad Council had been given an important role in this mission: to seek out hucksters who promised miracle cures or failed to disclose potential side effects or dangerous ingredients in healthcare products. In response to this mandate, the Ad Council issued its 17th Bekanntmachung in 1936, which dealt solely with the advertising of pharmaceutical products. The regime had encouraged the various states to introduce their own regulations of pharmaceutical products before 1936—legislation that was now replaced by this decree.75 According to the new measure, only medical professionals could offer endorsements for medical treatments. It also banned announcements for health products that made misleading claims, and required ads for pharmaceutical preparations to be more explicit about the ingredients used and the potential side effects of the formulas.76 None of the changes were foolproof, and because the Ad Council did

111

112

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

not prioritize its policing function with regard to ad content, misleading ads still appeared occasionally.77 Reminders to follow the large and growing number of Werberat orders were frequent—appearing in various venues, from professional journals for advertisers and sales staffs to company newsletters and memos to employees. The Ad Council staff would contact advertisers directly, if they believed an ad failed to follow the appropriate regulations. Individual ads and brochures were retracted for revision in this fashion; fines were levied, and in some cases advertising licenses were withdrawn.78 But even when it came to lifestyle changes that the regime heartily supported, such as the campaigns to decrease smoking and alcohol consumption, Hunke and his colleagues always looked for ways to support the commercial needs of advertisers while working toward the shaping of corporate and consumer behavior. Although Hunke’s decision not to ban advertisements for cigarettes and alcohol in May 1939 directly contradicted the wishes of the state’s and party’s health offices, his move was in line with the Werberat’s past practice.79 On the one hand, it signaled Hunke’s desire not to have other arms of the state or party interfere in advertising matters as a way to bolster his own authority and in order to reassure corporate managers and owners that they had to deal only with his office. On the other hand, Hunke’s response also conformed to other Werberat decisions that sought to balance corporate and consumer discipline with profit making. Hunke’s ruling on this matter was greatly anticipated by the makers of brand-name products in other sectors as a barometer of future conditions. They were undoubtedly pleased with the outcome.80 Restrictions were eventually introduced for tobacco ads at the very end of 1941, vastly reducing outdoor advertising for tobacco and reforming ad content. Hunke’s new regulations emphasized public health, but also demanded the removal of all women and imagery with a sexual undertone, including images of sexually attractive male smokers, “athletes or pilots for example.” Even with these limitations, Robert Proctor notes that critics of smoking still estimated that tobacco ads filled 25 percent of classified space.81 Playing by the rules—being good corporate citizens—became a selling point all its own. Not only did it allow firms to pick up on ideological trends in their own promotional efforts, it also made the denunciation of other businesses thought to be doing injury to the Nazi consumer or Volkswirtschaft a potential business strategy. For example, the Osram and AFE newsletter Der Werbeleiter [The Ads-Leader] included a section that highlighted ads they found to be less than truthful or misleading. The examples



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

shown always came from competing industries—often ads promoting gas or other energy sources for home or industrial use. So while the editors at Der Werbeleiter could claim to be upholding Ad Council directives, and protecting consumers’ and national interests by throwing light on shady promotional practices, their critiques also provided retailers of electrical appliances and lighting fixtures, as well as electricians and installers, with effective arguments against rivals in sales discussions with potential customers. Viewed from another angle, these critiques were an end run around the long-standing prohibition of “negative ads” that criticized rivals’ goods or services. In the first issue of Der Werbeleiter from 1936, in a new column designed “to take a critical position on the questions of the day in advertising,” the editors targeted one print ad for personal diesel generators for using “ego as an ad motif.” The slogan was “Your own light, your own power! Be your own master on your property with Deutz Diesel [generators].” The columnist admitted that there was no falsehood here per se, but the egotistical, individualistic tone of the ad rejected the goal of “enlightenment in the sense of the new economic ethics,” because it did not line up with “the communal interests of the public electric power supply.” The same issue of the journal also criticized an advertisement for gas stove tops, which showed water heating in a paper cup balanced on the burner’s center tile, between the flames, to demonstrate the safety of open gas flames. This ad, according to Der Werbeleiter, was very problematic: the editors doubted whether the water was even close enough to the heat source to cook; they felt that this “swindle” did nothing to prove whether an open flame was indeed safe; and they added that such ads really only demonstrated the continued need for further “education on ethical ads” and “permissible technical comparisons.”82 While pointing out the missteps of others as a sales pitch for one’s own brand was easy, creating ads that “enlightened” and lived up to the new “ethical” commercial standards was a more difficult task. Most companies sought to integrate a subtle use of the Nazi worldview into their ads, without disrupting the brand image that had been developed, in some cases, through decades of effort. Overstepping the boundaries and appearing to jump on the Nazi bandwagon too explicitly could contradict the qualities associated with the brand, create a feeling of disingenuousness among customers, or attract negative attention with regard to state regulations against use of party or state symbols and personages. The German automobile industry provides some excellent examples of

113

114

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

these challenges. Popular estimations of German technological prowess (Daimler-Benz boasted frequently in its ads that Carl Benz had invented the first automobile, though that claim remains disputed), the popularity of motorsport, and the regime’s desire to increase living standards all seemed to indicate that Germany should be a country in which the car was a mass consumer item. Hitler prioritized the motorization of the country, which entailed promises to make cars and trucks more affordable and to develop the infrastructure needed to support more vehicles. Though the building of the Autobahn system of high-speed motorways was hailed as a central element in the regime’s job creation strategy, most scholars agree that this project did little to combat German unemployment. What is often overlooked, however, is that the investment in motorization led to real advancements in terms of better and cheaper technology from tanks and armored vehicles to airplanes and logistical support. On a more symbolic (and public) level, the execution of the Autobahn vision also paid dividends by demonstrating “the dictatorship’s greatness and ability to act.”83 As Wolfgang König has shown, the idea of bringing a mass-produced Volkswagen [people’s cars] to the market in Germany faced tremendous hurdles during the Third Reich.84 Despite the hype surrounding the Strength through Joy savings plans for the Volkswagen, and the photo spreads in German magazines of Hitler inspecting the prototype designed by Ferdinand Porsche, consumer purchasing power was too low and taxes on imported gasoline too high to make mass car ownership a reality. In addition, the steel, rubber, and other resources needed to produce and keep cars running were increasingly directed toward the military rather than the civilian economy. We should not, however, underestimate the fact that the VW raised expectations among consumers that their deposited funds were bringing them ever closer to ownership of a coveted item that had been far out of reach for all but the wealthy. Growing comfortable with the idea of making layaway purchases also aided the transformation of a society that had been averse to credit schemes. While such financing would really take off in the postwar period, in the meantime the regime enjoyed the substantial windfall created by the regular deposits of German citizens into their VW-accounts. German car manufacturers too hoped to expand their share of the consumer market throughout the 1930s. And while they benefited mightily from the opportunities afforded by new government contracts tied to rearmament, they were all struggling in the global automobile market. In fact the branding efforts of Daimler-Benz, BMW, and Audi as the successor to



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

Auto Union became so successful in the postwar era that we tend to forget that Germany’s revered auto manufacturers were not market leaders in the interwar period.85 Mercedes-Benz enjoyed strong brand identification among wealthy sedan owners, but that was a very small clientele. BMW did best in its aircraft engine and motorcycle sectors, and the four brands that became Auto Union joined forces in part out of desperation at the height of the Depression. In 1928, 40 percent of cars sold in Germany were imports, mostly from Britain and the United States, including those assembled in Berlin by Ford, Chrysler, and GM. Adam Opel was the clear frontrunner in Europe with its small, relatively affordable cars. In March 1933, four years after GM bought an 80 percent share in Opel, the company laid claim to 38 percent of the entire German market and leveled off at 40 percent in the following years. The 114,000 automobiles produced in 1938 by Opel surpassed the next three German producers combined. These were Daimler-Benz, BMW, and Adlerwerke.86 Despite this modest success, Mercedes-Benz and BMW have become two of Germany’s most revered and recognizable global brands. Designed in 1917, BMW’s stylized logo of blue and white propeller blades was already at the forefront of a sophisticated branding effort by the 1930s.87 In addition to an extensive collection of logo-branded purchasable kitsch (ashtrays, calendars, cigars, and lapel pins), the BMW publicity department directed a sizable budget that included the sponsorship of motorcycle and motor car racing teams, the publication of magazines for racing and technology fans, the development of highly trained sales teams for the company’s vehicle showrooms, and print ads that were lauded as some of the most aesthetically arresting on the market. In 1930 the company began publishing the magazine BMW Blätter, which despite the tough times of the Depression offered fans of the brand stories about new models and technical advancements, articles about the victories and records of their racing teams, and pictures and text about the wonders experienced by individual BMW owners on tour at home or abroad.88 One of the tropes that the magazine relied on throughout the early 1930s was the motorsport rivalry between Germany and Britain. The magazine’s editors admitted that the English were world leaders, but tried to offer consistent proof that BMW was closing the gap, as in a 1930 article written in English by a Briton living in Munich who raved about the high performance of BMW products.89 In the late Weimar Republic, BMW Blätter not only represented the company as a competitive force in the masculine world of international motorsport; it also gave significant space to ads and articles for products

115

116

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

aimed at female consumers. In June 1930, the third issue’s pastel-colored cover showed men and women relaxing in the countryside, picnicking, bathing, dancing, and exercising amid their parked convertibles and motorcycles. The only person in the image at the wheel of a vehicle is a woman. A lengthy article within answered the question: “For whom is the BMW created? For the woman.” The text noted that new models were sized to fit a female driver’s smaller frame, which would allow for the same sense of independence and symbiosis between driver and machine that was often touted in ads directed toward men: “The feelings of independence that are so clear in our modern women’s world require the freedom of movement that is satisfied only through unconstrained autonomy. . . . A trusting relationship develops in time between the female driver and auto that is a precondition for deep and lasting joy.”90 The article was accompanied by a staged photo of a woman working on her car’s engine, while her female friend looked on.91 Whether such images were really aimed at female consumers or placed for the visual enjoyment of male readers is unclear. Either way, they were bound to draw attention. By mid-1933, the feel of the BMW Blätter changed markedly. In June, the last articles featuring women appeared. The company increasingly identified itself as a supporter and servant of the new regime. The July 1934 issue included articles that featured Hitler looking at new car models and Mussolini viewing motorcycles. Though more individuals owned motorcycles in both countries, this photograph may have been planned to highlight Germany’s alleged superiority over its “less developed” Italian friends. While travel essays about Germany’s beauty or exotic foreign lands continued, the fact that BMW was assisting in the rearmament of the German military was never far from the company’s image. The first fully militarized cover photo of the Wehrmacht’s armed motorcycle corps in formation on Unter den Linden appeared in February 1937, followed regularly by similar covers thereafter (see Figure 6.2). This shift in tone was an easy one for the company to make. Unlike many companies, BMW produced goods the rearming nation needed. Moreover, the aspects of the brand’s image that had always emphasized technological progress, speed, and strength fit well with the ideological profile of the new government, and the international motorsport success the company enjoyed also meshed with the increasingly aggressive, masculine political culture. All in all, it was easy to shift the brand image in some respects to keep its number one customer happy and maintain the steady flow of government contracts. The prioritization of rearmament in the years leading up to the war,

fig. 3.4.  Female consumers and cars, BMW Blätter, 1930. Courtesy of Historischen Medienarchivs, BMW Group Classic, Munich.

118

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

however, meant that by 1937 the company was reporting shortages related to its consumer products, forcing the head office to send regular tips to dealers on how to handle dissatisfied customers. For example, one mailing encouraged salesmen on the showroom floors to push fabric upholstery because of shortages in leather seat coverings.92 By 1938 presenting BMW cars as a luxury status symbol, as many 1920s and 1930s advertisements had done, also no longer seemed wise in a commercial culture that officially supported sacrifice and community. BMW advertisers adjusted by trying to emphasize the practicality of their vehicles. Through science and technology, BMW had achieved both beauty and utility—“the safest . . . most comfortable . . . most fuel efficient cars”—while other brands, the company maintained, continued to rest solely on the opulence of their products.93 At the same time, headquarters pleaded with sales managers to be patient with shortages and not to ask “through letters or visits” for special consideration in filling new orders but rather to remember that the short-term difficulties were in the long-term interest of the Reich.94 In 1938 the company was also forced to respond to charges that it had non-Aryan business partners abroad, as discussed in the last chapter. Despite these challenges, BMW benefited from its close relationship with the military in terms of government contracts and Hitler’s own personal interest in motorizing Germany. Both facts resulted in free publicity for BMW every time the Führer visited one of BMW’s plants or made an appearance at the annual automobile exhibition—an opportunity not lost on the advertising department, which asked that all dealership showrooms prominently display a 24 x30 cm photo of Hitler at the BMW stand of the 1938 international auto exhibition.95 Daimler-Benz had a somewhat trickier situation on its hands. Unlike BMW, the company could not rely on sports enthusiasts to stay interested in its brand. Mercedes did participate in some international racing events, but the brand’s maker had always prioritized its image as a symbol of elegance, luxury, and tradition. Throughout the 1920s, ads for the brand had touted the Mercedes hood ornament “star” as representing the “world famous product of the oldest automobile works in the world” and as the ultimate symbol of luxury.96 During the Depression a visible shift can be detected in its advertisement copy. In 1929 Mercedes was still the “oldest member of the Auto-aristocracy,” but it was also now recognized for its integration of “tradition and progress.”97 In 1930 the focus of the campaign was on the cutting-edge technology and rational construction of the Mercedes—a modern machine with a price that reflected the times.

fig. 3.5.  “Luxury”—the hallmark of a Mercedes-Benz automobile, late 1920s. Courtesy of Mercedes-Benz Classic Archive, Daimler AG, Stuttgart.

120

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

Despite such efforts, the brand never ventured too far from its hallmark image. As one advertisement put it rather presciently in 1930, “MercedesBenz—Quality, Race [Rasse], Class, Elegance.”98 While no one would want to claim that luxury was dead in the Third Reich, after 1933 the company did seek other ways to promote the brand. As Fabrice d’Almeida has shown, luxurious commodity goods were central to the privileges of being a member of the party and/or state elite.99 Powerful German families were not going to downgrade to an Opel or take public transit for the sake of the Volksgemeinschaft. Certainly Hitler and other top figures in the regime were not shy about being seen in their top-of-the-line Mercedes.100 Nonetheless, in the mid-1930s the company did attempt to extend its reach. In part this was done by introducing new models that were smaller and less expensive—not a “people’s car” by any stretch of the imagination, even though the “Type 130” was advertised in 1934 with slogans like “Finally—A Mercedes for everyone!”101 In addition to allowing the company to expand its customer base to some extent, the move was largely one that anticipated further market segmentation with the Volkswagen and the small models being introduced by other manufacturers. The new “popular” [volkstümliche] models were not replacements, however, for the luxurious eight-cylinder models. As noted, the regime and the NSDAP preferred Daimler as a business partner, and there was still a market for large sedans. Beyond the introduction of new models, mid-decade ad campaigns aimed to evoke different emotions than in the past. Previously Mercedes had focused almost exclusively on upper-class lifestyles. The new ads spoke of the Mercedes star as the epitome of “German craftsmanship”102 and represented the company’s attempt to bring the brand in line with the “new Germany” without diluting its reputation for flawless design and technological achievement. Another example from 1933 did without any product image; instead, it used portraits of Gottlieb Daimler and Carl Benz as “fighters for progress and quality,” and described the practicalities of Mercedes engineering, including fuel efficiency, tasteful lines—nothing less than “good value for all their models.”103 The company copied the regime’s rhetoric of struggle and victory, without overstepping regulations about national symbols. “The Victory of Quality!” proclaimed one ad in 1935.104 In many ways, the Mercedes star became a national symbol of the goals and successes of the regime. The marriage of the company’s image and the state’s propaganda was most powerful in the series of ads that promoted simultaneously the Autobahn and Mercedes automobiles. Beginning in 1936,

fig. 3.6.  “Victory of Quality,” mid-1930s. Courtesy of Mercedes-Benz Classic Archive, Daimler AG, Stuttgart.

fig. 3.7.  “We are keeping step with this gigantic development,” 1937. Courtesy of Mercedes-Benz Classic Archive, Daimler AG, Stuttgart.



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

images of the Mercedes star over the newly opened stretches of highway became the leading visual motif in print ads placed by the Stuttgart firm. With slogans like “Constructing Germany,” and “We are keeping step with this gigantic development,”105 a revered company supported the regime’s agenda with language and imagery.106 The star also turned up repeatedly in coverage of Hitler’s public appearances, and is featured in Leni Riefenstahl’s popular film Triumph of the Will. More than any other brand, Mercedes-Benz came to be associated with the person of the Führer. Members of the auto industry were not the only businesses to use advertisements to try to link their corporate identities with that of the nation. Indeed, many companies in Germany were well prepared to accept the dictatorship. The captains of German industry going back to the nineteenth century, including Siemens, Daimler, Lingner, and Henkel, held great importance in German society as leaders of families (their own and those of their workforces), innovators, and intellects. They were national heroes, but their entrepreneurial spirit was never conceived of as democratic. Regardless of the motives for accepting the integration of National Socialist ideals into company advertisements, it can be argued that many promotional campaigns encouraged consumers in the “conversion process,” as Peter Fritzsche describes it, from ordinary Germans to members of the Nazi Volksgemeinschaft. No firm was better at this than Osram.

let there be light Long before 1933 Osram recognized the advantages of working with others, primarily installers and electricity producers, who shared the company’s goal to “awaken the need for more and better light.” The company was also aware that even during the Depression its brand name “was the strongest asset” it held—and that cutting back on ads that promoted it would only “dull the shine on the brand name Osram.” The firm even admitted internally that “it was not the case that Osram sold a bulb that was much better than others.” Rather it was the “steady advertising year in and year out that had made Osram so much larger than the other light bulb manufacturers.”107 Central to this steady promotion was the company’s famous light bulb logo. The image was first created in 1921 and besides some minor tinkering remains a globally recognized trademark today.108 In 1932 Osram estimated that 25 percent of all German households were still lacking electricity, which left a completely untapped domestic market

123

124

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

of about 4 million households—never mind that most homes, shops, offices, and other work stations that did enjoy electric light had limited light fixtures.109 Despite this data and the faith of its management in advertising, in the summer of 1931 the company had been forced to cut expenditures from 3.5 million to 2.5 million RM for the coming fiscal year. Still Osram managed to aim its promotional material at sixty-four countries and deliver it in twenty-eight languages.110 Two-thirds of the entire advertising budget for the domestic market was still spent on print ads in daily newspapers, magazines, and professional journals. A further 15 percent was shared between brochures, posters, and window displays. A meager 1 percent of the budget was divided between radio ads and lighted signs.111 There was talk of further cuts, but competition and promises already made to their “Phoebus” cartel partners (Philips, Osram, Tungsram, GE-International) led company executives to search elsewhere for ways to reduce expenditures.112 Osram had always focused on light as an aid to daily life in its Weimarera ad campaigns. In 1929 the new exhibit at Osram’s Lichthaus, an exhibit space that opened in 1925, was planned with that title in mind: “Light in the Service of People.” The summer after Hitler came to power as the “Fighting Fronts” of the opposition’s political parties were being rounded up, Osram was busy mobilizing the “Elektrofront” to call for the extension of lighting in towns, businesses, and homes as a way to put electricians to work and pump money into the economy. It was exactly the sort of activism the regime welcomed. As always, Osram’s leaders worked alongside power brokers from outside the company, including members of the Industry and Trade Boards and Brandenburg’s state trustee for work.113 At one Elektrofront assembly for home owners and landlords at Berlin’s enormous Sportpalast in December 1933, organizers were able to distribute twenty thousand flyers.114 The handout read in part: “Home owners! There must be no home, no apartment in Berlin without electricity in the future! The tireless [aim of] electrification of all homes is a pressing imperative in this hour! The purpose is not only to create work, but also to align house ownership with the requirements of our times.” Electrification met the standards for modern living (not luxurious living) according to Osram and the Elektrofront. The same month, Osram reported to its staff with pleasure that State Trustee Engel had praised the “Elektrofront” no fewer than fourteen times in a recent speech. He had congratulated Osram for leading the way against unemployment, and spoke of its promotional materials as particularly exemplary.115 That the leadership at Osram and on the Wilhelmstrasse were on the same page is clear. Both saw the modernization of infrastructure



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

as essential to popularity with consumer citizens; whether that popularity resulted in corporate profits or support for the dictatorship, the means were the same. Indeed to separate business profit from political profit is mistaken. The two became dependent on each other. Osram also sent letters to likely customers. One that was sent to inns and pubs began by noting how the owner might believe he has done everything to make his patrons more comfortable, but that he may not be aware that his rival’s “profits rise from month to month, because his visitors have more light, are cozier and therefore find more pleasure [at his establishment].” While cheering the tenacity and dedication of the independent pub owner, Osram also promised to “show him the way toward lasting business stimulation” provided by the instructions in the latest brochure, Lichtheft C17. Not only did Osram incorporate the same sort of language about the hard work and honesty of the small business owner found in Nazi propaganda, but the company also explicitly called for support of the regime in militaristic language at the very time the regime was moving with great brutality against its “rivals.” Hiring an installer, explained the booklet, to follow Osram’s tips on lighting pubs and inns “will support the work creation policies of our government . . . . Fight alongside! Declare yourself a fellow soldier [Mitkämpfer] in the Elektrofront and as an expert who offers good advice . . . and good service by handing your future fitter [Osram’s Lichtheft C17].”116 Similarly, Osram’s brochure C15 explained that nine-tenths of all German craftsmen’s studios could benefit from better light. In the daily press and in theater slides, they used the slogan “Working by hand demands good light: for the productive expansion of electricity.” In addition to these efforts, Osram printed short “anonymous” articles in forty-eight specialized craftsmen’s journals. Among these were eight magazines for clock makers, five for bakers, two for furriers, as well as journals for book binders, cobblers, leather workers, and others—the tip of the iceberg of the vast publishing world in Germany at this period, and proof of the continued importance of the crafts within the German economy.117 While Osram bulbs were not center stage in these short essays, “[E]lectricity use was made synonymous [hier gleichbedeutend] with the promotion of the economic interests of the nation.”118 The “economic interests of the nation” remained the focus for Osram’s promotional efforts, but as state policies began slowly to turn away from job creation, so did the company’s literature. Osram’s 1934 campaign took the position that its products were of higher quality than those of com-

125

126

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

fig. 3.8.  “Better light—more beautiful living,” Osram advertisement, 1934. Courtesy of Landesarchiv, Berlin (A. Rep. 231, no. 1224).

petitors and deserved their higher prices.119 Use of the top-quality brand bulb meant nothing less than “Better light—more beautiful living.” In its visual representation of this simple phrase, Osram offered consumers an electrical grid that tied the country together literally and figuratively, and explained: “Light also for you [dich], whether you are a city-dweller or farmer, whether you swing a hammer or a wield a pen; light for the easing of your work, for the extension of your energy, light for your safety, for your pleasure and relaxation!”120 As in the Henkel film discussed earlier, the reader is addressed here with the informal form of “you,” creating intimacy and signaling membership in an imagined community. The language of



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

uniting the city and country, as well as bringing together blue- and whitecollar laborers in support of the same goals, was commonly used by the NSDAP in its propaganda, particularly in the first half of the 1930s, as we see in the following Osram ad and DAF poster (Figs. 3.9 and 3.10). Both images present the Kopfarbeiter [professional] and the Handarbeiter [laborer] as two partners in the rebuilding of the nation.121 The Volksgemeinschaft being built here was not, however, one of work and sacrifice alone. Surely the two “halves” of the nation, divided along regional, economic, or cultural lines, must come together, but the payoff was to be a pleasurable one. As part of this formula, the redemption of consumption from its alleged Weimar incarnation as unrestrained and divisive was critical for a company like Osram. The light bulb manufacturers could easily adapt to this message. Its products fit snugly in this holistic vision of production and consumption working in concert. The state’s role was never far from the picture. In 1934 the firm also produced an advertisement for newspapers and other print venues that was built around a “cheerful and pretty poem.” There was one caveat however: “[T]he poem is only appropriate for the German market, because it refers to the 1,000 RM in state

fig. 3.9. United white- and blue-collar workers invent new technology, rebuild Germany, ca. 1935. Osram advertisement courtesy of Landesarchiv, Berlin (A. Rep. 231, no. 1221).

127

fig. 3.10. German Labor Front (DAF) Poster, 1933, Courtesy of www.calvin. edu/academic/cas/gpa/posters/daf.jpg.



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

aid for new [Aryan] marriages—as well as the tax incentives for families with children.”122 Osram’s ad department was never shy about its aims of connecting Osram products with the goals of the regime. Company pride in this affinity is evident in the following quotation from the publicity department in 1935, under the frequently used Nazi slogan “Common good before self-interest” [Gemeinnutz vor Eigennutz]: This phrase, which characterizes the moment, sums up like nothing else, what the economy and its leaders are always saying, that everything that is of use to the whole nation [Volksganzen], must be. And when one really thinks about it, the light bulb industry and electric light in general fits in [to this worldview] especially well. For years Osram has acted in this sense, in which the company hammered home in word and deed the usefulness of good and sufficient light to all national comrades [Volksgenossen] and to the nation’s economy.123

By the summer of 1936 big changes were under way at Osram. First of all a new product was being launched, known simply as the “D” lamp for its double filament, which was ready to hit the shelves in Germany and select foreign markets. The D-bulb technology promised 20 percent more light at the same cost, and for the company represented a large enough leap forward to warrant a whole new branding campaign. The introduction of the D-bulb was timely, because the company was finding that its current ad slogans, “More and better light, Light is life, etc.,” were starting to run out of steam.124 A certain indifference was building, they felt, among consumers about more and better light: “[T]here is enough light for me.”125 A new message was needed, Osram informed its cartel partners—one that would be worthy of the new D-bulb, and one that would continue to fit explicitly with National Socialist goals. They landed upon the slogan “Preserve your eyesight with better lighting through Osram bulbs.”126 Osram concluded that this “battle call,” written along the border of the new Augenmarke logo featuring the human eye, matched well with the regime’s priority of protecting the health of the racially valuable.127 By appealing to consumer concerns about hygiene and health, Osram’s advertisers believed that they might overcome the “false savings and indifference” that kept people from lighting rooms properly. The end goal would be to make better lighting to preserve eyesight “as self-evident as other hygienic requirements had become.”128 The company also hoped to integrate scientific evidence about the links between poor lighting and eye health into ad copy, but the medical research was inconclusive. Ultimately unable to say with confidence that Osram products actually improved the health

129

130

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

of the nation, the publicity department stuck with the watered down slogan “Preserve your eyesight.” The campaign for the new bulb was extensive. Not only did Osram flood the newspapers (spending 750,000 RM on dailies alone) and professional journals of the electrical industry with advertisements and direct mailings, the company also mounted other publishing offensives, including new editorializing articles for newspapers about the need for better light and the technological progress embodied in this new product.129 The firm printed 15,700 newsletters to explain the campaign to the entire workforce, in the hope that they too would become “advocates for Light-thinking.” There would also be a new Osram magazine for retailers, which would not discuss dry technical advances alone; it would have “pep,” and provide tips for increasing sales that shop owners would come to await with eager anticipation. And since in many cases, Osram admitted, wives of retailers did much of the selling, women were not to be forgotten in writing the magazine. Kids too would receive some space in the new publication to learn about the development of the lighting industry—“and don’t forget the crossword puzzles!”130 Last, but certainly not least, the publicity department saw great opportunity to gain momentum for the product with state and party organizations, in particular the housewives’ organizations, the German Labor Front (DAF) and its offshoots, and also government bodies such as the Propaganda Ministry, police, and schools. Combining health and productivity, as Osram did, made great sense. Not only did the appeal elicit sales contracts from the government and party organizations, it also meant that Osram and other members of the German lighting sector were able to secure official backing for their advertising efforts from the DAF and its offshoot, Beauty of Labor.131 The ingenious aspect of this appeal was that it could be used for every consumer: from the craftsman in his studio to the business executive, from the young boy with his homework to the old woman darning socks. As one set of instructions to sales representatives put it, “[T]he advertising must be delivered so that it impresses blue- and white-collar workers as well as mother and child.”132 The large-scale purchasing managers for hospitals, factories, and state offices would all see the benefits of more light for the same cost. In other words, the whole Volksgemeinschaft could be included, and Germans would be happier, healthier, and more productive by switching to the D-bulb. How Nazi was this commercial culture? Attention to health was common in the 1930s throughout the Western world, with advancements in

fig. 3.11.  “Preserve your eyesight through better light,” Osram ca. 1936. Courtesy of Landesarchiv, Berlin (A. Rep. 231, no. 1229).

132

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

medicine and greater interest in sport and hygiene, as well as a tendency toward rationalization that prioritized efficiency and productivity. Osram’s leaders, however, recognized that in the Third Reich these transnational trends had a particular racialized quality that could not be ignored. Some advertisements could still be used for domestic and foreign markets, but in the summer of 1935, there was open discussion among the board of directors about what more could be done to show that Osram was in step with the popular interest in and state policies regarding race. As the new ad campaign was coming together for the following year, Osram’s directors summed up the atmosphere in the following way: In connection with today’s strong public engagement with the race question [Rassenfrage], Mr. Kleeber and Mr. Schulze generated a general discussion about the topic, so far as it concerns our [advertising] division. The difficulties, which still exist at the moment for carrying through the national-socialist program are not to be misjudged. . . . Nevertheless, clarity remains over the fact that in the long term, only the complete, practical affirmation of the national socialist view in total, in other words including the race question, allows for the right to exist [Daseinsberechtigung] in the Third Reich.133

With the help of the DAF’s Beauty of Labor program a massive increase in sales was achieved, with the largest single jump coming from sales to the Wehrmacht. In February 1936, Osram reported that Wehrmacht sales were up 71 percent over the previous year.134 It appears that these figures do not include the sales of bulbs for vehicle headlights, so instead the bulk of the purchasing would have been to light the work and training spaces for the military. However, even if one includes the bulbs purchased for the national railway and postal service, which also saw significant increases, the total amounted only to 5.8 percent of all German sales. In other words, the private sector, including individual consumers and manufacturers, presumably including factories outfitting the nation for war, still accounted for the vast majority of Osram’s domestic sales. The DAF’s Beauty of Labor was a committed Osram partner, contributing its own propaganda campaign for “Good light—good work” to the higher expectations for autarchic-minded production announced in 1936 under Göring’s Four-Year Plan. As a result, the imagery in the press, retail outlets, and at exhibitions presented by the light bulb manufacturer was largely about creating more effective workspaces at home (cooking, cleaning, and sewing), in the office, and on the factory floor. More efficiency at work meant less stress, good health, and greater pleasure. Women were frequently shown performing housework and rarely shown at wage labor,



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

except for secretarial work. Men can be seen executing tasks at the office or workbench, and at home relaxing with a book or newspaper. Boys appear frequently doing their homework. Their sisters are almost completely absent from representation, except as mother’s or grandmother’s helpers or as preschool-aged siblings watching their brothers.135 Mostly sketches, these advertisements do not demonstrate much aesthetic or textual innovation. The most distinguished design novelty of the campaign was the human eye logo, which when paired with a photograph of a woman’s portrait, or laid over a bold exclamation point, could lead to striking results for shop windows, as in Figure 3.11. By 1937, the directors at Osram could celebrate success in making their humble light bulbs stand for much more. They were tools for greater productivity and safeguards of public health. Beauty of Labor had so heartily endorsed the D-bulb that the DAF also established and staffed its own “Head Office for Good Light,” solidifying its relationship with the firm and others within the electricity sector.136 Artificial light allowed for the greater enjoyment of free time, though in Osram’s advertisements relaxation was almost exclusively a male domain. In addition, company director Brocke applauded the fact that electric light was now a means toward greater cultural and artistic expression, illuminating historic buildings, famous ruins, the Olympic stadium, and creating Albert Speer’s “cathedral of light” at the Nuremberg party rally grounds.137 As Brocke concluded happily, good lighting had become an “affair of state.”138 Despite the seriousness with which Osram cultivated its brand, there is no evidence that “scientific” research was undertaken in preparation for these campaigns. The first large-scale marketing study undertaken in conjunction with the GfK occurred in 1937.139 Osram’s prior indifference may be indicative of the larger claim that German companies, even those with strong international ties, did not embrace market research early or often. Osram’s lack of interest in precampaign testing of slogans and images may have also been due in part to the fact that the Nazi worldview already provided companies with ready-made branding opportunities. Marketing studies might help refine the message, but the messages were already available. This point was demonstrated again in 1937 when a new opportunity arose to show that electric light was essential to national goals. As Osram’s directors explained, “All of Germany stands under the symbols of two slogans, which have been provided by state and party offices: Fight Waste and Fight Danger.” At first, the company thought that it would be most able

133

134

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

to latch on to the latter by showing how Osram light bulbs could protect against dangerous falls, reduce workplace accidents, and prevent kitchen burns and other domestic injuries. There was one problem—the company had to find a way to adopt the message without using the exact same slogan as that used by party or state offices, which was prohibited under the 1933 Law for the Protection of National Symbols. The first proposal, “Fight against danger through better light,” was rejected as sounding too similar to the official propaganda campaign. The ad director Heinrich suggested “Protect yourself through better light,” but there were many possibilities from which to choose: “Better light protects against accidents,” . . . “Better light—better protection,” and so on. The Osram ad department was particularly excited by the simplicity of the new campaign, given that it was little more than an extension of the previous “Preserve your eyesight” campaign (which would continue in the company’s non-German markets), and the same “human eye” motif could be reused. Knowing that a team effort was the best way to spread the safety through light message far and wide, Heinrich hoped to find both official and “neutral” (private) partners to assist the firm in its support of this “important question for the entire Volksgemeinschaft.” He even dreamed, for example, of ways to engage the 20.5 million members of health insurance plans, presuming that insurance providers would be more likely to disseminate brochures and posters if they were approached by “neutral” bodies rather than by “a directly interested company.” Finding such neutral partners would not be a problem. In addition to the professional associations for electricians and engineers that were already involved, Osram’s ad director listed twenty-five other associations, many with links to the state and party, that might want to join the “fight,” including the Reichsausschuss für Volkswirtschaftliche Aufklärung (RVA), which answered to the Werberat.140 Fortunately for Osram, by 1938 the company had also realized that light bulbs could be a great tool in the efforts to Kampf dem Verderb [Fight waste]. Although that exact slogan could not be incorporated in product promotions, since it was trademarked in a sense by the Office of the FourYear Plan, Osram’s ad images could illustrate how light fixtures in storage rooms, basements, and pantries made it far more likely that individuals would spot food items before they rotted, and find other supplies that could be reused or recycled. By the time the war arrived, Osram had shown itself to be a terrific partner to the state. But that is not the only point to be made here. The visual ads, exhibits, brochures, direct mailings, and posters that appeared after



Advertising and the Everyday in Peacetime

1935 were not simply creating a showcase for Nazi aims, or a fantasy of happy, productive workers, thanks to the installation of artificial light at home and work. Much of the imagery put forward by Osram in these years had a dark side that emphasized emotional and physical stress and labor. Even the images that show “proper” lighting are fairly realistic portraits of nonmechanized labor and household chores that had not changed in fifty years. Osram was not the only advertiser to put forth such images. Sunlicht’s film “Mehr Sonne,” discussed at the beginning of the chapter, did not glamorize the life of the housewife. A wide variety of other products from decaffeinated coffee and typewriters to treatments for male impotence also highlighted the physical and mental strain that was perceived to be threatening Germany’s adult population. Such realism may have had particular resonance among Germans struggling to remake the Reich. Coming from trusted employers and brandname goods manufacturers, who were themselves in some cases national icons of German perseverance and success, such as the Siemens and Henkel families, this was a powerful vision of community, struggle, and the possibilities of measured relief through consumable goods. Advertising’s messages, which were well integrated into the fabric of daily life, were not revolutionary. Indeed the ubiquitous presence of ads and their necessarily subtle visions of Volksgemeinschaft likely had far more persuasive power to inspire than the state and party propaganda that is often touted as having been essential to building and maintaining support for the dictatorship. The existence of these images challenges us to rethink our understanding of prewar Nazi Germany. It was not dominated by fantasies of prosperity and pleasure, nor was it locked in a dreary landscape of sacrifice and deprivation. Rather, companies continued to vie for the attention of individual shoppers and government contracts. They attempted to persuade consumers with slogans and images that fit the “new order”—both the hopes of change and the stresses of that transformation. In the next chapter we will examine this commercial culture in action from the bottom up, as we turn from company headquarters to the sales staffs on the streets and the consumers they depended upon.

135

chapter four

Buyers and Sellers Every visit must have something personal. That is the first rule of the art of sales as it applies to the traveling salesman.1

In 1936 the Siemens-Schuckertwerke in Berlin, manufacturer of small electrical appliances, chose to devote one issue of the company magazine, Der Anschluss, to the topic “women in business life.”2 The significance of women in the economy was great; the magazine began: We know that her judgment and her taste in fashion and cosmetics are decisive. Her critical judgment reigns supreme over the foodstuffs sector and controls to a high degree the course of business in all industries, handicrafts and retail related to the manufacturing and sales of jewelry, gifts, and household goods. Even the handmade and mass produced items used and enjoyed by men are in most cases not beyond her influence: she is directly or indirectly, wanted or unwanted, taking part in many of the decisions, even acting as the decision-maker, though the man sees it as the result of his own will.

The article also repeated the frequently cited statistic that two-thirds of the entire German Volkseinkommen passed through female consumers’ hands.3 One might expect this to be the start of a tirade against greedy or domineering housewives. Instead the Siemens author concludes that in response to this reality, more women should be employed in the sales process, because a female shopper will prefer to discuss products with another woman who has tested the appliance in her own home.4 The article reflected an awareness among manufacturers in the mid-1930s that German women played a central role in the national economy. Consumption meant more to the economy than purchases made; consumers influenced design and branding, taste-making and trends for all products, even those “used and enjoyed by men.” Erica Carter made this point in her ground-breaking work on West Germany, but my research encourages us

fig. 4.1.  Cover for Der Anschluß, the Siemens-Schuckertwerke AG newsletter for electrical appliances retailers, 1936. Courtesy of Siemens Corporate Archives, Munich.

138

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

fig. 4.2. Women’s importance to the economy, Der Anschluß, 1936. Courtesy of Siemens Corporate Archives, Munich.

to consider whether the tipping point of recognition of female economic power arrived before the war.5 There is no recommendation in this Siemens newsletter that women be employed more readily as design engineers for new products, but there is an admission that women shoppers were rational, making use of their critical judgment as consumers and trend setters. The author implies further that female shoppers were not likely to be bowled over by a flashy sales pitch but instead wanted proof of a product’s worth, ideally from someone who could personally testify to its value. The first three chapters of this book have been largely about advertis-



Buyers and Sellers

ers as a professional group, their employers in Germany’s businesses, and the bureaucratic liaisons established between the state and private sector. While advertising remains the focal point in this chapter—as a language that mediated the commercial transaction—it acknowledges that much of the day-to-day process of buying and selling happened on a more intimate scale. This chapter, therefore, examines a new set of actors, chiefly consumers and sales staff. Both of these terms are used liberally—at times a company might use the word “customers” to mean housewives (the most important sector of the consuming public), and at other times the same business might use “customers” to refer to its retail outlets or other firms that distributed its goods. Sales staff too is a very broad category, including everyone from regional sales representatives, to local shop owners, to doorto-door ad-ladies [Werbedamen] and others. As is often the case when dealing with nonelites, in this case female consumers and low- and mid-ranking sales staff, a good deal of the evidence presented will be assertions about these groups penned by others—speculating, instructing, overseeing, and imagining how sales are going on at the local level. Nonetheless, combining these top-down views with sources that come directly from individuals at the retail level allows us to see how this commercial culture operated on a daily basis. It becomes apparent that despite attempts by large corporations and state bodies to direct and control commerce, buying and selling was still marked by personal relationships, between sales representatives and retailers, retailers and individual consumers, and increasingly by companies seeking to speak and listen more directly to their customers. Advertising played a key role in this communication—and it went both ways, with consumers in particular gaining confidence in their economic power, and challenging companies to offer products and arguments for products that fit their needs and desires.

consumer agency German consumers had begun to mobilize in cooperative associations before the First World War, and as Claudius Torp explains, those who ran consumer cooperatives must have felt like “victors” in the defeated nation. The economic crises that arrived in the postwar period led many citizens to look for less expensive goods, and the new political climate made legislative reform that benefited the associations possible. By the time the hyperinflation of 1923 had dissipated, almost one-quarter of all German households

139

140

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

had a stake in one of the cooperatives, which could no longer be considered solely “proletarian” institutions. At the end of the Weimar Republic, there were still close to 3 million members.6 Although it was taken for granted by Germans that women did the shopping, Torp insists that consumer cooperatives did little to upset traditional gender roles. Men held the majority of administrative positions within the institutions, and most correspondence went to male heads of households.7 Nonetheless, because they had their origins in the trade union system and connections to international socialism, the new National Socialist leadership after January 1933 sought to outlaw this form of self-help. It turned out to be harder than expected to do, particularly given the economic context in which the NSDAP came to power, but by 1936 the last vestiges of the republican-era system were gone. The eradication of the consumer cooperatives did not mean shoppers no longer needed help providing for their families. The consumer market remained shaky.8 Shortages of some consumer goods appeared in peacetime, and there were frequent rumors about the possibility of more. Already in 1934 reports from Germany’s Social Democratic Party in exile (Sopade) included episodes of hoarding (“hamstering” or “fear-shopping”) in Germany: instances in which available goods were being bought at dramatic rates out of concern that those goods would soon be scarce. While there may be some level of exaggeration in these accounts in the hope that they provided evidence of a coming collapse of National Socialism, such hoarding did take place. The most commonly hoarded items were textiles and rubber goods. As one Sopade report that originated in Berlin put it: “People, who in some cases don’t even own a car or bicycle, are getting car or bicycle tires,” on the hunch that rubber would soon be hard to find and hence more valuable.9 In part their fears were prompted by memories of hardship during the First World War, as well as the hyperinflation that followed. Some observers even interpreted the growth in auto sales in the first years of the regime, and increases in other large purchases made on installment plans, as a sign of lingering inflation fear rather than a reflection of worry over possible shortages.10 The hoarding of 1934 slowed in some sectors by 1935. One overly optimistic Sopade author referred to the change as a “shopping strike.”11 The more likely scenario, however, is that those who had engaged in such purchases the previous year had simply exhausted their surplus cash. Others were being affected by the downward pressure on wages and increased taxes. Still others may have decided to wait for the further implementation of state price controls, hoping for lower prices. Despite



Buyers and Sellers

these anxieties in the early days of the dictatorship and the rationing that predated but was extended at the start of the war, scholars agree that it was not until the last stage of the conflict and the immediate postwar years that severe shortages of daily goods began to affect the bulk of the population.12 As Atina Grossmann has noted, in 1945 Germans appeared to arriving Allied soldiers as “privileged survivors” compared with the civilians in the occupied territories they had encountered.13 A decade earlier, however, companies found themselves in a conundrum with regard to hoarding. Emerging slowly from the Depression, they were happy to see sales rise, but firms also understood the need to contain hoarding. In July of 1934, the Reichardt cocoa and chocolate manufacturers complained that all their advice against large orders by retailers was not having the desired effects. Thinking about the long-term stability of their own positions, salesmen were having trouble bringing themselves to dissuade store owners who wanted to meet demand while it existed, and who feared the possibility of bare shelves. Company headquarters, however, pleaded with their salesmen that it would not do the company any service to have overstocked inventory melting in the summer months. Eventually Reichardt simply implemented new rules that regulated the size and types of orders that could be placed.14 This brief burst of hoarding is important to this chapter for a number of reasons. It is emblematic first of individual consumer agency. Individuals were listening to rumors, reading advertisements, looking in shop windows, and making their own decisions regardless of attempts by corporations or state and party offices to direct their spending. As Nancy Reagin points out, members of the Nazi women’s organization (around 11 million by 1938) needed constant reminders not to shop at Jewish-owned stores— and even then the results were spotty.15 Second, the policies meant to re-educate and even coerce female consumers to shop and care for their families in ways that aided the Volksgemeinschaft, as discussed by others including Reagin, ran up against a growing respect for (female) consumers among businessmen. German firms may not have always relied on the most sophisticated methods for evaluating consumer desires and preferences, but there seems to have been a growing acceptance of the fact that consumers were smarter than ever before, and demanded a level of respect from advertisers. This story is part of a longer trend within Germany and beyond. By the 1920s the economy of the United States had shifted to one built far more clearly on the mass marketing and consumption of goods. As Ro-

141

142

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

land Marchand explains, this effort to sell goods to large sections of the population led not only to research into consumer behavior but also to new styles of advertisements. Marchand finds that “modern” ads emerged after the First World War, and consisted of images and text that centered on the consumer (and life with or without the product in question), rather than the product alone. He refers to this strategy as a more personal “sideby-side” approach to selling.16 This formula was picked up by only a few brand-name manufacturers in the 1920s in Germany. Julia Sneeringer has found that some advertisements from the middle years of the republic portrayed women consumers as “rational decision-makers motivated by positive values such as science, thrift, and a better standard of living for their families.”17 The Depression motivated more company leaders to think about how consumers made spending decisions, and led them to take more seriously consumers’ abilities to shop strategically. For example, while one hallmark of any branded product was clear and stable pricing, in 1931 salesmen for Salamander shoes requested that the shoes not be labeled with the price. Their reasoning was that in the current economic crisis, competitors were dropping their prices and shoppers were growing “mistrustful” of any apparently fixed prices. The sales staff responded by recommending that Salamander shoes no longer be shown with prices until some stability returned to the economy.18 Customers were not shy about sharing their opinions, either. In February 1931, Frau H. S. wrote to Kaffee Hag to explain that while she had been a longtime fan, she had recently switched to the cheaper rival decaffeinated coffee “Idee” to save money. After two weeks with the competitor, she “regretted her disloyalty to Hag and fled back.” Letters like this one were regularly circulated to sales representatives around the country by Kaffee Hag and other companies to boost morale and to provide what would be termed today “talking points” for point-of-sale discussions.19 In May, Kaffee Hag circulated a letter by Florence Kilroy of London—a fan in Britain was a particularly noteworthy recommendation for the product—as well as those from professional chefs in Munich and Leipzig.20 Beiersdorf was also careful to save letters from customers. Not only did these notes demonstrate loyalty to Nivea products, with praise for their power to soften the skin and slow the aging process, but fans of these creams and oils also appear to have developed some attachment to the advertising campaigns of the company. Throughout the interwar period, Beiersdorf regularly received letters from customers with rhyming poems and jingles that they thought would serve the brand well.21 Some satisfied customers even sent



Buyers and Sellers

in pictures of themselves fully tanned, or looking youthful at sixty, as evidence of the brand’s effectiveness—perhaps hoping they might find themselves in one of Nivea’s well-known photo advertisements. However, many letter writers were explicit that they expected no compensation for using their ad slogans, songs, or images. Particularly in these cases it seems that the individual felt compelled on some personal level to invest time and effort to congratulate the company and identify themselves as a member of some invisible community of loyal users. While actually putting pen to paper represents extreme rather than typical consumer behavior, it does indicate that some consumers had developed strong brand loyalties in the interwar years, a development more frequently associated with the postwar era.22 Although Germany was never a leader in market research, German firms continued in these years to expand their interest and expertise in this area. They hoped to combat the data put forward by one of the nation’s best known researchers in the science of sales and advertising, Professor Rudolf Seyffert at the University of Cologne. He claimed that 20 percent of the money spent on advertising in Germany was a complete waste, and at least 30 percent more had little effect.23 One response came from Sunlicht, which reported using demographic information about population density and employment in 1934, as well as the level of purchasing power of various socioeconomic groups, in its design of promotional efforts.24 The company also turned to information provided by trade commissions and other interest groups within its own industry, and analyzed reports from sales representatives. Sunlicht was even beginning to make use of customer surveys, finding that female students were well suited to conducting the surveys: female consumers were less suspicious of young women holding student identification cards than they were of women holding identification that marked them as employees looking to make a sale.25 Founded in 1935, the Society for Consumer Research (GfK), which has been studied in some detail by S. Jonathan Wiesen, operated out of Nuremberg even through the darkest days of the war.26 The GfK hoped to make its study of consumer choices more relevant than that of American market researchers by spending less time counting and more time interviewing; they gathered in-depth commentary from consumers on their likes and dislikes, choices made, and desires left unsatisfied.27 As the director of the GfK, Wilhelm Vershofen, wrote in 1936, “We are all consumers.” The problem was that producers had no way of knowing which goods would be successful until they were already on the market. “Products and distribu-

143

144

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

tion could be designed more cheaply—whereby the prices of goods could also be dropped—if one knew exactly what the consumer actually wanted,” explained Vershofen.28 The immediate task of his research institute was, therefore, “to give a voice to the consumer”; its long-range aim was “to make the German economy productive [ergiebig].”29 To achieve both goals, the GfK enlisted correspondents who understood the importance of the economy “and were of German blood” [Abstammung]. While racially exclusive, they sought strong participation from women, for reasons similar to those found in the Siemens anecdote at the start of this chapter. No particular education was necessary, because the institute trained its own correspondents.30 In other words, Vershofen and colleagues hoped to build a cohort of correspondents who represented the Volksgemeinschaft and could learn to speak to consumers with a shared vocabulary of national economy. In each issue of the GfK journal, Vershofen began by describing the significance of the work—essays that noted frequently how consumers’ “needs” in the modern world had far greater significance than meeting the necessities of life. He explained, for example, that “[c]onsumption serves also to satisfy the need to be well respected by others. . . . It is almost the case that the phrase ‘show me what you can consume, and I will tell you who you are’ is true.” Vershofen was under no false impression that individual consumption was losing importance in the new Nazi order, going so far as to write that “in general one can say that consumption satisfies the needs of social standing today more than in earlier periods.” Nonetheless he tempered his enthusiasm for material culture by extending credit to the “national government” for lessening class disparities.31 The excerpts from interviews published in the GfK newsletter are extremely instructive, and make apparent the organization’s attempt to include comments across class and regional divides. It is quite clear that participating consumers felt emboldened in the marketplace. Obviously those without strong views on the products under review (or the larger project more generally) remain absent from the summaries. However, the newsletter does succeed in illustrating a variety of opinions on individual products, as well as questions concerning the value of brand name goods, advertisements, and trademarks. There were still a few voices, particularly in the countryside, according to the editors, who held that branding did little more than raise the price of goods to cover the cost of fancy packaging, advertisements, and other forms of display.32 On the whole, however, respondents seemed to find more advantages to brand-name goods than disadvantages, highlighting in particular standardizations of price and quality.33



Buyers and Sellers

A shopper from Cologne noted that recognizable brands made shopping in other cities easier.34 One Berliner commented that brand-name goods allowed her to ignore the aggressive sales pitch in some shops, because she already knew to trust a previously purchased brand item.35 A respondent from Kaiserslautern offered that retailers were usually more knowledgeable about the merits of their brand-name goods, so could provide better advice.36 A consumer from Gladbach was determined to point out the poor quality that was turning up recently under the mantle of “brand-name” goods and that this designation no longer guaranteed value. She was more confident choosing only long-standing brands.37 However, a number of respondents also pointed out in 1936–37—at the height of the prewar economic boom—that many people were still unable to purchase brand-name goods. For them, seeking the lowest price offered by “anonymous” goods was the only option.38 And by mid-1937, references to new replacement products, including rayon textiles and cellulose pantyhose, turned up in GfK interviews.39 Overall, the people quoted in the GfK newsletter come across as confident shoppers. Whether they liked brand-name goods or ignored them and followed their own “personal taste,” the respondents (and perhaps this is the result of self-selection) believed that they knew their way around the marketplace. They felt they understood the value and/or underlying messages of advertisements, salesmen’s advice, and pricing.40 And while the tone of the “voice of the consumers” grows more negative, though not uniformly so, throughout 1938, the GfK remained convinced that consumption was an essential part of the human condition. According to Vershofen, “[T]he individual wants to stress his personality and set oneself apart through consumption, but he also wants to follow the general [social] rules and fit in.”41 Given the National Socialist context, this formulation demonstrates that while community, and even conformity, was important, men working in marketing and advertising still recognized the individuality of the consumer as something natural and immutable. The Nazi Ad Council supported the work of the GfK, and professional journals and other treatises on advertising in these years lauded the importance of marketing science, and called for more substantial research into consumer behavior. These were early days, however, and it is difficult to find clear evidence in German company archives of in-house or freelance advertisers and designers employing much psychological training or marketing acumen in their work. In this sense, the GfK should be seen as a forerunner of later developments in postwar Germany. A number of the GfK’s directors

145

fig. 4.3.  “A delicate topic?” Camelia sanitary pads, Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung, 1936. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.



Buyers and Sellers

in fact played key roles in the West German economy, including Ludwig Erhard, who became the minister of economics under Konrad Adenauer and is considered the architect of the social market economy that helped West Germans enjoy an abundance of consumer goods by the 1960s. Looking first at examples of print ads, we can see that some German advertisers did follow the lead of their American counterparts, who were writing copy that came across as good advice rather than aggressive salesmanship. The advertiser became a “confidante,” as Roland Marchand has put it for the American context, in a type of advertising that began appearing in the late 1920s in Germany, growing far more common in the 1930s. While this formula was not accepted uniformly in Germany, its adoption was steady, and by mid-decade, there were many advertisements that addressed the reader directly with “suggestions.” Another style that worked on the same principle portrayed a woman, who implicitly takes the place of the advertiser as she talks with a younger daughter or friend about the efficacy of a certain product. Rarely did these advice ads show a salesman imparting the secrets of a product’s worth. Rather the conversations between two consumers demonstrated that advertisers believed that word of mouth promotion of a product, even if it was simulated through image and text, was still the most trusted referral. Such advice ads can be found in all sectors, but were particularly popular with hygiene and grooming issues, especially more sensitive topics, such as feminine protection or bad breath. One variation of this strategy, used in the United States as well, was particularly popular in Germany in the mid-1930s: “the scare copy.” Negative ads that warned of dire consequences capitalized on recent experiences with political upheaval and economic Depression, along with a National Socialist ideology that stressed struggle and the presence of enemies at every turn. Instilling fear in consumers also fit well with psychological theories, which argued that effective ads targeted the fundamental drives of the human psyche, such as the desire for social acceptance, physical comfort, and safety from danger.42 Bayer scared potential customers with thoughts of missing work, or having their children struck down with flu after participating in group activities.43 Some of the most striking examples in this genre came from the Dresden manufacturer of Chlorodont toothpaste. Many of its ads offered rather frightening images of the health risks of ignoring oral hygiene. Comparing two ads for toothpaste from 1935, we see Chlorodont’s dark reminder that parents were responsible for setting a good example for their children by protecting their own health through brushing. Nivea’s toothpaste ad in the same issue of Berliner Illustrierte Zei-

147

148

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

fig. 4.4.  “Who here is in danger?” Bayer print advertisement, mid-1930s. Courtesy of Bayer Unternehmensarchiv, Leverkusen.

tung chose the more lighthearted approach associated with the brand: the role of toothpaste in creating an impression of natural beauty and health.44 Though these two print ads present very different messages, they both provide readers a way of imagining life with or without healthy teeth. While the strategy may have come from the United States originally, these were considered model ads in Nazi Germany because they “enlightened” the reader, as the Werberat liked to say, about the value of the product. In fact, as explained in Chapter 2, the Ad Council’s mandate of encouraging promotional efforts that “educated” fit nicely with transatlantic trends in this regard. My point here, however, is that offering advice, even advice that claimed dangerous results if ignored, presumed that the recipient can recognize, evaluate, and act upon the advice. In this sense, advertisements in this period were appealing more directly to the consumer’s rational decision-making abilities. Whether the consumer took the advice or not was another matter.

fig. 4.5.  “I mean you!” Chlorodont toothpaste ad, Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung, 1935. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.

150

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

fig. 4.6.  “It depends on your teeth . . .” Nivea toothpaste ad, Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung, 1935. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.

Henkel started its 1934 new year’s message to sales staff on an optimistic note. It had been fifteen years since the conclusion of the war, but Germany finally had a man at the helm who had led a successful “bloodless revolution” to create “one united German state, free of all provincialism and party division . . . . The chancellor had asked for four years’ time to bring order to everything, and awaken joy in work and life. Already within a year this has been achieved.” This Henkel memorandum went on to detail the regime’s first-year successes in domestic and foreign policy, before eventually getting around to discussing its products and how to sell them. It was not just the “good quality and purposeful advertisements” that had made their consumer washing agents successful; it was also the “warmth with which the sales representatives dealt with customers [retailers, in this case].” Their hard work to explain the uses and advantages of Henkel products to shop owners not only made it impossible for the competition to make inroads in market share; it was also critical to company success, because female con-



Buyers and Sellers

sumers were seeking accurate information from shop owners, and would be put off by ignorance or inaccurate advice. Henkel warned that only precise, truthful arguments were to be made, because today housewives “are able to hear what is not being said more than ever before.”45 Recognizing the need to build trusting relationships with their increasingly astute consumers, a number of companies issued magazines for their clientele that gave them the opportunity to know the products better. The emergence of these magazines represents an admission from the companies that their customer base expected more information, and was ready and able to digest it. One of Henkel’s closest competitors, Sunlicht Gesellschaft AG of Mannheim, initially printed only a traditional Hauszeitschrift for employees, the Sunlicht Post, which alongside company news also provided its staff with a sense of how the brand-name products were being presented to the public. In April 1933, however, the Sunlicht Post reported that the recent mail-in coupon program had unintentionally created a much more significant way for the firm to build its relationship with female customers. When sending in the Gutscheine, housewives had taken the initiative to ask questions about Sunlicht products and how they could be used in different contexts. While the firm was thrilled that it could create this “personal relationship” by providing advice about cleaning, Sunlicht was quite astounded by the range of questions received—questions that went far beyond the normal uses of Sunlicht products. As explained in the article, “Many mothers have questions about the care and raising of children, household budgeting, choice and decoration of apartments, purchasing household appliances, nutrition questions, recipes; and every question receives its answer. . . . The task becomes more difficult when we [at Sunlicht] are asked about treatments for itchy scalp, rosacea, or weakness in the legs, hair coloring or even whooping cough and gout.” The office in charge of responding did not shy away from providing answers even to these medical questions, though the staff admitted that caution was necessary. While the company’s team of writers worked behind the scenes, Sunlicht managers reveled in the fact that the correspondence was “winning housewives for its products and maintaining their loyalty. Through it we create trust, and trust is a strong bond and always creates a good atmosphere.”46 To draw more women into the conversation, Sunlicht established Die Sunlicht Freundin in 1936, a magazine solely for “friends” of Sunlicht products. The first issue stressed that the new publication was responding to and facilitating the growth of a community initiated by consumers. Sunlicht users would not only receive news from the firm in a one-way exchange;

151

152

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

the Sunlicht Freundin created a venue for women to share their own experiences and tips regarding products, and pose questions to be answered by other “friends” of the company. Presuming the answers to individual questions would be of interest to others, the existing response office would now have the means to communicate with a much wider audience.47 This new promotional effort was motivated primarily by the quest for market share, but its editors also reasoned that nurturing a community of “friends of the brand” was appropriate to the times, in which “every individual steps up where he/she is offered the opportunity to join the work, to become—in the words of Goethe—‘a link that supports the whole.’”48 A German subsidiary of the Anglo-Dutch conglomerate Unilever, Sunlicht’s managers at headquarters in Mannheim were conscious of the need to develop a German sensibility.49 At the end of the first year of circulation, a magazine survey asked readers to rate which articles they found particularly useful, compared with those that either failed to present new information or were simply uninteresting. Many of the articles had a subtle political message, as the firm tried to negotiate the difficulties faced by detergent and soap producers under the new autarchic measures, such as an article about Sunlicht’s interest in whale hunting (as we saw with Henkel) or one that reminded women that “textiles are valuable property of the Volk” and should be treated with care. Some issues also included technical essays, such as the “Science of Floor Mops.”50 While many of the essays appeared to also reflect the needs of the state and the interest in rationalization more generally, there were other essays that indicated a greater self-consciousness within the firm to promote Sunlicht products and attract female consumers regardless of public pronouncements by the regime. Two articles serve as good examples of this difference. The first, “Cosmetics are not a luxury,” began by arguing that progress in the chemical industries and greater understanding of hygiene meant that even “low-income” individuals were able to afford a variety of cosmetic products, including hair oils, bath salts, body lotions, and more. Makeup was not mentioned in this opening list of cosmetic products, reflecting perhaps the opinion held by some that makeup was unbecoming, a view that was echoed in official propaganda images and rhetoric surrounding the ideal German woman.51 The December 1937 article, however, did defend the production and consumption of makeup. The author reminded readers that the cosmetics industry included “3000 manufacturing plants, which employed many many thousands of Volksgenossen,” along with those employed in the production of makeup tubes, boxes, and bottles, not



Buyers and Sellers

to mention the people who worked at the 20,000 drug stores and 13,000 soap stores, 100,000 salons, and 4,500 parfumerie. With its parents located in London and Rotterdam, the author for Sunlicht praised Germany’s cosmetics industry as a global export leader in everything from cologne to lipstick.52 What was more, consumers need not worry that certain perfume essences or colorings were imported; German chemical firms had found domestic replacements for all raw materials. This message suited the goals of autarchy, but it also demonstrated Sunlicht’s determination to hold on to customers who might have heard that cosmetics, particularly hair coloring and makeup, were un-German from the National Socialist women’s organizations. The 1939 article “The First Gray Hair” discussed the sadness women allegedly feel when confronted with this visible sign of aging. The author explained that this experience can lead to a discouraging change in selfperception: that one is indeed old, regardless of age or fitness. It also could have damaging consequences for “the career woman,” who may seem to colleagues to be “less capable” than before. Supporting career women at a time when they were rarely mentioned, the author exclaimed that the firm’s hair coloring brand, Kleinol, was the obvious solution.53 The article faced potential critics head on. Noting that some readers might respond that dyeing hair was “unnatural,” the author retorted: “Stop. We don’t want to be so old fashioned.” Permanent waves for hair were no longer considered unnatural, so why should hair coloring be deemed so? In fact, the author pointed out, it was far more natural to return hair to its original color.54 Die Sunlicht Freundin, then, had a complex purpose in the last years before the war. On the one hand it was a way to promote the usefulness and sale of company products and, importantly, to get feedback from customers about how well Sunlicht was meeting their needs. On the other hand, it gave the firm a venue for walking the line between National Socialist ideology and the desires of female consumers in the Third Reich. Sunlicht stayed abreast of regime policies, including campaigns toward more “rational” production methods and the conservation of fats, and its desire to champion consumer products in the lead-up to war, even those that conservative voices rejected as frivolous or unbefitting German women. Sunlicht created its own community of “friends,” and through that network aligned itself with some national goals while continuing to cultivate customer loyalty. The pharmaceutical giant Bayer reasoned that brochures that did not come across as advertisements had the best chance for “long lasting effect”

153

154

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

with consumers. Female consumers were savvy enough to see an advertisement for what it was, explained the in-house ad department at Bayer, but offering them practical tips for completing housework more easily and meeting the demands of family responsibilities more successfully would build the sort of respect that ensured long-term brand loyalty. Like Sunlicht, the makers of Bayer products made special mention of career women, who needed good advice and effective products to bear their heavy domestic duties alongside employment. Although the regime had continued the Depression-era policy of encouraging the layoffs of so-called double earners (female wage-earners married to employed husbands), the pressures of rearmament on the labor supply meant that women were increasingly encouraged to work, despite continued emphasis that women maintain a “true German” domestic realm. A Bayer booklet entitled “Tips for the Housewife” might include a note about how best to store apples through the winter, as well as a reminder of the range of its pharmaceutical products that should be kept on hand in case of illness.55 Similarly, newspaper articles about the importance of sleep for good health, workplace productivity, and stress-free living could slip in a mention of the Bayer sleep aid Adalin. The tone of these short essays, and their appearance in newspapers without images, had the added benefit of possibly catching the eye of male readers who were thought to skip past the pages of classifieds.56 Another strategy for engaging consumers was taken by Christian A. Kupferberg, who by the mid-1930s had been maintaining his family’s sparkling wine brand for two decades. In 1936, Kupferberg went on a research trip to the United States alongside other business leaders, including Erich Wohlfahrt, the chief of advertising for Germany’s well-known beverage brand Kathreiner. As the two men were sailing across the Atlantic, according to Kupferberg, it was Wohlfahrt who suggested that he try telling his brand’s story in a series of connected ads, in which he himself, Christian Kupferberg, would play the leading role. The Mainz sparkling-wine magnate first rejected the idea, claiming that he did not want to turn himself into a celebrity, but on second thought and with the encouragement of his shipmates, he was convinced that such a plan offered the perfect way to forge the personal connection with consumers often enjoyed by retailers, craftsmen, and other small businessmen but rarely achieved by larger consumer goods firms.57 Still worried that consumers might be turned off by the egotistical stunt, he turned to the ideology of the day for reassurance. Heeding the messages sent along by the party about the responsibilities of the Betriebsführer to lead by example, Kupferberg declared that “if a master



Buyers and Sellers

baker stands in his shop or a cobbler can be seen at work through his studio window, why shouldn’t the maker of a brand-name product be willing to stand in front of his firm with pleasure in the responsibility of representing and promoting his business?”58 To present a vignette about the company and its chief executive in two or three short paragraphs was a risky venture. First, the company had trouble finding someone to take on the job of creating such “a stew” of company narrative and sales pitch. Second, there was concern that offering so much text might turn off readers instead of hooking them like a serialized novel. The company claimed to have received many letters from fans who praised the new style, requested autographs, or noted that they looked forward to ads like the long-running comic “Father and Son” in the Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung. There were also a few critics, but Kupferberg stuck with the series confident that a scripted, even fictionalized, personal message to customers was the way of the future. Heinrich Hunke, Ad Council vice president, cheered all attempts by companies to build ties with their potential customers, while working with the needs of the regime. As Hunke explained in his address to the Continental Ads Congress in 1937: “Right now, personality is everything in advertising. And personality will continue in the future to influence the market freely, it does not impinge on the general good.”59 It is easy to see why Kupferberg would appreciate Hunke’s comments, but this short passage also speaks more broadly to the Nazi resolution of the impersonal nature of capitalism. Commerce needed personalized heroes like Kupferberg to demonstrate its usefulness, and its Germanness. A final example of the growing respect for consumers can be found in a 1935 dispute that involved the Werberat, a number of professional interest groups, and the company whose campaign was under attack, Böhme Fettchemie (BFC) of Chemnitz. BFC, a laundry detergent manufacturer, brought a new product to the market in 1935 called Fewa. The company and its ads touted the new cleaner as revolutionary: as an alkaline-free detergent, it could handle fine washables (silk and wool primarily, but also increasingly the new synthetic fibers) without the shrinking that forced many people to use expensive dry cleaning. The campaign to introduce the product to the market was extensive, involving a drawn female character, “Johanna,” who was anything but the White Lady of Persil. Johanna was smaller than life-size, doll-like in simplicity with undefined hair pulled back in a bun, and dressed in the plainest of clothing. However, Johanna knew the secrets of Fewa: saving money by launder-

155

fig. 4.7. Entrepreneur as adman, Kupferberg Sekt, Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung, 1937. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/ Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.



Buyers and Sellers

ing fine washables at home, while protecting the fabric and color of delicate textiles. At first glance Johanna is an idealized, if stylized, Nazi woman— Germanic in name, happy with her domestic work, frugal, and rational. On second glance, however, Johanna is not the female consumer. Indeed, her stout stature, when compared with the tall, slender fashionable dress silhouettes she is pictured with, makes it clear that these are not her clothes. For the female consumer who owned a closet full of fine washables but needed to cut back financially, Johanna helped garments last longer without dry cleaning. For the woman who had stayed away from such styles because of the cost of maintenance, Johanna made it possible to add to her wardrobe. The fantasy of emancipation from financial concern or from a drab cotton wardrobe is borne on the back of women’s work. Johanna may be smiling, but the female owner of the dresses will have to do the actual hand washing. Ads for Fewa came under immediate attack by competitors. The most vociferous critics were the members of the industrial subgroup for the producers of fabric dyes and dry cleaning (FiKcR), which fell under the oversight of the professional group for textile refining, which (in turn) reported to the Economic Group Textile Industries in Nazi Germany’s hierarchically centralized economic system. The FiKcR wrote to the Chemnitz firm first on 9 August 1935, charging that BFC’s product literature under the title “Wash old into new, 20 Fewa-Tips” [Wasch alt auf neu, 20 Fewaratschläge] violated the new laws on advertising because the images and accompanying text would “disappoint and mislead the public.” Most wool, silk, cotton, and even the new man-made textiles simply could not handle any washing in water and certainly would not “walk themselves from washing tub to closet,” as indicated on the brochure cover page and in ads found in illustrated magazines.60 The FiKcR critics insisted that BFC bring its ads in line with Werberat rules on fair competition and truthful advertising. The first thing BFC sought to do was find out how the Werberat had responded to similar cases and was pleased to find a Werberat ruling posted in the professional journal Deutsche Werbung that defended an ad promising to “Make your old hat like new.” The Ad Council’s reasoning was that such a saying did not indicate that the old hat (or clothing item) would be made new in the sense of resale, but that servicing the item (through cleaning or replacement of worn parts) could make it valuable again to the owner. It was clearly in the best interests of the regime to support consumers in their desires to remake out-of-fashion or worn articles of cloth-

157

fig. 4.8.  “Here Johanna washes—‘from old to new!’” Controversial Fewa ad, 1935. Courtesy of the Sächsisches Staatsarchiv, Chemnitz.



Buyers and Sellers

ing. However, the ruling went further in its defense of consumers’ ability to digest ad copy accurately. Consumers were not misled by such slogans, declared the Werberat. They would understand the meaning and not be duped into thinking old garments could ever become brand new once again.61 BFC may have thought this was assurance enough to silence its critics. Perhaps it did for a time, but in July 1937 the FiKcR, still upset that the ads were appearing, appealed to the Werberat directly. The Ad Council reported the charges as laid out by the dry cleaners and called for a meeting between the two opponents and a staff member at the Werberat office in Berlin.62 BFC responded to the Ad Council, declaring that the dry cleaners were only using the Ad Council in their desperate bid to save market share. The Chemnitz company continued confidently, relying on language that suited both Nazi policy-makers and the most ardent of capitalists. It was clear, BFC argued, that Fewa simply filled a niche in the market, providing a more economical way for women to wash fine textiles at home. This practice saved raw materials and opened up more fashionable options for those Germans who could not afford the expense of sending out their wash. Consumers were not as naive as BFC’s detractors would have the Ad Council believe, the report continued: “No rational person would think that clothes leave the wash basin without any deterioration.” Furthermore everyone knows that washed clothes must be ironed—“the caricatured nature of the whole [ad] image is so obvious that no one could mistake it [for reality].” In fact, if critics really believed that consumers would conclude that dresses could rise from the washbasin fully ironed and waltz into the closet, explained BFC’s legal department, then they must expect also “that all women who wash with Persil are young, blond, good-humored, and carry floral bouquets in the depths of winter.”63 At the meeting held to discuss the complaint against BFC’s ads, the Ad Council threw out the charges laid by the dry cleaners association.64 Böhme Fettchemie’s victory in this case stemmed from a variety of factors. First the example demonstrates again the Ad Council’s desire to defend advertisers where possible, and to accept that consumers were able to judge advertisements for themselves. BFC may also have benefited from the fact that its detergent did not use fat—and was therefore friendlier to the autarchic policies of the day. Fewa’s manufacturers had already pointed out to earlier critics from within the advertising industry that the most pressing task for advertisers, as stated by the Ad Council at its inception, was “the support of the sale of German goods and services within and beyond Germany’s borders.” A product like Fewa was worthy of defense. It was

159

160

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

not reliant on imported oil, offered a more economical way for the Volk to care for delicates (including the notoriously difficult-to-handle ersatz textiles that were appearing in ever greater quantities), and even employed more workers in its complicated manufacturing process than traditional detergents. Ads for Fewa could be construed quite clearly, therefore, as “in the general interest” of consumers and the regime.65

salesmanship in the “new germany” Most of the firms discussed in this book depended on large numbers of sales representatives, referred to as either Reisende (travelers) or Vertreter (representatives), who were the mediators between company headquarters and wholesalers and/or retailers. The duties of the Reisende, to coordinate “advertising and sales” of a brand-name product, were markedly different and more complex than those who represented “loose” or “anonymous” goods.66 They often spoke directly to individual consumers in large public gatherings, at meetings of party organizations, or in front of members of professional organizations. In some cases they coordinated door-to-door efforts, targeting individual housewives. They were also responsible for training retailers in making sales and disseminating the company’s promotional literature, booklets, posters, store displays, indoor and outdoor signage, and more. In many cases they set up, supervised, or evaluated shop window displays of the products they sold. Traveling sales representatives were also encouraged to inform headquarters about any changes in local conditions and attitudes among consumers.67 Given all these tasks, British observers from Unilever headquarters felt that the position in Germany was “young man’s work,” which “demanded enthusiasm” and a level of physical fitness necessary for travel and “considerable shop decoration work.”68 With this in mind, the British visitors noted that the German sales staff would need to be reorganized, because the current team of men was too old. Looking at this lengthy and diverse job description, it is clear that despite the need for youthful energy, the sales representatives were the key link in a company’s promotional efforts: they were the men on the ground who made it all happen.69 Like their cousins the advertisers, sales representatives also pined for more professional status and security.70 While standardized training paths in sales, unlike advertising, had been in existence for some decades in Germany, the image of the sales representative suffered in comparison to those



Buyers and Sellers

who held fixed and visible sales positions behind a store counter. Unlike shop owners or even retail sales staff who became familiar faces in their communities, these men represented two forms of potential menace within anticapitalist or racial critiques. They were outsiders, and therefore likely dishonest in commercial dealings, and, they resembled Jewish peddlers from an earlier era, who were considered racial pariahs. By 1933 there was certainly great overlap between these two prejudices, but either way the Reisende lost.71 Even brand name manufacturers used such stereotypes to their advantage. For example, Osram emphasized the alleged links between low-quality, nonbranded items and duplicitous claims by their sales representatives in an essay warning customers to be wary of anonymous goods. The point was dramatized by an image of a small, effeminate salesman and his disheveled case that accompanied the text.72 Judging from the professional journals of Reisende from the first years of the new regime, it is clear that sales representatives were an unhappy bunch. Indeed the tone is even more pessimistic than that of the advertising journals from the same years—perhaps a sign that the propagandasavvy NSDAP had made more of an effort to convince advertisers that there was a home for them in the new Reich. Issues of Der Reisende Kaufmann from early 1933 are replete with articles about the prohibitively high costs of appropriate work attire and gasoline. The Reichsbahn was also too expensive, they complained, and moving costs were a common burden on members of the profession. Further articles covered headaches, the dangers of mixing alcohol and motor vehicle driving, demands for a drop in the taxes on cars, and data on vehicular accident death rates.73 Issues of the magazine also regularly contained photos of centuries-old villas belonging to the successful merchants of the Renaissance and early modern eras, as if to reassure readers of their own Germanic heritage and to lay claim to a mythologized past in which merchants had been respected (and wealthy) pillars of the community.74 As a group the Reisende felt neglected as they toiled behind the scenes, and scholars too have paid them scant attention.75 The rest of this chapter will demonstrate, however, just how important they were in maintaining commercial life while helping to build the Volksgemeinschaft. During the first months of the regime, as in other economic sectors, there was a call for unity among Aryan traveling reps to help each other and calls on Aryan manufacturers, wholesalers, and retailers to work only with their racial brethren in the tough economic times.76 Refusing to purge Jews from employment in sales, argued one apparently committed National

161

fig. 4.9. “Warning!” Osram editorial, mid1930s. Courtesy of Landesarchiv, Berlin (A. Rep. 231, no. 1224).

fig. 4.10. Traveling Salesman, Henkel Blätter vom Hause, 1937. Courtesy of Corporate Archive, Henkel AG & Co. KGaA, Düsseldorf.

164

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

Socialist, would push the “German” salesmen toward further “proletarianization.”77 That he chose to frame his anti-Semitic argument in Marxist terms—that is, that salesmen were becoming nothing more than impoverished and alienated workers, even though Marx was the epitome of Jewish subversion and danger to Nazi Germany—is in itself rather telling of the difficulty many supporters of the regime had in formulating a workable critique of capitalism. Nonetheless, it is difficult to trace the purging of nonAryan sales representatives. Although very few Jews would have still held their jobs in sales by the end of 1938, when anti-Jewish measures effectively pushed any remaining Jews out of the German economy, the elimination of Jewish sales staff took place at different rates according to the individual company’s policies. We do know, however, that many so-called Aryan men who remained participated not only in the “cleansing” of their own ranks but were eager middle-men in the Aryanization of the retail sector—a subject we will come to later.78 The “art of sales” did not shift overnight with the change in government. The “12 suggestions for the traveling salesman” printed for the men of the brand-new Unilever margarine Sanella in March 1931 were considered “old truths” by the experienced salesman who put the list together, and they remained practical tips throughout the decade: “Don’t pass by a store that could be a customer because a competitor is firmly entrenched. Perseverance will pay off sooner or later. . . . Let the customer speak. Don’t forget that most people love to hear their own voices. . . . Do not criticize your employer . . . . Show loyalty.”79 While there was no avoiding the daily grind of making contacts with retailers, even if that meant telephoning or writing letters, perhaps one significant change in the Weimar era over previous decades would have been the increasing respect the salesman was expected to afford to the brand—its image and advertisements. As the makers of Sanella noted in their handbook for representatives in 1931, “Our ads, as you see, set the pace and prepare the way for your sales work; they open doors, they allow you to speak of a brand that is well known by the retailers and asked for by the consuming public.”80 These instructions were sent to a massive sales force. In 1927 Margarine Union, which would become part of Unilever in two years’ time, counted fifty-six hundred travelers in Germany. This veritable army saw significant decline in the years that followed, owing to rationalization measures within Unilever and decreasing margarine consumption. However, Charles Wilson still estimates that half that many, or twenty-eight hundred men, served as Reisende for Unilever in the early 1930s.81



Buyers and Sellers

Sales representatives were joined in some cases by “propaganda troops” organized for door-to-door offensives. It is not surprising that this sort of militarization of economic life emerged at the end of the Weimar Republic, given that the paramilitary units of Germany’s political parties were becoming more and more present and aggressive on Germany’s streets.82 As Sunlicht’s headquarters instructed for the promotion of its all-purpose cleaner, Vim, the troops would consist of one leader, one person in charge of the wagon carrying materials (a car or handcart), and four distributors. Troop members worked a nine-hour day, wore uniforms, and were prohibited from smoking, stopping off at pubs, and talking to passersby in the streets. They were to march along the street in pairs behind the wagon. Distributors were to hand the promotional material to the housewife only, and have a brief discussion of the product’s merits. Brevity was a must, for they were expected to reach twelve hundred households per day, or three hundred per man. Considering the stair climbing with samples and brochures to carry aloft, the company recommended that only men in their twenties, who could undertake this task in a “zippy and perky” manner, be hired.83 By the start of 1939 a few things had changed. Sunlicht was still delivering advertising materials door-to-door for Vim and also for Fex, a new product designed to compete with Fewa for the fine-washables market. Since 1937 the company had begun to use women for this work, Werberinnen (ad women). The shift was due in part to the belief among corporate leaders that women preferred to speak to other women. The change also reflected the simple truth that the labor surplus of qualified men in 1931 had disappeared six years later. Even then the company noted that it was difficult to organize enough labor. A second change was that more of the work was done in stores, which had previously been trusted only to senior, male sales representatives. While ad women could be trusted to speak to individual housewives, there was concern about letting them speak with or in front of male retailers. Henkel still warned against having Werbedamen (ad ladies) visit stores in 1935. If having a woman visit local shops could not be avoided, then only “trustworthy women should be engaged, who understand how to be polite without being too shy with the retailers and housewives.”84 Ultimately, the ad women spent more and more time in the stores. Store owners could listen in and learn about the products, while more potential customers (already primed to buy, given their presence in the shop) could be captured at once than with door-to-door efforts. Despite these new opportunities, by the end of the 1930s there was actually more control exerted over these women’s performances via the intro-

165

166

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

duction of scripted texts. Even when speaking to a housewife at her home, female ad troops were no longer allowed to present the product effectively on their own. Though Fex was an obvious competitor to BFC’s Fewa, direct comparisons were illegal, as they had been before 1933. In place of mentioning the rival product, the female advertiser was instructed to start all her conversations with “Heil Hitler, Frau X.” The text emphasized that Fex worked well with all types of fabric, including the new cellulose ersatz textiles. It could also be used in hard water and was ideal for cleaning glass, porcelain, windows, doors, and more. In conclusion, she was to mention its low price and reassure the customer of its high quality as a Sunlicht brand, closing with “Heil Hitler.”85 In assessing the move to a scripted approach, two points are worth mention. Some brand name companies, or at least their (male) sales managers, continued to challenge the suitability of women for these tasks, particularly those working outside controlled retail spaces. Henkel managers complained, for example, in late 1935 that some Werberinnen “who were not even the worst in their jobs, had forgotten all moral standards in their private lives and had to be let go.” The report added that female employees needed to be continually reminded not to discuss competitors’ products, get in “political arguments,” or “discuss familial matters” with the housewives they encountered.86 The scripted conversations are also indicative of the growing acceptance of “scientific” sales techniques. The combination of “proven” sales language and the desire for tighter control over women who allegedly ranged off topic, however, may have actually hindered female sales staff from engaging in the sorts of one-on-one trust-building chats that some believed led to increased sales. Unfortunately, we have no records to evaluate the success or failure of this technique. The tightening of the consumer market is discernible: fewer, now female, advertisers, highlighting the multiple uses of Fex and its low cost.87 Moreover, the call to begin and end with “Heil Hitler” reflects a desire by the company to show its allegiance to the regime. Whether Sunlicht was motivated by fear of retaliation if the greeting was omitted, or the sense that it brought the brand in line with popular sentiment, is unclear. No Werberat directive requiring the greeting has been found. Regardless of the motivation, if the Sunlicht employees were following through in praising the Führer, these private corporations were helping in the Kleinarbeit [the daily grind] of building a commercial culture to support the Volksgemeinschaft. Although it is difficult to gain much more understanding of the role played by the “ad ladies” from the corporate archives, examining the work



Buyers and Sellers

of the Reisende in Nazi Germany does demonstrate the emergence of a new mission for sales staff as servants of the Volkswirtschaft, or people’s economy. In typically confused political rhetoric, Sunlicht wrote to its retailers that in “the new order,” the misunderstandings of the “liberal era” in which Marxist phrases such as “class conflict” were used should disappear. The traveling sales representative should no longer be viewed as “an annoying person.” Instead, he should be seen as a servant of commerce and receive the courteousness he deserves. It is an injustice, to treat a salesman, who does not earn his bread easily, particularly in the presence of the shopping public, in an impolite or curt way. It makes a bad impression on customers. And so-called “icy” courtesy is also unfit for our times, it hinders the necessary emotional bond between the traveler and businessman. . . . The traveling sales representative is in general an advisor.88

Creating trust between the company representative and the retailers not only benefits the latter, the article concluded. “It serves, in truth, the entire Volk.” This reminder to retailers of Sunlicht’s products provides clear evidence of a lack of respect for Reisende, possible class tensions, and a wariness of big business. Mistreatment of sales representatives by shop owners confirmed the latter’s own superior status and respectability. The reliance on Nazi rhetoric to make these points about commercial interactions can be read either as opportunism on Sunlicht’s part, pandering to what they believed would find resonance with retailers, or the belief that National Socialism was the best way forward for the company. Regardless of Sunlicht’s motivations, what remains critical is that by sending out the reminder couched in these terms to retailers in all corners of the Reich, Goebbels had his work done for him without ever spending a pfennig. Teamwork between the retailer and sales representative was needed, and behind closed doors at company headquarters, Sunlicht executives placed the blame for tensions between retailers and Reisende on the older store owners who failed to understand “modern advertising techniques” and “modern consumers.”89 This theme of partnership continued to be emphasized in the Sunlicht Post. In October 1938 the company’s traveling representatives were reminded that dealing with retailers in the countryside took particular tact and care. Though the article was titled “Comrades at Work,” the author referred to the difficulty of dealing with rural retailers, “simple people . . . who would treat the salesman on first visit shyly and with mistrust.”90 This contrast between the commercial culture in villages and urban areas is a red thread throughout the period’s literature on sales and advertising, as we have also seen in the previous chapters. While attempts

167

168

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

to unite the Volksgemeinschaft may have been underway for some years, the purveyors of brand-name products remained convinced that the sales strategies and advertisements that served as their products’ calling cards were still more suited to Germany’s cities than to the countryside. There was more to selling in the new era, however, than being sensitive to the fears and prejudices of old-fashioned retailers. Working for these private firms was an extension of work for the Fatherland. As early as the summer of 1933, companies began advising their sales staffs (and retailers) that they had new ethical standards to uphold in their business practices. While many commercial actors supported the call to root out the dishonorable behaviors that were allegedly endemic to the profession, they also felt comfortable referring back to the “old sales fundamentals of acting in good faith.” Most of the time it was not clear when the good old days ended and the problems began.91 The Ad Council also got into the act by pointing out to sales representatives the necessity of following council standards for proper advertising. Knowing that these men were conducting “verbal advertisements” in their conversations with customers, Reisende were reminded that their sales pitch could not criticize competitor products, even if the manufacturer had provided data to prove the product was superior to its rivals.92 The traveling salesman was left in a bind between the Ad Council and his employer, and we can only assume by the existence of the Ad Council missive that Reisende frequently ignored the ban on “negative” ads when meeting privately with customers. While Henkel, for example, “was not surprised” that the political changes ushered in at the start of 1933 were the subject of discussions with customers, the sales staff needed to be careful. “They [salesmen] try to give their own opinions, without remembering that [retailers and customers] have already formed their own opinions.” In such cases further conversation could lead to debate and weaken “the harmonious partnership” between buyers and sellers. The goal was to remain “neutral.” The instructions to Henkel’s staff were clear: “It must not interest our gentlemen [salesmen], whether one or two, or another, or even no flags were hung, in fact [Henkel’s men] should take no notice of such activities or such banners—that has nothing to do with our company, our gentlemen have only business interests and they are, as always: Persil remains Persil.”93 While this missive to sales staff to remain apolitical may have been Henkel’s official policy for dealing with its customers, the internal newsletters from headquarters to sales staff were consistently replete with congratulatory commentary on the new regime. Not only did Henkel (and other large firms) cheer on Hitler’s



Buyers and Sellers

domestic agenda, company newsletters also agreed with official positions on foreign policy matters such as Mussolini’s invasion of Abyssinia and the League of Nations response in 1935.94 There was money to be made and goodwill to foster with the regime. In 1936 Henkel sales staff, including the “ad ladies” who normally visited individual homes or performed demonstrations in stores, were reminded that they should not forgo stops at “home economics schools, SA-Homes, Labor Service Camps, Sports- and Leadership schools etc.” As Thomas Kühne rightly notes, Aryan Germans were slowly being segregated into various camps that fit their professions, political ambitions, and leisure pursuits.95 In addition to serving as opportunities to build “comradeship,” camps served as new commercial sites, and grew increasingly important as targets for promotional efforts. The captive audience (as individual consumers) could easily be rounded up to attend a film or lecture on the product in question, and there were big purchases to be made by the party organizations and state offices responsible for the upkeep of these camps and trainings centers.96 While the professional journals of salesmen remained pessimistic throughout this period, showing none of the spirit of success and reform voiced in the advertising journals, pointed essays about the “rebuilding of salesman’s honor” and calls for sales representatives to recognize their duties in the new economy grew increasingly common.97 The continued negative tone of the journals for Reisende indicates that they had a steep hill to climb to respectability, presumably owing to the number of Jewish wholesalers and retailers with whom they had business ties, as well as the older stereotypes about “nomadic Jewish” peddlers. For example, in 1937 the Reichswirtschaftsminister decided to ramp up the structures to purge business life of “dishonorable conduct” (coded as Jewish). As one article calling for stricter policies explained, the deep memories of profiteering in the war and postwar periods, “the undermining of a moral economy by the influences of racial aliens and other incompatible elements in leading positions of the economy,” has led all “right thinking” people to agree with the need for more extensive measures. Following this introduction, the journal announced the implementation of a new system of “honor courts” in January 1937. Eighteen such courts would be set up within the corresponding regional economic associations, taking the place of the fifty volunteer courts that had already been established in the Industry and Trade Associations around the country. “Warnings, reprimands, fines, and bans from participation in the individual’s professional association” were the possible

169

170

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

outcomes of charges ranging from “false advertising, selling poor quality [goods] under the promise of high quality, [and] using improper competitive strategies.”98 As we saw earlier with Christian A. Kupferberg’s self-promotion and Hunke’s lauding of “personality” in ads, we have here a state response to the less pleasant aspects of capitalism. In this case, demonizing such practices by racializing them worked to create a positive, ethically acceptable countermodel of commercial behavior. All members of the Association of Traveling Sales Representatives were expected to follow these practices. They were also called on actively to push “Jewish influence out of public life,” though even supporters of such blatant anti-Semitism, such as Horant Holm for the journal Der Reisende Kaufmann, recognized the complexities of this task for working salesmen. In fact, it was “the most difficult for men in the traveling profession (Reiseberuf), because there still exists here the closest ties and bonds to Jewry.” Alluding to personal relationships that Aryan company representatives might have developed with Jewish retailers or Jewish sales staff over years of business contact, Holm seemed concerned that some Reisende would have trouble cutting ties. The best medicine, according to Holm, was a more active role for non-Jewish sales staff in the national struggle.99 Overlooked in the past, Holm argued that salesmen’s very position put them in the “front lines” of the battle. In the past one’s word and trust had been enough to back a business deal. Certainly, belief in “the common good over self-interest” had taken hold, uncovering the “decayed fundamentals” and “capitalist exploitation” of the recent past, but now the Reisende had to become active, vigilant in a commercial culture that had been cleaved in two in Germany: Aryan business interests and non-Aryan. “The go-between is the traveling sales representative. [He] stands at important posts in the coming fight against Jewish domination of the economy.”100 As intermediaries, these “front line” troops were not only valuable as partners for Aryan business contacts, they also had a larger role to play in selling Nazi ideology alongside their material wares. A description from 1937 of how this might work is worth quoting at length: Since we live in a politically dynamic time, the discussions between salespeople or between retailers and their customers will not revolve around the weather, personal well-being, or gastronomy. One speaks also of the political and economic happenings, exchanges one’s own observations and supplements what stands in the newspapers and journals with one’s own professional experiences. . . . This invisible newsletter, whose “editor” is in reality the traveling salesman or retailer need not be boring. . . . The salesman who



Buyers and Sellers travels with chemicals, with new compression molded material, textiles, wood products or with iron and steel—the retailer who offers household goods, clothing, colonial wares, vegetables, fruit and citrus, and many other salespeople live daily in this material world and create [knowledge] from direct observation. Their reports appear therefore as particularly trustworthy, even though their view may be of a small part of the larger events or be clouded by subjective conditions. They find, nonetheless, a grateful readership. Decisive is however the question, whether the salespeople despite this great potential for influence are aware of—whether they know—the state-political responsibility that falls to them.101

This author may have had his doubts about the seriousness with which Germany’s sales representatives took their political tasks, but he was not alone in charging the Reisende with important work for the Volksgemeinschaft. In 1934, another notice in Der Reisende Kaufmann reminded sales representatives that Jewish-owned businesses may try to hoodwink consumers and other business partners by changing the company’s name, particularly if a Jewish surname was involved. Though a visual change to the storefront from “Levy and Sons” to “Lehmann and Sons” may appear to signal the desired Aryanization, company representatives should be forewarned that “the eternal Jew” was capable of this sort of “false” advertising.102 By the end of 1938 this feared invisibility was a thing of the past. Traveling sales representatives in some cases played an even more active role in the Aryanization process than this author hoped for. Founded in 1885, Salamander shoes grew into the largest shoe manufacturer and retailer in Germany. By the late 1920s, the Salamander brand, well known for its green trademark bearing the tiny amphibian and the company name, boasted employing five thousand wage-earners and another five hundred white-collar staff. The sale of the firm’s shoes was handled in a bifurcated way. The company had Salamander-only stores: ninety-three branches throughout Germany in the late 1920s, thirty-two of which were in Berlin alone, and another twenty-five located outside of Germany. In smaller cities and towns throughout the country, Salamander products were sold in shoe shops alongside other brands.103 Usually only one shop per town was given a contract to sell Salamander goods. In exchange for the privilege, the roughly fourteen hundred such shop owners at the end of the Weimar era agreed not to sell competitor makes in the same price range, to follow the pricing set by headquarters for Salamander shoes, and to promote the brand’s wares with advertising and prominent displays. In 1933 the Aryanization of Salamander shoes was undertaken from

171

172

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

inside the company. By 1934 this process was completed, when the last Jewish member of the board of directors, Arthur Levi, a nephew of one of the founders, Max Levi, left his position. With their links to the firm severed, the extended members of the Levi family emigrated, according to a 1985 company brochure created on the occasion of Salamander’s one hundredth anniversary. The brochure describes the safe exodus of the Levis and the Aryanization of the company as a set of normal business transactions rather than the forced surrender of the family’s business empire.104 By 1935 the company had grown further, employing sixty-three hundred and producing over 4 million pairs of shoes per year.105 In the years following Aryanization, Salamander bought up a number of Jewish-owned leather companies and tanneries to ensure supplies, given the rationing of leather that began in 1934.106 By the onset of war in 1939, the company had added another seven hundred employees and boasted an annual output of 6 million pairs sold at 126 Salamander outlets and 1,882 independent shoe shops.107 Already in 1934, according to Sopade reports, Salamander was enjoying contracts to produce shoes for the military and party organizations.108 During the war the company employed twenty-one hundred slave laborers, about 30 percent of the workforce, in order to continue production, outfitting civilians and the German military with shoes and boots.109 Like other consumer products manufacturers, Salamander had local sales representatives who reported to regional supervisors. These individual reports, along with summary reports by region, were collected at headquarters in Kornwestheim north of Stuttgart in Germany’s southwest. The reports themselves give us some sense of the broad scope of the Reisende’s activities. In addition to presenting the contractually bound shops with the new season’s merchandise, checking inventory, and taking new orders, they also spent their visits discussing and setting up the advertisements and displays. Because Salamander had a certain brand image to uphold—one that stood for good quality and fashionable, yet practical, well-wearing shoes— the sales representatives were concerned that the private shops live up to the brand’s standards. Shops had to remain clean, window displays were to be up to date, and the posters and signs should be in good shape and properly hung. In particular, the company representatives were charged with making sure that the shop owner lived up to his end of the contract with regard to merchandise from competitor firms.110 The Salamander representatives had to know the other brands’ wares, the various price points, and which styles were acceptable for sale alongside Salamander products. This was a system that had worked extremely well for two generations.



Buyers and Sellers

The Salamander brand was well known and respected. Its advertisements had not changed much over the decades; in the 1930s, the company still relied largely on simple, hand-drawn images of stylish women in day or evening wear, successful professional men, and happy children in durable shoes. The company’s one marketing innovation was the introduction of the cartoon salamander “Lurchi,” which helped popularize the brand among children and their families through its use in a comic book series and other promotional efforts. Surprisingly, the company chose not to move to text-laden ads in the 1920s or 1930s in order to provide information about the benefits of their products, even though the saleswomen who worked in the Salamander branches had shifted to a more scientific approach to selling.111 They were trained in foot anatomy, taught to examine the customer’s foot in a variety of ways for improper foot care in the past, and told to explain to customers how and why shoes should fit correctly. Problems with feet, resulting from shoes that were too narrow or too short, explained one training manual, was the “greatest cultural illness from which civilized peoples suffered.” A properly fitting shoe should allow the foot to roll over all five toes, and ensuring this at the point of sale was the Salamander staff ’s “service to the people’s health.”112 As in other aspects of Germany’s commercial culture, there was some tension between the brand’s flagship stores in the major cities and the shoe shops in the provinces. One memo to the sales representatives from 1927 complained that the smaller shop owners had not caught on with modern methods of display or ordering. They were too cautious when placing orders for hot trends, and quickly ran out of the newest styles. In these cases, headquarters warned that customers initially seeking Salamander shoes might very well walk out of the store wearing a style belonging to the competition. These provincial, out-of-step shop owners also needed further training in the separation of Salamander products from other makers in their displays. Again, consumers desiring the Salamander label in some stores might mistakenly buy a different brand, simply because the various makes were all shown together. The implication, of course, was that the sales staffs within the provincial stores often did not recognize the benefits of building brand loyalty by pointing out the differences between Salamander and its rivals.113 By 1935 little had changed. Minus a few exceptions, one report noted that there were still “glaring differences” between the company’s chic Salamander-only outlets and the contract retailers in terms of “the decoration, the character, the service, the leading products, the presentation of fashion,

173

174

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

etc.” The report’s author surmised that in most cases “the stores selling Salamander wares [under contract] in the provinces had exactly the same face and the same character as any old shoe store.” What mattered in righting the situation, he argued, was the ability to find “first-class” sales representatives who could turn these outlets into “Salamander stores,” which meant convincing the provincial store owners to take more risks with fashion and setting higher standards for acceptable competitor merchandise. Since Salamander “stood for quality,” retailers needed to be convinced by the company’s representatives that while all other brands were acceptable according to the contract, very cheap merchandise should not be sold alongside their products. Doing so only served to drag down Salamander’s reputation.114 Other brand-name goods manufacturers were also confronted with the difficulties of creating a uniform image and sales pitch that worked equally well in both rural and urban settings. However, Salamander faced a more serious challenge as well. Harold James notes that anti-Semitism as well as the mass-production methods that Salamander followed left it vulnerable to attacks after January 1933. The company’s shops were included in the 1 April 1933 national boycott, and some of its outlets were forcibly closed by the SA. Individuals denounced the company for hiring Jewish retailers and representatives.115 At the end of the month in defense of its Aryan credentials, Salamander took out large newspaper advertisements touting its German management, use of German raw materials, and employment of thousands of German workers. In April the company also made a large contribution to the “Adolf Hitler Donation.”116 Behind these public relations maneuvers, the company was quietly at work calculating the future viability of the Jewish-owned stores that sold Salamander shoes. Despite undergoing the reorganization of its ownership and directorship in the months immediately following the accession to power of the NSDAP in order to receive its seal of approval as a “pure German company,” the company still faced the fact that an estimated 12 percent of the independent shoe shops that held contracts to sell Salamander products were owned by Jews.117 The matter was not a simple one, because some of these were Salamander’s most profitable shops. From a business standpoint, it would be unthinkable to end these relationships. Even if ideological conformity was deemed financially wise (never mind the possibility of political conviction, which was likely in the mix on some level), breaking these contracts would need to be done carefully in order not to lose valuable market share in the increasingly difficult shoe market. As the anti-Semitic diatribes in the professional journals had predicted, the



Buyers and Sellers

traveling sales representatives for Salamander found themselves front and center in the process of abandoning Jewish retailers around the country. It was typical for all the companies discussed in this book to send newsletters to their salesmen on a regular basis. As has been seen, these newsletters attempted to pass on information about upcoming sales campaigns, newly available advertising materials, and pricing, and to create a sense of comradeship among the sales force and foster links between their men on the road and headquarters. In return sales staff made regular reports to regional managers or directly to national headquarters about what they were experiencing. It is these reports from Salamander’s Reisende that give us an inside look at what Germany’s Jewish retailers were facing. One report from late 1937 detailed the complexity of the situation in the Thuringian region of central Germany, focusing on stores in Altenburg, Apolda, Weimar, and Erfurt that sold Salamander goods. Of the four towns, only Apolda’s shop was held by an Aryan, who had owned it since before 1933. The others were still held by Jews. The mere fact that these families had endured for this long is remarkable. Indeed, in some cases they were still doing well financially, which indicates that their customer base had not dropped off significantly in the previous four years. Nonetheless, movement for change was underway, and Salamander’s regional representative was in the midst of it all. The Jewish owner in Altenburg had reported that the “political difficulties” had had no effect so far on his sales, though if that were to change he was prepared to sell to his son, “who is a Reich-citizen.” Not all Jewish retailers had been as lucky fending off the vicious antiSemitic campaigns to isolate and drive Jews from the economy. The same Reisende described a particularly poignant situation in Weimar: “The S. family siblings have lost all interest and love in the store. The once model window displays now look terrible.” Further, some Salamander shoes were mispriced, and the interior of the store, particularly the carpet, was in disrepair. Of note here is that the Salamander representative had held the three sisters in high esteem, remarking that their window displays had in better days been a model of artful display. Perhaps anti-Semitic stereotypes had influenced his earlier view that they were somehow innately good businesswomen, or perhaps the propaganda of the Nazi period was now leading him to see dirty and worn carpets where he had not before. Nonetheless, there is some compassion in his writing when he refers to the two elderly sisters he meets at the store as “completely worn out.” He added that he made an extra stop in Wiesbaden to visit the third sister in order to “come

175

176

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

clean with her. She knows now that we wish a change in Weimar as quickly as possible and is not at all sad about it.” Clearly, the elderly women were completely demoralized to the point that they were no longer able to put up a fight or even register sadness (or anger) about what was transpiring. This passage also demonstrates the clarity of Salamander policy “to make a change . . . as quickly as possible.” However, finding an Aryan to take over the Weimar shop, which still had a two-year lease to fulfill, would be difficult given its current state. From a legal standpoint, breaking a lease, even on anti-Semitic grounds, was not acceptable until 1939. However, there were ways around this technicality.118 That is where Salamander’s non-Jewish retailer from nearby Apolda came in. Working as intermediary between the parties, the sales representative found out that the building owner in Weimar was willing to rent to Herr G. from Apolda after the current lease was up, but Salamander was “unwilling to wait” two years, if the Jewish siblings lasted that long, without successful—that is, Aryan—representation in Weimar. The Salamander representative suggested instead that the Apolda retailer find a different property in Weimar; he even had one in mind to recommend. A new Weimar outlet would “leave the sisters with no choice” but to close their doors before their lease was up, meaning not only the loss of their business but further financial penalty for breaking the lease. Having little concern for the well-being of the elderly women, the only risk the Salamander representative could see was the possibility of a competitor moving into the space vacated by the sisters. Given that customer loyalty is often connected to a familiar commercial location, we can see just how anxious Salamander was to rid itself of its Jewish business partners. The decision was made to warn Herr G. from Apolda that he should not sign any irrevocable lease on a separate property before the sisters’ shop became available. He could even “take over a portion of the [women’s] Salamander-stock and pay a little something [Kleinigkeit] for the furnishings and equipment.”119 Not all Jewish retailers were suffering economically as were the sisters in Weimar. And yet, even those who were still managing to stay in the black knew it would not last much longer. This prognosis created great anxiety for the shop owner in Erfurt—fear that was made explicit to the Salamander representative who visited in November 1937. The Erfurt outlet’s owner was, of course, right to be worried. Exactly one year from the report’s date, Göring would make his notorious proclamation banning any remaining Jewish participation in the economy. When the company representative visited at the end of 1937, the Jewish retailer was still flourishing and had even



Buyers and Sellers

enjoyed slight gains over the previous year. Nonetheless, a nearby “Jewish shoe store” that had also been managing well had recently “closed its doors in dramatic fashion.” While no violence was mentioned, the incident had clearly upset the local Salamander partner. So much so that he expected to follow suit in the near future, despite his current prosperity. The Salamander representative reassured Herr D. by saying that “he need not worry about the liquidation of his store, because when it comes to that point, we [the company] are likely to take over.” After all, Herr D. had a lovely store “in the best of locations” and already sold only Salamander products. It was the perfect opportunity to open another Salamander boutique.120 As in Erfurt, the news from the Jewish shop owner in Eberswalde, northeast of Berlin, was also of increasing profits. It is remarkable given the rationing of leather and the extent of anti-Semitic propaganda that some of these families were still having business success. Though the reports do not provide many details, we can only assume that profits were rising owing to nearly full employment, decreases in availability of other consumer items, and fears that shoes might not be available in the future. Whatever the mix of reasons, we must not overlook the fact that despite the call to stay away from Jewish-owned stores, many people remained loyal to their local retailers and brands—even brands that had past and present links to Jews. In Eberswalde Herr W. had sold two hundred more pairs of Salamander shoes in 1936 than in 1935, and 1937 was off to a similarly good start. His profits for 1936 were RM 118,000. Nonetheless, in early 1937 the company representative told Herr W. that their partnership “stood on weak legs.” Like his colleague in Erfurt, Herr W. made it plain that he was not ready to sell. “If he sold the shop,” admitted the Salamander Reisende in his report to superiors, “he would be left with only RM 20–25,000, with which he could not begin anything new. Therefore I cannot condemn his plan to hold on to the business as long as possible.” In addition to the profits being made, and perhaps some understanding for the owner, a third reason to continue the holding pattern in Eberswalde rather “than canceling the contract outright” was that there was simply no good alternative to Herr W. in town. The best “[Aryan] shoe store” sold Mercedes shoes (a leading Salamander competitor)—but the Reisende knew that store well and was quite aware that it “was far behind” Herr W. in sales volume, making it a less than attractive alternative location for a Salamander contract, despite its racial credentials.121 Once again short-term business interests ran up against the ideological goals of the company to encourage the Aryanization of all its business partnerships. Despite the immediate risk, it was deemed in the

177

178

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

best interest of the company to sever the ties with Herr W., and the sales representative was willing to push the owner in that direction by reminding him that Salamander’s involvement was “on weak legs.” The only question that goes unanswered is whether Herr W. eventually consented under such duress, whether Salamander “canceled the contract outright” at a later date, or whether Kritstallnacht and Göring’s proclamation of 12 November 1938 interceded on Salamander’s behalf. The Reisende who covered Lüneburg, south of Hamburg, was also dealing with a complicated case. The children of the proprietor, Herr B., had been able to immigrate to Palestine, and he was away visiting them when Salamander’s man stopped by. The family evidently understood the importance of emigration, and had the financial means to do it, but did not see it as imminently necessary for everyone. The wife of Herr B., who spoke with the visitor in her husband’s absence, understood the financial and political situation well. She too agreed that 1936 had been better than 1935. According to the report, Herr B. still ran “absolutely the leading store” in the area. His next closest competitor, who sold the brand Northwest, had a turnover only about half the size of Herr B. Moreover, the Aryan owner of the Northwest outlet was getting on in years, and, more important, was friendly with Herr B. Indeed he appears to have made it known to the inquiring Salamander representative that he categorically refused to buy his friend’s store or to take over the Salamander contract. There were other interested parties: businessmen from Schwerin to the northeast and from as far away as Kattowitz (Katowice in Poland) were looking to poach the business in Lüneberg. The Salamander representative, however, found all interested parties unsuitable, and so the waiting game continued. Herr B.’s wife said that her husband “would give up the store under no conditions until he was forced to do so by the authorities.”122 We can only presume that is indeed what happened. These records all come from one corporation, but owners and directors of businesses of all sizes were confronted with the question of how and when to cut ties with Jewish associates. Perhaps smaller Aryan enterprises felt the need to hold on to these partnerships as long as possible in order to stay afloat themselves. Or perhaps only the big brands could afford to “support” their Jewish retailers this long, because the majority of their outlets were owned by Aryans. In each scenario, however, a good understanding of local conditions was crucial to making a decision. The following directive, sent by the biscuit manufacturer Bahlsen of Hanover to its representatives in the field, gives us a sense of how policy made at the top about



Buyers and Sellers

whether to maintain business relations with Jewish-owned stores was influenced by sentiment from below. In July 1938 Bahlsen headquarters took the step of cutting off relations with Jewish retailers—a step predating the Reich proclamation to the same effect by four months: Given the current situation we must come to a final decision about visiting and supplying Jewish stores. The vast majority of leading chocolate manufacturers have already abandoned their Jewish stores; also the competition within the biscuit industry has recently followed suit. Until this point we have not taken a strict policy for all of Germany, but have acted on a case by case basis, according to the needs of the area. Today we are sending you the following instructions neither to visit nor to supply Jewish stores. The allotments [of Bahlsen products] that become available can be distributed according to your own discretion, to the Aryan retailers who will serve the bulk of customers from the Jewish stores left out.123

The relationships between these Jewish-owned shops and brand-name company representatives are instructive on a number of levels. First, we can see that individual consumption was still steady, even growing for some retailers through 1936 and into 1937, because of declining unemployment, which fell below 1 percent by late 1938, and continued concerns about periodic shortages, which were particularly frequent in sectors such as chocolate and leather goods.124 Second, the Salamander reports provide examples of the daily calculations made by Jewish retailers and the range of emotions that they endured: from the downtrodden sisters in Weimar, to the defiant owner in Lüneburg, and the successful owner in Erfurt who had to witness the frightening collapse of his colleague’s business and plan for his own “liquidation.” We should also not forget that families were sometimes divided. There are reports, for example, in which grown sons or daughters actually work with the Salamander representatives to convince fathers that the time is right to sell (and emigrate).125 Finally, as the company’s archival records indicate, the actions documented here by the Reisende were being replicated all over the Reich. While Bahlsen may have finally sent down a nationwide policy to stop deliveries to all remaining Jewish retailers in the summer of 1938, until that point decisions were being made on an ad hoc basis—with local or at least regional representatives having their say. These traveling salesmen, often looked down on by anti-Semites for their ties to Jewish businessmen, were therefore themselves frontline instruments of Aryanization, serving as contacts, advisors, and scouts for new owners or partners. They effected the transfer of properties, the dissolution of Jewish business assets, and the protection of the brand.

179

180

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

This desire to uphold the brand, and thereby also one’s job, did not end with the transfer of ownership or contract to an Aryan retailer. In some cases the new owners were young, inexperienced, and simply not very good at their jobs. Naturally, these local and regional sales representatives wanted to do all they could to support these new owners, given that they had often helped them secure their new businesses. A poor selection of successor would reflect badly on the Reisende with upper management. A couple in Ettlingen, just miles from the French border in Baden, were struggling, but they were “young people, who are hardworking and ambitious.” In time it was expected that they would bring things in order.126 There was less hope for Herr M., who had taken over his “Jewish store” three years prior. Though his overseers were satisfied that he was a capable “businessman and bookkeeper, he failed to equal those skills when it came to the selling of shoes.” In October “he still had more sandals in the window than anything else.”127 Further north in Solingen, west of Düsseldorf, where Aryanization of a Jewish shop had meant the opening of a Salamander-only branch, there was particular concern expressed by the sales representative who felt personally invested. Because the store’s location was an expensive one, and “since we [the new owner and the Salamander representative authoring the report] planned the shop together, counting on a turnover of 10,000 pairs,” he felt that despite shortages “there is no single customer who needed and deserved support [receiving timely shipments of goods] as [this new Aryan shoe dealer] did.”128 This chapter and the one that preceded it have sought to offer a new perspective on the economy in Nazi Germany before the onset of war in 1939. While most scholars have understandably focused their attention on the ever-expanding preparations for war and the centralization of the economy, this section has sought to describe how the consumer economy managed to survive the challenges of rearmament and autarchic state policies. It did not survive unchanged, most certainly, but these two chapters have described how people attempted to carry on with their lives during this upheaval. Buying and selling continued to play a central role in the lives of Germans. Business owners, advertisers, and sales staff tried to uphold their brand images and keep customers satisfied, even with shortages of raw materials and labor. Consumers tested new products, looked for those in short supply, enjoyed others they relied on, and dreamed of some not yet in reach. Particularly housewives and other female shoppers were actively recruited to join new communities of brand users, either through pamphlets and fan newsletters or through ads that counseled the reader,



Buyers and Sellers

setting up a sense of intimacy among those “in the know.” These strategies indicate not only a new perceptiveness on the part of advertisers and their employers but also a new confidence on the part of consumers. Whether it was chiefly commercial initiative or consumer power that gave life to this new relationship is less important than to recognize its existence and the contributions made by both sides. The deepening relationships between consumers and their favored brands in these years was part of a longer trend, noted by scholars also in other national contexts, and already recognizable in its infancy in 1920s Germany.129 This growth occurred despite the difficulties posed by the regime: companies were willing and remarkably able to integrate the National Socialist Zeitgeist into their conversations with consumers. Instead of adding to our image of state control, the role of the regime in these chapters has been one of facilitator—with corporations taking the lead in the integration of racist ideology into their advertisements and sales strategies. The trust and respect companies like Osram or Henkel achieved through their deepening relationships with consumers aided the regime as ads and corporate images parroted back state goals: national unity, prosperity, and racial hygiene. The products of many of the brand-name companies discussed in these chapters had been in Germans’ homes longer than the NSDAP. As we know, the party itself was not always popular—the arrogance and corruption of many low-level officials meant that many Germans had little respect for party membership. However, the idea of the Third Reich, the vision of racial unity and prosperity, had many more supporters throughout the country.130 Messages and images of the Third Reich, as presented in advertisements, were potentially more persuasive coming from these venerated firms, which had long traditions as employers and were led in some cases by icons of German industry, than from the representatives of the party and state. Even the Ad Council itself often tried to highlight its distance from the regime when communicating with those in the private sector, as we will see in the next chapter. The traveling sales representatives, like advertisers, played a key role in building and maintaining the links between the national brands and their customers (both retailers and individual consumers). Now expected to know the advantages of the product line, competitors’ wares, the needs of housewives, and the ins and outs of product display and advertising, the salesman had far more on his plate than ever before. A brand was nothing if it did not have capable people to present its image properly in stores, in households, and in the local media. And finally, given the nature of the

181

182

Branding for the Volksgemeinschaft

regime, these men found themselves as actors in a very different sort of buying and selling—as agents of Aryanization. These middlemen in the consumer economy were seeking greater status in a new Germany. Like advertisers they felt unappreciated and targeted by those who mistrusted capitalism or equated Reisende with the same alleged dangers posed by the “nomadic” Jews.131 Now was their time to aid Germany and themselves. Better than anyone they knew the commercial actors and local markets, and they were instrumental in shifting company loyalties from Jewish retailers to Aryan ones in the hopes of maintaining success and winning favor with their employers and perhaps the regime. The trust that developed between the leaders of the consumer sector and consumers also had the unintended effect of bolstering consumer confidence in the (Nazi) future. This book does not focus squarely on the experiences of consumers. However, the evidence offered about growing attention to market research, attempts by brands to reach out to their fans, and ads that purported to engage consumers in rational discussions of a product’s merits could only have added to a sense of empowerment among consumers. Although it has been important to point out that the standard of living was relatively low in Germany, and workers still had little disposable income, the success of many brands also relied on reaching beyond a circumscribed middle class to a broader mass audience. The extent to which this vision of a mass consumer society may have bolstered consumer confidence, however, also created the potential to lead to crisis once shortages and ersatz goods became a daily reality.132 The next two chapters will examine the tensions that developed during the war years, as brand-name companies and consumers tried to sustain their budding romance.

chapter five

Advertising in the First Half of the War Those who advertise announce they are alive.1

By late August 1939, companies selling consumer items found themselves paralyzed by the uncertain political situation. When the “hoped for release of tension” did not materialize, Henkel assured its traveling staff that headquarters understood that “normal visits to customers and the work of our ad ladies are no longer possible in any usual way.” Suggestions were made for ways to keep busy: “[P]erhaps make an inventory of your ad materials, bring your [customer] cards in order; there may be one or two customers to visit in order to reassure.” The Werbedamen were to be released from their duties until further notice, “since demonstrations of washing methods will now only be poorly attended.” All film equipment was to be stored in fire-proofed garages. Soap rationing had arrived, though Henkel complained that the press releases on the matter had not been clear that Persil fell among “soap powder” rather than “cleansers.” Another way to keep busy, therefore, was for sales staff to clarify the situation with their wholesalers.2 Of course these plans were all somewhat moot—this was not a situation in which companies enjoyed the freedom to set their own agendas. Twelve days later, Henkel announced the introduction of the “unity cleaning powder, which meant in other words: For the time being, there is no more Persil.”3 The question, then, for this chapter is what the war economy meant for the buying and selling of consumer goods. The quotations above seem to provide an obvious answer. Brand-name consumer products and the advertising to promote them were to disappear from the marketplace. For the Werberat too it appears that its usefulness was at an end and that earlier calls for its dissolution would no longer be ignored. At best, Ad Council staff members could hope to be integrated directly into the Pro-

186

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

paganda Ministry in service of the war. The scholarship on consumption in Germany bears out these conclusions, taking a sharp turn in 1939. Some scholars simply end their analyses at the war’s onset, while others indicate through their emphases on shortages and ersatz products that the war years signify most simply the end to individual consumption and its replacement with a form of war socialism that failed to meet the needs and desires of consumers.4 One exception is Götz Aly, who has maintained that allegiance to the regime was secured through the dissemination of goods stolen from Jews and the occupied territories.5 But his arguments have not convinced everyone, and his focus on the distribution of goods merely as a means of generating political support says little about how the distribution of war loot fit in with wider patterns of consumer expectations and long-term economic thinking. This chapter will challenge those who discount the significance of buying and selling during the war years, and will also confront Aly’s view by emphasizing the active role taken by the private business sector to shore up the home front. It insists that day-to-day buying and selling remained integral to life in Germany during the war and needs to be considered more seriously if we are to understand life on the home front. Second, I argue that discussions about the role of commerce in the Volksgemeinschaft were much more significant within official circles than has been previously thought. Indeed, there were theoretical and practical links between advertising, consumption, and the politics of imperialist expansion. In other words, the chapter works on two levels: it examines the ways companies and their advertisers attempted to hold on to market share as long as possible and to bring their promotional efforts in line with the present and future plans for a Germany-led European marketplace—and the consequences such promotional efforts had for German consumers facing changing times. It also discusses the plans for a commercial empire via a return to the writings of Heinrich Hunke, president of the Werberat since 1939,6 and those he worked with in other professional capacities who defended commerce, and advertising in particular, as economically and politically critical to victory and the future peace. In making this case, Hunke and those around him were seeking to secure their own livelihoods and legitimacy within Nazi Germany and lay the groundwork for a prosperous and politically unified postwar German Empire. While Hunke’s work was upended by the collapse of the regime, the planning, reform, and partnerships with certain corporations, begun in peacetime and extended into the war years,



Advertising in the First Half of the War

had implications for the consumer paradise that eventually emerged in the Federal Republic. The story, therefore, is one of continuity. While the war changed a great deal, consumers and the manufacturers and retailers who sold to them naturally sought to maintain normalcy to the greatest extent possible. The Werberat too attempted to contribute to this goal to the best of its ability. The key point here is that buying and selling remained an integral part of daily life, albeit in muted and distorted forms. We must also not forget that after the start of the war, commercial advertising shared the public visual landscape with increasingly virulent state and party propaganda that “advertised” the war and genocide as an existential battle against the Jewish-Capitalist-Bolshevik conspiracy to destroy Germany.7 While Nazi war propaganda does not play a role in this study, this chapter adds to our understanding of how the majority of Germans could remain steadfast in their support of the war and at best indifferent to the plight of Europe’s Jews. The images and messages offered by light-hearted feature films in theaters, on radio request shows—and in commercial advertisements— provided a means of escape and also enabled the genocide by normalizing a daily life “free of Jews.” Though the last stage of the war led to extensive upheaval, which will be covered in the concluding chapter, advertising played an important role at least into 1943 as an aid to a population coping with war.

advertising under attack Undoubtedly new challenges faced the advertising industry at the start of the conflict. As one practitioner bemoaned, “No other profession has been so called into question by the war as the ad executive.”8 The most strident arguments came from those critics who believed advertising was a nonessential service, one that distracted citizens from the seriousness of the conflict, used up scarce resources (particularly paper), and sought only to line the pockets of private corporations rather than serving the nation. If advertising could not be brought to an end, at the very least the duties of the Werberat could be scaled back and made to focus more squarely on the policing of proposed limits on advertisers. But Hunke and others within the Werberat were unwilling to go so quietly or to view their sole task as a punitive one. In speeches, articles, and images, Ad Council members, advertisers and businessmen alike sought to counter their detractors in the early months of the war.9 Hunke admitted that the onset of hostilities had

187

188

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

rocked the industry, but by 1940 a staff writer in his journal proclaimed that “German advertising has withstood the shock of war in 1939 better than in 1914.”10 By then most of the men and women who worked in advertising had rallied and found a place in the new war economy. At every opportunity, Hunke stressed the three priorities of the German economy at war: arms, exports, and consumption (in that order).11 At the end of 1940, he cheered that so far the “great hope of enemy war plans” to resurrect the blockade of Germany had been a failure: arms production was increasing from month to month; German exports were circulating through the Continent at “satisfactory” rates; and individual consumption too remained at a “satisfactory level. That means economic life is proceeding as if Germany is only partially [teilweise] at war.”12 To some this was the crux of the problem, but for Hunke it was a point to be celebrated. There was a danger, he insisted, in abandoning any sector of the economy not tied to the production of war materiel. Exports and domestic consumption were vital to the war effort, and advertising could stimulate both. Though these economic benefits of advertising remained critical, Hunke and his colleagues set out to highlight additional positive contributions they believed could be made by the industry throughout the growing empire. For them the war necessitated more than ever before the expansion of their work at home and abroad “to achieve freely the changes in feeling and understanding necessary to prepare the way for German goods in foreign lands.”13 Some ad men were recruited into the Propaganda Ministry, as happened in the Allied states as well. Among those who remained in the private sector, it was clear that advertisements were an effective way to sell German products and German authority abroad. Back home within the 1937 borders or Altreich, the Werberat also maintained its relevance by reminding all who would listen that “war time is a time of preparation for peace; time that must not go unused.”14 In addition to supporting advertising as a way to bolster the present and future economic health of the empire, the Werberat also advocated for partnerships on massive projects aimed at educating consumers about the best ways to manage wartime shortages of food and household goods and accept the new ersatz products. This education had obvious immediate significance, but it was also hoped that these ties between the purveyors of big brands and state bodies would be maintained after victory. “Educated” consumers would make for a more predictable market in peacetime as well as war. Those working for the Society for Consumer Research also insisted that their work, rather than becoming superfluous, took on greater purpose during the conflict



Advertising in the First Half of the War

and complemented these other efforts.15 Werberat officials were pleased to announce that companies appeared on-side and that thousands of advertisers continued to serve the nation by powering the economy and influencing consumer behavior at home and abroad.16 In the most practical terms, it was claimed, advertising helped the economy remain efficient and even increase productivity. Advertising encouraged mass production, which brought down prices. It helped move goods more quickly, freeing up warehouse space and allowing factories to shift more smoothly from season to season.17 These arguments did not sway all critics. Some attacked brand differentiation more specifically. Why should brands be maintained in a war economy that could not guarantee quality or availability? Even if it could, should differentiation that potentially exacerbated class tensions be upheld in a time of national crisis? The Reichstelle für Lederwirtschaft (Reich Office for the Leather Industry) tried to bring an end to all branding on shoes and shoe packaging in the early months of the war, partly out of sympathy for those manufacturers who were being squeezed out of the market owing to leather shortages. The Ad Council reversed this decision, however, arguing that given the emerging empire it was particularly important to retain brand names “above all for the shoe industry in the freed territories [whose owners] want to reintegrate their businesses in other areas [of the Reich].” Weighing the difficulties of maintaining brands against the economic benefits of brand loyalty in a war economy, Hunke’s colleague Hans Ruban concluded: “[W]hile brand names in some economic sectors cannot be used to their full capacity in promotional efforts, this point should not be seen as universal. First, there are still many brand name articles, which so far remain untouched by the times, and second there are still many advantages of brand name products, which deserve to be upheld.”18 Hanns Brose concurred, explaining that even those products that had largely disappeared by 1940, such as whole bean coffee, would not lead housewives “to swear off these things forever.” Consumers understood the cause for the shortages and would wait and expect the return of their favorite brands.19 As one official within the Werberat announced in an article published in the Henkel newsletter at the very end of 1939, “[T]he position that ads for goods in short supply are prohibited was before the war in general incorrect. And today nothing has changed in the judgment of such advertising.” Rather, he continued, the bigger challenge had come earlier with the introduction of the Four-Year Plan in 1936. “The condition of the

189

fig. 5.1. Advertising for advertising, Die Deutsche Werbung, 1940.



Advertising in the First Half of the War

economy today is not fundamentally different than what existed before the war.”20 While this optimism would not last through 1945, it demonstrates well the relative stability in the first years of the conflict—the gradual, but far from complete, scaling back of individual consumption and the advertising that encouraged it. Hunke and others also argued that ads were an important cultural asset. With the recent reforms to the industry ushered in by the Werberat, its members felt confident that ads now offered a “mirror image of the times,” in the same way they believed newspapers did, and as such had intrinsic cultural value.21 Just as the press and entertainment media could contribute to the national cause, so could advertising. In his role as president of the Werberat, Hunke issued a series of “tips” for how to make commercial advertisements more useful to the war effort: highlighting conservation, waste reduction, maintaining good health, hospitality, and helpfulness were all on the list. However, he was emphatic that “private commercial advertisements should never become propaganda. . . . How these themes are to be integrated is left up to the skill and tact of the individual. . . . What is important is that they appear freely and are not forced into a cramped coupling with the advertisement.”22 Other supporters of advertising also noted the importance of allowing German companies to demonstrate their “good will” [in the English] in this time of national crisis, even if that meant only the use of “reminder ads” of a company’s brands as tangible examples of “German” traditions of quality, innovation, and service, once their products were no longer widely available (see Figures 6.10 and 6.11).23 Therefore, in these terms—political, economic, cultural—advertisements for advertising appeared frequently throughout the first half of the war. Presenting the practitioner as duty bound, rather than profit-driven, one full-page image in the country’s Nazified trade journal Die Deutsche Werbung (DW) reminded readers that the slogan for 1941 was “continue to advertise” [weiter werben].24 The ad man was pictured standing strong, legs outstretched, hands on hips, ready to do his part for National Socialist Germany.25 Even after the fortunes of war began to turn against Germany, the Werberat held on, despite a shrinking budget and continued calls for its dismantling, by relying on Goebbels’s powerful patronage and by repeatedly emphasizing the value of its work—the ability of advertisements to produce meaning for consumers at home and abroad about daily life in war and the future peace.26

191

192

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

advertisements in the service of war Ultimately advertisers were right that ads would provide a number of services for the country during the war. Of course there was the danger in this difficult time that ads might succumb to a “tactless Hurra-Patriotism,”27 and the Ad Council worked to ensure that this was not the case—watching more closely than ever for infringements of the Law for the Protection of National Symbols, for example. Although companies that already used words like “Fatherland” in their company names or trademarks were still protected by the Ad Council, there was an effort to keep firms from adding “Germania, Fatherland or national” to their business slogans and logos during the war. As Hunke explained in his 1941 annual report, “many symbols, which were earlier only valued in a historical sense, speak again to the entire Volk.” And while “in liberal times they were adopted unthinkingly . . . they become objectionable amid the new, deeper feeling for the majestic dignity and worth of such concepts.”28 Advertising could serve the Volksgemeinschaft better by not replicating the state’s propaganda. Instead, advertisers and their supporters in government ministries understood that the ubiquitous presence of ads had the potential to pre­

fig. 5.2. Appropriate advertisement during war, Die Deutsche Werbung, 1940.



Advertising in the First Half of the War

sent the war to Germans in an easily digestible way. As an article in DW explained in 1940, there were three types of war-related ads: those that showed soldiers’ “joys and suffering” (primarily the former); those that showed the home front and the changes occasioned by the conflict; and those that educated consumers about shortages and unavailable goods. The author provided examples of ads, including Figures 5.2, 5.3, and 5.4, that highlighted the camaraderie of the soldierly experience, the health benefits of gasoline shortages that encouraged walking to work, and the pleasure occasioned by the novel presence of cheerful female postal deliverers.29 It was important, ad designers were reminded by the accompanying text, to use both “tact and skill” in representing daily life in time of war. Uniforms on postal deliverers or train conductors bearing state emblems did not contradict the Law for the Protection of National Symbols, because there were no claims that the party or state sponsored or supported the products, though surely the advertisers chose these subjects as current and presumably sympathetic figures. While ads depicting soldiers were few and far between, a handful of companies did pick up on this theme in the early part of the war. As the Agfa ad in Figure 5.5 noted—camera film could provide the perfect conduit to bridge time and space between separated loved ones.30Ads that did show

193

figs. 5.3 (above) and 5.4 (facing page). Appropriate advertisements during war, Die Deutsche Werbung, 1940.

fig. 5.5. Agfa film brings families together, Die Deutsche Volkswirtschaft, 1940.



Advertising in the First Half of the War

soldiers always depicted them happy and in good health, often singing and usually without helmets, which would have reminded readers of the real danger the men faced. The rarity of finding ads that used soldiers as subjects may be evidence that advertisers were aware of the potential risks of these sanitized images of war. Companies uniformly refrained from depicting soldierly life in ads during the second half of the war. Beiersdorf was probably not the only company to receive a letter from a magazine reader in 1942, who was convinced that she had spotted her recently fallen brother in a Nivea ad and was hoping that the firm might have information for her that contradicted the devastating news.31 While war was no laughing matter, humor too helped people accept the more unsettling and potentially traumatic aspects of the conflict, such as the absence of loved ones or the presence of women in heretofore masculine forms of employment.32 Humor had never been a staple of German advertising. As discussed earlier, there were many articles throughout the 1930s in professional journals suggesting that Germans follow their American counterparts more closely in capturing consumers through laughter, though humorous ads remained uncommon. The years after 1939 were certainly not a time for experimentation, but those few companies that had used comical figures and scenarios before the war continued to do so. We see this in the postal worker’s leering neighbor and in the light-hearted verse in the “walk to work” ad as well as in Figure 5.6. Other ads stressed the possibility of life continuing unchanged. Nivea skin cream ads were considered a model for two reasons. On the one hand they pictured bathing beauties “browning” in the summer sun, hardly touched by the conflict—images that were likely welcome to men in service and reminded readers on the home front that some forms of leisure and relaxation were still possible. On the other hand, many Nivea ads provided detailed instructions on how to enjoy the sun safely. Such instructions not only fit well with the ideological goals of building a healthy Volk, but also represented an example of the Werberat’s desired “enlightenment” ads, explaining the product’s usefulness to the rational consumer. In the Nivea ads pictured in Figures 5.7 and 5.8 from the summer of 1941, we can see both of these aims at work. In “Dear Husband,” a young wife pictured with her daughter writes to her beloved at the front that all is well, a reassuring message in itself, while also instructing readers to be mindful of shortages and the health concerns of spending time in the summer sun: This picture best answers your rather worried questions . . . . It proves most clearly that we are 1) healthy, 2) cheerful and enjoying each other, 3) Heidi is no

197

fig. 5.6.  “With a Raxon tie, you’re always well dressed!” in Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung, 1940. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.

figs. 5.7 and 5.8.  “Dear Husband!” and “Dear Brigitte!” Nivea print advertisements, 1941. Courtesy of Beiersdorf, AG, Hamburg.

200

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat longer pale-faced, 4) we are having good weather, 5) we are both savoring unbridled the summer sun and can easily handle it, and 6) we repeatedly apply NiveaCrème daily, always remembering both sides. Heidi covers my back like an expert and uses Nivea according to today’s necessary frugality. Of course, tanning with Nivea oil would go more quickly, but one can barely find it now. But that doesn’t matter, we have plenty of time, and slow tanning is surely the most prudent.33

When this spot ran in Germany’s shrinking illustrated magazine market, Nivea crème was still available in short supply throughout Germany. Reminding readers to conserve worked to the benefit of the manufacturer and retailers, who could stock shelves longer with dwindling supplies and convince those looking for “oil” that the crème was an acceptable substitute. But this ad, which was part of a series of “letter” ads bearing similar messages, scripted by Elly Heuss-Knapp, was also a boon to the regime. Life’s pleasures could still be enjoyed—it “doesn’t matter” that certain things are missing (like the husband and the tanning oil). The mother and child were still healthy and happy, and indeed their lifestyle, including their habits of consumption, had become “more prudent.” Other companies sought to use the intermittent shortages of their products as an actual selling point. The cigarette manufacturer Greiling of Dresden had decided in May 1939 to do a series of ads for their new 4 Pfennig cigarette, “Türkisch 8,” that would feature recognizable German cityscapes. Though the plan had been to roll out the new product regionally with appropriate new images for each market, by December 1940 the product was still unavailable in some parts of the Reich, owing to a drop in tobacco supplies. The Dresden manufacturers of the new brand used the failure to meet their original goal to their advantage in the ads, reminding readers in the capital, for example, that “Berliners and travelers [to the city] know to treasure the fact that in all of Berlin TÜRKISCH 8 is available in reliable quality and freshness.” With such a sales pitch, Berlin’s smokers might be persuaded to try this new product simply because of its rarity. One might expect that an ad which admitted that only some Germans would have access to this product would be prohibited out of concern for morale. Rather the industry’s leading trade journal praised the creativity of the firm’s ad department for finding a “solution” to the limits the brand faced, while also stimulating consumer desire in the capital.34 Some of the most dramatic shortages experienced were in textiles. Already in the last years of peace, Germans complained that it was difficult to find fabric or thread or finished clothing and linens.35 Cloth made of synthetic fibers was also hard to come by, difficult to care for, and often



Advertising in the First Half of the War

of poor quality. And while the competition from Jewish clothiers had vanished either by forced closure or Aryanization, the Aryan manufactures and retailers also had to comply with the rationing of textiles, introduced in November 1939 with the first “Reich Clothing Cards.” Despite these challenges, Germany’s largest ready-to-wear clothing manufacturer and retailer Peek und Cloppenburg (still one of Germany’s major clothing chains) found its own advertising solution to help the firm stay competitive in this vastly changed sector. In the middle part of the 1930s, the firm had enjoyed considerable growth, by expanding its line to include women’s clothing and opening two new stores in Frankfurt and Essen. The firm also introduced a new logo in 1936 that picked up on the medieval iconography favored at times by the regime through its use of a coat of arms to carry the “PuC” initials. Shortly before the war the company also added the phrase “from the P&C workshops” as a border around the shield—a clever tie-in to the regime’s glorification of German labor and handicrafts. Once the war rationing arrived, however, some might expect that the company stepped back from these branding strategies. However, instead of concluding that expensive advertising in these conditions made little sense, given that consumers were severely limited in their purchasing power by the “points” on their Reich Clothing Card, the firm opted to emphasize its brand name even more. The rationale at Peek und Cloppenburg was that with a decline in overall volume, drawing attention to the forty-year-old reputation for PuC quality would help the company retain its edge over the competition. Reasoning that consumers buying less would seek goods that would last longer, the firm began to attach a larger more visible tag carrying the company’s heraldic logo to the outside of all its garments.36 The company also invested in new print ads that provided tips on mixing and matching to create more outfits, under the slogan: “Who combines, saves points.”37 While it would be wonderful if it could be said with certainty that consumers consciously recognized the usefulness of advertisements or distrusted their messages during the war, such evidence is rare. In one letter that Henkel claimed to have received from a housewife in 1940, the author wrote that she relied on ads to learn which shops still stocked certain goods, how one could make do with available products, particularly foodstuffs, and how to manage housework.38 If this letter did come from an unsolicited housewife, it must have been music to Henkel’s ears. Unfortunately for us it provides anecdotal evidence at best. But it serves repeating that companies tried after 1939 to hold on to loyal customers (and even create new ones) by recognizing that female shoppers and homemakers faced

201

202

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

new challenges with the onset of war. The makers of Nivea crème offered ads, for example, in 1941 which admitted that housework was becoming more arduous during the war—the consequences of which for women’s chafed and cracked skin could be mitigated to some degree by greater use of Nivea products.39 While such a sales pitch made a lot of sense for Beiersdorf, it also serves as an example of how ads by trusted brands implicitly supported the war by acknowledging women’s increased work and offering advice to counter the difficulties that came with the conflict in a language less overtly propagandistic than the reams of patriotic pamphlets supplied by the Deutsches Frauenwerk or NS-Frauenschaft. Print advertisements by the family-owned baking supply company based in Bielefeld, Dr. Oetker, provide a particularly vivid example of how companies tried to stay current and appear sympathetic to their loyal customers’ desires. As soon as the war began, the firm started printing regular advertisements in women’s and weekly illustrated magazines that highlighted a recipe alongside the promotion of one of its products. These ads were not offering a dreamscape of a prosperous nation—rather they provided women alternative recipes to uphold the standards expected for middleclass family dinners, which included a dessert, preferably one made using Dr. Oetker baking powder or prepared mix. Although we can certainly critique the company’s assumption that women should still be trying to bake and prepare desserts, given the conditions of war, the point here is that these ads were aiding in the normalization of the conflict. During the mid-1930s the firm had run ads without recipes under slogans like: “Next Sunday a delicious Dr. Oetker pudding.” By 1939 the slogan had become “Cheap but good” and suggested a recipe for a potato crumb cake. In the winter of 1940, the company asked, as did many consumers, “What can we bake with no eggs and no fat that is still good?” And Dr. Oetker had an answer: the jam bunt-cake featuring the firm’s own “well tried” baking powder and vanilla flavoring.40 Without a doubt, many consumers must have been upset by the lack of baking supplies, the monotony of the few recipes available, or perhaps even by the quality of recipes presented. However, the exasperated tone of the text from late 1940 probably made some friends for the brand in the shared frustration over the scarcity of butter and eggs. Women readers may have felt that there were those at Dr. Oetker who understood the bind they were facing, stuck between shortages and a society that still demanded women achieve a certain domestic standard. And while Dr. Oetker did its part to uphold this ideal, if the recipes were any good, they may have provided a partial solution to a difficult situation.



Advertising in the First Half of the War

figs. 5.9 and 5.10.  “What can we bake with 50 grams of fat and one egg?” and “What can we bake without eggs and fat?” Dr. Oetker recipes, BIZ, early and late 1940. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.

Stripped of the overt language of sacrifice and national duty, these private sector ads, unlike the state and party-sponsored recipe booklets, portrayed the brand as on the side of consumers and their families—the Volk. And any strengthening of the “people’s community” helped the regime, even if this boost came in a somewhat backhanded form. While all these companies were looking for ways to maintain brand images in the face of shortages and rationing, manufacturers of soaps and

203

204

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

detergents were in an even more unenviable position. The state had begun restricting fat content in soaps as early as September 1934, even though, according to Henkel’s statistics, Germany already consumed far less soap than its Western European and North American counterparts. Even the firm’s insistence that laundry detergent usage had a direct correlation to infant survival rates was not enough to sway this race-obsessed regime to grant it open access to the market.41 In mid-September 1934, Henkel informed its sales representatives that the state did not want the public informed of the reductions and expected that customers would not notice the change.42 The government was wrong. Women complained almost immediately about the decline in quality as the top-selling brands were altered and then began disappearing from store shelves altogether after the war began. The question arose again, why advertise?43 Henkel felt the need to respond to this question, which even came from its own staff, by saying that advice and “consumer enlightenment” had always been hallmarks of Henkel’s ads. “In other words, why shouldn’t we advertise?” They were only continuing past practice, and of course many Henkel products that did not contain fat were being produced at rates as high as in the prewar period: Henko, Sil, iMi, and Ata. If there were shortages of these cleansers and water softeners, they made clear, the problems did not originate at Henkel’s manufacturing site. Rather housewives wanted more than ever to soften water, which made the available detergent go further; others had unreasonably hoarded these items, and transportation and the increased washing of soldiers’ uniforms, “at least here in the West,” had led to some intermittent difficulties.44 With fats under tight regulatory control before the war, it is not surprising that Henkel and its two principal rivals, Böhme Fettchemie and Sunlicht, took the opportunity held out to them in 1938 to partner with the Reich Propaganda Ministry and Office of the Four-Year Plan.45 The plan was to teach women how to use less and accept ersatz cleaners, by convincing them that their own patterns of textile washing were actually detrimental to these goods and therefore the nation. For the companies, the motivation for participation was obvious: to show their support for the regime and its preparations for war and perhaps to find a way to keep products like Persil, Vim, Fewa, and Lux available and in the minds of consumers. While it is hard to judge the efficacy of the campaign in convincing women to change their washing habits, the evidence we have suggests that female consumers made do with what was available to them, though they were never satisfied with the quality or quantity of cleaners, and some resented the “lessons” on how to wash properly. What is clear is that the



Advertising in the First Half of the War

corporations involved were able to manipulate the program to suit their own needs. Germany’s detergent companies produced some of the country’s most recognizable brand names. Persil had landed on store shelves in 1907.46 By the late 1930s, Henkel had spent 60 million RM over the previous decade on advertising, forcing other manufacturers to take a more aggressive approach in order to compete.47 In the 1930s, Böhme Fettchemie’s product, Fewa, had succeeded in taking over a large portion of the fine wash market, thanks to a dynamic ad campaign, discussed in the previous chapter. Sunlicht also offered consumers a wide range of cleaning products for the home. As David Ciarlo and Uta Poiger have made clear, racial tropes about cleanliness had been employed to sell German soap products since the nineteenth century.48 Though the Wilhelmine Empire was a thing of the past, consumers in Nazi Germany were likely to have deep memories about what the whitening of their laundry meant in terms of hygiene and racial supremacy—beliefs that were intensified by the overtly racist language of the regime, particularly after the onset of the war. As Jonathan Wiesen explains, the inclusion of racist images (like the Henkel sketch from a company newsletter shown in Fig. 5.11) was not necessarily a “strategic decision,” as much as an expression “of prejudices consumers shared.”49 The logistics of the campaign were to be handled by the Reich Board for Economic Enlightenment (Reichsausschuss für volkswirtschaftliche Aufklärung [RVA]), which answered to the Werberat.50 Henkel was the natural choice to serve as the lead corporate partner. Not only was it the largest of the three main corporate participants, but Paul Mundhenke, Henkel’s chief of advertising, liked to point out that his firm had already distanced itself during the 1920s from the sort of advertising now branded negatively as screaming, manipulative Reklame.51 Rather, Mundhenke asserted, Henkel’s house-to-house promotions, lectures, and films already performed “enlightening and advising work” that showed the firm’s willingness to take on “responsibility for the common welfare.” In the mid1930s, the firm’s lessons about saving soap, promoting the no-fat cleaner iMi, and eventually the production of the whaling film—“that was far more about the rise of the German people in a time of re-emerging national consciousness than about business interests”—demonstrated the company’s allegiance to the regime and its understanding of the Werberat’s goals for deutsche Werbung.52 The RVA called on the well-respected ad man Hanns Brose to help launch the program. In a letter to retailers who were already dealing with

205

206

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

fig. 5.11. Race and Cleanliness, Henkel cartoon, 1930. Courtesy of Corporate Archive, Henkel AG & Co. KGaA, Düsseldorf.

the changes to the product selection of detergents and household cleaners and would soon be passing out literature in their stores on the importance of the campaign, Brose pointed out that the RVA was “a neutral and independent office with semi-official status.”53 He must have thought that stressing the RVA’s independence rather than its links to the RMVP would more likely win over shop owners. The RVA’s semiofficial status, however, led to conflict with the party’s Deutsches Frauenwerk, throughout the war years, particularly with respect to this campaign. The Frauenwerk’s leaders had trouble submitting to the authority of the RVA on a matter so central to its constituency’s daily lives. Privately, the RVA fought back, arguing



Advertising in the First Half of the War

that despite its extragovernmental status, which was trumpeted to retailers, its mandate came directly from Joseph Goebbels (via the Werberat), which certainly outranked the authority of any mere party organization like the Frauenwerk.54 Nonetheless, RVA funding and manpower were limited, and so its members relied from the start on the advertising expertise of the detergent companies.55 Henkel, and then Böhme Fettchemie, Sunlicht, and Georg Schicht for the Ostmark and later Bohemia-Moravia and occupied western Poland, the Warthegau, were asked to write much of the literature, build the displays, hire the female speakers, and transport the supplies for the extensive campaign, which began in earnest in 1939. Even before the start of the war, RVA literature insisted that “hundreds of millions [of RM] were wasted annually, owing to improper cleaning.”56 In addition to these economic concerns, it was clear that women were unhappy with the fat-reduced cleaners, and the situation was bound to get worse in a hurry when the war began. The campaign, therefore, was also motivated by the government’s desire to convince women that the loss of their trusted products and the shortages of rationed soaps were both necessary and manageable. Radio, film, the daily, weekly, and party presses, exhibits, and posters were all employed to get these messages across. The central text for the campaign was a pamphlet that provided the basics to women on how best to care for the Reich’s various types of textiles. The first problem RVA staff encountered was deciding on a name for the pamphlet. As was common in the heady days of 1940, those making the decision saw victory on the horizon. Calling it Waschfibel, or “Washing Primer,” was ruled out because a new brochure would be needed in peacetime, and they did not want to use the same title twice. While “War-Laundry Primer” made the most sense, the RVA staff members were initially unwilling to saddle the pamphlet with such negative connotations.57 In the end, they chose Schone deine Wäsche [Conserve your Linens].58 Over the next four years, millions of copies of this brochure were produced to be handed out at shops and exhibitions, and millions found their way into magazines as inserts.59 In April 1941, the RVA reported proudly that two hundred lectures featuring the pamphlet were given daily to women’s groups around the Reich.60 Retailers who had the opportunity to advise female consumers were also targeted for training. Shop owners were reminded that educating consumers was not only a duty to the Volk but also an honor. Their personal knowledge of their customers was highlighted as a tool in achieving the overall aims of the project. The “shop owner who sees not only change

207

208

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

Advertising in the First Half of the War

purses but people in his customers” was well placed to choose the women most likely to be open to the concept of relearning these household tasks. These receptive women would in turn pass the information on to “10–12” other women each, and the news would spread.61 Even schoolgirls were subject to informative slideshows on the topic.62 Men were addressed infrequently, but at least one three-minute radio program encouraged men to be flexible in their willingness to change old habits—even if the fictional husband at first declared that “as a man” he had many more important things to remember than that he should no longer dry his razor on the bathroom hand towel.63 Four years into the war, the campaign was still underway, even though the bombings of German cities had led to temporary cancellations of lectures, the budget of the RVA was in sharp decline, and paper shortages were a constant problem.64 The costs were significant. Sunlicht, which participated the least of the three companies working in the Altreich, claimed the following expenses in the last six months of 1941 alone: 76,000 RM on lectures, 50,000 RM on press inserts, 47,000 RM on brochures, 40,000 RM on exhibits in Leipzig and Strasbourg, 10,000 RM on a film, and another 50,000 RM in smaller increments.65 Each company was reimbursed under the budget of the Reich Preiskommissar when the firm sent in an itemized list of expenditures. The total budget for 1943 was close to 7 million RM, down from 10 million the previous year.66 The firms’ participation in the Aktion amounted to nothing less than millions of Reichsmarks worth of free advertising over the course of the war.67 Radio ads for consumer goods had been banned at the end of 1935, and during the war print advertisements for unavailable products or those facing shortages, which included soaps and detergents, faced significant limitations—only Wertreklame, or ads that championed the company’s values and tradition rather than its products, were permitted. In other words, without participation in this massive campaign, these companies never would have had this sort of public exposure during the war. That so much money and access to consumers was available exacerbated pre-existing rivalries and created new ones. In addition to the antagonism between the RVA and Deutsches Frauenwerk, there was tension from the beginning among the corporate partners and between them and the RVA. The design men on each side who created the literature and images for the public regularly “sabotaged” one another’s ideas in order to appear the most talented and productive.68 Some designers may have fought for artistic recognition, but what really mattered was the firms’ desires to take the



Advertising in the First Half of the War

lead in copy writing in order to represent their own brands, if subtly, in the most favorable light. Competition had been stiff between these brands throughout the 1930s, and all three had been involved in challenges to their competitors’ advertising strategies. The newcomer, BFC’s Fewa, was at the center of the struggle. In addition to the challenges raised by dry cleaners, as discussed in the last chapter, a number of daring ads by BFC’s Fewa had attempted to woo customers away from the market leading Persil and Sunlicht’s fine-wash detergent Lux. BFC had tested the limits of anticompetition legislation, claiming quite bluntly that its formula would not damage fine fabrics and synthetics the way the other products did. After a long debate mediated by the Werberat in the mid-1930s, BFC won out by presenting evidence that in fact Fewa was different and better for delicates.69 The RVA’s campaign to support rationing and use of replacement cleaning products may have been an indirect pathway to consumers, but the three companies sought to make the most of it. From the start of the campaign to its last weeks in mid-1944, the three firms infused the propaganda with their own recognizable brand styles. It was true that the RVA had to sanction all promotional literature, but the RVA had control over the smallest percentage of the creative budget.70 In order to achieve the goals of its mandate, therefore, the RVA was dependent on the firms’ cooperation financially and on their expertise in the science of washing and appealing to female consumers. As a result, Henkel, Böhme Fettchemie, and Sunlicht continued to turn out literature and images that reminded consumers how much they loved these products. The easiest way to do this was to insert the name of the company and its brands on the brochures and posters, as at the bottom of Figure 5.12 (Persil), or in the less subtle advertisement for Fewa, Figure 5.13. Through mid-1941, including this sort of information was officially tolerated by the RVA as long as the rest of the text was neutral. In other words, it was fine to say: “Sunlicht will show you how to save soap. Follow these easy tips.” However, seeing that the firms were using this state-financed campaign for their own benefit, the Reichskommissar für Preisbildung tightened the definition of “neutral” in July 1941. Thereafter, the propaganda was to be “neutral and anonymous.”71 However, this new restriction did not stop the companies from making frequent mention of their brands. Doing so served to remind consumers that what they were using to clean their sheets and clothes was not their beloved Persil or Fewa. In a sense, they were creating the very comparative ads German law had always frowned upon. Female consumers could compare their current frustrations with the Einheitswaschmittel with fond memories of im-

209

fig. 5.12. Henkel-produced Waschfibel that encourages the use of Persil, 1938. Courtesy of Corporate Archive, Henkel AG & Co. KGaA, Düsseldorf.



Advertising in the First Half of the War

fig. 5.13.  “Johanna is going—but she’ll be back,” Fewa print advertisement, 1940. Courtesy of bpk, Berlin/Staatsbibliothek Berlin/Art Resource, NY.

maculate white sheets and sparkling dishes washed with the brand-name detergents.72 It helped that the RVA allowed Henkel to take charge of the literature about white textiles.73 Persil’s famous Weisse Dame was no longer present, but those women who sought the best ways to whiten their laundry even in the darkest days of the war would be reminded that Persil set the standard. Similarly, Böhme Fettchemie’s Fewa, which had secured the fine wash market for itself in the last years of peace, handled the brochures about delicate natural and synthetic fibers and so could easily reach its customer base throughout the campaign. While all the companies involved benefited from the lax RVA surveillance of their work, the three companies were not above denouncing each other’s non-neutral ads. The rivalry between Henkel and Sunlicht came to angry words, when Henkel reported that the Sunlicht brochure “We Relearn to Wash” was an ad for Vim and in no way neutral. The RVA promised Henkel that they would encourage Sunlicht to “at least refrain from handing out the brochure at lectures sponsored by the Deutsches Frauen-

211

212

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

werk.” In taking this step, the RVA prioritized its own protection from further criticism by this vocal party organization, but it did little to combat Sunlicht’s self-promotion.74 The fact that this allegedly neutral propaganda was a great advertising opportunity for the companies that issued it was not lost on those smaller firms who were left out of the campaign. In 1941, when Henkel and BFC published classified ads that snuck in the names of their products, including Persil, iMi, Ata, and others, some of the other 630 smaller manufacturers of cleaning products in the Reich sent a “storm of requests” to the Preiskommissar looking for an exception to be granted so that they too could advertise their products.75 Although it was decided that these companies should be allowed to apply for permission to write “really neutral consumer enlightenment” materials, no evidence was found that additional firms were brought on board the campaign. The small manufacturers had good reason to be angry, when the Preiskommissar got a chance to view the controversial materials; he was so incensed by the non-neutral character of Henkel’s and BFC’s ads that the two firms were required to pay back all state funds that had contributed to the production of the publicity. Henkel probably considered the punishment well worth it, given that consumers had been told: “So it has been since then [the start of the war], nevertheless, don’t forget housewives, Persil again in peacetime.”76 Tension between the publicity departments at Henkel and Sunlicht erupted again in late 1941, when Sunlicht’s representatives sought to expand their participation in the program at the expense of Henkel’s large share. Mundhenke was willing to turn over the design of classifieds for magazines but not the production of those ads slated for the daily press, leading to further complaints from Sunlicht to the RVA, and cries by Mundhenke that Sunlicht was only interested in “power politics” that had nothing to do with the overall aims of the project.77 In fact, Mundhenke continued, the steps taken by the “adversarial company [Sunlicht] were no longer bearable,” and he warned his RVA counterparts of the dangers of allowing such disruptions to the working relationship. In this matter and others the RVA stood by Henkel. By far the largest and most sophisticated marketer of its multiple brands, Henkel was the best equipped to make the RVA look good to its superiors, despite the rhetoric about neutrality and cooperative advertising.78 Taking sides in the squabble, the RVA announced that henceforth its staff would communicate only with Mundhenke, and he would in turn pass on decisions to the other corporate partners.79 By 1943, the RVA and its superiors were fed up with what amounted to a series of separate campaigns run by the various firms. The decision was



Advertising in the First Half of the War

taken to find a character that could unify all campaign literature and supplant the corporate identities.80 Change was necessary, because even “lay people note that it is still clear who stands behind each ad. A classified by Henkel is still recognizable externally [in design] and internally [in text] as carrying the Henkel style.” One ad agency suggested that they could create a generic woman to appear in all the literature, but their designers wanted to know whether the RVA thought it better to use a positive image, “Frau Textiles-clever,” a naive one, “Frau Textiles-bumbler,” or perhaps even a malicious character, “Frau Textiles-murderer” or “Frau Textiles-enemy.”81 In the end, the Dreckspatz [mud lark] was introduced as a “scapegoat” that would be recognizable to mothers who already referred to their messy children with this moniker.82 A small, black cartoon bird with a dirty bib around its neck, the Dreckspatz appeared on posters and pamphlets flitting from tablecloth to bathroom towel to laundry basket, leaving behind its stains for the housewife to tackle with the (oft-repeated) tips handed out by the RVA and its corporate partners. The Dreckspatz was not a success and was terminated exactly one year after its introduction.83 The archival record does not explain the reason for failure—but we can speculate that the corporate partners may have lost interest, now that they had less to gain; perhaps female consumers did not like the mud lark whose messy trail seemed to draw attention to housewives’ inability to keep things clean, rather than the regime’s inability to provide adequate soaps. Or perhaps the crises of 1944 made the introduction of any new propaganda a losing battle. In the last year of the war, the employees of the RVA were too busy scavenging office space and undamaged desk lamps under the continual threat of Allied bombing raids to decide on a replacement. This sort of constant badgering of housewives during the war years was not uncommon. Irene Guenther and Nancy Reagin have shown that most female consumers did not welcome this sort of advice.84 In this case too, we know that the RVA faced complaints that attendance at lectures was on the decline, particularly in the latter years of the war, and women who did attend often came with complaints—wondering for example, in 1942, how they were supposed to follow the tips for making use of remnant soap chips, when they had no soap to start with. Yet the RVA and its partner firms were content to push on with the campaign despite the opinion of many consumers that much of the advice was “senseless.”85 Instead the companies involved fought over all resource allocations. They made the most of every liberty taken and exception granted to them.86 In short, they competed for a voice in the market as they had always done, though un-

213

214

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

der far different circumstances, and apparently concluded rightly that consumer complaints would be directed at the state rather than its corporate partners. One might question, in fact, whether the whole “proper washing” campaign was a colossal waste of time and money for the regime, counterproductive even, for it reminded consumers of the absence of favorite household products and raised the ire of female consumers. And yet we can see both the anxieties and principles of National Socialism at work. The specter of World War One deprivation pushed the government to accept the expenses associated with directing consumption in ways they hoped would prevent extreme shortages of goods. That concern would be particularly intense surrounding cleanliness comes as no surprise, given the state’s and party’s demonization of Jews as filthy and vermin-ridden. Outbreaks of typhus (carried by lice) epidemics in Jewish ghettoes were viewed as proof that Jews were the “carriers and disseminators” of the disease, owing to their supposed lack of hygiene and cultural backwardness.87 For Aryan Germans to succumb to such epidemics would uncover the falsehoods on which National Socialism had been built. Keeping Germany clean had greater significance than morale alone.

preparing for victory After the first two years of the war, it appeared that the fighting would soon be over, and the RVA’s corporate partners were happy to have forged a relationship with the regime that would position them well for success in peacetime. Paul Mundhenke believed that even after the war was won, business conditions would not return to the prewar status quo. He expected that governmental control would remain tight, and that only a few brands would survive, meaning that the “struggle for markets, at least within the German people’s-economy, would be considered a waste of energy.” He predicted that advertising would continue, but that some of the old “fighting spirit” would be gone. Mundhenke was generally satisfied with this prediction, however. He was confident that the work done by Henkel during the war had positioned the company well with all offices that mattered for the advertising of consumer items, “Werberat, RVA, Frauenwerk and others.”88 In some regards, Mundhenke was right. Though Germany did not win the war, he correctly foresaw that only some brands would survive—few more well known than Persil. It seems clear, then, that when we think about the re-emerging popularity of some brand names in the postwar pe-



Advertising in the First Half of the War

riod, we must recognize that the enthusiasm with which they were greeted did not stem solely from a romanticization of the prewar period, though surely such idealized memories were crucial to sustain these brands into the 1950s. We must also consider the hard work done by these companies during the war itself. Germany’s women were ready for the moment when Persil ist wieder da, [Persil is back!], because Henkel and likewise Sunlicht and Böhme Fettchemie had manipulated the wartime propaganda to show their own products as the truly proper ways to wash. The significance of defending commerce during the war was not limited to helping Germans cope with scarcity or the other changes they were witnessing in their cities and towns. The euphoria of the first years of the war was viewed by many businessmen (large and small) as an opportunity for commercial expansion, and they were encouraged to think in these terms by a variety of state offices and economic interest groups. For example, the Economic Group Iron told its members in 1940 to start preparing their “wish list” for the coming peace treaty with regard to the economic reorganization of Europe.89 The great Nazi empire was emerging and companies wanted to prepare their brands for the new markets that would open. For some companies, empire meant salvation from a very dire situation. In the face of massive cutbacks to the coffee supply during the war, Jacobs brand requested guidance from the Industry and Trade Commission in Bremen in 1941 on the proper procedure for acquiring plantations in new colonies as soon as possible.90 For some companies, growth predated the war. For example, BMW and Daimler-Benz benefited from rearmament from the beginning, but shifted their promotional efforts particularly after 1939 from the consumer market to competition for government contracts, as the only real path forward. Nonetheless ads remained part of their sales strategies, as a way to catch the eye of those bureaucrats charged with procuring war materiel and also as a way to remind civilians that BMW and Daimler-Benz were serving the country with the best technology in the world, a reassuring message in itself.91 In addition, ads for companies like BMW were explicit that lessons were being learned in the rush to develop new technologies for the military effort. Coming out of the war such innovation would make their products stronger and faster—leaders in the automotive and aeronautical industries. All examples to this point have referred directly to businesses based within the Altreich. The situation in the first war years was not so dissimilar in the eastern borderlands, except of course that new conditions arrived in the former Austrian and Sudeten-Czech territories as early as 1938 with

215

216

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

fig. 5.14.  “Helper in War and Peace,” 1939. “WH” stands for Wehrmacht. Courtesy of Mercedes-Benz Classic Archive, Daimler AG, Stuttgart.

annexation in spring and fall, respectively.92 Two years earlier the Unilever subsidiary, Georg Schicht company, based in Aussig (or Usti nad Labem, in today’s Czech Republic), which produced a number of brand-name products popular in the region, including Elida hair products, Hirsch soap, and Marga margarine, was approached by the German nationalist organization Bund der Deutschen Arbeitsgebiet: Volkswirtschaft about participating (after a review by the Bund) in their list of recommended German firms and other promotional materials. Schicht declined the offer of this external support, citing its long-standing reputation for quality, which did not require further legitimation from any external board.93 While Schicht applauded the Bund’s work in the letter declining participation, unwillingness to participate might have also been motivated by fears of alienating Czech customers.94 Throughout the 1930s ads for Schicht brands had often been printed in both languages either in separate monolingual versions or together as bilingual posters or classifieds.95 By September 1938, however,



Advertising in the First Half of the War

Reisende for the company were warned to prepare all customers (retail and wholesale) for the “new situation.” Anxious about the future, the company blocked new shipments of goods to current customers who held outstanding debts with Schicht and insisted that any new customers would have to pay up front for the company’s products.96 By mid-October 1938 Schicht headquarters was issuing separate newsletters for their representatives working in the Sudetengau and those in the “current Czechoslovakian Republic” mostly asking for patience. The “general shopping malaise” of late October turned to fears of hoarding by late November. Headquarters warned its salesmen not to provoke such behavior to increase their own orders.97 By December, company officials in Aussig were practically giddy with the sales forecast: they were gaining new customers from the Altreich, and the large brands within Germany’s former borders had no plans to expand eastward into Schicht’s territory, because their products were more expensive and already had lower fat content. Many Sudeten towns also had new military garrisons open for business, and Christmas was always a time of high profits.98 However, this perfect constellation of forces in the Sudetengau came to an end for Schicht in February 1939, when the same fat rationing back home reached this annexed region. In March the Protectorate of Bohemia and Moravia was established after Prague was occupied, but the Easter season was a disappointment overall. Headquartered in the Reich town of Aussig but with sales and manufacturing sites across the western half of the protectorate, the last months of relative peace were characterized for Schicht by the removal of some products, the introduction of fatless cleaners, including Schicht’s “Unity soap, Nr. 28,”general distribution problems, and the new partnership with the RVA. Headquarters promised the Schicht sales force (so it could in turn reassure retailers) that the Unity Soap would still look as good as “a brand name package.” However, just in case their customers were more concerned with Nr. 28’s ability to wash than with its package design, the Aussig office also circulated one retailer’s tips for successful sales of the ersatz cleaner: Herr K. in Mährisch-Neustadt (Unicov, Moravia) put the carton of Nr. 28 in an “advantageous location in his store,” and every shopper who entered was told that Herr K.’s wife had already tried the new product and was “fully satisfied with the results.”99 This sales strategy was not accompanied by the recommendation that retailers be encouraged to have their wives actually test out the product in order to verify Frau K.’s alleged satisfaction. Clearly doubts lingered about the new product. Retailers balked at the idea of promoting

217

218

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

fig. 5.15.  “Like in the Altreich” Persil products! Sudetengau advertisement, ca. 1940. Courtesy of Archiv města Ústí nad Labem, Czech Republic.

Nr. 28 before all stocks of the old (better) Schicht soap were gone, but headquarters responded that the ad campaign for the new product would be a waste if the product was not on display and available for sale. Soon Schicht also had to compete with Germany’s leading brands. Henkel, for example, advertised the availability of its products “now, as in the Altreich”—with “new prices” but “unchanged quality.”100 Facing this new competition, Schicht salesmen were asked in the summer of 1940 to keep track of how well the competitors’ fat-free cleansers, which did not require ration coupons, were selling and at what price points. Company representatives were also told to report back about the success of the Schicht/RVA “Schone deine Wäsche” literature that retailers were distributing.101 When the customs border between Germany and the protectorate was removed in October 1940, Götz Aly reports that German soldiers went on a shopping spree in the region, buying up and hauling home presents and specific requests for goods no longer available back home.102 Though Schicht’s archival materials do not offer much of a sense that the firm benefited greatly



Advertising in the First Half of the War

from the removal of duties, this commercial activity offers a hint of Chad Bryant’s description of the protectorate in the early 1940s as “surrounded by war, living in peace.”103 The occupation of the rump of Czech lands in the spring of 1939 had been ideologically significant, because it signaled that the Nazi quest for Lebensraum would not be limited to the unification or “liberation” of German-speaking peoples.104 And while other scholars have unraveled the details of the murderous plans put into action to build the Nazi empire, 105 advertisers and their supporters in the Werberat and business world became preoccupied with how buying and selling fit in the future of a Nazi-led Europe.106 Believing that they had largely dispelled the cloud of suspicion that hung over advertising at the start of Hitler’s reign, and having held on to much of the industry through the initial shock of the war, the military successes seemed to indicate that advertisers and their employers should be busily planning for a victorious postwar era. One fact that all could agree on was that commerce would not revert to the pre-1933 or even the pre1939 system. The trade journals concurred that after victory “advertising will remain [politically] mobilized” and “will never again have free rein to run amok like wild horses as was the case in the liberal economic system.”107 While the wartime economy was a step in the right direction, advertisers insisted that experience gained during the conflict positioned them to take on an even greater role in peacetime, when the store shelves would be full again. In the new era, the “specialists” of the Reichswerbeschule would replace any remaining “half-educated dilettantes” and complete the task of creating an advertising style that truthfully described the “usefulness” of the product for the individual and wider community.108 We should hold no false perceptions about the state of the economy in the Nazi Empire. Hitler, for one, tended to focus on “how much coal, iron and steel, edible fats and grain he could extract from a given territory.” As Mark Mazower points out, however, from an economic standpoint, given their pre-existing dependence on imported foodstuffs, some of the territories subsumed into the empire, such as Greece and Norway, “were hardly worth invading” and became burdens on the Reich.109 Nonetheless, advertisers who were optimistic about what the future held for them at home were just as eager to demonstrate their value abroad as the Reich’s borders expanded. As Werberat president Hunke had argued all along, advertisers performed a necessary role in the struggle to win the hearts and minds (to use today’s phrasing) of those in the occupied territories.110 In early 1940, for example, despite tensions over control, a partnership was forged

219

fig. 5.16.  Signal, cover, February 1941. Courtesy of Anne S. K. Brown Military Collection, Brown University Library.



Advertising in the First Half of the War

fig. 5.17.  Zeiss Dutch-language advertisement, Signal, November 1940. Courtesy of Anne S. K. Brown Military Collection, Brown University Library.

between the Wehrmacht, Foreign Ministry, and Propaganda Ministry that gave birth to the magazine Signal.111 This weekly magazine circulated throughout the Continent and even at times in northern Africa, appearing over the course of the war in an astounding twenty-five languages. The magazine was not sold within the Altreich, but a German version did exist for those who could read the language in the annexed territories, and its editorial staff worked closely with that of the Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung.112 Ads for well-known German name-brand products, such as the Dutch-language ad for Zeiss binoculars in Figure 5.17, Dr. Oetker foods, or Pelikan pens and ink were included, along with extensive war coverage, some feelgood social and cultural content about films and local customs, and discussion of the present and future European economy by Hunke and others.113 The goal was to create a European equivalent of Life magazine in terms of layout—a glossy, colorful image of Europe during the war that would sell the German view of the struggle along with the idea of Germany as occupying force and future benefactor.114 The consumer goods sector was anxious to show itself as part of this vision of a new Europe. On the one hand, expanding its market share for the coming peace was an obvious incentive to placing advertisements in Signal, but the companies that advertised here

221

fig. 5.18. Dutch-language, Reich lottery ad, Signal, October 1940. Courtesy of Anne S. K. Brown Military Collection, Brown University Library.



Advertising in the First Half of the War

also sought through their imagery and text to tie their German brands in with a broader idea of Europe. The Alps do not extend to Holland, so one can only imagine that the Zeiss advertisement in Figure 5.17 sought to encourage the desire to travel (with Zeiss products) or connect the greatness of this natural wonder to the superiority of (German) Zeiss technology and also the racial strength of the northern European male, who could easily be Dutch or German in this image, gazing outward toward the future. Ads for the Reich lottery, such as the example in Figure 5.18, which depicted young couples celebrating winnings that will help them establish their life together, are particularly compelling in this regard. Clearly the Reich lottery hoped to sell tickets and make a greater profit beyond Germany’s prewar boundaries, but in these representations readers also receive a very benevolent view of life’s possibilities in the empire. Even when other magazines and newspapers were publishing shorter issues, resorting to poor production quality, or disappearing all together, Signal continued largely unaffected, with access to rationed paper, the most talented photographers, and the best equipment. For example, in February 1944, according to the expressed wishes of General Alfred Jodl, twenty color-capable presses were found in Paris and charged with the printing of Signal covers in order to stay at par with the American magazine Victory, which had been introduced in 1942 to counter Signal’s presumed success.115 Numerous German ad men were involved in the production of Signal, including Fritz Solm, who apparently had the original idea for a publication to showcase the “new Europe.” It is not surprising that Solm was the one to suggest the magazine. Educated at Columbia University and married to a British woman, Solm had worked in the New York office of the American ad firm J. Walter Thompson (JWT) in the 1920s. He was sent to Germany at the end of the decade to work in the Berlin branch of JWT and bought the business after 1933 in a rather acrimonious deal with his former employers. Solm changed the company’s name but continued to run it in the style of an Anglo-American full-service agency throughout the 1930s.116 Also a member of the SS and close friends with Heinrich Hunke, Solm worked for the RVA and the military’s propaganda corps during the war and remained a leading figure at Signal through to the end of the conflict.117 In articles that appeared in Signal and elsewhere, Hunke and others associated with the Werberat saw the greatest immediate potential in developing the economies of East-Central and Southeastern Europe. Advocates for the expansion of Germany’s soft power in this region had been vocal on this issue well before 1933.118 Hunke’s Ad Council offered financial support

223

224

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

to some of these cross-cultural ventures, such as study-abroad exchanges for German and non-Germans from the southeast who would become the generation of engineers and businessmen to unify the region.119 The Werberat kept in step as the borders of the Reich extended further east by introducing regulations to coordinate the advertising industries within the Ostmark and Sudetengau.120 Beginning in 1938, Hunke also took the first of a series of trips to the Balkans, stopping in Greece, Yugoslavia, Bulgaria, and Turkey. Before each of these visits, he received information about his host’s personality and political viewpoints, as well as tips about the local culture.121 The first trip was a memorable one for the director of the Werberat. It led him to make visits to capital cities and trade shows part of his regular routine. On these visits Hunke and his companions discussed German export goods, investigated what the new territories could offer the Reich, and explored the potential for further development both in terms of raw materials to fuel German growth and in terms of building a local consumer goods market.122 Though historians would not agree with his rosy view of Nazi-led integration, in 1941 Hunke claimed that the Werberat had contributed greatly to the creation of a Nazi-led sphere of economic influence that benefited the entire region.123 On the one hand, the visits and the reports undertaken by Werberat delegations make clear the regime’s and German industry’s intentions to exploit these foreign lands for Germany’s immediate betterment.124 On the other hand, Hunke’s goals for Southeast Europe went beyond milking the region for its natural resources.125 Hunke wrote years later that at the time he believed that a unified European market could be established within fifteen years under Nazi leadership—a Europe that would “break the British monopoly” on trade.126 For Hunke, the greatest roadblock to German prosperity in the last century had been the British stranglehold on international commerce, which had led to the “systematic neglect of the German East and European Southeast.”127 The establishment of a “continental European community” faced many hurdles, he admitted, among which the most daunting perhaps was the industrialization of the agrarian southeast. Essential to meeting this challenge would be “the awakening of new needs” among the population, which Hunke emphasized was often overlooked as an important strategy in the vitalization of any economy. Germany’s ability to consume the products of the southeast was “practically unlimited,” but the marketability of sophisticated German goods in the southeast depended on whether that region’s “cult of the primitive” could be overcome.128 While one would expect that Hunke was well versed in the racial



Advertising in the First Half of the War

cleansing underway in the east, his writings also discuss the need to teach local inhabitants to consume—and that is where advertising, via exhibits and trade shows, films, speeches, and print ads, could help. By creating consumer desire in this region, Hunke insisted, ads would further the Nazi cause more generally. “An underestimated aid to political propaganda” in the occupied territories, advertisements had the power to reconcile conquered peoples with the German way of life, while ensuring continued prosperity for those at home.129 By 1942 Carole von Braunmühl, writing for the Ad Council, could claim that throughout Europe new measures had been instituted to bring advertising more closely under the command of governments (within the German sphere of influence, including Spain), in imitation of the successful efforts of Germany’s own Ad Council. This development was noteworthy, because in the “new Europe” the economies of Europe would be more united than ever, meaning also that “advertising will [increasingly] jump across borders.” Braunmühl now called on these bodies to begin coordinating their efforts.130 While military success and genocide were the lynchpins in these designs for empire and prosperity, steps were also taken toward these goals by advertisers, their employers, and supporters to further the professionalization of advertising and encourage ads that promoted the empire abroad while making claims of support for consumers facing the traumas of war at home. In the early 1940s brand names were kept alive in the minds of shoppers, generating anticipation for their return after they were no longer available on store shelves. Hunke and his supporters also spread the word about the possibilities of an economic bloc that could challenge the historic dominance of Britain and the emerging strength of its American ally. With similar thoughts in his mind in the summer of 1939, Heinrich Hunke wrote a personal letter to Hans Domizlaff, the former Siemens and Reemtsma (cigarettes) branding guru, asking Domizlaff to provide advice on selling German goods in Switzerland. The Hamburg iconoclast responded by explaining that Hunke should think less about political ideals in his approach to foreign markets.131 What mattered most when selling goods was reputation for quality: “Made in Germany” was the place to start. The point of this chapter has been that when we look at “Made in Germany,” we should not focus solely on the aspect of production implicit in the phrase. After all Domizlaff was a leading brander of his age, and this chapter has demonstrated that there were voices beyond his in the Reich during the war years enthusiastic about the idea of selling the “new Germany,” and that individual consumption was part of that vision.

225

226

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

In order to understand the experience of war, we also need to think through the attempts at maintaining commercial life, as a fundamental aspect of social organization. Instead of arguing that consumption and the advertising to drive it was dead, it is quite clear that its very continuation, albeit in muted and distorted forms, helped Germans retain a sense of continuity with their prewar lives, and prompted them to remember and return to certain “household friends” like Nivea as a safe and dependable sphere, once the political system had been defeated and morally discredited. This uncoupling of the ideology of National Socialism and commercial culture in Germany in the last stage of the war and into the period of occupation is the subject of the concluding chapter.

chapter six

Ads amid Ashes As the first two humans appeared, advertising began.1

In 1943, BMW celebrated twenty-five years of manufacturing under the famous blue and white logo. Despite the fact that the company no longer provided products to the consumer market, the company’s marketing director chose to mark the occasion not by emphasizing the significance of the company to the nation’s war effort but by showcasing the brand’s popularity among motorsport fans. Attachment to the firm’s logo had been evident for some time, according to the article’s author, in the daily purchases by young and old of BMW-branded items. Furthermore, the author boasted that before the war, Austrians had used BMW lapel pins to demonstrate their support for Anschluss, showing “their silent sympathy for greater Germany by sporting the lapel pin of the Bavarian manufacturer.” “And now [in 1942],” he added without a hint of unease about the destruction of the cities and towns of which he spoke, “there is no village in the territory of the empire [Reichsgebiet], . . . in Hungary, Holland or Belgium so small that it isn’t home to a young friend of the firm’s logo.”2 This all sounds rather curious. First, Austrians have never been close friends with Bavarians. Perhaps the story was simply the result of wishful thinking at BMW, but it is also possible that for some Austrian motorsport fans the brand could be disassociated from its local origins and serve as a secret password for support of Großdeutschland. Similarly, a Dutchman wearing a BMW lapel pin in Rotterdam would have faced certain scorn from some of his countrymen. In other circles, however, the possibilities for economic collaboration likely superseded Dutch nationalism. Whatever the political impact, it seems clear that the company was focused first and foremost on the commercial power of its brand. The firm’s marketing team wanted to portray its logo as standing for far more than

228

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

fig. 6.1.  Catalogue of items for purchase with BMW logo, 1936. Courtesy of Historischen Medienarchivs, BMW Group Classic, Munich.

just the production of quality aviation motors or vehicles for the military. Surely very few even in peacetime Germany could dream of owning a BMW automobile, and only a somewhat larger group might ever sit astride a BMW motorcycle (outside of military service), but the company still sought to highlight its relationship with consumers. Beyond the image of BMW as a racing superpower and beacon of technological know-how, the firm claimed that individuals rallied around the logo as a symbol of European unity behind German leadership. And the Bavarian manufacturer made sure everyone could participate in this brand identification; everyone could afford the lapel pin—they were only 5 Pfennige each.3 The company’s rhetoric, written in 1942 in anticipation of the upcoming anniversary, reflects the skill and seriousness with which BMW approached publicity. However, as this article was being penned, Germany’s empire was in the early stages of collapse. The second half of 1942 was a turning point for Germany not only in a military sense. As the momentum on the



Ads amid Ashes

battlefront shifted against the Reich, Goebbels began to preach the ideals of Total War and the deadly consequences that would accompany defeat. In response to growing paper shortages and the scarcity of more and more products, the Werberat instated far more severe restrictions on print advertisements.4 The first section of this chapter will explore the effects of the demise of the Third Reich on the partnership between state and consumer products industries. With the disappearance of branded consumer products from store shelves and sharp cuts to promotional efforts, the bonds that had emerged between these brands and the goals of the racial state weakened, even as these manufacturers fell most directly under the control of the dictatorship’s total war efforts. One visible sign of this process was the appearance of black markets, which not only grew in size but moved out into public spaces by the autumn of 1944—a clear sign to citizens that the downfall of the regime was imminent, as it had been in 1918 when the same phenomenon occurred.5 After years of supporting the regime, how did businesses, advertising, and advertisers survive the death throes of the dictatorship with their brands (if not their factories and distribution networks) largely intact? Further, were they able to make use of the lessons learned during the Third Reich in preparation for the societies that would emerge out of the occupied east and west? The final section of this chapter will offer concluding thoughts about the postwar period and the ease with which many brands were resuscitated during the transition to peace, and examine why advertisers and their industry came out of the Third Reich in surprisingly good shape.

advertising and sales in the final stage of war Even though BMW had plenty to do to meet the needs of the nation at war, the company also kept an eye on its loyal brand supporters. In April 1940, headquarters had called its leading sales representatives to Munich to discuss the situation, including plans for the peace that was presumed to be just around the corner. A summary of the meeting that was circulated to all dealerships bemoaned increasing shortages and the prioritization of the export market for those cars still in production. However, it also called for unity behind the plans to introduce a new model series in peacetime—a sign of optimism that both victory and expanded consumer demand for autos in Germany were on the horizon.6

229

230

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

Without the arrival of the expected victory, the company continued to release “reminder ads” in Germany and abroad to keep the brand in public view and nourish the flow of government contracts. The company sought to uphold its reputation, without focusing squarely on BMW’s military contribution, by reminding Germans and others within the empire of the brand’s prewar successes on the international race circuit and the technological respect allegedly afforded to BMW’s products even in enemy countries such as Britain. Produced in eighteen languages, one series of ads from 1943 explained to readers that BMW produced “the fastest car in the world,” and others claimed the same for BMW motorcycles. The point of these multilingual ads was to position BMW as representing a German Empire that promised industrial and technological progress for all those favored by the regime, once peace was restored. BMW ads circulated throughout Europe in Signal, among other publications. In each ad, including those that featured racing images and those that depicted the company’s significance to the Wehrmacht or Luftwaffe, the message was clear: BMW quality stood at the forefront of the industry and that “experience gathered and measured in wartime would benefit Europe [not just Germany] in peacetime.”7 Relatively speaking, therefore, even in 1943 BMW remained in an advantageous position in terms of its promotional agenda. The Ad Council still believed wholeheartedly in the positive impact that ads could have for sustaining the empire, and encouraged companies investing in foreign image-making that emphasized German know-how and will as cornerstones of the “new Europe.”8 Yet from this point forward, the Munich manufacturer’s ads department had far fewer resources and opportunities to champion the company name. All auto shows had been suspended and BMW Blätter appeared only sporadically in 1943; the last issue rolled off the press in January 1944.9 As the external opportunities for publicity dwindled, the ads department increasingly directed its messages about BMW ideals to its own labor force.10 In late 1942, the ads department launched its first attempt to “awaken interest” in its employees for suggesting efficiency reforms. These sorts of programs for improving production were not uncommon during the war, of course, but at BMW, more than most, the company’s advertising staff could rely on the pre-existing image of the brand as a leader in innovation to encourage participation. On the first day of the campaign, employees entered the Munich plant gate, passing by a poster that read: “[E]very improvement leads to progress and every invention is capable of improvement.” A bicycle awaited the employee with the best practical reform to work procedures.

fig. 6.2. Advertisements for BMW technology in eighteen languages, 1943. Courtesy of Historischen Medienarchivs, BMW Group Classic, Munich.

fig. 6.3.  BMW Blätter cover, December 1941. Courtesy of Historischen Medienarchivs, BMW Group Classic, Munich.



Ads amid Ashes

Two days later a flyer was handed out with the title “The Pyramids.” Below a sketch combining the Great Pyramid and Sphinx, the text contrasted the twenty years and 100,000 men it took to build these wonders with the estimated nine months and 500 workers that would be needed to do the job at present. Encouraging BMW workers to see themselves as part of this history of human progress, the text asked: “And who knows better where improvements can be made than the man who is occupied daily by that work?” The campaign combined such slogans with movies, an exhibit of machinery and tools called “Then and Now,” and special broadcasts on the plant radio. What was not made explicit was the war, or duty to Führer and Fatherland, as reasons to come forward with proposals. Only on the last day of the Aktion was a quotation from Hitler employed. Instead, the motivating force for change was the universal human desire for progress and innovation, which was also at the heart of BMW’s own corporate image.11 In addition to the fact that such rhetoric came easily to a company that had been representing its brand with similar language for decades, ignoring the war made sense given the audience. By 1942 the size of the nonGerman BMW labor force equaled the native-born contingent, and the company’s 1943 Kriegsleistungsbericht detailed the “particularities and difficulties” of working with this “thrown-together workforce.” For example, the company had responded in 1942 to more than ten thousand requests to visit hometowns, over forty thousand requests for certificates of various kinds including those to excuse an absence from work due to illness or injury, and over two thousand permanent departures from employment (not including those called up to the Wehrmacht or transferred elsewhere by officials). Additional disruptions to production included constant training for new workers and stoppages caused by aerial bombardment. And though the company intended to establish the “most comfortable work conditions possible” for a workforce representing at least twenty-two countries, including POWs, conscripted civilians, and concentration camp prisoners, the report admitted privately that this goal was not always achieved.12 During the early 1940s, and especially in the second half of the war, it became the task of the ads department, in service to the BMW-Gefolgschaftsamt (literally translated, the Office for the BMW-Following), to design images and texts that would integrate and placate the workers so as to support the war effort—and uphold BMW’s reputation for progress and innovation. The criticism of advertising as frivolous intensified after 1942, and the new limitations on the industry by the Werberat meant that ad professionals were on the defensive more than ever before. As one BMW publicity

233

234

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

man admitted in a report on his department’s work in 1944: “[It] is not surprising that the question is always asked: what is actually advertised during the war?” And so he explained that in most cases the work that the department handled “did not originate from the initiatives of the ads department nor could its completion be avoided.” Rather, “most of the work was ordered by the German Labor Front, the Munitions Ministry, and the company, rather than superfluous work dreamed up by the ads department, as is often assumed.”13 The remaining advertisers in the civilian economy must have been desperate to hold on to their jobs in 1944, the last year of fighting being by far the most deadly for German soldiers.14 The BMW report leaves no doubt that these employees felt under attack for avoiding military service. However, as the excerpt also demonstrates, their superiors in Munich and in state and party offices continued to rely on these men and women to produce meaning for the war effort, all the way to the bitter end. Among the tasks recounted in the 1944 report, the design of print ads has already been mentioned. BMW still placed these classifieds with permission of the Werberat,15 which was conscious of the need to keep brands alive in the minds of consumers. BMW’s publicity department lamented, however, that it had been unable to spend the entire 250,000 RM allocated that year for advertisements, likely owing to space shortages in the dwindling number of press outlets. Through the end of 1944, the staff also continued to supply the domestic and foreign press with essays about its products and images to be used in related stories. The department’s graphic artists also remained busy, creating hundreds of technical drawings for BMW’s military products, including diagrams of individual parts and manuals for use and repair. Many other posters and brochures were designed for the workforce, and most are exactly what one would expect in 1943 and 1944: air raid protection notices, slogans to encourage the conservation of resources, reminders about productivity quotas, and care for tools. There are also a number of images and texts that serve as odd companions to the war-related materials. Staff within the ads department tried to create a world of peace and calm by painting a mural of farm animals on the wall of the plant’s childcare facility. They also worked on theater sets for the children’s dramatic endeavors, and decorations for the dentist’s office. Because of their facility with languages, used in writing ads for foreign press outlets, members of the ads department were also employed as translators for the foreign workforce. Translation services in seven languages were offered to the Gefolgschaftsamt and to the company health office.16 In addition to individual translation work, the ads department was in charge of



Ads amid Ashes

fig. 6.4.  “Your idea— your profit!” appeal to French forced laborers at BMW, 1944. Courtesy of Historischen Medienarchivs, BMW Group Classic, Munich.

large-scale campaigns directed solely toward French workers, the largest contingent of non-Germans working for BMW. Just as the firm had tried to encourage the submission of ideas for improvements in the production process in 1942, two years later management appealed directly to the large number of French workers for suggestions. The campaign votre idée—votre profit offered financial reward to winning entries. The men working on the text shrewdly avoided the war effort as a motivator for participation; they also concluded that focusing on the BMW tradition of technology and engineering excellence would not appeal to the French “national character.” In the end they claimed to have adjusted the text “to fit the French mentality perfectly,” which, judging by the campaign slogan was all about earning some extra cash. Their cultural sensitivity also came through in the image used to advertise the contest, which indicated that Frenchmen ruminated over how best to improve production at BMW while smoking pipes and wearing berets. Confident that their message would strike the right chord, the contest organizers were disappointed to find that those individuals

235

236

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

who did come forward with ideas were roundly beaten by their fellow countrymen, bringing the company’s attempts to recruit French laborers to an early end.17 Although this plan was a failure, the ads department was flattered by the praise it received from the DAF and the RMVP for the many brochures and posters released in these years. Two of the most important were the separate handbooks for Germans and French laborers about life and work at BMW. No evidence of handbooks for Soviet POWs or concentration camp inmates was found. Rules were necessary, admitted the handbook, to keep order and the racial hierarchy intact. In the German version, BMW was portrayed as the ideal community, but male workers were reminded that sustaining this utopia required them to uphold “chivalric ideals” toward female German workers. They were also reminded that while they were the “kings of the castle” this meant not “control [over non-Germans]” so much as “self-discipline.” So while it was “hard for Germans not to show our good hearts to all foreigners,” it was their duty “to be watchful of the dangers of mixing with foreign blood, because according to the unsentimental laws of nature the future belongs to the racially pure and never to the mongrels.”18 This rhetoric was combined in the handbook with the promotion of modern workplace advancements, including an emphasis on hygiene, spa vacations, counseling for female workers, rationalized shop floor discipline, and additional leaves for those working far from home. The French version, La vie et le travail chez BMW, addressed its readers “Camarade français!” and presented the stay at BMW as a pleasurable, if temporary, experience—one in which French workers could participate in the communal spirit “of the house of BMW.” To foster integration, French workers were also encouraged to join sports teams and learn German.19 The ad men and women for AEG, the giant manufacturer of electrical equipment and appliances, had also turned largely to shop floor propaganda campaigns by 1944. The company’s call to ramp up production was heralded by the slogan “No time will be given to the enemy.” Wasteful, untrained female workers were targeted for their inefficiency. Designers drew on their experience making appeals to housewives in peacetime. Commands like “You should not,” or “You must not” were rejected in favor of “heart to heart” discussions that demonstrated “understanding” for workers’ “private feelings and desires and remind them that only victory in war can fulfill those wishes and lead to the attainment of what each comrade hopes for his [or her] life.” This example illustrates how during the



Ads amid Ashes

last year of war loyalty and perseverance were retained in part by recourse to more intimate hopes for the future—namely, personal safety and survival for oneself and loved ones.20 The suggestions for improvement were to resonate with the “practical housewife-view of the female employee.” Visual strategies from print advertisements were also adopted. AEG chose photos of women working efficiently to use in the new posters. Doing so would “honor” the women and, by replicating the visual and textual cues of advertisements for household products in magazines, provide a “model” that other female employees could easily understand.21 Even though work for the military gave them some exposure, it was still difficult for companies like BMW and AEG to retain a presence in the public consciousness by 1943. In the spring of that year AEG produced a confidential assessment that compared its own delicate position with that of its rival, Siemens.22 Siemens still employed a larger staff in public relations, besting AEG in this regard by a ratio of 4 to 1. However, AEG felt that its smaller number of experts had done a better job of keeping the company in the news. This was no small feat, explained the report, given the fact that Werner von Siemens, who had died more than fifty years earlier, “is at all times presented as the prototype of the German engineer, which in today’s state-controlled press works very advantageously for Siemens, while we must be very careful to avoid historical discussions.”23 In other words, AEG’s directors had to steer the conversation away from the Jewish heritage of the company’s founder, Emil Rathenau, a goal that was not always met even in the last stage of the war, after Germany’s Jewish population had been decimated.24 And what of businesses that did not have a major contribution to make to the war effort? Beiersdorf AG of Hamburg maintained a healthy budget for Nivea ads into 1942. The company was forced to begin scaling back its ad campaigns that summer, however, because of Werberat proscriptions against advertising goods that were in short supply, and because of limited space in the dwindling number of newspapers.25 By 1 November 1943, all skin creams were to appear under the simple name Haut Crème, and sales were limited to the military, hospitals, mothers of small children, and armaments workers.26 However, if we look at the new “debranded” packaging, it is clear that consumers who could procure Beiersdorf ’s Haut Crème would be reminded of the famous round blue and white canister of Nivea: the size, shape, color, and typeface were the same. Even the company name remained. The regime faced the same problem it had encountered in the attempt to create anonymous publicity for the Schone deine Wäsche campaign. As in that case, the new Haut Crème and its presentation to shoppers served

237

238

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

fig. 6.5. Nivea canisters, 1943. Courtesy of Beiersdorf, AG, Hamburg.

indirectly as an advertisement for the original—leaving consumers doubly fond of the now-absent product, because they were visually reminded of the superior Nivea crème every time they reached for the Haut Crème. Even with Nivea (as such) gone from the shelves, ads reminding consumers of the brand and the company’s reputation continued to run in small numbers until April 1944, when a halt on cosmetic industry promotions for all but childcare products was announced.27 In the following months, the company continued to receive letters like the one from Giessmannsdorf that described the family child, now seven, who had played with Nivea canisters his entire life. Not just young Dieter but the whole family looked forward to the return of this “indispensable household friend,” a phrase the family copied from prewar Nivea ads.28 Even then the Beiersdorf ads department, which still relied on the freelance expertise of Elly Heuss-Knapp, was lucky to be able to turn its attention to ads for another of its products, Hansaplast bandages, the production of which had doubled since 1938.29 Considered a “war-essential” item, Hansaplast ads were released under the brand name through 1945. When Heuss-Knapp was hired to write new Hansaplast ads in the summer of 1944, she tried to forgo the calls for conservation that had become ubiquitous since 1936. As she explained, “[T]he public today is downright angry, when so much is said about saving, and, really, no one uses Hansaplast



Ads amid Ashes

fig. 6.6. Drafts of classifieds for Hansaplast bandages, 1943. Courtesy of Beiersdorf AG, Hamburg.

unnecessarily.”30 The first drafts she submitted to Hamburg from her home in Heidelberg did not satisfy the company. Her drawings focused mostly on possible household accidents that would require bandages, but she also depicted accidents occurring in air-raid shelters, a scenario that was all but taboo in commercial imagery. Although her superiors at Beiersdorf did not specify these images as problematic, they did insist that “the ads should do more; they should be a useful contribution to the war effort. The goal of the war is victory, and the leadership within the propaganda ministry

239

240

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

wishes that the word ‘Sieg’ be integrated where possible.” Such direct intervention from Goebbels’s ministry or its underling the Werberat had remained extremely rare. The needs of “total war” were now more important. In other words, as in the shop floor propaganda of the war’s last stage, the few ads being produced also encouraged individuals to think about how their daily lives were bound to the outcome of the war. The Beiersdorf ads department suggested that Heuss-Knapp’s revisions include agricultural scenes and women working in armaments factories, since these newcomers more frequently suffered injuries owing to their lack of experience with the machinery. In other words, war-related injuries were acceptable, but

fig. 6.7. Tet brand biscuits, store window sign, 1942. Courtesy of Archiv der H. Bahlsen Keksfabrik KG, Hannover.



Ads amid Ashes

perhaps only those connected to active involvement in the struggle for victory, rather than passive scenes within homes and shelters. Heuss-Knapp was also reminded, surely unnecessarily, not to include images of wounded soldiers.31 Although this last period of the war is often chronicled as a time of severe food shortage, a limited number of ads continued to be produced even in this sector. The cookie manufacturer Bahlsen of Hannover was still trying to uphold its brand’s style, which had been noted for its abstract modernist aesthetic since the 1920s. The fact that Bahlsen was not criticized by the Werberat or any other official body, even though its artistic style could easily have been deemed “degenerate,” illustrates the relative independence that Aryan firms enjoyed in their advertising strategies. While it may also indicate a division in the minds of art watchdogs between high art and graphic art, scholars have shown that despite the closing of the Bauhaus in 1933, the school’s artistic styles and some of its artists continued to enjoy success in the years that followed.32 Business was good at Bahlsen—in May 1943 the company noted that current profits surpassed 1938, thanks largely to orders from the military.33 Managers even decided that a series of new posters should be readied to circulate in 1943. The owners of the barn facades, fences, and apartment buildings where the signs were to be hung were asked to send Bahlsen the invoices for the installation costs.34 In 1944 the company released a limited amount of promotional material, even though Bahlsen’s Leibniz Keks name had devolved to Union Keks. Looking at the packaging for the debranded Union Keks, we see again a strong resemblance to the former brand name favorite. While Bahlsen products were now available only on bread ration points and were supposed to be reserved for children and the infirm, the company continued to promote the brand as alive. The most common print ads of the late war years were the small “reminder” classifieds. These spartan text boxes were framed by dark borders and had no images except perhaps a company logo. They resembled in aesthetic form and textual content the other staple of the era’s print media: obituaries. Reminder ads were similar to obituaries in that both kinds of classifieds announced the absence of loved ones, be it a brand name product or family member, who had fallen in the war. Like obituaries, many of these ads offered sentiments of pride in the fatherland and the willingness to sacrifice. Both sets of classifieds often included verses that hinted at future resurrection (of the brand or soul). The unprecedented scale of mass death in the final stage of the war was not discussed publicly, but compa-

241

fig. 6.8. Abstract design on Tet packaging with bread ration stamp, ca. 1944. Courtesy of Archiv der H. Bahlsen Keksfabrik KG, Hannover.

fig. 6.9. Union-Keks in Leibniz Packaging, ca. 1944. Courtesy of Archiv der H. Bahlsen Keksfabrik KG, Hannover.

fig. 6.10. Maggi “reminder ad,” Der Markenartikel, 1943.

fig. 6.11.  Bayer “reminder ad,” 1943. Courtesy of Bayer Unternehmensarchiv, Leverkusen.



Ads amid Ashes

fig. 6.12.  Soldier’s obituary, 1944. Courtesy of Deutsches Historisches Museum, Berlin.

nies limited in their designs by resources and regulations were also striving to demonstrate that they too were victims of the destruction. Despite their efforts to maintain “normal” business practices, many companies found their advertising work complicated by the diverse and often illegal methods adopted by commercial actors in their struggle to survive. In the occupied east, the firm Georg Schicht maintained advertising offices in Aussig, Prague, and Pressburg (Bratislava today) to coordinate promotional efforts for the region well into the war years. These three bureaus, which undoubtedly had only small numbers of staff, carried on with regular contact to the Berlin office of Unilever’s advertising agency, Lintas. Yet underlying these “normal” business practices, there were some significant changes. At the end of 1941, corporate leaders in Aussig received a disturbing letter from their Vita Margarine subsidiary. The author from Vita reported that sales of Schicht soap products, both the “unity soap” and “soap powder,” were declining. The author of the Vita report believed that the drop could be explained by a number of factors. First, there was still some good quality soap available in stores, “not just the 40% fat, but

245

246

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

even 64%.” The existing stock was likely ordered in advance of rationing and held in reserve by shop owners until it became more valuable, which was the case by late 1941. Second, the letter added that many housewives were making their own soap out of collected fat residue, which was a more effective cleanser for some purposes than available substitutes. Third, he also explained that some shop owners had given up the sale of cleaning products out of fear of the “not always ethical procedures of the [rationing] administrators.” In some areas of the protectorate, selling rationed soaps and detergents was a dangerous trade and could lead to unfounded charges being laid by ambitious bureaucrats hoping to secure bribes or earn recognition from their superiors. Some retailers were making the decision that trading in these goods was not worth the anxiety of falling afoul of local administrators. A further problem driving shop owners away was the “package deal” scam. Some sales representatives, wholesalers, and even manufacturers would force retailers to buy goods they did not want in order to receive shipments of the ones they did. An order for candles, for example, would only be honored if the store owner also ordered that same firm’s cleaning products.35 Orders for shaving cream and other specialty items were often coupled this way with household cleansers. “What is even worse,” continued the report, were the entrepreneurial sales representatives who carted around their own homemade goods, such as “jam, cucumbers, and sweets,” and made the additional purchases of these items a further condition of orders for highly sought-after wares. “Ultimately, it was the wholesalers who make the distribution of all sorts of scarce commodities dependent on the sale of cleaning products, by which ours [Schicht products] fall to the back of the line”—perhaps because the local Schicht cleaners represented a smaller profit margin than brands from the Altreich. The despairing report ended with a quick look at the distribution center in Prague. The author pointed out that “at the moment [goods] with the name ‘Schicht’ are seldom seen” at the warehouse.36 This report offers a new take on the black market during the war years. While our image of such activities is often of individual barter and trade disconnected from legally sanctioned commerce, daily business life was also infused with such extralegal commercial behavior, which in some cases bordered on extortion and certainly generated fear among local retailers.37 By mid-1943, Schicht’s situation had changed dramatically again. The company admitted that sales visits were no longer practical, but did not rule out phoning customers to maintain contact.38 Vita Margarine, how-



Ads amid Ashes

ever, was still sending out sales representatives. The company was even helping employees with the cost of purchasing bicycles (if anyone could find one) to make travel possible; after all, Maggi and other consumer brands in the food sector were reportedly doing the same, and the desire to stay abreast of the competition remained strong.39 Henkel’s products were still on the market as well, and the Moravian Reisende noted “that there was no aversion [among customers] to [the German] ATA or Vim.”40 Not only did Schicht have to compete with such Reichsware, it was also required to send a certain percentage of its own goods westward into Germany’s pre1938 territory, in order to “avoid any unjust disadvantages.”41 Even while regular sales travel was becoming less feasible, new promotional efforts were still being planned. One report for 1944 referred to the new production of signs, classifieds, store posters, slides, and sound recordings for Slovakian territory.42 Attempts were also made to keep up the morale of those sales representatives still in the field. The company suggested that Schicht Reisende visit the manufacturing plant in Aussig to be reminded of “the solidarity of purpose and the will to victory,” which they could then pass on to their customers.43 In one tragic case, no one at Schicht seemed to recognize the inherent conflict between the “will to victory” and the company’s willingness to pay the salary of a traveling salesman imprisoned in a concentration camp. The company kept sending paychecks to the man’s wife after his arrest and deportation to Theresienstadt in 1942. By early 1943, Herr P. of Kladno, central Bohemia, had been transferred to Auschwitz. The company now faced two options: release him from employment at Schicht or keep him on unpaid leave. His margarine-selling colleagues pushed for the latter, “since deportation to Auschwitz was not to be taken as a sign of a conviction [for a crime], but should be seen instead as a form of compensation [to the state] or re-education.”44 By placing the man on unpaid leave, rather than firing him, his wife would have access to his pension, health insurance, and other benefits. It is hard to fathom the motivations behind this exchange. Is it really possible that Herr P.’s colleagues did not understand what his deportation to Auschwitz indicated in April 1943? Perhaps they did, which is why they were concerned to ensure that his wife retain his benefits as long as possible, now that she would be widowed. Regardless of their knowledge of their coworker’s fate, his colleagues were apparently able to differentiate between “solidarity of purpose,” as a business goal aimed at maintaining the brand and their jobs, and the “will to victory” of a racist regime. The financial fate of Salamander’s Jewish retailers was discussed in

247

248

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

Chapter 4. Once the Aryanization process was complete, the shoe giant’s long-time and newly minted Aryan shops continued to provide shoes to the consuming public in Germany. In early 1941, shoes were rationed: only the sick and elderly had access to slippers, pregnant women had the right to one new pair, uniformed men got boots and a pair of street shoes, and so on.45 One year later, further restrictions were issued, limiting the colors and styles produced, prohibiting all decorative appliques, and requiring the removal of company trademarks from the soles.46 As in other industries, 1942 was a turning point. By the end of the year, leather goods were no longer produced for the civilian market, and even members of the military witnessed the introduction of some imitation leather in their boots and other gear.47 Shoe sales at shops holding Salamander contracts did not decline radically, however, according to the inventory and sales records of the stores.48 Salamander continued to prioritize the needs of the armed forces through the end of the war, yet the Kornwestheim firm never produced more than 12 percent of the shoes made for the military during the war years. Between 1940 and 1944, Petra Bräutigam reports that Salamander increased its production of children’s shoes from 13.4 percent to 20 percent of total output.49 As scholars and eyewitnesses have reported, the quality of shoes deteriorated throughout the conflict. The chief problem was finding a replacement for leather or rubber soles that one could “offer to consumers in good conscience.”50 Looking at data for 1945, it is astonishing how productive Salamander continued to be despite these problems with resources. On 1 January 1945 the company held more than 600,000 pairs in warehouses throughout southwestern Germany. Between January and March alone, Salamander produced a further estimated 167,000 pairs.51 Ironically, these stockpiles of Salamander shoes would soon be reaching people who were considered by the regime to be far less deserving than civilian Germans. As American troops entered German territory from the south near Füssen, and French troops entered from the west around Stuttgart at the end of April 1945, both armies happened upon large storehouses of Salamander goods. Beginning on 21 April, French troops entered Kornwestheim, the home of Salamander’s headquarters, with requisition papers to enter the warehouse. While the French had permission to take 49,033 pairs, the company’s owners complained that more than 23,000 additional pairs went missing. Most of these, they suspected, were taken by “foreign workers” and local inhabitants who were not stopped, and perhaps were even aided, by the French soldiers. Though this plundering came to an end



Ads amid Ashes

on 7 May, when the Americans took control of the territory and, in the opinion of Salamander executives, set up better security than the French, the company was still trying to receive compensation in April 1947 from the district’s inquest office in Ludwigsburg for the estimated cost of the missing 23,000 pairs, or 255,799 RM.52 Though American troops restored order in Kornwestheim two days after capitulation, Salamander officials complained that the Americans had acted very differently when they entered Pfronten, south of Munich, a week earlier. On 30 April, according to the firm’s officials, two American soldiers, “led by a Pole,” had beaten the landlord who held the keys to the warehouse. Once it had been opened, most of the goods stored there were taken by “concentration camp inmates, who had been left in the midst of transport in the neighboring village of Kappel, as well as Russians, Serbs, and Frenchmen. Bit by bit, local inhabitants and evacuees also joined in . . . the emptying of the warehouse.”53 More than twenty-one thousand pairs of men’s and women’s shoes were taken.54 A black market was quickly established, though some of the shoes were also thrown onto a bonfire and others ended up in the nearby Vils River—an act of vandalism that must have seemed like a small measure of retribution to the liberated forced laborers and prisoners. The company blamed the local government and police for not providing adequate security. In the following weeks Salamander sent an emissary to the area with a statement about the stolen goods to be posted at milk stations and read to church congregations after Sunday services. The statement, which explained the “consequences of the unlawful possession of shoes from our warehouse,” must have evoked some remorse or fear among local inhabitants, because the company was able in this way to collect close to 50,000 RM, the cost of about four thousand pairs of shoes, by late June.55 Local residents’ honesty, however, did not pay off. Names of those who admitted having a pair of looted Salamander shoes in their possession were submitted to the local Wirtschaftsamt and subsequently lost their rights to ration points for shoe purchases.56 Despite Salamander’s desire to seek compensation for the losses suffered in the closing days of the war, capitulation led to an immediate windfall for the company. Between May and December 1945, Salamander sold close to 100,000 pairs of shoes, all of which were paid for at average prices from the late 1930s and early 1940s: 10–12 RM. Local civilian administrations were the firm’s first customers, purchasing shoes under orders of the occupying forces to care for former POWs, slave laborers, and camp inmates. In June, communities were still buying, but they appear to have begun

249

250

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

outfitting their own residents alongside the continual stream of refugees and displaced persons—the orders no longer specified camp names, such as the 100 pairs ordered for “KZ Dachau” on 23 May, or the 351 pairs for the “Yugoslavian Camp” in Bad Woerishofen three days later.57 The American occupiers seem to have taken only very small numbers for themselves, sometimes one pair at a time—perhaps as gifts for German women. The UN Relief and Rehabilitation Administration (UNRRA) did not directly purchase many pairs in these early weeks. By November Salamander had permission to begin supplying its old wholesale and retail network again, and business began to return to normal, at least in some regions of the country.58 Just as 1943 had brought new conditions for large consumer brands and other smaller firms, it was a pivotal year for Heinrich Hunke and his Werberat colleagues too. Travel became much more difficult and resources much more scarce. The Werberat’s offices on Unter den Linden were bombed in January, and the Reichswerbeschule was also completely destroyed by the Allies. That fall Hunke tried to celebrate the achievements of his office on its tenth anniversary. He was confident that advertising and marketing had secured their positions in the economy: “It is recognized as self-evident that sales and distribution are as important as production, that mass production requires the dependability of sales and therefore the direction of taste and consumption is required.” In fact, he added, “the modern economy cannot be imagined without advertising. What, for example, would a metropolis be without sumptuous shop windows, eye-catching posters and above all without light or lighted signs?” Yet he countered what seemed to be an emphasis on control with his insistence that his office had defended competition—that there had been no “nationalizing of the ads industry” and that “the content of ads remained free.” Always the optimist, Hunke noted that while the war had made a complete overhaul of the market impossible, the fundamentals of the Nazi vision had become so ingrained “in the consciousness of business people” that the unfinished work was offset by “the recognition of the goals.”59 According to the evidence offered in this book, Hunke was right. The business community had come to National Socialism largely on its own.60 In other words, whether professional ambition, profit-seeking, political affinity, or a mixture of the three best captures the motivations of actors within Germany’s commercial culture, consumer products companies, sales staffs, and advertisers were willing to embrace the goals of an advertising that reflected a new Germany at the head of a new Europe, offering a modern



Ads amid Ashes

message of consumer enlightenment and participation in the Volksgemeinschaft through consumption. In September 1943, Hunke published his most important article in Die Deutsche Volkswirtschaft under the title “The Central Questions of the Present Economic-Political Struggle,” also sometimes referred to in the scholarly literature as his “Ten Theses.”61 He began with answers to what he saw as the three burning economic issues of the day, including his favorite topic, “the economic order of the future.” And in dealing with them he arrived at the ten principles on which his vision of German and European political economy was based. Among the ten, he declared full employment and military readiness as goals of the future postvictory economy. He stressed again the need for the coordination but not the planning of the economy: “Lead, don’t manage!” [Führen, nicht verwalten!]. Entrepreneurial spirit and know-how must be safeguarded, and private property should find its rightful “moral and economic” place. Hunke rejected critics who declared German policies to be nothing more than “a claim to power or an attempt at exploitation.” In contrast, he insisted that the economic community of a Nazi-led Europe would strive only toward military and economic security. Trade beyond Europe was to continue and the goals of the new European community would be reached: “Security and the raising of living standards through our own strength and cooperation.”62 For Hunke, like other supporters of the regime, prosperity was dependent on German victory and expansion, because stabilization of the market could be assured only by the removal of the political threats that had become military targets: the Jews and the so-called British trade monopoly.63 Down to a skeletal staff in 1944, the Werberat and NSRDW soldiered on. No longer confident that Germany was the sole model for future economic organization, one author representing the Nazi professional association of advertisers commented that worldwide advertising had only become more competitive during the war. The Allied states and Germans were not only promoting their wares and services, they were presenting competing “visions of the future.”64 Despite such public rhetoric, companies that had survived somehow to 1945 were busy taking stock of what remained, and preferred a wait-andsee attitude about peacetime. Bahlsen, for example, became increasingly concerned about the state of its extensive outdoor signage. At the end of 1944, the publicity department compiled a list of more than 250 names of private individuals (as opposed to retailers) who hosted Bahlsen signs on their properties for a fee. The individuals were owed rent for these signs, but executives in Hanover wanted to know whether the signs still stood,

251

252

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

and in what condition, before paying. Company officials were also worried that damaged signs, if not removed, would reflect poorly on the brand’s image. As a result the company set out to compile a complete inventory of its outdoor promotional materials. Given the level of destruction, it took until 1949 for the company to produce a full picture of the situation.65 Bahlsen’s efforts illustrate the thinking of advertisers during the transition from war to peace. Since the regime never required companies to dismantle pre-existing outdoor advertising, companies had worked hard to maintain these ads as best they could during the conflict, often via any sales representative who was still able to get about on foot or bicycle. This was particularly true in 1945 when, even if virtually no new advertisements were being produced, the prospect of re-establishing “normal” buying and selling appeared close at hand. Immediate plans for business after the war, however, remained subdued.

advertising and commercial culture after nazism For many years, historians have grouped the years from 1943 until 1948 together, as characterized by worsening food shortages and widespread violence—first by the Nazi regime that carried out brutal acts of retribution for signs of “defeatism,” and then by the advancing victorious troops. According to this interpretation, the currency reforms and official statehood for West and East Germany that arrived at the end of the decade were the significant landmarks on the path to recovery. Until then, however, life in occupied Germany got worse before it got better. As Katherine Pence and others have demonstrated, women used a variety of strategies to secure necessary goods: they stood in long lines, traded on the black market, fraternized with soldiers, stole, and traveled to the countryside to trade with farmers (an illegal practice at the time).66 Richard Bessel reports that in 1947 it was estimated that 95 percent of the German population was trading in some fashion on the black market.67 In 1949, the foundation of the two states on the heels of currency reform ushered in a second stage of increased buying and selling, lasting until 1957 in the West. In this phase, the reconstruction efforts in the Federal Republic finally cleared a number of statistical hurdles. As Erica Carter reports, for example, it was not until “1952 that private consumption per capita of food, tobacco and alcohol reached pre-war levels.” However, West Germans would have to wait until the very



Ads amid Ashes

end of the 1950s to enter a third stage—marked by a period of great expansion in the consumer market, leading to the young state’s characterization as a “consumer wonderland.”68 The German Democratic Republic began its own separate trajectory in these years, marked by a growing interest in the consumer market after the unrest of 1953, yet growth was far slower than in the West, and rationing would stay in effect until 1958. The importance of these developments cannot be denied, but the scholarship has shifted in recent years, reinforcing the significance of 1945. With the end of the war, the regime that had encroached on so many aspects of individuals’ lives was gone, and the totality of the defeat was unmatched. As Bessel remarks, “Nineteen forty-five was a year of catastrophe and, as a result, it was also a year of new beginnings.”69 While there certainly was continuity in terms of individual consumption patterns from 1943 until 1948,70 the emphasis on “new beginnings” is most apt. The phrase recognizes change but does not rule out the possibility that Germans used their pasts to chart the future. In other words, the language of continuity versus discontinuity presents a false choice. At first, the new dawn of 1945 meant stitching back together a daily existence in the ruins. People in each of the four zones turned inward, shutting out the larger questions of responsibility and long-term planning. Material and psychological survival took center stage, which for most meant establishing a daily routine as quickly as possible. The official notices of available foodstuffs, clothing, and fuel posted by occupation forces served as the closest thing to new ads in the weeks following capitulation.71 Germany’s remaining Jews, who had been divested of their right to participate in the economy back in 1938, including the right to advertise their services and wares, were eager to restart their businesses as soon as possible. While at first the classified section of Berlin’s Jewish newspaper, Der Weg, was filled with ads placed by those seeking information about lost loved ones, Atina Grossmann reports that by mid-1946 survivors were beginning to advertise their services once again as shop owners and professionals. One orthopedist in the occupied capital reopened his practice with the simple slogan: “Back from Auschwitz.”72 Given the level of physical devastation, the speed with which businesses reopened is remarkable. All companies had to have permission from occupation authorities before getting back to work, but this was handled relatively smoothly, albeit differently in each of the three Western zones. By the end of 1945 the majority of companies that sought permission had been granted it. A surprising number of firms found that their machinery

253

254

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

still functioned. They could therefore begin production relatively quickly, if at lower capacities owing to limitations on fuel, labor, raw materials, and damages. Despite losing 60 percent of its production facilities to Allied bombings, Bahlsen in Hanover was completely still for only a few days, receiving permission from the Americans to bake as early as April 24.73 In Wolfsburg, the Volkswagen plant finally got to the long-awaited work of producing cars for individuals—more than eighteen hundred had rolled off the assembly line by December 1945. Some manufacturers of consumer products struggled to get going in part because the occupation forces prioritized the re-establishment of manufacturing that suited their needs: heavy industry to fuel rebuilding on the one hand and particular items needed by occupation soldiers, like beer, on the other. France and the Soviet Union, more than their British and American counterparts, prioritized their national economies in making decisions about occupation: the French zone sent 89 percent of all its exports to France, and the Soviet Union largely “deindustrialized” its zone by dismantling machinery for use in the USSR.74 Although private firms could apply for production permits in the Soviet zone as well, the occupier’s appropriation of wealth and property limited such activities. The introduction of the new Deutsche Mark in the western zones on 20 June 1948 reined in inflation and allowed for the dismantling of price controls, creating a more attractive market that encouraged manufacturers and retailers to expand their attempts to attract customers.75 By the summer of 1949, if not before, companies were looking to relaunch their brands through advertisements. In the west, Frankfurt am Main developed into the new business capital. From the Frankfurt headquarters of the venerable AEG, the corporate giant that had produced consumer electrical appliances among other related goods and services for more than sixty years, managers wrote to the firm’s branches announcing the official reopening of the company’s “Information- and Ad-service.” In setting the department’s mandate, company managers looked to a 1937 document for the most upto-date list of the office’s duties.76 There does not appear to have been any thought given to the appropriateness of returning to the practices of the late 1930s. Time was of the essence. Indeed, by November the sales department had begun to panic that AEG had re-entered the commercial fray too late—neon signs promoting brand-name goods were popping up all over the place, and the AEG electrical installations service was not getting the commissions. Steps needed to be taken immediately to rebuild partnerships with old leading brands. Headquarters instructed the Frankfurt office



Ads amid Ashes

to contact all the champagne [Sekt] firms and leather manufacturers such as Gold-Pfeil; managers in Cologne needed to reconnect with the makers of cologne [Kölnisch Wasser No. 4711]; AEG’s men in Düsseldorf needed to get in touch with Henkel; and in Munich sales visits to breweries were to be prioritized.77 Just days after the introduction of the Deutsche Mark in the west, a new currency was introduced in the Soviet zone as well. To facilitate the stabilization of the economy and the consumption of state-produced goods, an official advertising agency, the Deutsche Werbe- und Anzeigengesellschaft (DEWAG), was opened to promote individual products and socialist ideals.78 However, the nationalization of East German financial institutions and industry, which had been underway since 1945, meant that the reinvigoration of the consumer economy remained in the hands of the governing party and their Soviet backers, who did not prioritize this sector. Most bureaucrats who set out to build the socialist planned economy viewed product promotion as a remnant of capitalism. Although these misgivings never faded, the advertising industry in East Germany (GDR) benefited from the popular revolt of 1953. With more than 1 million citizens taking to the streets to protest in part the state’s failure to improve the standard of living, the governing Socialist Unity Party (SED) was forced to implement reforms in the consumer sector. From 1953 until 1976, advertising and marketing were common practices in the GDR. In this society that sought to demonstrate the superiority of socialism over capitalism, the purpose of advertising was to broadcast the availability of products after years of shortage, and convince customers that the goods on offer would meet their needs. The pyramids of canned goods and cascades of textiles that graced the shop windows of East Germany’s market squares served to advertise the achievements of state-owned production and the victory over severe crisis. Drawing attention to the end of what had been years of unrelenting scarcity did not mean that fantasy was removed from the equation entirely.79 GDR advertisers also put their own spin on dreams that were fairly common in capitalist societies in the mid-twentieth century: the ease of household labor through new appliances, the benefits of these devices for women in particular, and the attainment of good health and happiness through individual consumption.80 Just as ad departments in the west were reopened with almost exactly the same aims that had guided them in the prewar era, the look of printed advertisements in the early postwar years was also similar. The typography may have been updated, but as Jennifer Loehlin notes, ads for Sun-

255

256

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

licht in spring 1951 still showed a housewife in front of a washbasin full of suds, as opposed to the motorized washers that remained beyond the budgets of most families. The Sunlicht consumer still used bar soap for this manual labor. Though a brand-name product, the bar could not be sold packaged until six years after the declaration of peace because of lingering paper shortages. Fewa, too, was back on the market, and once again it was promoted as a practical cleanser that would not damage precious textiles. It was also marketed for its ability to clean furniture and windows.81 Even in the 1950s, as the choices became more varied, particularly in the Federal Republic, the advertiser’s address to female consumers remained similar. Erica Carter is surely right that “consumption as a form of labor regulated by specifically feminine rational forces was reinforced . . . by advertising . . . and other media.” Advertisers called on women to use their judgment in choosing products that would best improve their lives, the lives of their loved ones, and ultimately assist in the nation’s efforts to achieve prosperity.82 It was a formula that had been successful in the 1930s. In addition to practicality, which was a touchstone in the ads of both young German states, tradition was a major selling point in the Federal Republic. (In the GDR the overthrow of capitalism required a rejection not only of the Nazi era but also the bourgeois republic and monarchy before it.) By emphasizing that a certain brand had returned to market, representing the value and trust of many years of service in German households, bridges to the past could bypass the war. As a print ad for Nivea toothpaste declared in 1948, the product was not only “once again” available, it featured “peacetime quality”—a designation that referenced both the prewar and postwar contexts. The advertisement’s stark Bauhaus-inspired design provided a powerful juxtaposition to the emotionally laden text, capturing both the present-day return of the product and potential nostalgia for the prewar era. In February 1950, AEG’s ad department reminded employees that brand image was crucial for the company’s future, even though a number of AEG manufacturing sites had been appropriated by the Soviets, the firm still lacked personnel in advertising, and few Germans could yet afford household appliances. In such circumstances, AEG relied on its “decades-old global reputation.” The tendency among some in the company to hold up 1938 as the pinnacle of the firm’s development was a “fallacy,” declared the report’s author, Hermann Lanzke. There was much more to be celebrated publicly in AEG’s past and in its present. From “the classical period” of 1890–1913, there was Peter Behrens’s industrial design, and the company’s



Ads amid Ashes

fig. 6.13.  Peace time quality at Nivea, 1948. Courtesy of Beiersdorf, AG, Hamburg.

internationally recognized leadership in training and social service initiatives for employees. Great strides had also been made since 1945 in the firm’s reconstruction efforts. Lanzke argued that more attention should be lavished on these means of “quiet advertising,” which would not replace standard forms of advertising but should be coupled with print ads and slides (films were too expensive) in the current climate to champion AEG’s achievements.83 Eight months later, company directors breathed a sigh of relief that “the period since the currency reform has proven that the brandname companies whose reputations have a long resonance among the public have quickly returned to the top rung.”84 If companies made a relatively smooth transition to peacetime with regard to their public images, does this mean that there was no significant link between successful consumer brands and National Socialism? If we look at brands like Mercedes-Benz automobiles, it is irrefutable that the images presented in advertisements were those of support for the regime and its policies. So how is it that this company could use almost identical imagery and text in the postwar period and avoid being labeled as a rogue company that had not made the transition to the “free world?” To some extent the answer lies in the Cold War mentality that accepted remnants

257

fig. 6.14.  “Your lucky star upon every street.” Mercedes-Benz ad, 1930s (left) and 1950s (right). Both images courtesy of Mercedes-Benz Classic Archive, Daimler AG, Stuttgart.



Ads amid Ashes

of National Socialism in the Federal Republic, and allowed continuity of personnel in the private and public sectors, as long as those institutions appeared to help defend against the threat posed by the Soviet bloc. By definition all capitalist ventures fit the bill. Another explanation for advertising’s successful transition was that the Nazi period had not fundamentally challenged the status afforded to brand-name goods. Instead, Germans were “enticed” with modest gains, coupled with greater leisure opportunities before 1939 and far-reaching promises of future material abundance. The brand names discussed in this book all existed before 1933, and consumers had long memories of using these products. While businesses owned by German Jews were forcibly sold or pushed into ruin, buying and selling as activities were upheld as valuable to society. Moreover, because so many consumer products became unavailable or were replaced by imitations during the latter phase of the war, consumers were able to dissociate these brands from the most brutal years of the dictatorship. Indeed the state was blamed for failing to provide these well-known “household friends” or make possible the expansion of consumption as it had promised.85 If the companies representing these brands were able to divest themselves of any wrongdoing or collaboration (at least for a time), what about advertising itself? Is it also true that advertising as a profession emerged in the postwar period unscathed by its reorganization under the Propaganda Ministry? Apparently so. The decision by Goebbels and others to keep some separation between the worlds of political propaganda and commercial advertising, as discussed earlier, paid off for advertising immensely after the war. Germans entered the postwar period highly skeptical of political campaign ads and slogans that appeared to embrace the Nazi penchant for emotionally stimulating text and arresting imagery.86 Promotional efforts for commercial goods did not face the same suspicions. Just weeks after the currency reform, Christian Kupferberg wrote in Die Graphik that with the “disappearance of the Werberat and its rules for all areas of advertising that it touched, new commercial circumstances developed.” The new situation was not characterized as liberating or offering the potential for greater creativity. Rather, Kupferberg bemoaned the fact that many of the old bugbears of the industry had quickly returned, including the lack of uniformity in sizing and pricing and opaque circulation figures for print media. “It became ever clearer,” he declared, “that the German advertising industry could not thrive in such an untrustworthy and fragmented form.” While Kupferberg and his colleagues decided not to establish a successor to the

259

260

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

Werberat per se, the work done between 1933 and 1945 represented positive reform to many commercial actors in the quest for fair representation of a product’s worth.87 After 1945 advertisers proudly claimed their prior support for or participation in Werberat campaigns and were welcomed into the newly formed West German advertisers’ association.88 The Reichswerbeschule also retained a positive image in the postwar era. The onset of the war had left the plans for expansion unrealized, and the school that had been in operation in Berlin since 1936 was destroyed by Allied bombing raids in 1943. Yet it appears that the school’s reputation remained strong among those who worked in the industry. One early postwar chronicler of advertising and marketing in the new Federal Republic held up the Reichswerbeschule as an important achievement that “enjoyed an excellent reputation.”89 An industry handbook from the early 1950s also lauded the Reichswerbeschule as a unique institution that had prepared more than seven thousand students to work in the field by the end of 1940. A smaller version of the school had opened in Berlin-Friedenau soon after the war ended, but the Berliner Werbefachschule was a disappointment. “Out of the rubble so far [nothing comparable to the Reichswerbeschule] in physical or pedagogical terms had been erected.”90 Hunke, too, rapidly reintegrated into the West German public sector, serving in Lower Saxony’s Landtag and as assistant secretary in the state’s finance ministry from 1955 until 1967, when he retired.91 Happily, the Germany and Europe that emerged after 1945 were not as Hunke had imagined, and yet the transnational quality to his vision, in particular, is startling in its perspicacity. A European bloc anchored by the West German economy did emerge as a counterbalance to American dominance. Therefore, the connections between Nazi economic plans and postwar integration and prosperity were not limited to Nazi investment in heavy industry. Strategies used during the Third Reich to market German goods, and many of the people who had employed those methods, made the transition to the postwar era. It is not surprising that the architect of the Social Market Economy, Ludwig Erhard, spent the National Socialist years at the Society of Consumer Research.92 As West Germans “pushed [politics] to the sidelines,”93 the economy took center stage—in part, because commercial actors during the Third Reich had made a convincing case for the social value of individual consumption. The influence of those who worked to build brand names and reform advertising after 1933, and keep individual consumption alive after 1939, helped prepare Germany for prosperity in the postwar era and promoted the concept of a “new Europe.”94



Ads amid Ashes

conclusion German advertising adapted and survived through three decades of societal turmoil and dramatic political upheaval. The changing commercial landscape in 1920s Germany inspired a range of reactions. While some advertising professionals sought closer ties with their American counterparts, others recognized an affinity between the new, psychologically sensitive marketing strategies and the powerful propaganda of the NSDAP, which was winning praise even from its political adversaries. Many of these individuals became enthusiastic about the Nazi movement and were willing to believe the party’s promises to value and promote advertising in the new Germany. Most practitioners believed that advertising deserved to be seen as a key tool in the sought-after recovery from the Depression, and as a “profession” worthy of that designation. Early NSDAP supporters within the industry, however, saw the party’s plans to rid the industry of what was coded as “foreign influence” on style and business practices as the best chance of achieving legitimacy for their field. The coordination of the industry in the mid-1930s under the auspices of the Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft and the Nazi professional association for advertisers (NSRDW) meant that very little outside censorship was needed in the years that followed. The companies and independent ad executives who went along with this process were allowed a certain level of freedom in terms of ad content and style. The Werberat had practical reasons for not intervening in matters of design, such as the desire to maintain profits by supporting companies that promoted their goods successfully. A “reformed” ad industry made it possible to defend advertising from critics within the party—those who believed it was unnecessary or, even worse, symbolic of the Jewish capitalist conspiracy to weaken Germany via (in this case) hedonistic consumption. And yet the Werberat should not be seen solely as a voice for business. As spelled out by its mandate, the Werberat hovered between the private sector and the Propaganda Ministry. Its funding came via a tax on those who placed ads, but its authority emanated from Joseph Goebbels. The minister of propaganda was clear that individual consumption had its place in Nazi Germany, and therefore so did advertisers. In the end, as scholars have identified in other cultural venues, including architecture, fashion, and film, what emerged was a melange of aesthetic styles and forms, from Bauhaus-modern to the return of Gothic script.

261

262

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

The ease with which some companies and their brands made the transition to the new era depended on a variety of factors: the company’s racial profile, the types of products it promoted, the strengths of its links to the export market, the business model it followed, and the image of the company established before 1933. These were complex issues. Beiersdorf was not considered Aryan in 1933, but state ministers defended the company from rivals, who hoped to boycott its products even after Aryan restructuring, because it was such a profitable and popular firm. The “Nivea style” was first crafted in the 1920s under the company’s Jewish leadership, and yet it became well known for its images of natural German beauty, and was easily adopted as a model to be emulated in the Third Reich.95 The light bulb manufacturer Osram was quick to show how its products suited the new Germany and state-sanctioned projects to increase electrification of homes and businesses throughout the country. Its advertisers also made a convincing case for the ability of electric light to reduce waste, increase productivity, and improve the health of the Volk by reducing eye strain and workplace accidents. These and other examples demonstrate that beyond the limits of “virtual consumption,” in which images of plenty were offered as the fruit of a future military victory, some companies presented relatively low-cost ways for German consumers to participate immediately in the Volksgemeinschaft. German corporate managers wanted to attract shoppers and maintain their loyalty, but they also recognized that an essential way to inspire such attachment among female consumers was to show some respect for women as rational shoppers. The misogyny of the regime does not seem to have interrupted the general trend in this direction seen in all Western societies. This does not mean that advertisers, managers, or sales reps were feminists, or that they admired women’s hard work in budgeting, planning, and shopping for their families. But it is apparent that those who worked within consumer products industries viewed female consumers as vital actors in the economy, and did not generally see women as irrational or easy to manipulate. Steps taken to reach out to women in these years were partly the result of an increasingly competitive marketplace. In the first years of the dictatorship, consumer spending power was still reeling from the Depression. In the second half of the decade, despite attempts by the government to dampen wage increases, Germans had more cash to spend. And yet now the pressure on companies to stay competitive came from shortages and the rising prices of imports connected to the prioritization of



Ads amid Ashes

war preparedness. Sustaining brand loyalty was seen as an essential way to weather the difficult times. Class remained a visual touchstone in German advertising, but it was overwritten by race after 1933. Race, not class, was to be the determinant of taste and standards of quality. Female consumers were addressed in promotional materials as “German” women, and were usually differentiated only as either mothers/housewives or wage-earning women. The skin cream that kept a German housewife’s hands soft after doing the dishes was also appealing to German female assembly line workers, typists, and farmer’s wives. Luxury items did not disappear from the marketplace, but many brands tried to project an image that was less conspicuously wealthy. Achieving this ideal was never fully realized, however. Ultimately, the visual representation of class(lessness) by German advertisers represented a picture of Nazi society that was different, yet just as inaccurate, as the representation of the United States (beloved by American advertisers) as home only to white middle-class consumers. Like advertisers, many people in other sales-related professions saw the emergence of the Third Reich as offering potentially greater social status. The extent to which this opportunity could include direct participation in the Aryanization of the economy becomes clear when we look at the case of Salamander shoes. Though Salamander was a leading manufacturer and retailer of shoes in Germany, it felt hobbled by Jewish controlling interests, contracts with Jewish shop owners, and its chain-store business strategy that, while hugely profitable, appeared to some Germans to be a destructive form of capitalism. By examining the correspondence between Salamander’s sales representatives and corporate headquarters, we can track the strategies employed to disassociate the company from these retailers while still holding on to the company’s healthy share of the market. Though only one case study, this part of the story reminds us of the day-to-day calculations made by companies about when and how to cut ties with their Jewish colleagues, while minimizing the financial damage to their own brands and bottom lines. It also demonstrates how readily some “ordinary Germans” colluded in the divestment of Jewish property. The onset of war introduced the most formidable challenges to those working in the consumer goods sector. For some time advocates in the business world and the Ad Council successfully defeated attempts to halt all advertising as a nonessential service. Advertisers insisted that ads had a role to play at home: educating consumers about living with wartime sacrifice,

263

264

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

maintaining some level of normality in the visual landscape, providing employment, and keeping brand names alive in preparation for a peaceful and prosperous future. Although the manufacturers of consumer goods often did not produce items counted as war materiel, there were some formal links forged between the state and business owners in the early war years, such as the massive partnership between the major soap and detergent producers (Henkel and Sunlicht) and the government from 1938 through 1944. While the regime insisted that female consumers learn to conserve detergent and make better use of ersatz cleaners in order to uphold racial ideals of cleanliness, the participating firms happily joined in and used the campaign to preserve their own status in the consumer imagination, despite complaints from corporate rivals and state officials that they had selfish rather than national goals at heart. The fact that scholars have traditionally focused on the regime’s lack of attention to consumer goods manufacturers, especially after 1936, indirectly lends credence to Götz Aly’s claims that the looting of the occupied territories kept German housewives relatively comfortable during the war.96 His analysis of the war years builds on his portrayal of the Nazi regime before 1939 as a “welfare state” that generated support for its racist vision by showering Aryans with material rewards. This book does not counter his claims about the extent of the larceny of Jewish-owned property, or the fleecing of the coffers of occupied states, which also plays a central role in Mark Mazower’s recent study of the empire.97 Nor does it diverge widely from Aly’s discussion of the optimism that many Aryans felt about their own material circumstances leading up to the war. This book does complicate matters, however, by emphasizing the role German manufacturers played in the prewar years in building support for the regime, and in maintaining that support after the onset of war.98 We should not underestimate the trust and affection that had developed between some consumers and their favorite brands.99 The ever-present ad culture, which cast the Third Reich in a positive light and the war effort as a sacred duty to sustain it, may have held more power of persuasion among Germans than state or party propaganda. Brands represented local employers, industrial families of high esteem, decades of reliability, and intimate dream-making. Indeed, one could argue that the public face of a company like Henkel was one of the few stable visual cues for Germans across the decades of political and economic upheaval of the early twentieth century. Moreover, the Titans behind German brands modeled the sort of entrepreneurial leadership qualities that the regime too glorified. It should not be surprising, then, that corporate



Ads amid Ashes

support for Hitler’s government and war would go far in strengthening public consensus. Though most of the 1940s were marked by severe want among German consumers, already in 1945 corporations were motivated to get their manufacturing sites running and their sales staffs working as soon as possible. By the end of the decade, and steadily through the following decade, consumer items became more available, more varied, and more affordable. By the end of the 1950s, citizens of the Federal Republic would be living in a mass consumer society, as defined in the Introduction. Despite the nationalization of industry and the heavy reparations exacted by the Soviets in their zone of occupation, advertising also rebounded in the German Democratic Republic, particularly after the 1953 uprising. In the West, a professional association of advertisers was re-established, and ad agencies from the United States and Britain once again made Germany a site for branch offices. In the East an official advertising office was founded to manage the consumption of goods and support the government’s economic plans. Even though Joseph Goebbels’s Propaganda Ministry had had authority over the Nazi Ad Council throughout its existence, advertisers in the postwar period emerged from the war relatively unscathed by their links to the powerful propaganda apparatus of the Third Reich. The Ad Council and advertisers more generally were thought to have conducted largely positive reform of the industry after 1933. Advertisers were able to continue their careers successfully after 1945, and brand names that had connections to the Nazi state, such as Persil and BMW, did not suffer from these earlier relationships. Indeed the search for a usable past in the postwar period led to the revival of trusted brands and imagery that reminded Germans of the prewar peace (both before and after 1933). It seems that most German consumers in these decades, like their counterparts elsewhere, continued to believe that companies had their best interests at heart. According to this thinking, the fantasies proffered by commercial advertisements could not by definition be as manipulative as political propaganda. This is not to say that modern consumers in Western democratic states or dictatorships have been delusional. Rather it is evidence that the confidence placed by individuals in their identities as economic subjects had by the interwar period begun to challenge their confidence as political subjects. The realities of the Nazi dictatorship and the war it brought to the world tipped the scales in favor of identity-formation through consumption. In West Germany, the consumer-citizen would emerge triumphant. In East Germany, politi-

265

266

Preparing for Victory and Surviving Defeat

cal leaders sought to harness the energies of the consumer to a new political project. It too eventually collapsed in favor of a society in which buyers and sellers could engage with each other more directly. Throughout the twentieth century, therefore, the role played by advertising as the language that mediates these relationships grew ever more significant. Since 1945, political discourses have been left to play catch up.

reference matter

Notes

abbreviations AAS Das historische Archiv der Axel Springer Verlag AG, Berlin ABK Archiv der H. Bahlsen Keksfabrik KG, Hannover AU Auto Union BAB Bundesarchiv Deutschland, Berlin-Lichterfelde Böhme Fettchemie BFC Berliner Illustrierte Werbung BIZ BMW BMW Group Archiv, Munich BU Bayer Unternehmensarchiv, Leverkusen DAF German Labor Front DAG Mercedes-Benz Classic Archive, Daimler AG, Stuttgart Die Deutsche Volkswirtschaft DDV DHMD Deutsches Hygiene-Museum, Dresden DTM Stiftung Deutsches Technikmuseum, Berlin DUHC Duke University Special Collections Hartman Collection, Durham, NC DW Die Deutsche Werbung EHK Elly Heuss-Knapp HAT History of Advertising Trust, Raveningham, Norwich (UK) Henkel Coporate Archive, Konzenarchiv Henkel AG & Co. KGaA, Düsseldorf JWT J. Walter Thompson advertising agency Kraft Foods Deutschland GmbH, Bremen KFD LAB Landesarchiv Berlin LNW Landesarchiv Nordrhein-Westfalen, Abteilung Ostwestfalen-Lippe, Detmold NARA U.S. National Archives, College Park, MD WBW Wirtschaftsarchiv Baden-Württemberg, Hohenheim

270

Notes to the Introduction

introduction 1. Former German chancellor Hans Luther, “Introduction” in Knapp, ed., Reklame, Propaganda, Werbung, 3. 2. Kroen, “A Political History of the Consumer,” 726. 3. As Sheryl Kroen has noted, historians of North America and Western Europe have demonstrated that consumers became politically empowered in the last decades of the nineteenth and first decades of the twentieth centuries, giving birth to the “consumer citizen.” Ibid., 709–36. 4. For a case study, see Baranowski, Strength through Joy. On the current state of the debate about Volksgemeinschaft, see Schmiechen-Ackermann, ed., Volksgemeinschaft. 5. Berghoff, “Methoden der Verbrauchslenkung im Nationalsozialismus,” 281– 316. See also König, Volkswagen, Volksempfänger, Volksgemeinschaft. 6. Betts, The Authority of Everyday Objects, 49. 7. Geyer, “The Stigma of Violence,” 75–110, here 102. Quoted also in Bavaj, Die Ambivalenz der Moderne im Nationalsozialismus, 71. 8. Before consumption became a mass phenomenon, the upper middle classes in Wilhelmine Germany were already struggling with this ambivalence. See Breckman, “Disciplining Consumption,” 485–505. 9. Brewer, “Was können wir aus der Geschichte der frühen Neuzeit für die moderne Konsumgesellschaft lernen?” 52–56. Brewer’s definition is cited in Kleinschmidt, “Comparative Consumer Product Testing in Germany,” 108. Kleinschmidt brings up the importance of consumer durables on the following pages. Another fine introduction to the topic is König, Geschichte der Konsumgesellschaft. 10. For discussion of the impact of various forms of shopping on credit in the 1920s, see Torp, Konsum und Politik in der Weimarer Republik, 292–313. For a handy review of the literature on consumption in Germany, see Dingel, “Consumption in Nineteenth- and Twentieth-Century Germany,” 247–56. 11. There is a lively debate on these issues. For a thoughtful overview of the literature, see Bavaj, Die Ambivalenz der Moderne im Nationalsozialismus, 57–81. 12. Tooze, The Wages of Destruction. 13. Ritschl, “Hat das Dritte Reich wirklich eine ordentliche Beschäftigungspolitik betrieben?” 125–40. 14. Ibid., 139. 15. For one example, see Abelshauser, “Germany,” 122–24 and 169. 16. Oral histories have shown that the second half of the 1930s and early 1940s were often remembered fondly in comparison with the Weimar instability that preceded it and the defeat and occupation that followed. Herbert, “Die guten und die schlechten Zeiten,” 67–96. Niethammer’s findings are echoed in the more recent Kohut, A German Generation, for example, 106–7. S. Jonathan Wiesen makes the argument that these fond memories extended to the world of consumer goods; see Wiesen, “Driving, Shopping, and Smoking,” 19–38. Peter Fritzsche discusses the emerging sense of optimism that was cultivated by the state and consumed by many of its citizens in the prewar years. See Fritzsche, Life and Death in the Third Reich, 56–65. Werner Abelshauser also emphasizes the importance of the “all-too-vivid



Notes to the Introduction

memories of conditions during the Depression.” He notes that 1938 levels of meat consumption per head, for example, may have been still lower than 1929 levels, but conditions were largely accepted by the population as a sign of improvement over the pre-Hitler years. “The blessing of a low starting point in the Depression,” notes Abelshauser, therefore “generally served the goals of the Four-Year Plan.” Abelshauser, “Germany,” 147. 17. Steiner, “Von der Preisüberwachung zur staatlichen Preisbildung” in Steiner, ed., Preispolitik und Lebensstandard, 82–85. Overy relies on the same data as Steiner and adds that real income did not achieve pre-Depression levels until 1941. See Overy, The Nazi Economic Recovery, 31. Mallmann and Paul also stress the importance of stability in the employment sector and slowly increasing wages, though coupled with longer hours. Mallmann and Paul, Herrschaft und Alltag, 57–64. 18. From the nadir of the Depression, the manufacture of consumer products grew steadily but did not surpass the precrisis highpoint of 1928 until 1937. Although rates of production continued to climb into the war years, about half of the output was siphoned off by the military. See Table 4.2 in Abelshauser, “Germany,” 125, and analysis on p. 152. However, in the prewar period sales of beauty products, for example, did well in this era. Inexpensive radios were also popular, with rates of ownership only low in comparison to the United States and the UK, according to Corey Ross, Media and the Making of Modern Germany. Hartmut Berghoff ’s study of the Hohner harmonica firm also sheds light on consumer goods industries in this era: Berghoff, Zwischen Kleinstadt und Weltmarkt. Baranowski’s study of Strength through Joy’s travel program has also shown the enjoyment found in the increased consumption of holiday travel in the Third Reich. Baranowski, Strength through Joy. 19. Throughout this book the Nazi definition of the term “Aryan” is used, which distinguished between those included in the racist Nazi utopia and those excluded from it (non-Aryans). 20. This definition of commercial culture comes from Confino and Koshar, “Regimes of Consumer Culture,” 135–61, here 141. 21. Some early thoughts about how to use advertising and advertisers as part of a history of mentalities can be found in Gries, Ilgen, and Schindelbeck, “Ins Gehirn der Masse Kriechen!” See also the dissertation by Hirt, Verkannte Propheten? 22. Within a sizable historiography, key texts are Marchand, Advertising the American Dream; and Lears, Fables of Abundance. 23. Indeed, the best monographs have been written about the Wilhelmine period: Ciarlo, Advertising Empire; and Lamberty, Reklame in Deutschland. Dirk Reinhardt’s study covers the first half of the twentieth century, but is strongest on the earlier decades, Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing. For forays into the twentieth century, see Borscheid and Wischermann, eds., Bilderwelt des Alltags; and Swett, Wiesen, and Zatlin, eds., Selling Modernity. Interestingly, art historians have recognized the importance of these decades for German graphic art. See Aynsley, Graphic Design in Germany; Cabarga, Progressive German Graphics; and Westfälisches Landesmuseum für Kunst und Kulturgeschichte Münster, Die Nützlische Moderne. 24. There is, of course, a massive literature on propaganda in Germany. Although the word “propaganda” was at times used to refer to product promotion,

271

272

Notes to the Introduction especially in the decades preceding 1933, in this book I do not use the words interchangeably. This study argues that advertising, and sales more generally, were infused with the ideology of the regime, and did some of the same work in terms of meaning production as state and party propaganda. However, because these commercial efforts were undertaken by actors within the private sector and were most immediately motivated by the desire for profit, I believe that we should keep the two concepts separate, while remaining aware of overlap. Indeed Bernd Sösemann points out that Hitler and Goebbels were keen to differentiate between political propaganda and economic advertising. See Sösemann, “Propaganda and Öffentlichkeit in der ‘Volksgemeinschaft,’ ” 114–54, here 124. Others have followed this same tack, omitting discussions of advertising from their own work on propaganda, even when they include the arts that were more closely monitored by Goebbels’s Reichskulturkammer. See, for example, Reichel, Der schöne Schein des dritten Reiches; and Welch, The Third Reich. The two forms of persuasion do often appear together in studies of the media; see Reuveni, Reading Germany; and Ross, Media and the Making of Modern Germany. For an assessment of Nazi propaganda that challenges its persuasive powers, see Mallmann and Paul, Herrschaft und Alltag, 339–44. 25. Compare Heßler, “Mrs. Modern Woman,” 150–55. Heßler comments on some of the same challenges to using advertisements. 26. Ciarlo, Advertising Empire, 16–17. 27. For a recent view about working with German corporate archives, see Kobrak and Schneider, “Varieties of Business History,” 401–24. 28. Retailers play an indirect role in this study. For a thorough treatment of this sector in an earlier period, see Spiekermann, Basis der Konsumgesellschaft. 29. Much of the secondary literature on advertising culture revolves around the same brands. See, for example, Seidel, MarkenWaren. 30. In his discussion of late nineteenth-century advertising, David Ciarlo notes that “countless images were not only imitated but stolen outright.” Advertising Empire, 192. 31. Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace, 89. 32. See further Bavaj, Die Ambivalenz der Moderne im Nationalsozialismus, 57–81. See also Fritzsche, Life and Death in the Third Reich. 33. Atikah brand advertisement quoted in Sösemann, “Propaganda and Öffentlichkeit in der ‘Volksgemeinschaft,’ ” 130. 34. See the diverse topics covered in Schmiechen-Ackermann, ed., Volksgemeinschaft. 35. Connelly, “The Uses of Volksgemeinschaft,” 899–930, here 928. For a similar argument about the power of ideology, see Joe Perry on “Nazi Christmas.” He explains that the existence of particular cultural practices around the holiday during the Third Reich should not be discounted as manipulation or just a “beautiful illusion that lacked popular legitimation. . . . As Germans participated in Nazified public rituals and private celebrations, they built the racial state in degrees, from the bottom up.” Perry, Christmas in Germany, 193. 36. De Grazia, Irresistible Empire. 37. Ross, Media and the Making of Modern Germany.



Notes to the Introduction and Chapter One

38. Ruecker, Wirtschaftswerbung unter dem Nationalsozialismus; Swett, “Preparing for Victory”; and Westphal, Werbung im Dritten Reich. 39. For example, see ch. 4 of Neve, Sold! 40. Compare Lüdtke, “The ‘Honor of Labor,’ ” 67–109. 41. Buerkle, “Gendered Spectatorship,” 625–36, here 631. 42. Ciarlo, Advertising Empire.

chapter 1 1. Slogan of the Deutscher Reklametag, Berlin, 19–20 Mar. 1932. 2. Kropff, Psychologie in der Reklame als Hilfe zur Bestgestaltung des Entwurfs, 1. 3. There is significant overlap between Kropff ’s analysis and other works that discuss advertising and psychology in this era. For example, see König, Psychologie der Werbung; and Paneth, Grundriss der kaufmännischen Reklame und Reklamerechts in Deutschland und Österreich, 5–20. Paneth is extrapolating from Wundt, Grundriß der Psychologie. 4. Reichel, Der Schöne Schein des Dritten Reiches. 5. Kropff was an ardent supporter of National Socialism. He taught at universities in a number of cities before taking up a position in Vienna in 1936. He remained there until he was removed from office in 1945. For more on the debate about professionalism, see, among others, Schug, “Das Ende der Hochkultur?” 503–29. 6. Fritzsche, “Nazi Modern,” 1–22, here 7. 7. See Zwahr, Bentele, and Topstedt, eds., Leipzigs Messen. 8. De Grazia, Irresistible Empire, 189. 9. Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 33. 10. Schug, “Innovation und Kundenorientierung,” 216. 11. For a contemporary view of the daily tasks of a German advertiser, see Weidenmüller, “Der Tageslauf des Werbemannes,” 66–68. 12. Schug, “Innovation und Kundenorientierung,” 217–20. 13. One reason this antiadvertising tradition continued to have adherents in Germany is that some of the lions of German industry had been outspoken in this regard. In 1876, Werner Siemens had written famously that any attempt to prepare the market for a new product from his company was a ‘scandal.’ Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 25. 14. De Grazia, Irresistible Empire, 106. The same stagnation of income levels can be noted for France and Italy. 15. This was particularly true around 1900 when only the youngest adults had grown up with the illustrated magazines and were comfortable with new forms of commerce. See Lamberty, Reklame in Deutschland, 311. 16. Kästner, Fabian, 7 and 29. 17. See, for example, Lamberty’s discussion of the early participation of women in advertising: Reklame in Deutschland, 295–307. 18. Wolff, “Mit der Kundschaft mitgehen,” 108. 19. Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 91–95. 20. Ibid., 83.

273

274

Notes to Chapter One 21. Lamberty, Reklame in Deutschland, 431–43. Such anti-Semitism was not a German-only phenomenon. Walter Friedman notes that American Jews were still limited in their occupation status to work as peddlers rather than traveling salesmen at the dawn of the twentieth century—the higher status of the traveling salesman was typically reserved for white Protestant men. See Friedman, Birth of a Salesman, 60. 22. Sombart, The Jews and Modern Capitalism, 138–39ff. For an exploratory essay that discusses this connection between Jews from the East making their way to German cities and fortunes as department store owners, see Lerner, “Circulation and Representation,” 395–413. 23. Christian A. Kupferberg, “Vom Lehrling zum Betriebsführer,” Bote aus dem Kupferberg (1942): 9. 24. Kupferberg, Das Wissenschaftliche in der Reklame, 68. 25. Ibid., 73. 26. Christian A. Kupferberg, “Eigenart, Auffälligkeit, Geschmak,” Das Plakat (Nov./Dec. 1921): 653. 27. See Reuveni, Reading Germany, 130–33. 28. Ward, Weimar Surfaces, 102–3. 29. Christian A. Kupferberg, “Kundenwerber und Werbe-Hochflut,” Das Plakat (Nov./Dec. 1921): 655. 30. Schwarzkopf, “Kontrolle statt Rausch?” 198–99. 31. These concerns about commerce were not, of course, found in Germany alone. See Michael Miller’s classic study about French reactions to the emergence of department stores, The Bon Marché; and more generally on the establishment of a mass culture in Germany’s urban spaces, Fritzsche, Reading Berlin 1900. For more on the debates about the effects of retail shopping on culture and society, see Briesen, Warenhaus, Massenkonsum und Sozialmoral. 32. Lerner, “Consuming Pathologies,” 45–56. Others have written about related topics. See, for example, Ward, Weimar Surfaces; and Breckman, “Disciplining Consumption,” 492. 33. Christian A. Kupferberg, “Kundenwerber und Werbe-Hochflut,” Das Plakat (Nov./Dec. 1921): 655. Compare Borscheid, Das Tempo-Virus, 320–26. 34. The national Heimatschutz association was founded in 1904, serving as the umbrella group for numerous organizations that had emerged throughout the country during the previous two decades. Unlike other preservation societies sprouting up simultaneously in other countries, the German movement wanted to create a harmonious relationship with nature, rather than nature preserves separate from human intrusion. Compare Rollins, “Whose Landscape?” 494–520, here 501. See also Lamberty, Reklame in Deutschland, 456–77; and Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 378–83. For more on Heimatschutz and its role more generally in bolstering the Volksgemeinschaft, see Speitkamp, “Denkmalpflege und Heimatschutz,” 149–93. 35. Lekan, “A Noble Prospect,” 826–27. 36. Behme, Reklame und Heimatbild, 36. 37. Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 382–83. William Rollins takes another view. He argues that the Heimatschutzler of the Weimar era came to see the



Notes to Chapter One

republican government as an enemy of the increasing incorporation of racist discourse into the movement’s philosophy. At the same time, Rollins warns of assuming all Heimatschutz activists became ardent Nazis. See Rollins, A Greener Vision of Home, 262. 38. For examples of the various local measures taken to limit the presence of advertisements in the first three decades of the twentieth century in Germany and elsewhere, see Behme, Reklame und Heimatbild, 72–90. 39. Stresemann was writing in 1900. For more on ads as a medium of communication associated with the metropolis, see Lamberty, Reklame in Deutschland, 37–43, here 41. For the Weimar era, see Ward, Weimar Surfaces. 40. WBW, Salamander Bestand, no. 677, Retailers’ Conference, 9 Nov. 1931. 41. Ernst Wagner, “Kritik der Reklame,” Die Reklame 22, no. 1 (Mar. 1929): 183– 84. 42. See, for example, the description of the June 1928 trip to the United States by German advertisers. The main stop on their trip was the World Congress of the International Advertising Association held in Detroit, after a tour of the New York Times offices, the New York and Boston Advertising Clubs, Harvard University, and then on through Buffalo and Niagara Falls before arriving at their final destination, at which the possibility of the selection of Berlin for the 1929 Congress was discussed. Die Reklame 21, no. 1 (Aug. 1928): 537; and Die Reklame 21, no. 1 (Sept. 1928): 620–24. In the following weeks when the DRV had its annual congress in Düsseldorf, those present welcomed the recently founded Kontinental ReklameVerband, which met in the following days in nearby Cologne. Representatives from France, Germany, Holland, Switzerland, Austria, and the Czech Republic were scheduled to attend. Die Reklame 21, no. 1 (Sept. 1928): 614. 43. Arthur Rundt, “Das lenkbare USA–Gehirn II,” BIZ no. 48 (1928): 2069, 2071. Found in DUHC, JWT Howard Henderson, Oversize Box 6. 44. In addition to the work by de Grazia already mentioned, see also Ross, “Visions of Prosperity,” 52–77. For a more complete analysis of the debates and outcomes of transatlantic contact within the German business community, see Nolan, Visions of Modernity. 45. Christian A. Kupferberg, “Vom amerikanischen Werbewesen,” Das Plakat (Sept. 1921): 508–10. 46. Arthur Rundt, “Das lenkbare USA-Gehirn II,” BIZ no. 48 (1928): 2069, 2071, here 2069. 47. H. Sakowski, “Amerikanisches—Allzuamerikanisches,” Die Reklame 23, no. 2 (Oct. 1930): 640. 48. See, for example, the article inviting German ad men to turn to Switzerland instead of the United States as a “school for advertising” ideas. Dr. Sizza HaynKarais­kakis, “Warum denn nur Amerika? Die Schweiz, eine hohe Schule der Reklame,” Die Reklame 21, no. 2 (Aug. 1928): 590–96. 49. For a brief history of the American founding of JWT, see de Grazia, Irresistible Empire, 234–42. 50. HAT, GB/2/9/(i), JWT London History. For more on the relationship between GM and JWT’s international development, see Merron, “Putting Foreign Consumers on the Map,” 465–504.

275

276

Notes to Chapter One 51. De Grazia, Irresistible Empire, map of JWT territory, 1930, 241. 52. HAT, GB2/4/i, JWT News (Berlin office), June 1930, 7. 53. Most of those working in the London office, which was opened in 1899 but closed during the First World War, in the 1920s were still either American or had American training. By 1933, however, only three top posts were held by Americans. For more on the London JWT office, see West, “From T-Square to T-Plan,” 199–217. 54. Of course the problems faced in Germany were not all that dissimilar to what JWT ad men found when they opened branch offices in other parts of Europe. See, for example, Pouillard, “American Advertising Agencies in Europe,” 44–58. 55. HAT, GB/2/23(i), Hand-written essay by George Butler on modern art, n.d. 56. Arthur E. Hobbs, “Advertising in Germany,” JWT research department, Jan. 1928, DUHC, reel 232. 57. HAT, GB2/20, “Bush House, Berlin and Berkeley Square: George Butler Remembers JWT, 1925–1962,” unpublished manuscript edited by Jill Firth, 1985, 15. Of course this editorializing style was not JWT’s alone. Other American agencies practiced it early on too, such as Erwin Wasey. It was deemed particularly useful in illustrated weeklies such as the Saturday Evening Post, where “ordinary” folks, with less developed artistic tastes, were more likely to be swayed by an argument than by image alone. See Ross, “Visions of Prosperity,” 55. Marchand notes that while the American agencies were quick to see the usefulness of having women on staff beyond the secretarial pools, their options were limited to copywriting, since they knew the “women’s point of view,” and research, because housewives were more likely to chat about their shopping habits with other women. Furthermore, Marchand notes that even the most successful female copywriters in the interwar period still earned far less than their male colleagues. Ethnic and racial minorities were completely absent from the American agencies. Marchand, Advertising the American Dream, 32–38. 58. For a discussion of how JWT became known as a site of scientific research, particularly after the arrival of the behaviorist John B. Watson, see Kreshel, “John B. Watson at J. Walter Thompson,” 129–44. 59. HAT, GB2/20, “Bush House,” 28. 60. For an essay that encouraged German ad writers to use more humor in their work, even though it was more difficult than writing purely rational text, see Schriftleitung, “Der Humor in der Werbung,” DW 32, no. 3 (Feb. 1939): 102–9. The author reminded his readers that there were differences between German humor and “foreign ad humor” that should be respected. Critical examples of American ads were offered as proof. The very next issue returned to the topic; see Werner Suhr, “Vergnügliche Anzeigen,” DW 32, no. 4 (Mar. 1939): 125–26. 61. DUHC, JWT Newsletter Collection, Box 1, Samuel W. Meek, “A Few Facts About Some Major Aspects of Our Foreign Work Abroad,” JWT Co. News Bulletin (Nov. 1928): 16–19. This report and the foreign research conducted by JWT more generally are discussed further in Merron, “Putting Foreign Consumers on the Map.” Merron notes that the investigators were not always greeted warmly in their foreign posts. The German Automobile Manufacturers’ Association even threatened to sue JWT for “business espionage.” Merron, “Putting Foreign Consumers on the Map,” 480.



Notes to Chapter One

62. Hobbs, “Advertising in Germany.” 63. For a company history of the Dorland agency, see Schug and Sack, Moments of Consistency; and Schug, “Vom Newspaper space salesman zur integrierten Kommunikationsagentur,” 5–25. 64. HAT, Ian Keil Collection, “Dorland—History,” unpublished manuscript by Elizabeth Hennessy, n.d. Dorland, the American agency opened by Walter Edge, had expanded by 1906 to London, which then served as the base of operations for the move to the Continent in the 1920s. The Paris office was established in 1927, followed by the Berlin office one year later. 65. HAT, GB2/20, “Bush House,” 33. 66. One German dissertation from 1937 listed thirteen dubious practices within the industry. These dated back to the nineteenth century, but according to the author who praised the “cleansing” of the industry after 1933, the situation had deteriorated particularly in the 1920s, owing to the political and economic crises faced by the defeated nation and the influx of so-called untrustworthy elements into the profession. Heuer, Entwicklung der Annoncen-Expeditionen in Deutschland, 46–47. On the practice of exaggerating circulation figures, see Fulda, Press and Politics in the Weimar Republic, 21–22. 67. Hobbs, “Advertising in Germany.” 68. DUHC, JWT, E. G. Wilson, Box 81, Henry C. Flower, Jr. “Memorandum as to Policy,” 15 July 1932. 69. Rheinisch-Westfälisches Wirtschaftsarchiv, Bestand 208, Rundschreiben Reichardtwerk, 20 Dec. 1932. 70. Excerpt from Advertising and Selling (30 May 1928), reprinted in Strübing, “Beitrag zur Künftigen Organisation des Werbewesens,” Die Reklame 21, no. 1 (Oct. 1928): 710. The Americans weren’t the only ones to criticize. According to a 1931 article in Die Reklame, the Swiss newspaper Neuen Zürcher Zeitung had reported that the Untertanen-Mentalität was so deeply ingrained in Germany that many ads simply commanded the consumer to “eat bread” or “drink red wine,” rather than making a persuasive argument. Hans Goslar, “Psychologisch rightige Reklame und deutsche Untertanen-Mentalität,” Die Reklame 24, no. 2 (May 1931): 323–24. 71. Strübing, Die Reklame 21, no. 1 (Oct. 1928): 711. 72. Paul Ruben contributed a chapter on the psychology of advertising in his edited collection, Die Reklame: Ihre Kunst und Wissenschaft. See also Mataja, Die Reklame [1st edition 1910] (1926). Viktor Mataja’s work is often seen as the standard early text and the first to discuss the “social power” of advertising. Reinhardt, “Zeitgenössische Ansätze der Marktkommunikation,” 41–56, here 45. Weidenmüller, who usually just went by Werbwart Weidenmüller or “ad-attendant,” was the most radical of these but also perhaps the most influential. On his fiftieth birthday, Die Reklame celebrated his achievements as an advocate for the profession, author, and instructor with a short essay—a rare honor, even though it ended thus: “Not always understood, but always respected. Happy birthday!” Die Reklame 24, no. 1 (Feb. 1931): 79. For a sample of his eccentric writing style, see http://dirk-schindelbeck. de/wp-content/uploads/2009/10/weidenmueller_anbietlehre_teil_1.pdf. 73. Thomas Genennichen, “Grundsätzliches über den Auf- und Ausbau des Werbeunterrichts,” Die Reklame 22, no. 1 (Feb. 1929): 89–90.

277

278

Notes to Chapter One 74. William H. Ingersoll, “Wie das Reklamewesen seinen Weg in Amerikanische Universitäten fand,” Die Reklame 23, no. 1 (Aug. 1930): 457–66. 75. Marchand, Advertising the American Dream, ch. 2, here 25–28. 76. The program, including statements by many of the key attendees, was printed as Knapp, ed., Reklame, Propaganda, Werbung. 77. Karl Dittmar, “Der Weltreklamekongress 1929,” Die Reklame 21, no. 1 (Nov. 1928): 775–76. 78. Staff writer, “The Press: Berlin Jamboree,” Time (26 Aug. 1929). See http:// www.time.com/time/magazine/article/0,9171,752041–3,00.html. 79. “Willkommen in Berlin,” Die Reklame 22, no. 1 (Aug. 1929): 517–18. 80. For a brief overview of Brose’s influence on the field, see Dirk Schindelbeck’s essay at http://dirk-schindelbeck.de/wp-content/uploads/2009/05/brose023. pdf, accessed 2 Dec. 2010. 81. Hanns W. Brose, “Was wir vom Ausland und was das Ausland von uns lernen kann,” Die Reklame 22, no. 1 (Aug. 1929): 594–98. 82. Hanns W. Brose, “Die Königin unter den Werbeträgern,” Die Reklame 22, no. 2 (Dec. 1929): 908. This article’s main purpose was to encourage advertisers not to overlook the provincial press as an untapped source of new consumers for brand name products. These housewives, too, Brose was arguing, were ready to be included in the liberating discussion about quality and taste that was provided in the new instructional advertisements that he promoted. He makes this argument again in 1937, writing that the most ads can do is educate the consumer, but he never doubted the consumer’s agency to make the final decision to purchase or not. See Brose, Sechs Briefe an Herrn M in the series Werbewirtschaft und Werbegestaltung, 41–42. 83. Great Britain’s Empire Marketing Board existed only from 1926 to 1933, during which time print advertisements, radio broadcasts, exhibitions, and films were employed to remind Britons of their duty to “buy British” and to see the British Empire as a force for good, even world peace, in the decade after the First World War. Put most plainly, the goal of the media offensive was to aid the ailing British economy by offering a more positive vision of empire—one that might also draw workers away from socialism. See Constantine, “Bringing the Empire Alive,” 192–231. For examples of the poster advertisements produced by Britain’s Empire Marketing Board, see Constantine, Buy and Build. 84. Alfred Knapp, “Deutsches Institut für Reklame-Wirtschaft,” Die Reklame 24, no. 1 (Apr. 1931): 223–25, continued in the September issue, 507–11. 85. Hans Blinde, “Wirtschaftskrise und Reklame,” Die Reklame 24, no. 1 (Nov. 1931): 654–55. 86. Rudiger Albrecht, “Die Werbung und der Geist der Zeit,” Die Reklame 24, no. 2 (Nov. 1931): 680–81. Albrecht, who was director of the Düsseldorf DRV, tried to calm his readers and colleagues about the chances of a “Soviet-style” economy coming into place. 87. Deutscher Reklametag, Berlin, 19–20 Mar. 1932, agenda in Die Reklame 25, no. 2 (Feb. 1932): 93–95. 88. Adolf von Batocki, “Werbung und Staat,” reprinted in Die Reklame 25, no. 2 (Mar. 1932): 187–88. Von Batocki was Oberpräsident for East Prussia and from a



Notes to Chapter One

large-landowning aristocratic family. Axel von Freytagh-Lohringhoven, a German National People’s Party (DNVP) member of the Reichstag, was the author of the speech on “Werbung und Politik” that denounced the Republic’s foreign policy. Reprinted in Die Reklame 25, no. 2 (Mar. 1932): 192–93. 89. Behme, Reklame und Heimatbild, 25. 90. Hedwig Auspitz, “Buy British! und Deutschland? Werbung als Entlastung der Politik,” Die Reklame 25, no. 1 (May 1932): 266–67. 91. Hedwig Auspitz, “Überall Propaganda für Nationalpropaganda,” Die Reklame 23, no. 2 (Nov. 1930): 730. The quotation comes from a poster at a Berlin Housewives Association exhibition. 92. See, for example, Siemens, 37/Ls510, Der Anschluss. Hausmitteilungen der Siemens-Schuckertwerke AG für Elektro—Fachgeschäfte 7, no. 11 (1936): cover article. 93. Reagin, Sweeping the German Nation, 100–105. 94. Henkel, Paul Mundhenke, “Wasserenthärtung im Haushalt. Ein Problem unserer Zeit,” Blätter vom Hause 10 (Sept. 1930): 346–49. 95. Walter Friedrich, “Volksgesundheit und Werbung,” Die Reklame 24, no. 2 (Sept. 1931): 544. 96. DHMD, Inv. no. K1022, Dr. H. Gebhardt, “Ein wirtschaftliches Problem bei dem zahnärztlichen Dienst am Volke,” Gesundheitsdienst. Ein Blatt für Lehrer und Erzieher 3, no. 6 (1930). In an early example of market research, the company had done a school survey in 1929 and found that 40 percent of the 475,157 children counted had no toothbrush, and 15 percent shared a family toothbrush, leading them to conclude that at least 55 percent of all German children were not getting adequate dental care. DHMD, 11/429 Hyg. A111, Dr. Julius Schmitt, Lingner-Werke AG Dresden (Berlin, 1931), 46–47. This book was volume 22 of the series Musterbetriebe Deutscher Wirtschaft. Die kosmetische Industrie. The series was published because the editors felt that with so much written about American companies, Germans actually knew more about these foreign firms than their own industrial giants. 97. DHMD, 11/429 Hyg. A111, Schmitt, Lingner-Werke AG Dresden, 46–47. 98. DHMD, Inv. no. K1022, Odol brochure, 1928–29, 15. 99. These training centers were expanded in some cases into “Persil-Schule” after 1933, though closed with the onset of war. 100. Henkel, Paul Mundhenke, “Volksgesundheit und Persil,” Blätter vom Hause 11 (1931): 209–11. 101. Otto Ernst Sutter, “Schlusswort,” Die Reklame 25, no. 1 (Oct. 1932): 545. Compare Schwabenthan, Deutsche Werbefachzeitschriften, 40–41. 102. NSDAP Zentralverlag, “In unserem Lager steht Deutschland!” advertisement in Die Reklame 25, no. 1 (Sept. 1932): back cover. 103. See Ross, Media and the Making of Modern Germany, 240. Ross explains that even on the eve of coming to power, at best the Nazi press counted for 5 to 7 percent of total circulation of newspapers and magazines, despite the fact that the party was receiving one-third of the national vote. Bernhard Fulda’s data complements that provided by Ross in Fulda, Press and Politics in the Weimar Republic, 21–26. 104. The second May 1933 issue of Die Reklame had a sketch of Hitler on its cover and a series of quotations by Hitler “about advertising” on the flip side. Of

279

280

Notes to Chapters One and Two course, these quotations were, to be more specific, about propaganda largely taken from Mein Kampf. The excerpts here largely demonstrate Hitler’s respect for the power of persuasion, if, for example, it was correctly attuned to the tendencies toward “doubt and insecurity of the child-like masses.” Die Reklame 26, no. 2 (May 1933): 300. 105. For examples, see Kershaw, The “Hitler Myth,” ch. 2. 106. The scholarly literature on Nazi propaganda is immense. See Thymian Bussemer’s comprehensive analysis of popular culture as a medium for propaganda in Bussemer, Propaganda und Populärkultur, ch. 4. For an analysis of the party’s pre-1933 propaganda, see Paul, Aufstand der Bilder. A starting point for the post-1933 period is Welch, The Third Reich. 107. Editors, “Arbeitsbeschaffung bedarf der Hilfe des Werbers!” Die Reklame 26, no. 2 (Jan. 1933): 38–39. 108. Editors, “Für Volksaufklärung und Propaganda,” Die Reklame 26, no. 1 (Apr. 1933): 203–4. 109. Ibid. 110. Ibid. 111. Ibid. 112. Wilhelm Köhler, “Deutsche Werbung,” Die Reklame 26, no. 2 (Apr. 1933): 235. 113. Editors, “Die National Gruppe im DRV,” Die Reklame 26, no. 2 (May 1933): 304. 114. Richard Wagner, “Nationale Gruppe im DRV und Reichsbund Deutsche Werbung und Organisation,” Die Reklame 26, no. 2 (May 1933): 304. 115. Richard Wagner, Grußwort, 30 Apr. 1933, Die Reklame 26, no. 2 (May 1933): 308. 116. Hans Hinkel, “Kultur und Werbung,” Die Reklame 26, no. 2 (May 1933): 309–11. 117. Wilhelm Stephan, “Werbeleute! An die Front der Arbeit!” SR 17, no. 4 (Apr. 1933): 112. 118. Staff reporter, “Die Deutsche Werbung und die Gleichschaltung,” excerpt from the meeting of the Bund deutsche Schaufenster-Dekorateure, Nationale Gruppe, in Die Reklame 26, no. 2 (May 1933): 341. 119. Ibid. 120. Eugen Johannes Maecker, “Wandlung, nicht Wendung!” SR 17, no. 6 (June 1933): 181. 121. Fritzsche, Life and Death in the Third Reich, 37. See ch. 1 for Fritzsche’s insightful take on the conversion of so-called Aryan Germans to the Nazi vision of their future. 122. Eugen Johannes Maecker, “Wandlung, nicht Wendung!” SR 17, no. 6 (June 1933): 182.

chapter 2 1. Emil Endres, “Die neue Gesinnung in der Werbung,” Die Reklame 26, no. 12 (July 1933): 382.



Notes to Chapter Two

2. Although advertisers were particularly vulnerable to Nazi subordination, all the professions had their advocates who worked from the inside to make the coordination of their fields more appealing to their colleagues. See Jarausch, “The Perils of Professionalism,” 107–37. 3. Georg Fritz, Die Reklame 26 (July 1933): 375. 4. Hirt, Verkannte Propheten? 15. 5. Die Reklame, “Aufruf!” 26, no. 12 (July 1933): 376. Of course membership was mandatory and required dues. Pleading poverty over the timely payment of party membership and other party organization dues was not an acceptable reason to avoid one’s responsibility to the NSRDW, as Hermann Matthiessen found out in October 1938. He complained to the Werberat that the NSRDW would not let him off the hook despite his inability to pay. The Werberat suggested he ask for a reduction in dues. Otherwise he had to choose whether he wanted to abandon a career he had practiced for seven years, with a wife and two children to support. See the letter from Gerber for the Werberat to Hermann Matthiessen, BAB, R55/347, 15 Oct. 1938. 6. Die Reklame 26 (July 1933): 377. 7. DW 27, no. 1 (Jan. 1934): 1. 8. Georg Fritz, Die Reklame 26, double issue (July 1933): 375. 9. Kaplan, Between Dignity and Despair, 21–22. 10. Fritz Nonnenbruch, Völkischer Beobachter, 9 Sept. 1939, as quoted in Dr. Hans Jacobsen-Faulück, “Marktordnung in der Werbewirtschaft?” in DW 33, no. 5/6 (Mar. 1940): 148. 11. Fritzsche reminds us that to some extent sacrifice itself became a consumable commodity. For example, a massive trade in collectible buttons that indicated donations to the Nazi Winter Relief campaigns flourished throughout this period. See Fritzsche, Life and Death in the Third Reich, 54. For more on the Winter Relief Campaign, see Perry, Christmas in Germany, 205–9. 12. Werner Sombart, Deutscher Sozialismus, excerpted in Brose, Sechs Briefe an Herrn M in the series Werbewirtschaft und Werbegestaltung, 29. 13. Tooze, The Wages of Destruction, 162. 14. For one example among many, see Staff writer, “Des Verbrauchers Anteil am Erfolg,” DDV 10, no. 1 (Jan. 1941): 21–22. 15. Die Reklame, now appearing with the subtitle “Die deutsche Werbung,” 26 (Sept. 1933): 449. 16. Many writers actually contrasted the two words, Reklame and Werbung. In Fritz Geratewohl’s study he describes Reklame as a “superficial” holler at the consumer; whereas “to advertise [werben] is to make an effort for another. Advertising seeks to make friendships.” Geratewohl, Werben und Verkaufen im Kunstegewerbe und Hausrathandel, 7. 17. LAB, Osram Bestand 231, no. 1124, “Sparsamkeit in Grenzen!” (n.d., likely 1934). 18. Brose, Götterdämmerung des Markenartikels, 20. 19. Beiersdorf, file no. 130, Politische Agitation, Joseph Goebbels, “Moral oder Moralin?” NS Mitteilungsblatt, no. 9, Sonder-Ausgabe (3 Feb. 1934). For more on why we should rethink the place of the individual in Nazi society, see Moritz

281

282

Notes to Chapter Two Föllmer, “Was Nazism Collectivistic? Redefining the Individual in Berlin, 1930– 1945,” Journal of Modern History 82, no. 1 (Mar. 2010): 61–100. 20. Heinrich Hunke was clear that advertising was not capitalist or socialist. It had more organic origins that existed outside of any ideology. Indeed without it, he argued, an economy would move only “by force.” It was true that capitalism had introduced certain unfortunate practices, but advertising could be rid of those through reform. Heinrich Hunke, “Die Bedeutung der Werbung,” Wirtschaftswerbung 2, no. 10/11 (May 1935): 65–66. 21. M. C. Schreiber, “Reichsministerium für Volksaufklärung und Propaganda,” SR 17, no. 3 (Mar. 1933): 77. 22. See, for example, the similar desire held among those who worked for the Statistisches Reichsamt in Tooze, Statistics and the German State, 185–89. 23. Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 423. 24. No author, “Unzulässige Werbung,” Wirtschaftswerbung 2, no. 10/11 (May 1935): 69. 25. See Proctor, The Nazi War on Cancer, for more on the Nazi food policy. 26. Schramm, Konsum und regionale Identität im Sachsen, 203. 27. While these products appear in a number of historical studies, the most comprehensive study is König, Volkswagen, Volksempfänger, Volksgemeinschaft. 28. The law against unfair competition (Gesetz gegen den unlauteren Wettbewerb), which prohibited a whole host of sales strategies, including advertisements that showed rival products in a negative light, was introduced in 1896, strengthened in 1909, and expanded on a regular basis throughout the interwar years. See Lamberty, Reklame in Deutschland, 157–61. For a Weimar-era legal discussion of “comparative” or “personal” ads, including cases from as early as 1916, see Herzog, Vergleichende Reklame. For a prewar look at the practice and the legal strictures against it, see Recht, Die Grenzen der Reklame nach dem heutigen Wettbewerbsrecht, 30–33. Recht also points to debates about whether the laws pertaining to advertising should be thought of as protecting advertisers, retailers, consumers, or all groups. 29. “Gesetz über Wirtschaftswerbung,” 12 Sept. 1933, Reichsgesetzblatt I (Berlin: Reichsverlagsamt), 625–26. On the establishment of the Werberat, see also Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 141–42. 30. Harold James calls Hunke “the most influential of National Socialist economists” in Gall et al., The Deutsche Bank, 343. Hauke Janssen lists Hunke among the most significant party functionaries for the development of National Socialist economic doctrine. Janssen, Nationalokönomie und Nationalsozialismus, 99. 31. On the Werberat and advertising in Nazi Germany more generally, see Westphal, Werbung im Dritten Reich; and Ruecker, Wirtschaftswerbung unter dem Nationalsozialismus. 32. Heinrich Hunke, “Judenfrage in der Wirtschaft,” DDV 4, no. 28 (1935): 882. 33. Hunke in DDV 7, no. 33 (1938): 1198. For more on Hunke’s understanding of race and Lebensraum, see Kletzin, Europa aus Rasse und Raum. On his participation in the Aryanization of Jewish businesses and businessmen’s associations as president of the Verein Berliner Kaufleute und Industrieller and Gauwirtschafts­



Notes to Chapter Two

berater, see Biggeleben, “Die Verdrängung der Juden aus der Berliner Industrieund Handelskammer,” 54–86. 34. With no banking experience, Hunke was brought on to the board solely as a party watchdog. On his tenure at Deutsche Bank, see Gall et al., The Deutsche Bank, esp., 356–58 and 360–66; and the brief note in James, The Deutsche Bank and the Nazi Economic War against the Jews, 30–31. 35. Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 141. Reinhardt explains that Reichard personally presented the Ad Council’s mandate to a number of industrial associations, including the committee on advertising within the Reichsstandes der Deutschen Industrie and the Deutschen Industrie- und Handelstag. 36. For more on Amann and his long relationship with Hitler, see Weber, Hitler’s First War. 37. Private Collection of Dr. Henrich Hunke. The full list appears in Heinrich Hunke’s unpublished essay “Wandel und Gestalt der deutschen Wirtschaftswerbung in den letzten 70 Jahren” (1970), fn 2, 4–5. See Westphal, Werbung im Dritten Reich, 165–66. 38. In its early days, Werberat representatives were sure to emphasize that reform and education of the public would lead to ads that were both more effective and therefore of greater economic value, despite the added cost of the tax. Von Braunmühl, Das neue Werbegesetz, 9. The order establishing the tax is found on 46–47. 39. See the correspondence between the Werberat, RMVP, and Göring from June to September 1938 in BA R55/347. Small businessmen who failed to pay their Werbeabgabe were treated with limited sympathy. Usually an installment plan was set up to help the business handle the mounting tax debt. However, in at least one case, a publisher who still had not begun to pay twelve months after his installment plan had been set up lost his license to sell ads. His response was to send the Werberat a long letter in which he recounted early loyalty to the NSDAP, even quoting a newspaper story that showed he had been injured in a street battle against the Communist Party before 1933. He also included 25 RM, one-third of what he owed, and promised the rest would soon follow. See the correspondence between Baumann, the Werberat, and the RMVP in November 1938, BA R55/347. 40. Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, Table 9: Werberat income, 143. The size of the Ad Council staff at various intervals can also be found on this page. To provide a point of comparison, in 1939 Goebbels had almost 100 million RM to work with for the entire RMVP, up from 29 million in 1934. Sösemann, “Propaganda and Öffentlichkeit in der ‘Volksgemeinschaft,’ ”114–54, here 124. 41. Swett, “Preparing for Victory,” 675–707. 42. The censorship mechanism of the Werberat worked in a rather curious way. Promotional materials were drawn up and released into circulation prior to receiving permission from the Werberat. If the advertisement did not pass muster it would be withdrawn until changes could be made that satisfied the authorities. Failure to do so or any other type of resistance to a suggested change could lead to the suspension of a practitioner’s license, though that threat does not appear to have been acted upon frequently. 43. Compare Jelavich, Berlin Alexanderplatz; Steinweis, “Anti-Semitism and the Arts in Nazi Ideology and Policy”; and Guenther, Nazi Chic?

283

284

Notes to Chapter Two 44. As explained in 1938 by a supporter of the regime’s consolidation of the press, “Absolutist [regimes] suppressed the press through censorship. National Socialism elevated the press and all other effective public organs to tools of leadership, because the participation of the Volk in politics is the precondition of National Socialist leadership.” Hönig, Das Aktuelle in der deutschen Presse, 34. 45. Gerd F. Heuer’s dissertation explicitly lauded the Werberat as an organ of “self-administration.” Heuer, Entwicklung der Annoncen-Expeditionen in Deutschland, 66. 46. Heinrich Hunke, “Die Lage,” DDV 3, no. 16 (1934): 482. 47. Among other contemporary writings on advertising to the export market, see Klein, Die Werbung als Mittel der Exportförderung. 48. Heinrich Hunke, unpublished memoir “Erinnerungen und Betrachtungen,” 1999, 4. Hunke’s son, Dr. Henrich Hunke, has been working on finishing the manuscript since his father’s death in 2000. I am grateful for his permission to see short sections of the larger work as it stood in 2006. 49. Anton Reithinger, “Die Kaufkraftsteigerung als wichtiges Problem der europäischen Neuordnung,” DDV 10, no. 1/2 (Jan. 1941): 72. Reithinger was the leader of the Volkswirtschaftlichen Abteilung of IG Farben Industries. 50. Alfred Maelicke, “Die Entjudung in Europa,” DDV 10, no. 1/2 (Jan. 1941): 74. In the early 1940s, Hunke expounded on what he saw to be the differences between liberal capitalism and Nazi economic theory. In one speech from early 1942, he spoke of three principles that separated the two theories: in place of the individual, National Socialism focused on the Volk; when liberal economists considered the global market, Nazis thought of Lebensraum; and when the British put value in capital as the driving force of the economy, their German counterparts emphasized the value of labor. Hunke, “Die Grundfrage,” 209–29. 51. Even as victory seemed less likely, Hunke continued to make this point. See Hunke, “Hat der Unternehmer noch eine Zukunft,” Signal (Jan. 1943), reprinted in Signal (Oberkommando der Wehrmacht, 1945): 237–43. See this book’s further discussion of Signal, the German propaganda magazine that circulated throughout Europe during the war. On the importance of entrepreneurship to Nazi ideology, see, among others, Buchheim and Scherner, “The Role of Private Property in the Nazi Economy,” 408–10. 52. For the most complete treatise on the role and aims of the Werberat, see Hunke, Die neue Wirtschaftswerbung. 53. “Nazis Put Dictator over Advertising,” New York Times (13 Sept. 1933): 10. 54. H. R. L., “News from Germany,” Advertiser’s Weekly 83, no. 1097 (31 May 1934): 238. 55. Emil Endres, “Die neue Gesinnung in der Werbung,” Die Reklame 26, no. 12 (July 1933); quoted also in Ross, “Visions of Prosperity,” 69. 56. Christian Lebahn, “Werbemittel als Ausdruck der Zeit und als Geschmacksbildner!” SR 20, no. 11 (Nov. 1936): 379. 57. Emil Endres, “Publikumsgeschmack—Volksgeschmack,” SR 18, no. 11 (Nov. 1934): 380. 58. Erwin Finkenzeller, “Was will der Werberat?” Die Reklame, Die Deutsche Werbung 26, no. 18 (Oct. 1933): 570.



Notes to Chapter Two

59. Offizielle Nachrichten aus dem Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft, “Zweite Bekanntmachung des Weberates der deutschen Wirtschaft vom 1. November 1933,” Die Reklame, Die Deutsche Werbung 26, no. 18 (Oct. 1933): 566–67. 60. For example, “truth in advertising” was the slogan of the 1924 Associated Advertising Clubs of the World meeting in England, noted in Hofheinz, Psychologische Grundlagen erfolgreicher Werbung, 28. 61. For copies of Werberat declarations through 1936, see von Braunmühl, ed., Die Regelung der Wirtschaftswerbung. 62. Gesetz zum Schutz der nationalen Symbolen, 19 May 1933, Reichsgesetzblatt I (Berlin: Reichsverlagsamt), 285. 63. Ruf der Werbung: Vertrauliche Mitteilungen für die Mitglieder der NSRDW, Betriebswerber 15 (Apr. 1939): 18. 64. BA R55/922. The case against Johannes Iversen, who was kicked out of the NSRDW, thereby losing his ability to practice, serves as a high-profile example. Although he refused to remove the black, white, and red flag used on his company stationery since 1918, his quarrel with the NSRDW and Werberat went much further. He had publicly criticized both associations from the start, claiming that they were led by dilettantes who knew little about advertising. In 1938 he attempted to turn the tables on his adversaries by requesting that Künzler and another individual be brought in front of a disciplinary committee hearing. Reichard denied the request. Documents and correspondence about the Iversen case range from December 1933 until December 1939. 65. This point about terror as infrequently used against Aryans, except when a series of infractions had been perceived as committed, or a very severe one, is made by Johnson and Reuband in What We Knew. 66. BAB R55/344, memo from the NSDAP Gauleitung Berlin to the Kanzlei Parteipolitisches Amt, 15 Oct. 1938. 67. BAB R55/349. Heinrich Hunke for the Werberat to the RMVP, 8 Jan. 1936. 68. Semmens, Seeing Hitler’s Germany, 77–81, here 78. Joe Perry also notes the aim of decreasing the amount of Nazified Christmas kitsch, such as swastika-shaped Christmas tree lights, with the implementation of the law. Perry, Christmas in Germany, 213. Of course there was nothing to keep a family from retaining and reusing such products once purchased. 69. Some questions remain about the timing of the product’s disappearance and whether it was a casualty of this law, the weakening of the SA in 1934, or resulted from a strange backroom deal between the cigarette magnate Philipp F. Reemtsma and Hermann Göring. See Proctor, The Nazi War on Cancer, 234–37. For great detail on which nationalist terms were allowed and which were seen as “tasteless,” see Naue, Werbung! Zulässig oder Verboten? 108–28. Some of the examples covered are using images of non-German world leaders, national songs, the image of a May tree [Maibaum], and even the use of concepts such as “pity.” 70. For more examples of the debate over the use of the term “radio” in product promotions, see Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace, 100–101. 71. BAB R55/344, correspondence between 1937 and 1938 between the Werberat, RMVP, and the Reichsrundfunkkammer over the use of the word “Rund-

285

286

Notes to Chapter Two funk” in advertising. It even turned out in 1940 that there were seeds for the begonia type “Radio” and dahlia type “Radio” on the market that also needed to be weeded out. 72. BAB R55/346. Fachschaft Hersteller von Reklameplaketen und Schildern to the Werberat, 1 Mar. 1935, and the Weberat response on 16 Mar. 1935. 73. BAB R55/346. See the meeting of all those concerned, including the Werberat, and representatives of the Reich and Prussian Interior and Transportation ministries, on 7 June 1935. 74. Offizielle Nachrichten aus dem Werberat der Deutschen Wirtschaft, in Die Reklame. Die deutsche Werbung 26, no. 18 (Oct. 1933): 563–64. 75. BAB R55/348. President Reichard regarding Aussenwerbung, 25 Nov. 1933. 76. LAB, Osram, Rep. 231, no. 1223, copy of President Reichard’s memo regarding Aussenwerbung, 25 Nov. 1933. 77. See, for example, the reporting of the new measure in the Hag-Post. KFD, Hag-Post (June 1934). 78. Henkel, Blätter vom Hause 14 (July 1934): 262. 79. For more on the relationship between the Werberat and the police, see Roßwog, Der Werberat als Mittel staatlicher Wirtschaftsführung, 57–67. 80. Henkel, G11, Rundschreiben no. 25, 8 Oct. 1935, 7. Henkel also noted their satisfaction with the Werberat’s handling of other new restrictions on classifieds, giveaways, and rebates. 81. Dirk Reinhardt agrees that the controversy never really subsided in the Nazi period. See Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 385–86. 82. For a contemporary discussion of the limits on Werberat power, see Roßwog, Der Werberat als Mittel staatlicher Wirtschaftsführung, 26–30. 83. BAB R55/348. Werberat president Reichard to the Reichwirtschaftsminister, 1 Sept. 1934. For more on the Heimatzschutz movement in the Third Reich with particular attention to the protection of historical monuments and the movement’s own Gleichschaltung, see Speitkamp, “Denkmalpflege und Heimatschutz,” 149–93. 84. BAB R55/346. Werberat president Reichard to the Reich und Preussische Ministerium für Wirtschaft und Arbeit, 7 May 1935. 85. Because the Heimatschutz movement dates back to the very beginning of the twentieth century and appears to be an obvious precursor to Nazi belief in the sacredness of the German landscape and the necessity of its preservation, the conflicts that arose between its members and supporters of business within the Nazi movement have not been adequately pursued by scholars. 86. Sächsische Staatsarchiv, Chemnitz, BFC Bestand 30950, Sig. 37/747, Henkel & Cie to Böhme Fettchemie, 27 Oct. 1937. 87. The final decision was not handed down until 26 May 1939. See Sächsische Staatsarchiv, Chemnitz, BFC Bestand 30950, Sig. 37/747, Verwaltungsstreitsache der Fa. Zeiss Ikon AG in Dresden gegen den Regierungspräsident in Frankfurt (Oder). 88. BMW, UA 561, Rundschreiben für unsere Herren Vertreter no. 753, 10 Mar. 1938. 89. Henkel, Karl Heinz Jonas, “Werberat und Polizei bei der Aufsicht über die Außenwerbung,” Blätter vom Hause 19 (July 1939): 260–70.



Notes to Chapter Two

90. Ruf der Werbung: Vertrauliche Mitteilungen für die Mitglieder der Reichsfachschaft Deutscher Werbefachleute—NSRDW 13, no. 3 (1937): 20. The three thousand individuals refused membership represented a sizable portion of the association’s potential membership, considering that the organization reported having 13,367 members at the start of 1937. Ibid., 3. 91. Ibid., 21. 92. See Bajohr, “No ‘Volksgenossen,’ ” 45–65. 93. Beiersdorf, Heft 130, company headquarters to the Sales Representatives, 12 Apr. 1933. 94. Bajohr and Szodrzynski, “Keine juedische Hautcreme mehr benutzen!” 515– 26; and Bajohr, “Aryanisation” in Hamburg. On the “campaign against Beiersdorf,” see 22–26. 95. Beiersdrof, Heft 130, Reichsleitung, Kampfbund des gewerblichen Mittelstandes (NSDAP) to P. Beiersdorf AG, 15 May 1933. 96. Beiersdorf, Heft 130, letter from Beiersdorf to Regierungsrat Dr. Hoffmann, Munich, 30 Aug. 1933. 97. A. Curt Müller, “Die Anzeige im neuen Staat,” Die Reklame 26 (July 1933): 394. 98. Beiersdorf, file no. 130, letter from Beiersdorf to Regierungsrat Dr. Hoffmann, Munich, 30 Aug. 1933. See also Poiger, “Beauty, Business and German International Relations,” 53–71. 99. Beiersdorf, file no. 130, Beiersdorf AG to the Reichswirtschaftsminister, 2 Sept. 1933, 6. 100. Beiersdorf, file no. 130, letter from the Behörde für Wirtschaft, Hamburg, to Direktor Claussen, 8 Feb. 1934, and the company’s response, 10 Feb. 1934. 101. Beiersdorf, file no. 130, Bericht aus Frankfurt, July 1935, and Bericht aus Hamburg, 3 Sept. 1935, with response from the Polizeibehörde Hamburg, 10 Sept. 1935. 102. Kaffee Hag had already established its own niche as a decaffeinated brand when Johann Jacobs sought to do the same for regular coffee, which had until that point been sold as a loose (nonpackaged) commodity in the “colonial wares” shops specializing in imported goods. 103. KFD, Joh. Jacobs & Co. Reklame 1933–35. Flyer “Kampf allen Verleumdungen!” 29 Apr. 1933. 104. Ibid. Flyer “Neue Preise—gute Geschäfte!” 17 Feb. 1933. 105. BMW UA/561, Rundschreiben to representatives, 22.1.38 and the accompanying documentation from Riga and Essen. This tactic was used by corporate competitors as well as National Socialist fanatics. See, for example, Bajohr, “Aryanisation” in Hamburg. 106. Wirtschaftsarchiv Baden-Württemberg, Salamander Bestand B150, no. 603, Lingel print ad. 107. Sächsisches Staatsarchiv, Chemnitz, AU Bestand 31050, no. 7270, Aktennotiz, 10 Oct. 1935. Jeff Schutts reports that in the latter half of the 1930s, Coca-Cola GmbH based in Essen also had to face a smear campaign by its closest competitor, Afri-Cola, which tried to tarnish the market leader as un-German and Jewish. See Schutts, “Die Erfrischende Pause,” 151–81, here esp. 164–68.

287

288

Notes to Chapter Two 108. The same metaphors were used by Paul Schmitt in his discussion of “moral” advertising. The struggle of the battlefield was to be replaced with the competition of the sports arena. Schmitt, Die Grenze der erlaubten Reklame, 17. 109. Dr. Danzmann, “Die vergleichende Werbung” in Wirtschaft und Werbung (Berlin: Haude und Spener, 1935), 27–29. This text was part of volume 1 in a series produced by DDV. See also Karlheinz Heuser, “Das Wort ‘deutsch’ in der Wirtschaftswerbung,” DW 28, no. 13 (Sept. 1935): 1372–76. And in October as a planned follow up, “Was ist ein Deutsches Geschäft,” which was excerpted from a longer piece, “Das Wort ‘deutsch’ in Werbung und Wettbewerb,” which appeared in the DDV 4, no. 28 (Oct. 1935). 110. The number of non-Aryan businesses was also shrinking steadily in Germany, which would account as well for the decline in explicit denunciations in advertisements. 111. LNW, Heinrich Hunke Nachlass, summary of the meeting between representatives of the Reichsleitung der NSDAP and Heinrich Hunke, 19 Jan. 1934 and follow-up memo, 9 Jan. 1936. 112. Ibid., Hunke memo to Abteilung C, 27 May 1935 and response, 14 June 1938. 113. For a very tidy summary of the reforms enacted before 1936, see the work of German emigre Redlich, “German Advertising and Its Regulation during the Last Three Years,” 95–104. Redlich argues that the “inflexibility” within advertising created by the changes made it less attractive to businesses. 114. 3. Bekanntmachung des Werberates der deutschen Wirtschaft, 21 Nov. 1933, reported in DW 26, no. 18 (Oct. 1933). The decree took effect on 1 Jan. 1934. 115. “Standard Card for Rates—in Germany,” Advertiser’s Weekly no. 1076 (4 Jan. 1934): 1. 116. The replacement of French and English words with German equivalents in commercial transactions was controversial. Opponents argued, for example, that since everyone knew the high quality of “cognac,” referring to the German version as Weinbrand “stamped it as a second-rate” imitation. Importantly, exports could still be promoted using foreign words and phrases. But supporters of the change reminded business leaders that “pride in one’s national achievements” should outweigh “purely economic” considerations. Rolf Riedemann, “Die Werbung muss deutsch sein,” Wirtschaftswerbung. Mitteilungsblatt des Werberates den deutschen Wirtschaft 3, no. 14 (July 1936): 80–81. 117. Robert Proctor’s work on cigarette advertising is discussed in a later chapter. The prohibition against sexually explicit advertising, or ads that “offend the moral sensibilities of the people,” as the Werberat decree put it, on first glance fits less well with what we know to be the case about sexuality in this period. However, ads with sexualized female figures continued to appear, and ads for products to improve sexual performance also remained acceptable. It appears, therefore, that this restriction is a good example of Dagmar Herzog’s point that National Socialists wanted to satisfy cultural conservatives as well as those with less prudish tastes. Herzog has argued that though always trying to bridge a wide range of opinions in Germany, National Socialism supported sexual expression as essential to racial health and individual pleasure. See Herzog, Sex after Fascism, ch. 1; and Swett, “Selling Sexual Pleasure in 1930s Germany.”



Notes to Chapter Two

118. Walter Ernst Schmidt, “Wirtschaftswerbung gestern und heute,” SR 20, no. 4 (Apr. 1936): 106–10. On the paradoxical nature of women’s fashion ads in the Third Reich, see Guenther, Nazi Chic? 119. While Odol mouthwash ads continued to be produced showing women flirting and smoking as they had in the 1920s, the company-supported Hygiene Museum in Dresden also put on ideologically charged eugenics displays. Compare Vogel, “Reiner Atem, frischer Kuß—Aspekte deutscher Reinlichkeit,” 107–57. 120. Opponents of the regime also saw good reason to introduce greater consumer protection. See Eliasberg, Reklamewissenschaften, 120. Eliasberg was a German-Jewish psychotherapist who worked in Vienna before immigrating to New York in 1938. For more examples of reform, see Naue, Werbung! Zulässig oder Verboten? On the widespread support for the limitation on product give-aways (premiums), see Albrecht R. Sommer, “Premium Advertising,” Harvard Business Review 10, no. 2 (Jan. 1932): 203–12. 121. De Grazia, Irresistible Empire, ch. 5. Corey Ross reports that regime-loyal magazine publishers complained in the mid-1930s that entertainment magazines, and especially the ads within them, still looked far too similar to those from the Weimar era. See Ross, Media and the Making of Modern Germany, 324. 122. Eliasberg, Reklamewissenschaften, 83. 123. L. Schreiber, “Warum Reichswerbeschule?” DW 29, no. 12 (July 1936): 666. 124. See the images that accompany the spread on the Höhere Reichswerbeschule in DW 29, no. 12 (July 1936): 662–65. The school was also introduced in the September issue of the NSRDW’s Ruf der Werbung. The full-time program took two years to complete and was capped with a series of oral, written, and practical exams. All successful graduates of the program received the license to practice (Berufsausweis) and membership in the NSRDW. Continuing education students did not have to take exams and received a certificate of evening course participation. For more on the various programs offered at the Reichswerbeschule, see Ruf der Werbung: Vertrauliche Mitteilungen für die Mitglieder der NSRDW 17, no. 1 (Mar. 1937): 12–15. 125. The Höhere Reichswerbeschule was completely destroyed along with the iconic KaDeWe in Allied bombing raids in 1943. Plans for additional campuses were never realized. 126. Dirk Reinhardt explains that the first such ads began around 1900. However, in these years the collaboration was normally of a different sort, with multiple noncompeting brands sharing ad space. As he puts it, the number of ads in which competing businesses within the same sector teamed up to make their case to consumers “before 1914 can be counted on one hand.” Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 148–68, here 149. 127. These examples all come from 1936, though there were dozens and dozens of other requests throughout the life of the Werberat. Unless those denied were not filed, it appears the Ad Council tried to meet the requests of these industries, even if it meant cutting back on the total sum. The Hairstylists Associations, for example, received only 10,000 of the 30,000 RM requested in 1938 because of budgetary restrictions. See BAB R5002/7. 128. Brose, Sechs Briefe an Herrn M in the series Werbewirtschaft und Werbe­

289

290

Notes to Chapter Two gestaltung, 81–83. In this unusual collection, Brose writes letters to a fictional Herr M about the leading questions facing the advertising industry in 1937. Whether it was intended in this way is unclear, but creating a fictional recipient for his own insights allows Brose to weigh in on the Ad Council’s work (and that of his colleagues in the industry) without pointing fingers. 129. Though no friend of the regime, it is still of note that Fritz Redlich was able to turn to examples from France, the United States, and Britain in his study of the history and development of the advertising industry. Redlich, Reklame: Begriff-Geschichte-Theorie, for example 62–89. This book was published shortly before Redlich immigrated to the United States. 130. Under his mantle as Werberat member, C. A. Kupferberg defended the use of Gemeinschaftswerbung, though he never stopped producing his own brand ads as well, in “Gedanken zur Gemeinschaftswerbung,” Wirtschaft und Werbung, Heft 1 in the Schriftenreihe DDV (Berlin: Haude & Spener, 1935), 21–22. 131. Brose, Sechs Briefe an Herrn M, 85–87. 132. Ibid., 89. 133. BU, record of the meeting of the Reipha Committee on Advertising, 8 May 1934. 134. Ibid. 135. Sächsisches Staatsarchiv, Chemnitz, BFC Bestand 30950, no. 746, report of a meeting with Ad Council representatives in Berlin on 28 June 1937. 136. Many small companies, in particular, were hit hard by the regulations of the Werberat. See, for example, the complaints lodged by small business owners in BAB, R55/355, such as Christoph Bader of Munich, whose thirty-five-year-old company that produced protective folios for magazines in hotel lounges and restaurants ran afoul of the Werberat’s 1934 regulation by including multiple pages of classifieds in its 1937 folios. Hartmut Berghoff reports further that in 1938 the Werberat was able to cover only part of its regulations in a 266-page single-spaced publication, and that the regulations were notoriously difficult for the average businessman or advertiser to understand. Berghoff, “Times Change and We Change with Them,” 134. Difficulty understanding the rules led to fears among some small businessmen of getting them wrong. In 1938 Fritz Geratewohl was still telling his readers, “Do not fear the laws for advertising!” Geratewohl, Werben und Verkaufen im Kunstegewerbe und Hausrathandel, 44. The terminology necessitated the printing of lexicons so practitioners could understand the rules they were to follow, such as Riedemann, Was ist erlaubt—was ist verboten? 137. Abschrift of the meeting of the Ausschuss für Warenzeichen- und Wettbewerbsrecht der Akademie für Deutsches Recht, 18 Feb. 1937, in BAB, R55/353, 31. 138. For the contours of the legal squabble, see Frese, Die Massnahmen des Werberats der deutschen Wirtschaft und ihre Bedeutung für den Richter. 139. Walter Ernst Schmidt, “Witschaftswerbung gestern und heute,” SR 20, no. 4 (Apr. 1936): 110. For more on the concept of morality in business and ads in particular, see Schmitt, Die Grenze der erlaubten Reklame, 11–25. 140. H. F. J. Kropff also cheered the Werberat’s accomplishments and the progress made in fostering a “total spirit” in advertising. Kropff, Totalität der Werbung. 141. Hunke, Die neue Wirtschaftswerbung, 19–21.



Notes to Chapters Two and Three

142. Ibid., 24–25. 143. Hunke, Der Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft im Jahre 1939 (Berlin, 1940), 15–16. On changing people’s perceptions toward fish, see Fritzsche, Erziehung zum Fischverbrauch. Fritzsche noted that the goal four years into the war was still to turn this “familiar food source” [bekanntes Nahrungsmittel] into a “beloved people’s-food source” [beliebtes Volksnahrungsmittel], 9. 144. Hunke, Die neue Wirtschaftswerbung, 59. 145. Ibid., 55.

chapter 3 1. From the catalogue Anzeigen im Werden und Wirken (Berlin: Scherl Verlag, 1939). According to the catalogue, 120,000 attended the exhibition of print ads that opened in the capital in May 1937. A smaller version was displayed in Hamburg, Munich, Stuttgart, and Ludwigshafen the following year. 2. By the second half of the nineteenth century, Uwe Spiekermann explains, window displays were the most important form of advertising for retailers. Basis der Konsumgesellschaft, 572. 3. Ciarlo, Advertising Empire. Pregnant with meaning, the histories of these corporate trademarks were often used in publicity literature and internal newsletters as a way to tell the story of the company’s own development. Bayer aspirin is a perfect example of a brand that valued its trademark, the “Bayer Cross,” designed in 1904, as essential to its international success. See Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace, 166. 4. Jelavich, Berlin Alexanderplatz. 5. In addition to ibid., see also Ross, Media and the Making of Modern Germany. 6. Fritzsche, Life and Death in the Third Reich, 66–68. 7. Advertiser’s Weekly, Jan. 1934. 8. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp, file no. 3: report of discussion with Reichswirtschaftsminister Schacht on the desire within industry to delay the prohibition of radio ads, 20 Feb. 1935. 9. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp, file no. 3: correspondence between EHK and Beiersdorf. She had spoken to the radio section of the NSRDW and had been reassured that the deadline had been moved to 15 May and perhaps would be extended until the end of the calendar year, which it was. 10. Ibid., letter to Clausen from EHK, 31 Oct. 1935, talking about options for the postradio era, including playing the ad-phonograph records in theaters and at lectures, sending out small ad-phonograph records, and “a new form of cinema ad. The short-film, for which the sound is as important as the visual.” 11. Lamberty, Reklame in Deutschland, 214–23. 12. Henkel, Blätter vom Hause 10 (Jan. 1930). Writing about this initiative, Paul Mundhenke even touted these films as general enlightenment for the community and a “service to the national economy.” 13. Reinhardt, Von der Reklame zum Marketing, 335. 14. Henkel, Blätter vom Hause 12 (1932): 219. 15. LNW, Heinrich Hunke Nachlass, “Notiz” on Film advertising, 9 June 1935. 16. Ibid.

291

292

Notes to Chapter Three 17. By 1930, German adults on average visited the cinema seven times per year, according to statistics gathered at the time. Ross, “Mass Culture and Divided Audiences,” 160. However, Ross notes that this was largely an urban phenomenon. With 8 percent of all theaters located in Berlin, the inhabitants of the capital were likely to see a film eighteen times per year. Ibid., 161. 18. Henkel, Blätter vom Hause 13 (1933): 86–87, “Mehr Sonne,” ein Ufa-Tonfilm, directed by Kaskeline, 1933. Text and stills on 86. Punctuation as provided in text. 19. Theodor Heuss was known for his anti-Nazi stance and would later become the first president of the Federal Republic. While Heuss was forced to withdraw from political life, he was still present in order to vote in favor of the Enabling Act, granting Hitler dictatorial powers on 24 Mar. 1933. His wife became the family’s main breadwinner, once the one-party political system took effect. 20. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp, file on Rundfunkwerbung 1933–1935, “Ein neuer Versuch in der Rundfunkwerbung,” Der Kaufmann ueberm Durchschnitt 9, no. 11 (Nov. 1933). She was interviewed in the same journal ten months later on the topic of “acoustic advertising.” 21. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp, file no. 1: Allgemeines, 1918–36, letters from EHK to the Werbeabteilung and from Juan Clausen to EHK, both dated 6 Nov. 1934. 22. Ibid., letter from the Werbeabteilung to EHK, 15 Nov. 1934. 23. Ibid., letter from EHK to Werbeabteilung, 19 Nov. 1934. 24. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp, file no. 1: Rundfunkwerbung, 1933–35, letter from EHK to Beiersdorf ads department, 20 Jan. 1935. The jingle read: “Gleich zur Hand! Hansaplast Schnellverband.” 25. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp, file no. 1: Allgemeines, 1918–36, EHK memo on records for Latin America, 13 Oct. 1936. 26. Ibid. The radio ad was made sillier by giving the family Swabian accents, in contrast to the narrator’s High German, provided by none other than Theodor Heuss, the future first president of the Federal Republic. Heuss had some time on his hands ever since his liberal political career had come to an abrupt end in 1933. He and Elly Knapp were married in 1908. They had one son. His temporary retirement from political life allowed him to help out on this project. See EHK to the Beiersdorf ads department, 28 Feb. 1935. 27. Alfons Brugger, ed., Die Anzeige in der Wirtschaftswerbung: Jahrbuch für vorbildliche Anzeigenwerbung im nationalsozialistischen Staate (Gohlicke, 1938/39), 136. 28. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp, file no. 1: EKH to Beiersdorf, 7 May 1935. See Merziger, “German Humour in Books” in Swett, Ross, and D’Almeida, Pleasure and Power in Nazi Germany, 107–31. One expert on psychological strategies in advertising noted that humor was effective in ads for children’s products and inexpensive mass-produced items (like Nivea crème). Even then one had to remain very careful that the joke did not overwhelm the purpose of the ad. See Hofheinz, Psychologische Grundlagen erfolgreicher Werbung, 19. 29. Beiersdorf, Werbefilme 1938–40, Korrespondenz, EHK to Clausen, 30 Sept. 1938. 30. The Nivea crème container’s design has certainly become iconic in its own



Notes to Chapter Three

right, changing little over the past eighty years. It was already familiar enough in 1935 among consumers to be recognized in the title’s play on words. 31. Beiersdorf, Werbefilme 1938–40, Korrespondenz, memo about “Weiss in Blau,” Jan. to Nov. 1936. The film can be viewed at the Beiersdorf Internet site https://globe360.net/beiersdorf.mediaservice/node/82. 32. Ibid., Korrespondenz, Beiersdorf to Epoche Gsparcolor-Film AG, 4 Oct. 1938; and Heuss-Knapp’s own assessment, 5 Oct. 1938. For the wide variation among theaters in terms of quality of presentation, see Ross, “Mass Culture and Divided Audiences,” 176. The film can be viewed at https://globe360.net/beiersdorf. mediaservice/en/node/199. 33. Elly Heuss-Knapp, “Ein Werbefilm entsteht,” DW 32, no. 2 (Jan. 1939): 58–60. 34. LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1165, AFE memo on Filmdienst, Oct. 1934. 35. Adolf Hitler, Zweites Buch, 58, quoted in Tooze, The Wages of Destruction, 10. 36. Hausman, Hertner, and Wilkins, Global Electrification. In 1933 close to 80 percent of Germany’s population lived in areas serviced by electricity, which was only bettered by smaller industrial states including France, Switzerland, and Denmark, while the sprawling United States had reached only about 68 percent of its population. German industry, however, accounted for 66 percent of total consumption compared with the 50 percent consumed by American industrial concerns. See Figure 1.6 and Table 1.3 on 28. 37. Tooze, The Wages of Destruction, 111–12. 38. These plans built on earlier rationalizing efforts of the Weimar era. Supporters of the regime were aware that electric appliances were beyond the country’s means in the 1930s, but less costly technological advancements, including greater lighting, were seen as in reach. See, for example, Peikow, Die soziale und wirtschaftliche Stellung der deutschen Frau in der Gegenwart, 49–53. 39. Loehlin, From Rugs to Riches, 26. For the discussion around improvements in housing in the 1930s, see König, Volkswagen, Volksempfänger, Volksgemeinschaft, 115–36. 40. In 1935 while negotiating with EHK for the composition of some last-minute radio ads for their new “D” (Doppelwendel) bulb to accompany a series of radio lectures about the benefits of electricity that were planned by the German Light Society (Deutschen Lichttechnischen Gesellschaft), Osram was also considering its options with regard to film. LAB, Osram, A. Rep. 231, no. 1218, letter from Brocke to EHK at her home, 29 Aug. 1935, explaining that their plans for radio ads for the new lamp were delayed because of technical difficulties. Film and radio plans for 1935/36 are also discussed in the report “Werbeplan für Deutschland 1935/36,” written on 7 Feb. 1935, same file. 41. According to Osram, the price of this sizable investment would be recouped by charging each child quarterly installments of 20 Rpf. LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1218, Osram Werbeplan für Deutschland, 1935/36. 42. Ibid. 43. Ibid. 44. Ibid., no. 1225, proposal for an “Osram-Film,” 25 Nov. 1935. 45. For another example, see any of a number of company histories produced in

293

294

Notes to Chapter Three these years to mark the occasion of a corporate anniversary, such as Bruno Kuske, 100 Jahre Stollwerck-Geschichte, 1839–1939 Cologne: Stollwerck, 1939. Although the history went to 1939, it ended with the naming of the company as a Nationalsozialistischer Musterbetrieb in 1937. Ibid., 148. 46. The popularity of Kulturfilme began in the 1920s and gained steam throughout the following decade in line with the regime’s policies of promoting German culture, unity, and optimism. Peter Reichel notes that the bulk of such films fell into three categories: “daily life, nature, and technology.” The Werkfilm was a particularly good fit for representing daily life and technological advances. See Reichel, Der schöne Schein des Dritten Reiches, 204–5. 47. KFD, Kaffee Hag Bestand, Hag-Post no. 6 (31 July 1937). Compare Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace. 48. Evans, The Third Reich in Power, 349–50. 49. KFD, Hag-Post no. 1 (4 Apr. 1939). 50. See S. Jonathan Wiesen’s coverage of this film, “Henkel—ein deutsches Werk in seiner Arbeit,” also by Ruttmann, and the company’s difficulties getting it past Werberat censors who claimed that it broached too closely on Nazi principles. The Propaganda Ministry had accepted the film, and the Werberat eventually relented. See Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace, 102–3. 51. According to the company website, only three whaling trips were ever made. The war, presumably, interrupted this venture. See http://www.henkel-ap. com/cps/rde/xchg/henkel_ase/hs.xsl/513_ASE_HTML.htm. 52. LNW, Heinrich Hunke Nachlass, Wirtschaftswerbung 8, no. 7 (July 1941): 252. 53. Despite his expressionist credentials from the 1920s, Ruttmann continued to work after 1933. In addition to these company films, he also directed a number of promotional films featuring German cities, alongside films promoting the success of agriculture under Nazi policy, a film about cancer prevention, and one about German tanks. He died in 1941 of natural causes. See the information on Walter Ruttmann at http://www.deutsches-filminstitut.de/dt2tp0051.htm. 54. LNW, Hunke Nachlass, Swiss Film Industry, 1937. 55. Rheinisch-Westfälisches Wirtschaftsarchiv, Stollwerk Bestand, Reichardtwerk Rundschreiben, no. 84, 3 Sept. 1934. On the expansion of film to rural Germany in the mid-1930s, see Ross, “Mass Culture and Divided Audiences,” 185. 56. Ibid., 187–88. 57. LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1218, for one example, see p. 7 of Osram’s 1935/36 plan for advertising. They had felt this way for years. See LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1215, Aktennotiz, 7 Apr. 1931, in which they refer to the dailies as the “best and cheapest ad material.” 58. Führer, “Die Tageszeitung als wichtigstes Massenmedium der nationalsozialistischen Gesellschaft,” 411–34. 59. Christian Kupferberg in DW 27 (1934): 213–214. 60. In addition to these examples from Deutsche Werbung and Seidels Reklame, many German firms drew similar conclusions. Bayer reported on the various international styles shown at the 1937 world exhibition in Paris and pointed out the following year in its own newsletter about company propaganda that certain cul-



Notes to Chapter Three

tural differences were represented in ads. See BU, Bayer Zepro, 1937, and Zentral Nachrichtenblatt, 1938. 61. This point was made repeatedly first in the Weimar era and through the 1930s, even if borrowing across borders was evident. For example, see Ernst Growald, “Reklameofferten müssen kalt genossen warden,” Archiv für Werbung 1, no. 1 (May 1930): 14–15. Schmiedchen went on to support the new regime, but he eventually had a falling out with the NSRDW. 62. Ad style in Scandinavian countries and the Benelux countries were also discussed regularly in Deutsche Werbung and Seidels Reklame, but there was little if any mention of ads from South America, Asia, or Africa and the Middle East. 63. Brugger, ed., Jahrbuch für vorbildliche Anzeigenwerbung, 127–28. 64. WBW, Salamander Bestand 677, meeting of Salamander retailers, 9 Nov. 1931. 65. KFD 4, Staff writer, “Wie heist Telefon auf Deutsch?” Der Hag-Post no. 2 (16 Mar. 1937). 66. Beiersdorf, letter from A. Führmann, who replaced Juan Clausen, who was called back to service in the navy as Beiersdorf ’s advertising chief, to EHK, 10 Feb. 1941. 67. Beiersdorf, letter from Führmann to EHK, 25 Jan. 1941. 68. Eskilson, Graphic Design, 285. 69. For example, see “Fraktur und Antiqua” followed by “Warum mit deutscher Schrift werben?” DW 27, no. 1 (Jan. 1934): 3–7. 70. Bormann’s declaration is dated 3 Jan. 1941 and can be found in Eskilson, Graphic Design, 285. 71. Sächsisches Staatsarchiv, Chemnitz, BFC Bestand 30950, 37/748, Erlass dated 24 Nov. 1941. 72. KFD, 7th Proclamation of the Werberat, 21 Mar. 1934, appended to the Hag-Post no. 2 (12 Feb. 1934). 73. KFD, Hag-Post no. 7 (29 June 1935). The Hag newsletter reported that the months of controversy over free samples seemed to be clearing up. The practice was not banned outright by the Werberat, but the “gifts” had to be actual trial samples of the products. Handing out other giveaways to win customers was prohibited, and the trial size (only big enough to test the quality of the product) was restricted. 74. For a long-range view of the German state’s interest in public health, see Weindling, Health, Race, and German Politics between National Unification and Nazism. For an examination of the Nazi state’s preoccupation with public health, see Proctor, The Nazi War on Cancer. 75. The 17th decree was predated, for example, by the Prussian police order of 2 June 1933 that made it illegal to advertise health products that had potentially dangerous side effects for consumers. 76. For more on the legal history of pharmaceutical advertisements in Nazi Germany, see Lill, Die Pharmazeutisch-Industrielle Werbung in der ersten Hälfte des 20. Jahrhunderts, 381–409. 77. Film was watched more closely through its own censors at the Reichskulturkammer and also because the quantity of advertisements appearing in film was so much smaller.

295

296

Notes to Chapter Three 78. How to exact fines remained a controversial topic. The legislation that established the Ad Council called on “Reich- and state [Landes-] agencies to offer legal and administrative assistance,” but whether this meant that the Werberat could call on the police to provide coercive measures in cases where advertisers refused to abide by Werberat regulations remained unclear. In 1934 Carole von Braunmühl announced that the ability to revoke the license to practice and the use of “administrative” means to block noncompliant ads/advertisers would be enough authority to ensure that the Ad Council could shape the industry. See von Braunmühl, Das neue Werbegesetz, 15. Apparently, over time the Ad Council sought the power to levy fines. On the difficulties that Ad Council staff had in involving the police, see Roßwog, Der Werberat als Mittel staatlicher Wirtschaftsführung, 63–67. 79. These two bodies made twelve recommendations to cut back on the misuse of tobacco and alcohol—and number four was an end to ads for those products. See “Gegen Missbrauch von Alkohol und Nikotin,” DW 32, no. 6 (Mar. 1939): 378–79. For Hunke’s view of his office’s success in reforming ads that affected the “people’s health,” including the 1936 reforms of ads for pharmaceuticals as well as the campaigns to decrease alcohol and tobacco use, see his speech “Volksgesundheit und Werbung,” delivered on 25 May 1939 at the University of Berlin and published under the same title that year by the Berlin press of Carl Heymann. 80. BU, no. 330/39–442, p. 0226647, IG Farben, the chemical giant and makers of Bayer aspirin, took note of this decision in their own files, May 1939. 81. For a full description of the reforms issued for tobacco advertisements on 17 Dec. 1941, see Proctor, The Nazi War on Cancer, 204–6. According to Proctor, targeting children in ads for alcohol was banned in 1933, and the legislation was stiffened three years later (p. 147). Though these official restrictions were released in late 1941, Hunke had already hinted at the sort of ads he disapproved of in Apr. 1939; see “Präsident Prof. Dr. Hunke über Tabak und Alkohol in der Werbung” DW 32, no. 8 (Apr. 1939): 520–21. 82. LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1226, Der Werbeleiter no. 1 (1936): 21–22. 83. Zeller, Driving Germany, 55–65. The quotation here is found on p. 62. Zeller disagrees with Adam Tooze on the military implications of the Autobahnen. Compare Tooze, The Wages of Destruction, 45–46. 84. König, “Adolf Hitler vs. Henry Ford,” 249–68. 85. Spoerer, “Die Automobilindustrie im Dritten Reich: Wachstum um jeden Preis,” 61–68. 86. Chandler, Scale and Scope 527–31. Ford in Germany fell back some in the early 1930s owing to its investment in a huge facility in Cologne that outweighed demand. 87. There are a number of books written on the history of BMW from the vantage point of the company archives and by enthusiasts of the brand or the auto industry more generally. For a sampling, see Werner, Kriegswirtschaft und Zwangsarbeit bei BMW; Mönnich, The BMW Story; and Schrader, BMW. 88. BMW, UI 1532/1, BMW Blätter no. 1 (Mar. 1930): Introduction by Dr. Hans Hirschhorn. 89. Ibid., UI 1532/2, “Ein Englischer Fahrer ueber BMW,” BMW Blätter no. 2 (May 1930).



Notes to Chapter Three

90. Ibid., UI 1532/2, BMW Blätter no. 3 (June 1930). 91. Ibid., HA/AF/1431/8 and HA/AF/1705/10, both 1930–33. During the early 1930s women were also shown at the steering wheel in print ads or as part of the decision-making process of choosing a model. 92. Ibid., UA/561, Rundschreiben and memo appendix, “Kabriolett oder Limousine?” 1937. The company also sought to mollify their representatives around Germany who, in 1938, were warned that they would see a 27 percent cut in deliveries of cars in the second half of the year. Ibid. UA/561, Rundschreiben, 14 July 38. 93. Ibid., UA/561, Werbebriefe examples, 1938. 94. Ibid., UA/561, Rundschreiben, 14 July 38. 95. Ibid., UA/561, Rundschreiben, 10 Mar. 38. 96. DAG, 1928 advertisement quotation from Daimler-Benz, DIG 1988 M012. 97. Ibid., Das Magazin, 1929. DIG 1988 M4211. 98. Ibid., 1930, DIG 1988 M430. 99. D’Almeida, High Society in the Third Reich. 100. Ibid., 113. 101. DAG, 1934, DIG 1988 M614. 102. Ibid., ad appeared in the Velhagen und Klasings Monatshefte no. 11 (1933). 103. Ibid., ad appeared in the Stuttgarter Illustrierte—Das bunte Blatt no. 26 (1933). 104. Ibid., ad appeared in the Münchener Illustrierte Presse no. 36 (1935): 1194. 105. Ibid., ads “Deutschland im Aufbau” and “Wir halten Schritt mit diesen gigantischen­ Entwicklungen!” 106. Mercedes was not the only company to see the building of the Autobahn as a perfect sales opportunity for their larger, more powerful vehicles: Ford’s plant in Cologne, which was still under American leadership at this point, though manufacturing officially sanctioned “German products,” because they were made in Germany “by German workers with German materials,” noted as well even before the new roadways had opened for traffic: “The Autobahn will be the foundation for the further unfolding of German transportation . . . and the first phase of this progress is embodied in the Ford V-8!” Ford Benson Research Center, Dearborn, Acc. 183, Ford Foreign Literature, Ford V8 promotional booklet, 1935. 107. LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1215, Zum Werbe-Etat 1931/32, 5. 108. Feldenkirchen, Siemens, 301. 109. LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1227, preface to the booklet “Osram Werbung, 1932/1933.” This data still showed great improvement over the 1928 statistics, in which only 60 percent of Berlin’s homes had electricity, which lagged at least ten points behind other major European cities, including the majority of German cities, Vienna, and even Budapest. Ibid., no. 035/1, A. Friedrich, “Wir stehen am Beginn des elektrischen Zeitalters,” Osram-Nachrichten no. 19 (Oct. 1930). 110. The company estimated that they sent ad materials to 100,000 retailers and wholesalers around the globe. Ibid., no. 1215, Zum Werbe-Etat 1931/32, 6. 111. Ibid., no. 1215, Aufteilung der Werbemittel in percent, Deutschland 1930/31. For print material, 43 percent appeared as classifieds in daily newspapers, with a further 22 percent being devoted to magazines and journals.

297

298

Notes to Chapter Three 112. Ibid., no. 1215, Werbe-Etat 1931/1932, 27 July 1931. Phoebus was a cartel established in the 1920s between Philips, Osram, Tungsram, GE International, and other smaller companies, in which the participants coordinated their pricing, sales, technology, and advertising. Members had exclusive rights to sell in their home markets, and worked together to control the market in what Osram called the “common areas.” Brand names were maintained, but it was mandatory that ads for all participants would follow the same argumentation but through different text and images. The assumption was that if the budgets were about the same the number of ads would be about the same, or an equivalent: a few full-page ads with the rest as small classifieds as compared with an entire series of half-page ads. There was even the possibility that the same ad would appear multiple times each with a different brand highlighted. They also promised never to advertise in the same issue of a newspaper or magazine. See ibid., no. 1215, Aktennotiz, 27 Apr. 1931, 12–14. See also Osram’s plans for an updated contract in ibid., no. 1217, 10 Aug. 1932. Wilfried Feldenkirchen also discusses the establishment of the cartel in Siemens, 297–308. 113. Ibid., no. 035/1, “Die Elektrofront,” Osram-Nachrichten no. 1 (1 Feb. 1934). Dan Silverman’s work on Nazi job creation emphasizes the psychological importance of overcoming the desperation of the Depression. This sort of ad campaign supports Silverman’s claims that the new regime represented hope that unemployment could be conquered and that itself helped to turn the tide. Silverman, Hitler’s Economy, 220–21. 114. LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1170, Osram Director Brocke to the Steering Committee of the Elektrofront, 5 Dec. 1933. Excerpt from the flyer handed out at the assembly comes from the same file, titled “Hausbesitzer!” 115. Ibid. 1223, Werb-Rundbrief 33/72, 15 Dec. 1933. 116. Ibid. 1223, Osram Werbebrief, 27 Dec. 1933. 117. Ibid. 1223, late 1933 memos about articles to raise awareness for the need for better light in the Handwerk industries. 118. Ibid. 1223, Osram memo, 10 Oct. 1933. 119. Ibid. 1224, “Werbung 1934/1935.” 120. Ibid. 1224, “Besseres Licht—Schöneres Leben!” 121. Ibid. 1221, “Gemeinschaftsarbeit” (most likely from mid-summer 1935). With reference to this image, Osram ad men wrote that this kind of image “once again has led to great success” and refers specifically to the long tradition of “Intellectual- and Hand work” in the development of better bulbs. 122. Ibid. 1224, Werbe-Rundbrief, 19 Apr. 1934, “Den Heiratslustigen.” 123. Ibid. 1218, Werbeplan für Deutschland, 1935/36, 7 Feb. 1935, 2–3. 124. Ibid. 1218, summary of the discussion between Osram, Tungsram, Radium, and Pintsch concerning the introduction of the Doppelwendel Lampen in Germany, 26 June 1935. 125. Ibid. 1218, Osram Werbung 1935/36, 1 Aug. 1935. 126. Ibid. 1218. The slogan seems to date to early 1935 and be purely an internal creation of the firm. It began with memos that suggested a more aggressive tone could be taken in the ads if science could show that poor lighting indeed weakened eyes. When they had trouble ascertaining such information, despite requests



Notes to Chapters Three and Four

to university eye clinics and the Dresden Hygiene-Museum, they continued with the same slogan in general terms. See the correspondence in this file about scientific proof, including the letter from publicity director Heinrich to Brocke, 9 Feb. 1935. 127. Ibid. 1356, Rundschreiben to the Kundschaft from 10 Sept. 1935. 128. Ibid. 1218, Osram Werbung 1935/36, 1 Aug. 1935. 129. There was some concern about a Werberat prohibition of editorial essays about particular products, but the company still planned to prepare material on their products and lighting more generally in the hope of requests for such writings from newspaper editors. About 25,000 RM was earmarked for this part of the plan. Ibid. 1218, Werbeplan für Deutschland, 7 Feb. 1935. 130. Ibid. 1218, Werbeplan für Deutschland, 7 Feb. 1935. The magazine was expected to have a circulation of between twenty thousand and twenty-two thousand. It would be sent to retailers, wholesalers, the offices of the companies AEG, Siemens-Schueckert Werke, and Bergmann, the electricity producers, Electro-associations, and “men in leading positions.” 131. For more on Beauty of Labor, see Rabinbach, “The Aesthetics of Production in the Third Reich,” 43–74. 132. LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1218, Aktennotiz Werbung 1935/36, 19 July 1935. 133. Ibid., no. 656, meeting of the Vertrauensrat, 24 July 1935, 5. 134. Ibid., no. 1036, Direktions-Verkauf, 1931–36, 31 Mar. 1936. 135. Ibid., no. 1229, Osram-Werbung, 1937/38. See also file no. 1228 for 1936 images. For an example of sisters watching their brothers, see ibid., no. 035/1, Osram Nachrichten 1935/36. 136. For more information on the partnership between Beauty of Labor, Osram, and others firms in this sector, see ibid., no. 1111. For example, the director of the office would have his work space at the Beauty of Labor offices, and his operating budget would be covered by them. His salary, however, would be paid for by the industrial partners. This director would lead a committee including representatives from Osram, AEG, Siemens, and others such as the professional associations within the electricity sector. See Brocke’s notes about a meeting with various stakeholders, 15 July 1937. 137. LAB, A. Rep. 231, no. 1350, ad “Zur Olympia” for an example of how Gemeinschaftswerbung was used to promote Berlin during the 1936 Olympics. 138. Ibid., no. 1109, speech text by Brocke on the development of the lighting industry, 1937. 139. Ibid., no. 1111, memo by Brocke, “Marktforschung,” 24 Aug. 1937. 140. Ibid., no. 1218, Diskussionsvorschlag für den Werbeplan 1937/38, by Heinrich for Directors Jensen, Brocke, and Rothweiler, 6 Feb. 1937.

chapter 4 1. BU 167/9.2.1, Herbert N. Casson, “Winke für den reisenden Kaufmann,” Zepro-Nachrichtenblatt, no. 2 (1936). Casson was an early British expert on the concept of “Customer Service.” Bayer reproduced a series of his writings in their periodical for sales staff.

299

300

Notes to Chapter Four 2. Although Anschluss can mean “political annexation,” as it did for Austria in this era, here the word refers to the electric “connection” made by their products and the connection to their employees made by this newsletter. 3. The influence of women as shoppers and as taste-makers more generally is also noted in Peikow, Die soziale und wirtschaftliche Stellung der deutschen Frau, 38. 4. Siemens, 37/Ls510, Der Anschluss. Hausmitteilungen der Siemens-Schuckertwerke AG für Elektro—Fachgeschäfte 7, no. 11 (1936). Siemens, therefore, encouraged the retailers of its goods to follow the perfect gender-specific division of labor—the wife would run the sales floor and attend to customers, while the husband would handle the behind-the-scenes ordering and installation of purchases. 5. Carter, How German Is She? 6. Torp, Konsum und Politik in der Weimarer Republik, 99–101. 7. Ibid., 121–38. 8. For a thorough description of the struggles of consumer cooperatives in the first years of the Nazi dictatorship, see Kurzer, Nationalsozialismus und Konsumgenossenschaften. 9. Sopade, “Berichte aus Deutschland,” 1 (May/June 1934): 104–5. 10. Ibid. Installment purchases first became available at the turn of the century. See Spiekermann, Basis der Konsumgesellschaft, 350–54. 11. Sopade, “Berichte aus Deutschland,” 2 (Jan. 1935): 30–31. 12. For some examples, see Stephenson, Hitler’s Homefront; Werner, “Bleib Übrig!”; and Bessel, Germany 1945. 13. Grossmann, Jews, Germans, and Allies, 32, 41, 51. Götz Aly has emphasized the role of looted goods and foodstuffs from the occupied territories to explain the relative well-being of German civilians at the end of the war—and their willingness to support the genocidal policies of the regime. Aly, Hitler’s Beneficiaries. 14. Rheinisch-Westfälisches Wirtschaftsarchiv, Stollwerck Bestand, Reichardtwerk Rundschreiben, 4 July 1934. 15. Reagin, Sweeping the German Nation, 159. 16. Marchard, Advertising the American Dream, 13–14. 17. Sneeringer, “The Shopper as Voter,” 476–501, here 493. 18. WBW, Salamander Bestand B150, no. 677, Conference of the Alleinverkäufer, 9 Nov. 1931. 19. KFD, Kaffee Hag, customer letter reprinted in Hag-Post no. 1 (12 Mar. 1931). 20. Ibid., customer letter reprinted in Hag-Post no. 2 (12 May 1931). Such letters continued into the late 1930s. 21. Not only Nivea fans but housewives who used Vim, Lux, and other Sunlicht products also sent in photos, poems, and jingles that expressed their loyalty and perhaps their hopes that the ad departments might make use of their ideas. See, for example, Archiv Unilever Deutschland, Sunlicht Post 7, no. 7/8 (July–Aug. 1937): 7. 22. Nivea’s photographed models were never chosen from among the throngs of happy customers. The shots were prepared professionally for specific scenes or drawn from stock photos sold by photographers. Elly Heuss-Knapp often called on



Notes to Chapter Four

her photographer sister, Marianne, to supply her with photographs from which she chose her favorites for the advertisements she was designing. There does not appear to have been a tradition of complaining to companies about their products. At least the businesses researched for this book did not receive or keep negative letters. The latter seems unlikely, because during the war years, companies did keep letters complaining that beloved products were no longer available. 23. BU, 169/1.2, Zepro-Nachrichtenblatt, no. 3 (Nov. 1934). This data comes from an internal Bayer newsletter founded earlier that year to instruct sales staff on I. G. Farben’s branding practices and suggestions for improvement. 24. It is not surprising that among German firms, Sunlicht would be a leader in market research as a daughter company of the Anglo-Dutch concern Unilever. For more on Unilever, see Wubs, International Business and National War Interests; and Jones, Renewing Unilever. 25. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, “Markt-Erfoschung,” Sunlicht Post 4, no. 3 (Feb. 1934). 26. Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace, ch. 4. 27. Wiesen, “Driving, Shopping, and Smoking.” 28. For more on Wilhelm Vershofen’s theories of consumer research, see Vershofen, Handbuch der Verbrauchsforschung, esp. 63–86. 29. Wilhelm Vershofen, “Verbraucher sind wir Alle!” Mitteilungsblatt der Gesellschaft für Konsumforschung eV no. 1 (Apr. 1936): 1–4. 30. Vershofen, “Verbraucher sind wir Alle!” 5. 31. Wilhelm Vershofen, “Über die ausserwirtschaftliche Bedeutung des Verbrauchs!” Mitteilungsblatt der Gesellschaft für Konsumforschung eV no. 3 (Aug. 1936): 23–24. 32. Mitteilungsblatt der GfK no. 5 (Jan. 1937): 53. This example came from a wife of a civil servant who came from a rural community. 33. Ibid., 52. The respondent was referred to only as a housewife. 34. Ibid., 62. 35. Ibid., 59. 36. Ibid., 63. 37. Ibid. 38. Ibid., 65. This female correspondent was from Bad Mergentheim. 39. For a discussion of “Volksseife” (people’s soap), see ibid., no. 6 (Apr. 1937): 84. For a lengthy report about the declining quality of pantyhose, see ibid., no. 7 (June 1937): 107–15. This topic was clearly one that elicited heavy responses from female consumers and may have received extra attention from female correspondents as well. 40. Ibid., no. 5 (Jan. 1937): 64. One male consumer from Leipzig insisted that he ignored advertisements and only followed his own tastes. 41. Wilhelm Vershofen, “Einführung in die Volkswirtschaftslehre,” ibid., no. 12 (May 1938): 221–22. In another essay written by a colleague of Vershofen, the importance of consumption for the new “developed economy” is also made clear. The “ever increasing speed [of life]” had led individuals to desire only the newest products. Fashion was not only a matter for clothing design, it affected all consumer

301

302

Notes to Chapter Four products and had become a more important criterion than quality when making decisions about what to purchase. Krengel, Die Reklame in der Lehre von der Marktwirschaft, 23–25. 42. For a discussion of all the private and social instincts that should direct the writing of ads, see Kropff, Psychologie in der Reklame, 9–42. 43. BU, 167/9.2.1 Pharma Werbe-Anzeigen, Panflavin lozenges ad “Who here is in danger?” and Bayer aspirin ad “While you are sick . . .” (n.d., mid-1930s). 44. Chlorodont and Nivea ads, BIZ 1 (Jan. 1935). 45. Henkel, G11, Rundschreiben an den Herren Reisevertreter, 13 Feb. 1934. “Hellhörig,” or clairaudient, means able to understand even what is not being said. 46. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, “Was Hausfrauen fragen,” Sunlicht Post 3, no. 4 (Apr. 1933). 47. Ibid., “Zum Geleit,” Sunlicht Freundin 1, no. 1 (1936): 2. The magazine appears to have been issued three times per year. The first edition was likely published in August of 1936. 48. Ibid., “Unsere Anfragen an die Sunlicht Freundinnen,” Die Sunlicht Freundin no. 3 (Apr. 1937). 49. Unilever was the outcome of partnership in 1929 between Lever Brothers Ltd. and the two Dutch firms, Jurgens Group and Van Den Bergh Group. The two latter companies had already agreed upon a merger in 1927 as Margarine Union/ Unie. The amalgamation was one of the largest in European history and truly global in its reach. The complicated history of the company until the early postwar era is still best summarized in the three volumes by Wilson, The History of Unilever. 50. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, Survey: “. . . und was hat Ihnen gefallen,” included in Die Sunlicht Freundin no. 4 (Aug. 1937). 51. Uta Poiger also makes this point in “Beauty, Business and German International Relations,” 53–71. Yet Irene Guenther does not hesitate to remind us of the glamorous style that members of the Nazi elite and other wealthy Germans embraced in Nazi Chic? Compare Pat Kirkham’s work on the place of makeup in British wartime society in Kirkham, “Beauty and Duty,” 13–28. 52. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, “Kosmetik ist kein Luxus,” Die Sunlicht Freundin no. 5 (Dec. 1937): 12. 53. Jill Stephenson is right to point out that the myth that women were squeezed out of employment after 1933 is false. However, she notes that there was criticism during the Depression years, beginning therefore before 1933, of married women working outside the home—and potentially “taking” a man’s job. Even after 1933, there was never any legislation against female employment in the private sector, and the percentage of women (even married women) working rose throughout the 1930s. That said, Nazis and other conservatives still disapproved of women in high-paying and high-status jobs. They were better suited to serve as a “reserve army” where men chose not to work or when men were deployed elsewhere. See Stephenson, Women in Nazi Germany, 50–55. 54. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, “Das erste graue Haar,” Die Sunlicht Freundin no. 10 (Aug. 1939): 7. 55. BU, 168/1.2, “Drucksachen mit Dauerwerbung,” Zepro no. 3 (Nov. 1934).



Notes to Chapter Four

56. Ibid., “Die Zeitungs-Notiz im Dienste der Bayer-Werbung,” Zepro no. 3 (Nov. 1934). 57. Archiv Sektkellerei Kupferberg KGaA, Christian A. Kupferberg, “Warum ich selbst die Werbebühne betrat,” Kupferberg Gold-Perlen, Haus-Mitteilungen der Sektkellerei Chr. Adt. Kupferberg 37, no. 2 (1937): 1–3. This article first appeared in the industry magazine Der Markenartikel, Jan. 1937. 58. Ibid. 59. Ibid., “Folgen der Popularität,” Kupferberg Gold-Perlen, Haus-Mitteilungen der Sektkellerei Chr. Adt. Kupferberg 37, no. 3 (1937): 11–12. 60. Sächsisches Staatsarchiv, Chemnitz, BFC Bestand 30950, 37/746, letter from Fachuntergruppe industrielle Kleiderfärberei und chemische Reinigung to Böhme Fettchemie GmbH, 9 Aug. 1935. 61. Ibid., copy of Werberat decision as reprinted in DW 28, no. 16 (Oct. 1935): 1564. 62. Ibid., letter from the Präsident des Werberates der deutschen Wirtschaft to Böhme Fettchemie AG, 22 July 1937. 63. Ibid., letter from the legal department of Böhme Fettchemie to the Präsident des Werberates der deutschen Wirtschaft, 4 Aug. 1937. 64. Ibid., summary of the meeting between representatives of BFC, the Werberat, and the subgroup, dry cleaners, on 30 Aug. 1937. In September the company decided to forgo the use of this phrase in their promotional materials in order to rebuild the relationship with the dry cleaning association, “the members of which we share many business contacts [with],” though the Chemnitz firm reserved the right to return to the slogan in the future. Ibid., BFC legal department to the Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft, 13 Sept. 1937. At the end of September, the FiKcR responded to the company that their willingness to drop the one sentence went only part of the way toward satisfying their complaint. Letter from the FiKcR to BFC, 29 Sept. 1937. 65. Ibid., 37/748, Böhme Fetttchemie to the Verband der Werbungtreibenden eV, 14 Dec. 1934. This letter is quite instructive because the company goes to great lengths to present their product as cutting-edge technology and provides citations for their research to back up their product’s claims. 66. Henkel, H30, Paul Mundhenke, “Wirkungsgrenzen der MarkenartikelInsertion und deren Beurteilung durch den Vertreter,” Blätter vom Hause (1938). Emphasis in original. 67. Ibid. Mundhenke uses the example found in Deutsche Werbung of a sales representative’s report to headquarters about the sale of buckets of soft water in the town of Schöningen, which was then featured in a series of ads for their water softener, Henko. In Roman Rossfeld’s article on the sales force employed by the Swiss chocolate manufacturer Suchard, we see that the company’s traveling salesmen and independent agents already had this sort of broad job description (without as much emphasis on advertising) in the last quarter of the nineteenth century. See Rossfeld, “Emergence of Traveling Salesmen in Switzerland,” 735–59, here 741. Advertising became a more central part of the Suchard traveler’s duties around 1900; see 748– 49.

303

304

Notes to Chapter Four 68. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, Discussion of Germany by British managers at Unilever House London, 14 Sept. 1938. 69. Roy Church refers to those working in commercial distribution channels as a “vital source of intelligence” for companies. Church, “New Perspectives on the History of Products, Firms, Marketing, and Consumers,” 405–35, here 430. 70. We should not overestimate the brotherhood among these two groups of professionals. There was at time tension between sales staff and advertisers over the quality of the advertising material or the seriousness afforded it by the sales staff. Susan Strasser provides an excellent synopsis of this rivalry at the start of the twentieth century in the United States in Strasser, Satisfaction Guaranteed, 196– 202. 71. Derek J. Penslar notes that 63 percent of Germany’s Jews worked in the commercial sector at the start of the 1930s. That percentage is notable, but it still only amounted to 3.4 percent of the total German labor force working in commerce. It is also worth emphasizing that while independent commerce was the path chosen by many German Jews in the nineteenth century, they were increasingly finding work as white-collar employees. Penslar, Shylock’s Children, 131–32. For critique of these “outsiders” ranging back into the late nineteenth century, see Rossfeld, “Emergence of Traveling Salesmen in Switzerland,” 752. See also the antiSemitic cartoon from the Swiss newspaper Nebelspalter from 1895 on page 754. For a discussion of the attempts taken to regulate peddlers and other forms of traveling salesmen, and the competition posed in the last decades of the nineteenth century by a growing retail sector, as well as catalogues, the shipping of samples, and other innovations, see Spiekermann, Basis der Konsumgesellschaft, 386–400. 72. LAB, A. Rep. 231, Osram no. 1224. 73. See regular articles on headaches, clothing and travel expenses, and other toils of being on the road in Der Reisende Kaufmann throughout 1933. 74. “Deutsche Kaufmannshäuser,” Der Reisende Kaufmann 9, no. 9 (Sept. 1933): 156, as an example. 75. The literature on salesmen in the United States and Britain is far more extensive than for Germany. For a brief overview of recent scholarship, see Walter A. Friedman’s “Editor’s Note” at the start of the special edition devoted to salesmanship in the Business History Review 82 (Winter 2008): 665–70. For monographs, see Friedman’s Birth of a Salesman; and Spears, One Hundred Years on the Road. On the earlier history of itinerant salesmen, see Fontaine, History of Pedlars in Europe; and the essays in Reininghaus, ed., Wanderhandel in Europa. 76. For some background on the social status of those working in retail and wholesale trade, see Prinz, Vom neuen Mittelstand zum Volksgenossen. Prinz shows that despite promises to protect this sector, many policies weakened the political and economic position of employees in the commercial sector, such as longer open hours at stores and the dissolution of their professional associations. 77. Adolf Beseln, “Förderung arischer Reisender,” Der Reisende Kaufmann 9, no. 6 (1 June 1933): 90. 78. While all companies studied referred to their sales representatives as gentlemen, and the names of individuals I came across were all male, it does appear that some women did find employment in this field. In Der Reisende Kaufmann there



Notes to Chapter Four

were a few articles in the early part of the decade that referred to women on the road. One piece discussed the etiquette of rail travel—and showed a pair of female feet in pumps relaxing on the compartment’s seat opposite and a pair of female shoes being cleaned with the hand towel in the rail lavatory. Both examples were considered inappropriate behavior and given the images deemed to be female errors. See Der Reisende Kaufmann 10 (Jan. 1934): 11. 79. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, “Alte Wahrheiten in neuer Fassung,” Nachrichten vom Hause, Jurgens-Van den Bergh Margarine-Verkaufs-Union, Berlin, no. 15 (Mar. 1931). 80. Ibid., Handbuch für Vertreter, Jurgens-Van den Bergh Margarine-VerkaufsUnion GmbH (1930), section 4/1, 3. 81. Wilson, The History of Unilever, Vol. II, 295. Margarine production and consumption in Germany were also affected by the protection of agriculture, which kept butter prices low in comparison. Ibid., 333. 82. Among others books on political radicalism in late Weimar, see Swett, Neighbors and Enemies. 83. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, Vim Propaganda Memo, 11 Feb. 1931. Given the economic crisis, there were many young men with sales training (a further requirement) who were more than happy to apply for this arduous labor at 6 RM/day for singles or 7 RM/day for married men. 84. Henkel, G11, Rundschreiben no. 30, 10 Dec. 1935. 85. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, Sunlicht Werbung, memo on Fex to the Aussenbeamten, 1939. 86. Henkel, G11, Rundshreiben no. 30, 10 Dec. 1935. 87. Ibid., “Anleitung für die Durchfuehrung der Hauspropaganda,” 10 July 1935. Henkel used female Werbedamen earlier than Sunlicht, but they were clear that these women were to be engaged in educating housewives not selling to them. While the company recognized this happened from time to time, they discouraged it and even insisted that the women resist taking tips for their educational information and free samples. 88. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, “Dienst am Volke,” Sunlicht Post 4, no. (2 Feb. 1934). 89. Ibid., H. C. Reemtsen, “Die Erfahrungen der Vertreter und Reisenden müssen vom Ladeninhaber genützt werden,” Sunlicht Post 4, no. 3 (Mar. 1934). For a view of the company representative as a “person of trust” from a non-Nazi, see Eliasberg, Reklamewissenschaften, 220. There were also plenty of manuals that retailers could turn to in order to educate themselves about how to promote their goods and services. For example, the brochure Gute Werbung macht Käufer zu Kunden! (1937) gave tips on all forms of product promotion as a way to make “loyal customers” out of shoppers. 90. Archiv Unilever Deutschland, Richard Seiter, “Kameraden an der Arbeit: Der Sunlicht Reisende und seine Kunden,” Sunlicht Post 8, no. 10 (Oct. 1938). 91. This quotation refers to the language of national cohesion to keep wholesalers and retailers from ignoring the pricing and sales conditions set by manufacturers, from Henkel, G11, letter from headquarters to their bulk purchasers, 31 July 1933. See also the tips for “honorable practices” included in the volume by Leder,

305

306

Notes to Chapter Four Gesetz und Werbung, 10–12. This book was part of the series Help Yourself! [Hilf dir selbst!]. 92. “Darf man Wettbewerberzeugnisse Auskunft geben?” Der deutsche Kaufmann no. 11 (1937): 7. 93. Henkel, G11, Rundschreiben no. 7, 28 Mar. 1933. 94. Ibid., no. 25, 8 Oct. 1935. 95. Kühne, Belonging and Genocide, 32–54. 96. Henkel, G11, Rundschreiben no. 30, “An unsere Reisevertreter,” notes for the coming year, 10 Dec. 1935. 97. Retailers were also called to this task. See Spiekermann, “From Neighbour to Consumer,” 147–73, here 156–58. 98. Staff writer, “Wiederherstellung der Kaufmannsehre,” Der deutsche Kaufmann no. 2 (1937): 7. 99. This position was related to the party’s attacks on department stores as an allegedly “Jewish” retail form that should be undercut in order to bolster the position of “German” small-scale retailers. On the fate of department stores after 1933, see Briesen, Warenhaus, Massenkonsum und Sozialmoral, 178–95. 100. Horant Holm, “Eine Aufgabe den nationalsozialistischen Reisenden im neuen Staate,” Der Reisende Kaufmann 9, no. 7 (1 July 1933): 112–13. 101. Werner Deiters, “Eine staatspolitische Aufgabe des Kaufmanns,” Der deutsche Kaufmann Ausgabe A, B, C, no. 6 (1937): 1. The magazine was issued with editions for different audiences in mind, such as industry, retailers, and wholesalers/ exporters. This article was presented to all three groups. 102. Staff writer, “Der Ewige Jude,” Der Reisende Kaufmann 10, no. 6 (June 1934): 99. 103. WBW, Salamander Bestand B150, no. 690, “Salamander Schuhfabrik” undated brochure. 104. Ibid., Salamander AG, “100 Jahre Salamander—Die Geschichte eines Unternehmens im Zeitraffer.” Three sisters of Arthur Levi were married to German Jewish brothers. They too were able to escape Nazi Germany. For more on the company, including other instances of Aryanization of the shoe industry, see Sudrow, Der Schuh im Nationalsozialismus, 501–4. 105. Bräutigam, Mittelständische Unternehmer im Nationalsozialismus, 64. 106. Evans, The Third Reich in Power, 395. 107. WBW, Salamander Bestand B150, no. 690, company brochure from the 1960s. 108. Bräutigam, Mittelständische Unternehmer im Nationalsozialismus, 155. 109. Ibid., 236. The vast majority were female forced laborers, with smaller numbers of male civilians and POWs; France, Greece, and Hungary were the leading countries of origin. 110. WBW, Salamander Bestand B150, no. 866, “Alleinkaufende.” For a sample, see the reports from the visit to the shop in Bautzen (8 Nov. 1938), Demmin (28 Feb. 1939), and Flensburg (16 Feb. 1939). 111. Ibid., no. 807. See the company’s ad samples here from the mid-1930s. 112. Ibid., no. 507, “Ausbildung für Verkäuferinnen,” n.d., likely early 1938. 113. Ibid., no. 602, “Rundschreiben an die Reisenden,” 31 May 1937.



Notes to Chapter Four

114. Ibid., no. 602, report by a regional manager, 17 June 1935. 115. Bräutigam, Mittelständische Unternehmer im Nationalsozialismus, 256. She quotes a denunciation from NS-Kurier, 1 Apr. 1933. 116. James, The Deutsche Bank and the Nazi Economic War against the Jews, 84. See also Bräutigam, Mittelständische Unternehmer im Nationalsozialismus, 257–58. 117. A list dated 9 July 1945 counts 198 towns in Germany with Jewish-owned shops with Salamander contracts in 1933. If we estimate that the company had sixteen hundred such contracts (extrapolated from the late 1920s and late 1930s data) in 1933, we can conclude that roughly 12 percent of the contracts were with Jewish retailers. The list of 198 stores can be found in WBW, Salamander Bestand B150, file no. 825. 118. Connelly, “The Uses of Volkgemeinschaft,” 925–28. Connelly discusses the abrogation of housing leases and the desire by landlords to evict Jews years before it became legal. 119. WBW, Salamander Bestand B150, no. 495, Bericht über Reise in Mitteldeutschland, 2 Nov. 1937. 120. Ibid. The list compiled in 1945 details the option taken in each instance in which Salamander had a contract with a Jewish shop in 1933. There were only four possible outcomes: the town either lost a Salamander outlet, the Jewish shop was Aryanized, turned into a Salamander branch store, or the contract was moved to another shop in the same town. 121. Ibid., no. 495, “Einzelberichte: Eberswalde,” 24 Feb. 1937. 122. Ibid., no. 495, “Einzelberichte: Lüneburg,” 24 Feb. 1937. 123. ABK, H. Bahlsens Keks-Fabrik KG, Hannover, Rundschreiben no. 46, 29 July 1938. 124. Silverman, Hitler’s Economy, 252–53, 125. See, for example, the advice given to the Salamander rep by the engaged daughter of a shop owner in Bautzen who wanted the store to be sold, enabling her desired emigration. WBW, Salamander Bestand B150, no. 495, Bautzen, 13 Jan. 1936. 126. Ibid., no. 495, report about Ettlingen, 3 Feb. 1936. 127. Ibid., no. 866, “Bensheim,” 25 Oct. 1939. 128. Ibid., no. 495, “Solingen,” 25 Jan. 1937. 129. The best known study in this context is Cohen, A Consumer’s Republic. While Cohen is most interested in the emergence of a consumer citizen identity in post-1945 America, she traces the origins of these trends to the Depression. Matthew Hilton presents a longer trajectory in his study of consumerism “as an organized social and political movement” in Hilton, Consumerism in 20th Century Britain. See also Daunton and Hilton, eds., The Politics of Consumption. 130. This duality has been picked up by a number of historians from Kershaw, The Hitler Myth; to Fritzsche, Life and Death in the Third Reich, among others. 131. For the overlap between sales and advertising, see the handbook on “service” by Karrasch, Ich will durch Leistung Vorwärts. 132. Though most historians might look to the 1920s in tracing the origins of consumer citizenship in Germany, Belinda Davis would challenge that assertion with her research on German women during the First World War. See Davis, Home Fires Burning.

307

308

Notes to Chapter Five

chapter 5 1. Alfred Maelicke, “Leistungssteigerung und Wirtschaftswerbung,” DDV 9, no. 3 (1940): 103. This sentiment was so poignant that Henkel reprinted the article for its own employees in Henkel, Blätter vom Hause 20, no. 6 (1940): 155. 2. Henkel, G11, Rundschreiben no. 25, 28 Aug. 1939. In some cases where too many Reisende had been called to military service to cover the sales market, arrangements were made for their wives to take over their territories. Jacobs brand coffee, for example, took on wives of their employees. See KFD, Jacobs, no. 1251, memo, 9 Oct. 1940. 3. Henkel, G 11, Rundschreiben, no. 29, 9 Sept. 1939. 4. See, for example, Berghoff, “Consumption Politics and Politicized Consumption.” Nancy Reagin’s book on domesticity discusses the Four-Year Plan before the onset of war and the domestic ideals transferred to occupied Poland, but she does not provide analysis of the home front, in Reagin, Sweeping the German Nation. 5. Aly, Hitler’s Beneficiaries. 6. According to the staff at DW, Hunke’s qualifications for the job included the fact that his work as an early “national socialist revolutionary and fighter trained him not to defend burghers’ security or capitalist interests.” Moreover, as Gauwirtschaftsberater for Berlin since 1929 he had focused all his energy on the “economic and social healing of Berlin.” This position led him to found the magazine Die Deutsche Volkswirtschaft in 1932, and he retained it even after 1933 when he helped set up the Werberat. “Heinrich Hunke,” DW 32, no. 4 (Feb. 1939): 158–59. 7. For a recent study on wartime propaganda, see Herf, The Jewish Enemy. 8. Harry Damrow, “Der Unbequeme Werbeleiter,” DW 33, no. 15/16 (Sept. 1940): 511. 9. See, for example, the short book by the ad man Hanns Lechner written “from the field” in 1940. Lechner, Munich’s Gaufachschaftsleiter for the NSRDW, writes of the “stepchild of the economy” (advertising) and defends it from those who see it as serving no purpose in war. He also warns against those who believe that “after victory,” in an economy “free of need,” there will be no cause to advertise. Rather, Lechner insists, ads will continue to serve consumers, the economy, and the community as they have done since 1933. Lechner, Wirtschaftswerbung im Krieg und nachher (Munich: n.d.), 30. 10. Staff writer, “Werbung mit volkswirtschaftlichen Gesichtspunkten,” DDV 9, no. 3 (1940): 99. 11. Heinrich Hunke, “Vorwort” to his annual report, Der Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft im Jahre 1940 (Berlin, 1941), 5. Again Heinrich Hunke, “Die Deutsche Wirtschaftswerbung im Jahre 1941” in Wirtschaftswerbung: Mitteilungsblatt der deutschen Wirtschaft 8, no. 12 (Dec. 1941): 390–92. 12. Heinrich Hunke, “Vorwort” to his annual report, Der Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft im Jahre 1940 (Berlin, 1941), 5. 13. Hunke, Die neue Wirtschaftswerbung, 56. 14. Staff writer, “Werbung als Wirtschaftsfundament,” DDV 9, no. 13 (1940): 416.



Notes to Chapter Five

15. Vershofen, Handbuch der Verbrauchsforschung, Vol I. See the essay “Kriegswirtschaft und Verbrauchsforschung,” 169–75. 16. Hunke, Der Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft im Jahre 1939 (Berlin, 1940), 62. 17. Alfred Maelicke, “Leistungssteigerung und Wirtschaftswerbung,” DW 33, no. 3 (1940): 104. This article was picked up in a variety of publications. See below. 18. Hans Ruban, “Markenartikel im Kriege,” DDV 9, no. 6 (1940): 162. 19. Henkel, Hanns W. Brose, “Was wird aus dem Markenartikel?” Blätter vom Hause 20, no. 4 (1940): 103. 20. Henkel, Dr. Jonas, “Werbung für bewirtschaftete Waren,” Blätter vom Hause 19, no. 14 (1939): 442. The magazine expanded to fifteen issues at the start of war, two more than its previous annual run. 21. Max Zimmermann, “Die Bedeutung der Anzeige im Kriege,” Wirtschaftswerbung: Mitteilungsblatt der deutschen Wirtschaft, no. 11 (Nov. 1941): 366–67. 22. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp file no. 3: Auswirkungen NS-Gesetze Kriegsereignisse, Rüstungswirtschaft, Heinrich Hunke, “Hinweise zum Kriegsdienenden Werbung,” 1939. 23. Alfred Maelicke, “Leistungssteigerung und Wirtschaftswerbung,” DDV 9, no. 3 (1940): 103. “Good will” also in the English appears in Ruban’s article “Markenartikel im Kriege” in the magazine’s sixth issue in 1940, 162. 24. DW 33 (1940): 769. 25. And yet to be upstanding members of the community, it was necessary for ad men to remember the dangers of advertising in a market racked by shortages and unavailable goods. Hunke, Der Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft im Jahre 1939 (Berlin, 1940), 64. 26. Although Goebbels and Hunke had a falling out in 1943, the patron refused to accept the resignation of the man whose career he had furthered for at least a decade. In fact, according to a report cited by Carl-Ludwig Holtfrerich, on 26 Apr. 1945, Hunke fled Berlin out of fear of Goebbels’s reaction to the news that Hunke had been trying “to convince the military and political leadership of the economic futility of defending the capital.” Gall et al, Deutsche Bank, 363. In July he was taken captive by the Allies in his hometown near Detmold. He was held by the Americans in Dachau and Nuremberg until 1947. 27. Ibid., 66. 28. Hunke, Der Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft in Jahre 1940 (Berlin, 1941), 61. 29. In 1936 the Werberat announced that images of soldiers were permissible only when the advertisement was for a product directly connected to armed service—such as uniform-related goods or insurance. Even then the Werberat reserved the right to make decisions on a case by case basis in cooperation with military authorities. “Abbildungen von Wehrmachtsangehörigen,” Wirtschaftswerbung: Mitteilungsblatt des Werberates den deutschen Wirtschaft 3, no. 5/6 (Jan. 1936): 29. 30. Agfa film ad from DDV 9, no. 5 (1940): 145. 31. Letter from G. Baier to Beiersdorf, 11 Jan. 1942. The company responded to the woman with the name and address of the photographer who supplied the image. 32. Staff writer, “Im Gleichschritt,” DW 33, no. 17 (Oct. 1940): 566–71.

309

310

Notes to Chapter Five 33. Interestingly, these persuasive text-laden ads were pioneered in the United States. The origins of this “foreign” style were overlooked, publicly at least, by Werberat officials and practitioners alike. See Ross, “Visions of Prosperity” for more on the German-American advertising relationship in the interwar years. 34. Staff writer, “Zwischen zwei Werbejahren,” DW 33, no. 21 (Dec. 1940): 753– 60. 35. For example, see Sopade, Berichte aus Deutschland 6 (July 1939): 872. 36. Curt Ehrlich, “Die PuC Werkstätten. Ein Werbeargument erst recht in Kriegszeiten,” DW 33, no. 5/6 (Mar. 1940): 140. 37. Ibid., 142. 38. Henkel, “Reklame oder Werbung? Eine Hausfrau äußert sich,” Blätter vom Hause 20, no. 7 (1940): 179. 39. Beiersdorf, 0733, 1941. 40. Dr. Oetker ads from 1936, 1939, and 1940, found in BIZ. 41. Henkel, Blätter vom Hause 15, no. 5 (May 1935): 192–95. 42. Henkel, G11, Rundschreiben no. 12, 12 Sept. 1934. See also Sunlicht’s response to the fat quota system in “Mr. Nairn’s visit to Berlin, February 1938,” Archiv Unilever Deutschland, Hamburg, no. 1823. 43. Beiersdorf also asked this question in a letter sent to more than twenty-four thousand retailers who carried their products in March 1940. The article insisted that in addition to offering advice and in order to keep the brand alive, retailers should also continue to run advertisements for Beiersdorf products so their stores would maintain the loyalty of shoppers. See Beiersdorf, Headquarters to “Geschäftsfreunde,” 30 Mar. 1940. 44. Henkel, Staff writer, “Die Henkel-Werbung im Kriege,” Henkel-Bote Heft 1 (1940): 13. 45. The fourth company to work with the RVA was Schicht of Vienna, which was put in charge of the propaganda for the Ostmark. 46. For more on the history of the Persil brand, see Henkel’s own 90 Jahre Persil. Die Geschichte einer Marke with text by Wolfgang Feiter (1997). 47. Henkel, H20, Paul Mundhenke, “Gedanken über unsere Werbung,” unpublished manuscript, 1941. This essay noted that between 1929 and 1939, Henkel spent 60 million RM on ads. The 6 million RM spent in 1938 was equivalent to 2.4 million USD that year. Accounting for inflation, the amount spent would equal roughly 39.5 million USD today. See http://www.history.ucsb.edu/faculty/marcuse/ projects/currency.htm, accessed 17 June 2013. 48. Ciarlo, Advertising Empire; and Poiger, “Beauty, Business and German International Relations.” 49. Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace, 92. 50. The RVA was created in 1934 but took on a larger role in 1938 once Göring, as the coordinator of the Four-Year Plan, turned over all advertising and education concerned with the program to the Werberat. In the two years prior, the plan’s propaganda was organized by a separate office, the Reichsstelle für Wirtschaftsausbau, which was then subsumed into the RVA. See Hunke’s annual report, Der Werberat der Deutschen Wirtschaft im Jahre 1939 (Berlin, 1940), 9–10. The RVA led five major campaigns in the war. In addition to the one discussed targeting textile care, the



Notes to Chapter Five

others focused on household budgeting, ending waste, the conservation of heating sources, and the promotion and proper use of German raw materials. Hans Ruban, “Volkswirtschaftliche Aufklärung im Kriege,” Wirtschaftswerbung: Mitteilungsblatt des Werberates der deutschen Wirtschaft 9, no. 2 (Feb. 1942): 34–35; see also Ruecker, Wirtschaftswerbung unter dem Nationalsozialismus, 291–93. 51. Henkel, H20, Paul Mundhenke, “Gedanken über unsere Werbung,” unpublished manuscript, 1941. For more on the reputation of ads in the republican era and Nazi reaction, see Ross, “Visions of Prosperity.” On the Werberat and advertising in Nazi Germany more generally, see Westphal, Werbung im Dritten Reich; and Ruecker, Wirtschaftswerbung unter dem Nationalsozialismus. 52. Henkel Konzernarchiv, H20, Paul Mundhenke, “Von ‘Reklame’ zur deutschen Werbung,” n.d. 53. BAB, R5002, no. 26, Hanns W. Brose, “Vortragsmanuskript für die Amtsträger der Fachgruppen des Einzelhandels,” 18 July 1939. 54. Ibid., no. 17, Aktennotiz an die Geschäftsleitung, 4 Nov. 1942. At other times the RVA referred to their orders as having come directly from Göring as the director of the Four-Year Plan. See ibid., no. 26, Hanns Brose for the RVA, 18 July 1939. 55. Ibid., no. 26, RVA memo “Aufklärungs-Aktion Waschmittel-Einzelhandels,” 18 July 1939, 224–25. 56. Ibid., no. 26, meeting synopsis, RVA, 17 June 1939. 57. Toward the end of the war, the title “War-Wash Primer” was employed; see Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace, 193–94. 58. BAB, R5002, no. 17, Aktennotiz “Waschfibel,” 19 Jan. 1940. 59. Ibid., no. 26, memo from Verlag Otto Beyer, 10 July 1941, in which they note that the Waschfibel would appear in seven of their magazines with a circulation of 944,000. See also, in the same file, DAF to RVA, 12 Aug. 1941, in which the DAF ordered close to 290,000 brochures. In 1940 alone, the Werberat predicted that 21 million copies would be distributed to households. There seems to have been a small price attached, but it is not clear whether this cost was to be charged to individual housewives or to local party organizations that would then distribute the pamphlet in their areas. It could be that magazines and retailers were used as free distribution sites thereafter because women refused to pay for the booklet at their doors. Hunke, Der Werberat der Deutschen Wirtschaft im Jahre 1939 (Berlin, 1940), 40. Of course these numbers pale in comparison to the 58 million copies of recipes distributed to food markets leading up the war on making better use of plentiful items from fish and low-fat milk to jam and potatoes. See Hunke, Der Werberat der Deutschen Wirtschaft im Jahre 1939, 45. 60. BAB, R5002, no. 24, RVA to DAF, 15 Apr. 1941. These impressive numbers were not uncommon when it came to addressing housewives. The Reichsnährstand issued almost 9 million copies of a pamphlet encouraging the consumption of Quark, made from sour milk. Importantly, Reagin stresses the point that messages of these materials were not new, but the scale of the efforts to shape women’s habits was. See Reagin, Sweeping the German Nation, 151–53. 61. BAB, R5002, no. 26, RVA memo, “Aufklärungs-Aktion Waschmittel-Einzelhandels,” 18 July 1939, here 223, 226.

311

312

Notes to Chapter Five 62. Ibid., no. 17, RVA Aktennotiz, 22 Mar. 1941. 63. Ibid., no. 26, “Wenn Männer Hausfrauenverstand haben,” radio manuscript, 1940. 64. Ibid., no. 5, Böhme Fettchemie report to RVA, 17 June 1943. 65. Ibid., no. 5, Zusammenstellung der Ausgaben für die Aufklärungsaktion Sachgemässes Waschen der Firma Sunlicht in der Zeit vom 5.6.41–31.12.41. 66. Ibid., no. 17, Gekürzter Werbeplan 1943; budget for 1942, 48–58. 67. Ibid., no. 1, RVA memo to Werberat, 12 May 1942. The companies did chip in by buying some of the literature to pass out to their customers free of charge. See ibid., no. 17, RVA Aktennotiz, 8 Oct. 1940. 68. Ibid., no. 17, Aktennotiz an die Geschäftsleitung, 2 Apr. 1943. 69. Sächsiches Staatsarchiv, Chemnitz, BFC Bestand 30950 Böhme Fettchemie, B7/746, See the lengthy correspondence between BFC and Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft, 1935. 70. BAB, R5002, no. 17, Sitzung des Werbebeirats der Waschmittelindustrie, 5 Mar. 1942. 71. Ibid., no. 22, RVA to Dobmann at Sunlicht, 5 Nov. 1942. 72. Ibid., no. 22, RVA to Sunlicht, 20 Feb. 1943. 73. Ibid., no. 26, RVA to DAF, 15 Apr. 1941. 74. Ibid., no. 17, RVA Aktennotiz, 12 July 1940. 75. Ibid., no. 17, RVA Aktennotiz, 17 Feb. 1941. 76. Ibid. 77. BAB, R5002, no. 17, RVA Aktennotiz, 25 Nov. 1941. 78. For articles on the need to create these Gemeinschaftswerbung (cooperative ads), see the leading professional journal of the era, Die Deutsche Werbung. 79. BAB, R5002, no. 17, RVA Aktennotiz, hand-written date 11 Nov. 1941. 80. Ibid., no. 17, RVA Aktennotiz, 2 Apr. 1943. 81. Ibid., no. 25, Lewilbo-Werbung memo to the RVA, 13 May 1943. Interestingly, the firm could come up with only one positive suggestion but found thirteen negative ways to characterize women. 82. Ibid., no. 17, RVA Aktennotiz, 2 Apr. 1943. 83. Ibid., no. 10. The official termination of Dreckspatz seems to have come in April 1944, though discussion of how to replace it began much earlier. See Aktennotiz, 8 Apr. 1944. 84. Guenther, Nazi Chic?; and Reagin, Sweeping the German Nation. 85. BAB, R5002, no. 22, RVA to Sunlicht, 8 Mar. 1943, includes discussion of declining attendance at lectures. Ibid., no. 27, Fachgruppe Seifen- und Waschmittelindustrie to RVA, 18 June 1942, notes that housewives are complaining about the “senseless” advice that cannot be acted upon without soap at home. 86. Ibid., no. 17, RVA Aktennotiz, 17 Feb. 1941. The RVA complained here that Henkel and BFC had overstepped the bounds of their special status. 87. Dr. Jost Walbaum, Chief of Public Health in Nazi-Occupied Poland, as quoted in Browning, Remembering Survival, 122. 88. Henkel, H20, Paul Mundhenke, “Gedanken über unsere Werbung,” (n.d., likely 1941), 21–22. 89. See Hans-Erich Volkman, “Zum Verhältnis von Großwirtschaft und NS-



Notes to Chapter Five

Regime im Zweiten Weltkrieg” in Długborski, ed., Zweiter Weltkrieg und sozialer Wandel, 102. This excerpt from the 1940 bulletin sent by the Economic Group Iron can be found in Weltherrschaft im Vizier, 265. 90. KFD, Joh. Jacobs & Cie, letter to the Industrie- und Handelskammer, Bremen, 10 Jan. 1941. The response arrived two weeks later in which Jacobs was told to join the Gruppe deutscher Kolonialwirtschaftlicher Unternehmungen in Berlin, which would send them a survey about what sort of colonial commerce they hoped to develop. 91. Some advertisements for military vehicles were far more dynamic than the one pictured here. In 1943, for example, Daimler-Benz produced an ad that showed cars and trucks advancing at pace toward the viewer with the Mercedes star shining over the lead car, while aircraft in formation raced overhead. See DAG, Image 1988M733. My request to include this image in the book was denied by MercedesBenz Classic Archive, Daimler AG, Stuttgart. 92. For a brief overview of the German coordination of Czech industry in the late 1930s and early war years, see Teichova and Waller, “Der tschechoslowakische Unternehmer am Vorabend und zu Beginn des Zweiten Weltkriegs,” 288–302. This article does not mention Georg Schicht, but it does give a good sense of the massive appropriation of Czech industries for the war effort, and the apparent lack of German investment (compared with other European powers) in the Czech economy before 1938. 93. Georg Schicht had been a major soap and margarine producer in Central Europe since the mid-nineteenth century. Given the political situation after 1918, it was clear that Schicht needed to come to terms with its Western European rivals, primarily Jurgens and Van den Bergh, and the other local soap supplier, Centra, which it did in 1920. Wilson, The History of Unilever, Vol. II, 227–30. Owing to this earlier partnership, Schicht became part of Unilever in 1929. 94. Archiv města Ústí nad Labem, Georg Schicht AG collection, Box 363, correspondence between the Bund der Deutschen Arbeitsgebiet: Volkswirtschaft and Georg Schicht AG, Aussig, Oct. and Nov. 1936. 95. Ibid.: see, for example, the posters in the 1937 folio. 96. Ibid., Box 468, Rundschreiben to sales staff, 21 Sept. 1938. 97. Ibid., Box 468, Rundschreiben, Oct. and Nov. 1938. 98. Ibid., Box 468, Rundschreiben, 5 Dec. 1938. 99. Ibid., Box 468, Rundschreiben, 12 Aug. 1939. 100. Ibid., folio of competitors’ ads. 101. Ibid., Box 468, Rundschreiben, 23 Aug. 1940 and 18 Sept. 1940. 102. Aly, Hitler’s Beneficiaries, 97–100. Aly provides evidence that this was common Wehrmacht behavior throughout the occupied territories in the West and East. 103. Bryant, Prague in Black. This is the title of ch. 5. 104. Mazower, Hitler’s Empire, 60. 105. For some examples of this growing field, see Aly and Heim, Architects of Annihilation; and Heim, Plant Breeding and Agrarian Research in Kaiser-Wilhelm Institutes, 1933–1945. For a different angle, see Epstein’s work on Arthur Greiser’s career in the Warthegau: Model Nazi.

313

314

Notes to Chapter Five 106. Volker Berghahn argues that more research into business is needed for the years 1940 to 1942, as the high point of optimism. Berghahn, “Writing the History of Business in the Third Reich,” 143–44. 107. “Werbung ohne Beruf?” DW 33, no. 13/14 (Aug. 1940): 449–50. See also Jacobsen-Faulück, DW 33 (Mar. 1940): 148–58. It is important to remember that this posturing was also a response to fear that ad men would become obsolete under a controlled economy when the dust settled after the war. This article articulates that anxiety, with section titles including “Is This the End of Advertising?” and “Between Scylla and Charybdis.” 108. “Werbung ohne Beruf?” DW 33, no. 13/14 (Aug. 1940): 449–50. 109. Mazower, Hitler’s Empire, 260–61. 110. For more on the importance of ads to bolster Germany’s reputation abroad, see Alfred Maelicke, “Auslandswerbung auch im Kriege?” DDV 12, no. 8 (1943): 271–73. 111. AAS, Wiessner Monatsberichte, Mar. 1940. The director of Signal’s press, Deutscher Verlag, kept monthly reports during the war that remark on the establishment of the periodical and make it possible to chart the growth of the magazine’s circulation. The first detailed monograph on this magazine has recently appeared: Rutz, Signal. On the rivalry among the RVMP, Foreign Ministry, and the military, see Rutz, Signal, 39–43; and Gross, Export Empire. 112. Führer, “Pleasure, Practicality and Propaganda,” 153, fn 44. 113. This author intended to include a Pelikan advertisement from a 1941 French-language Signal edition showing a bird’s-eye view of their large manufacturing plant nestled into the peaceful Hanoverian landscape. However, the company refused permission to reprint the image. Most other companies contacted about having their ads appear in this book were more than willing to assist in the publication. 114. Rutz sees the Europe propaganda in Signal as a convenient slogan lacking real vision. See Rutz, Signal, 253–65. 115. AAS, Max Wiessner Monatsbericht, Feb. 1944. In 1943, Life magazine itself criticized the Office of War Information’s Victory as “a pallid imitation” of Signal. The American publication had a circulation less than half the size of the German magazine, and was produced in only eight languages for neutral territories. See “U.S. Is Losing the War of Words,” Life 14, no. 12 (Mar. 1943): 11–15. Reproduced at http://www.uw3.de/documents_life.htm, accessed 24 May 2013. 116. DUHC, JWT in Berlin files. Solm was remembered as “a big, handsome chap, bit of a brute” by his JWT colleague George Butler after the war. Jill Firth ed., Bush House, Berlin and Berkley Square, unpublished manuscript, 36. 117. Fritz Solm file in Berlin Document Center, BAB, PK/L0322, p. 2818; BAB SM/R007, 2358; and RK/I503, 658. Solm joined the NSDAP and SS in 1933. He was also an early joiner of the NSRDW, holding the membership number 396. Within the OKW he achieved the rank of Rittmeister in 1941 and major in 1945. According to Rainer Rutz, Solm died in 1946 in Switzerland from a self-inflicted tuberculosis infection that he had used as his ticket out of Germany at the end of the war. On Solm, see Rutz, Signal, 36–39 and 128–31; and Schiller, NS-Propaganda für den ‘Arbeitseinsatz,’ 141–42. Both authors note Solm’s reputation for shady business dealings.



Notes to Chapter Five

118. See Gross, Export Empire, ch. 6. 119. On cultural exchange as part of the larger effort to represent Germany abroad through a host of promotional efforts, see Klein, Die Werbung als Mittel der Exportförderung, esp. 18–29. The Werberat’s role in supporting these efforts is also discussed throughout the text. 120. See, for example, LNW, Hunke Nachlass, Detmold, Box 7/2, Ala-Nachrichten und Beratungsdienst, Heft 1/3, 12 Jan. 1939. Ala was the official advertising service for the Nazi press. 121. Hunke, unpublished memoir, 1999/2006, 7–8. 122. Ibid., 8. Hunke notes that the trip on a Romanian steamer from Pireas to Istanbul on 15 September 1938 was particularly unforgettable, because he and his colleague, Dr. Gerber, were the only Germans on board and “very unedifying scenes could only be controlled by the intervention of our Romanian captain, who took us into his personal protection.” Stephen Gross offers examples of others traveling in much the same way throughout the 1930s. 123. Hunke, “Die Grundlagen der Zwischenstaatlichen Wirtschaftsbeziehungen,” 42. Here Hunke explains that since 1933 the Reich “has worked toward a constructive European economic order,” particularly in this region, helping the small nations of Southeast Europe overcome their own economic crises “by buying so that the other countries could buy.” Hunke was a member of the presidium of the Southeast European Society (SOEG), an interest group founded in 1940 by Walther Funk and headed up by Ostmark Gauleiter, Baldur von Schirach, to promote Germany’s political, economic, and cultural connections to the region. Schumann, ed., Griff nach Südost-Europa, 54–56. The SOEG was the party-led rival to the industry- and finance-dominated Mitteleuropäische Wirtschaftstag (MWT). 124. Long-standing arguments about Nazi exploitation of the smaller European states, particularly in the southeast during the 1930s, have been challenged in recent years. While the “ideological commitment” to orient the German economy toward the east was strong among the Nazi leadership, as we see with Hunke, before the outbreak of war, patterns of trade between Germany and Europe’s southeastern countries remain historically consistent. Ritschl, “Nazi Economic Imperialism and the Exploitation of the Small,” 324–345, esp. 245, 340. 125. Victoria de Grazia mentions the greater attention shown to commerce between Germany and the southeast at the Leipzig Fair in Irresistible Empire, 222–24. Stephen Gross also discusses the role played by the Leipzig Fair in integrating the southeast into the German economy in the interwar period, and he alludes to the desire of German planners to increase the region’s purchasing power to bolster the health of the German-led Großraumwirtschaft in “Selling Germany in South-Eastern Europe,” 19–39, esp., 38. 126. Hunke, unpublished memoir, 1999/2006, 5. For further analysis of Hunke’s anti-British sentiment, see also Kletzin, Europa aus Rasse und Raum, 63–71 and 170–71. On Britain’s affluence in this period, and the commonly held jealousies of Germans vis-à-vis Great Britain, see Tooze, The Wages of Destruction, 140–41. 127. Hunke, “Die Grundlagen der Zwischenstaatlichen Wirtschaftsbeziehungen,” 40. 128. Heinrich Hunke, “Die wirtschaftliche Einheit Europas: Tatsachen und

315

316

Notes to Chapters Five and Six Probleme der kontinentaleuropäischen Wirtschaftsgemeinschaft,” DDV 10, no. 1/2 (1941): 68. Hunke was aware that such talk would raise concern in the north about their quality of life being damaged by the focus on the southeast. Hunke attempted to allay such worries, by emphasizing that a “higher standard of living [for all] was also the goal of the German leadership” and that its “struggles will be to the benefit of all Europe, including the North.” 129. Heinrich Hunke, “Aktive deutsche Werbung,” Wirtschaftswerbung 10, no. 1 (Jan. 1943): 7. While Hunke does speak directly of raising the standard of living for local inhabitants in southeastern Europe, we can only presume from earlier statements that he also favored the racial cleansing that was underway in this region. 130. Carole von Braunmühl, “Die Neuordnung des Werbewesens im neuen Europa,” Wirtschaftswerbung. Amtliches Organ des Werberates der deutschen Wirtschaft 9, no. 10 (Oct. 1942): 242–44. 131. Hans Domizlaff and Heinrich Hunke correspondence, 1941, LNW, Hunke Nachlass, Karton 7/1. For more on Hans Domizlaff in this era, see Friebe, “Branding Germany,” 78–101.

chapter 6 1. Joseph Winschuh, “Werbung als Kriegsinvestition,” Wirtschaftswerbung: Mitteilungsblatt des Werberates der deutschen Wirtschaft 8, no. 1 (Jan. 1941): 12. 2. BMW, UA 45/1, 1942, “Ein Firmenzeichen entstand,” draft by Wilhelm Farrenkopf. The comment about Anschluss was removed in the final version, but the passage about friends of the brand throughout the Reichsgebiet remained—and Italy was added to the list. 3. Ibid. 799/2, booklet of items with logo, Nov. 1936. 4. On the Werberat and advertising in Nazi Germany more generally, see Westphal, Werbung im Dritten Reich; and Ruecker, Wirtschaftswerbung unter dem National­sozialismus. 5. Zierenberg, Stadt der Schieber, 177 and 193. Mallmann and Paul also note the increased black market activity as well as pan-handling and theft of food and other necessities in the Saarland, particularly among foreign laborers, after 1942. Mallmann and Paul, Herrschaft und Alltag, 401–2. The regime understood well what the appearance of a black market signaled. Germany’s leaders took unsuccessful measures to thwart its growth, including trials of more than thirteen thousand citizens between 1939 and 1944—over five thousand of whom received the death penalty, as reported in Niemann, “‘Volksgemeinschaft’ als Konsumgemeinschaft?” 107. 6. BMW, UA 559, BMW, memo “Der Kraftwagenverkauf im Krieg,” 3 Apr. 1940. 7. Ibid. 78/1 Inner- und Ausserbetriebliche Werbung, 1943/44. Even so, in 1944 the ads department complained that they were unable to spend the entire 250,000 RM budget they had for placing images and articles about the company. 8. Ibid. The ads department noted that the Werberat had found this series of Anzeigen to be a model for German industry and had given permission to continue and expand the campaign.



Notes to Chapter Six

9. Ibid. 10. Compare Werner, Kriegswirtschaft und Zwangsarbeit bei BMW. 11. BMW, UA 94, Aktion Verbesserungsvorschlaege, Oct.–Nov. 1942. 12. For a journalistic account of life at BMW for forced laborers, see Mönnich, The BMW Story, 253–66. On forced labor more generally, see Spoerer, Zwangsarbeit unter dem Hakenkreuz. 13. BMW, UA 551/0, “Tätigkeitsbericht 1944.” 14. Among others, see Geyer, “There Is a Land Where Everything Is Pure: Its Name Is Land of Death,” 118–47, see 123–25. Civilian death tolls also escalated in the final year owing to bombings, ground combat, and a regime increasingly willing to lash out at those whom it claimed to represent. 15. Swett, “Preparing for Victory.” 16. BMW, UA 551/0, “Tätigkeitsbericht 1944.” 17. Ibid. 78/1, Bericht ueber die 7. Aktion der betrieblichen Werbung, “Votre idée—votre profit, ab. 15 Mar. 1944. 18. Ibid., “bei BMW” (c. 1943). 19. Ibid., “La vie et la travaille chez BMW,” 1944. 20. Kershaw, The End, 186–90. 21. DTM, AEG, file #03366, Anlage zum Direktionsrundschreiben, 10 Aug. 1944, Betr. Innerbetriebliche Werbung, 1944/45, Blatt 43–44. 22. AEG and Siemens, Germany’s two most historic and powerful producers of electrical products for individual consumers and heavy industry, were rivals but also cooperated on many ventures. They were equal partners first in TelefunkenGesellschaft (1903) and then in Osram’s founding in 1919. Feldenkirchen, Siemens, 294, 299. 23. DTM, AEG Bestand, file #0336, Notiz Betr: AEG Pressetätigkeit im Urteil von Siemens, 30 Mar. 1943. 24. Ibid. See the correspondence between the AEG Kassel office and the Pressestelle at company headquarters about anti-Semitic articles in May 1944 in the Kurhessische Landeszeitung. 25. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp, Ordner: Werbeabteilung to EHK, 6 Feb. 1942. 26. Beiersdorf, Nivea Anzeigen 1943, company memo, 29 Oct. 1943. 27. Ibid. 1944, letter from customer in Giessmannsdorf, 28 July 1944. 28. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knapp, file no. 1: letter from Führmann to EHK, 22 Apr. 1944. 29. Ibid., file no. 2: “Allgemeines, 1936–52,” Werbeabteilung to EHK, Hansaplast Anzeigen, 2 May 1944. 30. Ibid.: “Allgemeines, 1936–52,” EHK to Beiersdorf AG, Werbeabteilung, 10 June 1944. While Heuss-Knapp was no friend of the regime, the company history of the brand goes too far perhaps when it says that she kept the “national socialist worldview out of Nivea ads.” See Beiersdorf AG, Nivea: Entwicklung einer Weltmarke. 31. Beiersdorf, Elly Heuss-Knap file no. 2: “Allgemeines, 1936–52,” Elly HeussKnapp an Beiersdorf AG, Werbeabteilung, 13 June 1944. She appears to have sent in her revisions on 5 July 1944, including fewer ads featuring children and more

317

318

Notes to Chapter Six featuring women in industry. See Elly Heuss-Knapp, file no. 1: EHK letter to Beiersdorf, 5 July 1944. 32. Betts, “Bauhaus und Nationalsozialismus—ein Kapitel der Moderne,” 34– 41. See also Brüning, “Bauhäusler zwischen Propaganda und Wirtschaftswerbung,” 24–47. Brüning makes it clear that the designs of Herbert Bayer were as impressive to audiences at the Chicago World’s Fair as they were to those at Nazi-sponsored exhibitions in Germany in the mid-1930s (p. 28). 33. A company publication notes that 40 percent of total production was going to the military, with an added percentage reserved for distribution by the German Red Cross to the nation’s POWs on foreign soil. This contribution was significant enough to gain the title “arms factory,” which brought with it certain privileges such as access to forced laborers. Kessler, Bahlsen, 33. 34. ABK, letter to Herr Konrad Heil of Mannheim, 16 June 1943. 35. In the protectorate, and likely elsewhere, candles became a chief item for barter at the end of the war—urbanites could trade them in the countryside for eggs, and villagers needed them because electricity and other fuel sources had disappeared. The Centra (Vita margarine) subsidiary of Schicht asked those in Aussig if they couldn’t find a way to ensure that a shipment of candles from their sister company (Saponia) be included for their best customers. “Besprechung mit 6 Vita Vertreter,” 9 Nov. 1943. Archiv města Ústí nad Labem, Georg Schicht AG, Box 496. 36. Ibid., Box 596, Wochenbericht from Vita Margarine to Georg Schicht AG in Aussig, 4 Nov. 1941. 37. On the significance attached to the black market by the National Socialist state and the serious consequences of conviction during the war years, see Zierenberg, Stadt der Schieber, 37–42. For further evidence that sales representatives may have found themselves particularly adept at engaging in the black market, see ibid., 92–94. On the social profile of war-era black marketeers, see pages 101–7. Seventy percent of all those charged were men, the majority of whom worked in positions that allowed them to have access to rare goods: tobacco, textiles, foodstuffs, and so forth. 38. Archiv města Ústí nad Labem, Georg Schicht AG, Box 496, memo no. 38/22, 8 June 1943. 39. Ibid., “Zur Landbereisung mit dem Fahrrad,” 11 Oct. 1943. 40. Ibid., Vertreter Besprechungen in Prerau and Brünn, 11 Oct. 1943. 41. Ibid., Akten-Notiz, 5 Aug. 1943. 42. Archiv města Ústí nad Labem, Georg Schicht AG, “Werbung: Slowakei,” 8 Dec. 1944. 43. Ibid., Box 496, “Besprechung mit 6 Vita Vertreter,” 5 Nov. 1943. 44. Ibid., Ceresreferat note to Weyricht at Aussig, 2 Apr. 1943. Unfortunately, the decision from headquarters about Herr P.’s status in the company is not recorded in the Schicht archive. 45. WBW, Bestand B150, no. 677, “Bestimmungen über die Erteilung von Schuhbezugsscheinen,” 1 Apr. 1941. 46. Ibid., Fachgruppe Schuhindustrie der Wirtschaftsgruppe Lederindustrie, memo to all members, 18 Apr. 1942.



Notes to Chapter Six

47. Bräutigam, Mittelständische Unternehmer im Nationalsozialismus, 95–96. 48. WBW, Bestand B150, no. 40, Alleinverkäufer card collections. This information is corroborated by Bräutigam, Mittelständische Unternehmer im Nationalsozialismus, 164. 49. Bräutigam, Mittelständische Unternehmer im Nationalsozialismus, 162. In September 1941 Salamander was fined 100,000 RM for having produced more shoes than allowed by the Reichstelle für Lederwirtschaft—and some civilian shoes with leather soles. See ibid., 226–30. 50. Salamander report, 1940, quoted in ibid., 194. 51. WBW, Bestand B150, no. 1410 1/4, Salamander AG to the Landratsamt in Ludwigsburg, 2 Apr. 1947. 52. Ibid. Despite this long battle, it is not likely their requests fell on sympathetic ears. As early as September 1945, the mayor of Türkheim had noted that for Bavaria all losses before 5 May 1945 were to be considered “war losses,” and only damage done between 5 May and 15 June could be considered “plundered property.” See the mayor’s Bekanntmachung of 10 Sept. 1945 in WBW, Bestand B150, no. 1410, 1/4. On looting in the final days of the conflict, see Bessel, Germany 1945, 349–50. 53. WBW, Bestand B150, no. 1410, 2/4, Bericht über die Schuh-Aktion Pfronten, 27 June 1945. 54. Ibid., Landrat for Ernährungs- und Wirtschaftsamt Professor Dr. Zwick in Füssen to Landrat Dr. Samer, 5 Sept. 1945. 55. Ibid., Bericht über die Schuh-Aktion Pfronten, 27 June 1945. The threat was likely the withholding of ration cards for shoes or other necessities. 56. Ibid., Landrat for Ernährungs- und Wirtschaftsamt Professor Dr. Zwick in Füssen to Landrat Dr. Samer, 5 Sept. 1945. 57. Ibid., individual invoices for Salamander shoes, May 1945. 58. Ibid., data from the chart “Ausweichlager Türkheim,” 31 Dec. 1945. The occupying forces in the western zones, in particular, were keen to see economic revival and permitted most firms who applied to restart their businesses in the summer of 1945, Bessel, Germany 1945, 370. 59. Heinrich Hunke, “Vom Geist der deutschen Werbung,” Wirtschaftswerbung. Amtliches Organ des Werberates der deutschen Wirtschaft 11, no. 9/10 (Sept./Oct. 1943): 113–14. 60. Mark Spoerer also speaks of industrial elites as “junior partners” working in conjunction with political leaders in Von Scheingewinn zum Rüstungsboom, 170. Acting with some independence does not rule out, however, company decisions that followed objectives not set by the regime. One example of this corporate behavior is discussed by Schneider, “Business Decision Making in National Socialist Germany,” 396–428. Neil Forbes argues that the desire for “entrepreneurial agency” was the key motivator among senior managers and directors in Forbes, “Multinational Enterprises, ‘Corporate Responsibility’ and the Nazi Dictatorship,” 149–67, here 150. 61. For more on Hunke’s 1943 speech and essay, see Herbst, Der Totale Krieg und die Ordnung der Wirtschaft, 249–52; Kletzin, Europa aus Rasse und Raum, 178– 87. 62. Heinrich Hunke, “Die Kernfragen des wirtschaftspolitischen Kampfes in

319

320

Notes to Chapter Six der Gegenwart,” DDV 12, no. 27 (1943): 833–36. Also available in Zeitschrift für Politik, 33, no. 10/11 (Oct./Nov. 1943): 425–35. An abridged version was reprinted for circulation throughout the Continent in Signal. The slogan “Lead don’t manage” appears earlier, as does his general wish to articulate the “central questions” facing the country’s economic and political leaders. For example, the slogan serves as the title of an article in Deutsche Allegemeine Zeitung no. 1 (1 Jan. 1941). For more on Hunke’s long view of the war and the European economy, see Heinrich Hunke, “Der dreißigjährige Wirtschaftskrieg,” DDV 13, no. 1 (1944): 14–5. 63. See Hunke’s introduction to Europäische Wirtschaftsgemeinschaft, 7 and then 215–17, for a sense of the importance of the British Empire in his thinking. 64. A. W. Post, “Um die neue Prägung der Auslandswerbung,” Wirtschaftswerbung 11, no. 5 (May 1944): 29–30. 65. ABK, folio “Lichtwerbung.” Most of the responses, which arrived at headquarters in the summer of 1949, indicated that replacements were needed. 66. Pence, “Shopping for an ‘Economic Miracle,’” 105–20, here 107. 67. Bessel, Germany 1945, 372. 68. Carter, How German Is She? 51. In 1955 only 11 percent of West German households had refrigerators. Ibid., 54. “Consumer wonderland” is Carter’s phrase, 59. On the 1950s as a decade marked by the emergence and critique of a “consumer mentality” in the FRG, see Schildt, Moderne Zeiten, 351–97. This shift not only affected what could be purchased, it also transformed how goods were purchased. On the explosion of self-service shopping, see Wildt, Am Beginn der Konsumgesellschaft, 186–94. See also Wildt’s chapter on magazine recipes for the shift in rhetoric about food in the 1950s, 214–39. 69. Bessel, Germany 1945, 394. 70. Because large quantities of currency were already circulating before 1945, and few products were becoming available anywhere to consumers, inflation skyrocketed, fueling the black market and leading to rationing and price and wage freezes. 71. Kaminsky, Illustrierte Konsumgeschichte der DDR, 12. 72. Grossmann, Jews, Germans, and Allies, 105. 73. Kessler, Bahlsen, 36. 74. Bessel, Germany 1945, 376–83. On conditions in the French zone of occupation, see also Höhn, GIs and Fräuleins, 17–31. 75. Eyewitnesses remember this moment as the first economic “miracle”—shop windows appeared to have been replenished overnight. In Kaminsky, Wohlstand, Schönheit, Glück, 23. 76. DTM, AEG Bestand, file 02493, AEG Verkaufsleitung Rundschreiben, no. 150, 31 Aug. 1949. 77. Ibid., AEG Verkaufsleitung to Heinz Dürrbeck, 7 Nov. 1949. 78. For a fuller discussion of DEWAG’s contributions, see Tippach-Schneider, Messemänchen und Minol-Pirol. 79. Merkel, Utopie und Bedürfnis, 210–18. 80. Rubin, Synthetic Socialism. Amy E. Randall provides examples of these practices from the Soviet Union in Randall, The Soviet Dream World of Retail Trade and Consumption in the 1930s; and on the former Yugoslavia, Patterson, Bought & Sold.



Notes to Chapter Six

81. Loehlin, Rugs to Riches, 12–13. 82. Carter, How German Is She? 99. Earlier in the book, Carter makes reference to these continuities. See page 41, where she offers a quotation from the National Socialist women’s leader, Gertrud Scholz-Klink, that sounds very similar to the postwar rhetoric that asked women to step up as consumer citizens. While I indicate that this language became common in the interwar period, the first steps in this direction were taken before 1914. See Neve, Sold! 83. DTM, AEG Bestand, file 03646, Hermann Lanzke, “Betrachtungen über die AEG-Werbung,” 10 Feb. 1950. Throughout the report, Lanzke refers to “winning the public trust”—a reference to the 1939 book by market guru Hanz Domizlaff, which had a vibrant rebirth in 1950s West Germany. 84. Ibid., file 00042, Vorstandssitzung am 1. und 2. Nov. 1950, 85. Michael Wildt charges that the idea of brand loyalty did not survive the 1950s, because loyalty to Führer and Volk had been so bitterly disappointed by the war experience. I would agree that by the end of the decade the abundance of new and varied products enticed consumers to break from their established shopping patterns, but I am less convinced that this trend is an outcome of the war experience. See Wildt, Am Beginn der Konsumgesellschaft, 203. 86. Mergel, “Der mediale Stil der ‘Sachlichkeit,’ ” 29–52, here 37. Mergel points out elsewhere, however, that a report from the 1961 parliamentary campaign demonstrated that the skepticism also reflected the assumption that propaganda would be less effective in a “free” society. Mergel, Propaganda nach Hitler, 102–3. 87. Christian A. Kupferberg, “Was wünschen die Werbungtreibenden,” manuscript for Die Graphik, 23 Sept. 1948. 88. The Zentralausschuss der Werbewirtschaft (ZAW—Central Federation of the German Advertising Industry), established in 1949 as an umbrella organization of ad agencies and professionals, easily accepted advertisers who had worked under the Werberat. Hunke too was a member. See Ruecker, Wirtschaftswerbung unter dem Nationalsozialismus, 359. The postwar literature from the GfK also speaks highly of the work done by the Werberat, including the founding of the Reichswerbeschule, which “enjoyed an excellent reputation.” See Bergler, Die Entwicklung der Verbrauchsforschung in Deutschland, 24. The successful postwar advertiser Hanns W. Brose also wrote proudly of his accomplishments in the 1930s and the war years. See Brose, Die Entdeckung des Verbrauchers, 55–88. After a successful career as a marketing director through the 1930s and 1940s, Carl Hundhausen remained a prominent figure in West Germany, writing “the public relations bible” for the country in 1950. See Wiesen, West German Industry and the Challenge of the Nazi Past, 107. 89. See Bergler, Die Entwicklung der Verbrauchsforschung, 24. 90. Wienkötter, ed., Wienkötters Handbuch der deutschen Werbung, 141–42. 91. Hunke was released by the Americans in 1947. He was also investigated by the British, who recommended that he be given work by the military government after leaving prison. NARA, RG 260: Office of Military Government U.S., entry 574 (A1), Dr. Heinrich Hunke, Box 232. 92. Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace, 231–43. 93. Tooze, The Wages of Destruction, 676. 94. Coming at the issue from another angle, the economic historian Albrecht

321

322

Notes to Chapter Six Ritschl finds “startling” evidence that leads him to conclude that “the regional and commodity structures of trade flows during the war anticipated trade patterns that became prevalent within the European Community in the 1960s”; in Ritschl, “Foreign Exchange Balances,” 341. 95. Bajohr, “Aryanisation” in Hamburg. 96. As Hartmut Berghoff remarked, “Consumption in Nazi Germany has been an enigma to many observers.” Berghoff, “Enticement and Deprivation,” 165–84, here 165. 97. Mazower, Hitler’s Empire. 98. Aly, Hitler’s Beneficiaries. 99. Wiesen, Nazi Marketplace, 89–90.

Works Cited

unpublished sources from the following archives: Archiv der H. Bahlsen Keksfabrik KG, Hanover Archiv města Ústí nad Labem (CR) Archiv Sektkellerei Kupferberg KGaA, Mainz Archiv Unilever Deutschland, Hamburg Bayer Unternehmensarchiv, Leverkusen Beiersdorf AG, Hamburg BMW Group Archiv, Munich Bundesarchiv Deutschland, Berlin-Lichterfelde Coporate Archive, Henkel AG & Co. KGaA, Düsseldorf Das historische Archiv der Axel Springer Verlag AG, Berlin Deutsches Hygiene-Museum, Dresden Dorland Werbeagentur, Berlin Duke University Special Collections Hartman Collection, Durham, NC (USA) History of Advertising Trust, Raveningham, Norwich (UK) Kraft Foods Deutschland GmbH, Bremen Landesarchiv Berlin Landesarchiv Nordrhein-Westfalen, Abteilung Ostwestfalen-Lippe, Detmold Mercedes-Benz Classic Archive, Daimler AG, Stuttgart Private Collection of Dr. Henrich Hunke, Hanover Rheinisch-Westfälisches Wirtschaftsarchiv, Cologne Sächsisches Staatsarchiv, Chemnitz Siemens Corporate Archives, Munich Stiftung Deutsches Technikmuseum, Berlin U.S. National Archives, College Park, MD Wirtschaftsarchiv Baden-Württemberg, Hohenheim

324

Works Cited

published sources Abelshauser, Werner. “Germany: Guns, Butter and Economic Miracles.” In Harrison, ed. The Economics of World War Two, 122–76. Aly, Götz. Hitler’s Beneficiaries: Plunder, Racial War, and the Nazi Welfare State. New York: Metropolitan Books, 2007. Aly, Götz, and Susanne Heim. Architects of Annihilation: Auschwitz and the Logic of Destruction. Princeton: Princeton University Press, 2002. Aynsley, Jeremy. Graphic Design in Germany, 1890–1945. Berkeley: University of California Press, 2000. Bajohr, Frank. “Aryanisation” in Hamburg: The Economic Exclusion of Jews and the Confiscation of Their Property in Nazi Germany. New York: Berghahn, 2002. Bajohr, Frank. “No ‘Volksgenossen’: Jewish Entrepreneurs in the Third Reich.” In Gellately and Stoltzfus, eds. Social Outsiders in Nazi Germany, 45–65. Bajohr, Frank, and Joachim Szodrzynski. “Keine juedische Hautcreme mehr benutzen! Die antisemitische Kampagne gegen die Hamburger Firma Beiersdorf 1933/1934.” In Herzig, ed. Die Juden in Hamburg 1590–1990, 515–26. Baranowski, Shelley. Strength through Joy: Consumerism and Mass Tourism in the Third Reich. New York: Cambridge University Press, 2004. Bavaj, Riccardo. Die Ambivalenz der Moderne im Nationalsozialismus. Ein Bilanz der Forschung. Munich: Oldenbourg, 2003. Behme, Theda. Reklame und Heimatbild. Neudamm: J. Neumann, 1931. Beiersdorf AG, Nivea: Entwicklung einer Weltmarke. Hamburg: Beiersdorf AG, 1995. Berghahn, Volker R. “Writing the History of Business in the Third Reich: Past Achievements and Future Directions.” In Nicosia and Huener, eds. Business and Industry in Nazi Germany, 129–48. Berghoff, Hartmut. “Consumption Politics and Politicized Consumption: Monarchy, Republic, and Dictatorship in Germany, 1900–1939.” In Berghoff and Spiekermann, eds. Decoding Modern Consumer Societies, 125–48. Berghoff, Hartmut. “Enticement and Deprivation: The Regulation of Consumption in Pre-War Nazi Germany.” In Daunton and Hilton, eds. Politics of Consumption, 165–94. Berghoff, Hartmut. “Methoden der Verbrauchslenkung im Nationalsozialismus.” In Gossewinkel, ed. Wirtschaftskontrolle und Recht in der nationalsozialistischen Diktatur, 281–316. Berghoff, Hartmut. “‘Times Change and We Change with Them’: The German Advertising Industry in the Third Reich—Between Professional Self-Interest and Political Repression.” Business History 45, no. 1 (2003): 128–47. Berghoff, Hartmut. Zwischen Kleinstadt und Weltmarkt: Hohner und die Harmonika, 1857–1961. Padeborn: Schonigh, 1997. Berghoff, Hartmut, and Uwe Spiekermann, eds. Decoding Modern Consumer Societies. New York: Palgrave, 2011. Bergler, Georg. Die Entwicklung der Verbrauchsforschung in Deutschland und die Gesellschaft für Konsumforschung bis zum Jahre 1945. Kallmünz: Lassleben, 1961. Bessel, Richard. Germany 1945: From War to Peace. New York: Harper, 2009.



Works Cited

Betts, Paul. The Authority of Everyday Objects: A Cultural History of West German Industrial Design. Berkeley: University of California Press, 2004. Betts, Paul. “Bauhaus und Nationalsozialismus—ein Kapitel der Moderne.” In Fiedler and Feierabend, eds. Bauhaus, 34–41. Biggeleben, Christof. “Die Verdrängung der Juden aus der Berliner Industrie- und Handelskammer und dem Verein Berliner Kaufleute und Industrieller.” In Biggeleben, Schreiber, and Steiner, eds. “Arisierung” in Berlin, 54–86. Biggeleben, Christof, Beate Schreiber, and Kilian J. L. Steiner, eds. “Arisierung” in Berlin. Berlin: Metropol, 2007. Borscheid, Peter. Das Tempo-Virus: Eine Kulturgeschichte der Beschleunigung. Frankfurt: Campus, 2004. Borscheid, Peter, and Clemens Wischermann, eds. Bilderwelt des Alltags: Werbung in der Konsumgesellschaft des 19. und 20. Jahrhunderts. Stuttgart: Franz Steiner, 1995. Bräutigam, Petra. Mittelständische Unternehmer im Nationalsozialismus: Wirtschaftliche Entwicklungen und soziale Verhaltensweisen in der Schuh- und Lederindustrie Badens und Württembergs. Munich: Oldenbourg, 1997. Breckman, Warren G. “Disciplining Consumption: The Debate about Luxury in Wilhelmine Germany, 1890–1914.” Journal of Social History 24, no. 3 (1991): 485– 505. Brewer, John. “Was können wir aus der Geschichte der frühen Neuzeit für die modern Konsumgesellschaft lernen?” In Siegrist, Kaelble, and Kocka, eds. Europäische Komsumgeschichte, 51–74. Briesen, Detlef. Warenhaus, Massenkonsum und Sozialmoral. Frankfurt: Campus Verlag, 2001. Brose, Hanns W. Die Entdeckung des Verbrauchers: Ein Leben für die Werbung. Düsseldorf: Econ, 1958. Brose, Hanns W. Götterdämmerung des Markenartikels? Neue Wege zu neuen Käufern. Schwarzenberg: E. M. Gärtner, 1934. Brose, Hanns W. Sechs Briefe an Herrn M in the series Werbewirtschaft und Werbegestaltung. Berlin: Deutscher Betriebswirte, 1937. Browning, Christopher. Remembering Survival: Inside a Nazi Slave Labor Camp. New York: Norton, 2011. Brugger, Alfons, ed. Jahrbuch für vorbildliche Anzeigenwerbung im nationalsozialistischen Staate. Dresden: Pietzsch, 1935/36. Brüning, Ute. “Bauhäusler zwischen Propaganda und Wirtschaftswerbung.” In Nerdinger, ed. Bauhaus-Moderne im Nationalsozialismus, 24–47. Bryant, Chad. Prague in Black: Nazi Rule and Czech Nationalism. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2007. Buchheim, Christoph, and Jonas Scherner. “The Role of Private Property in the Nazi Economy: The Case of Industry.” Journal of Economic History 66, no. 2 (2006): 390–416. Buerkle, Darcy. “Gendered Spectatorship, Jewish Women and Psychological Advertising in Weimar Germany.” Women’s History Review 15, no. 4 (2006): 625–36. Bussemer, Thymian. Propaganda und Populärkultur. Wiesbaden: Deutscher Universitäts-Verlag, 2000.

325

326

Works Cited Cabarga, Leslie. Progressive German Graphics, 1900–1937. San Francisco: Chronicle, 1994. Carter, Erica. How German Is She? Postwar West German Reconstruction and the Consuming Woman. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 1997. Chandler, Alfred D., Jr. Scale and Scope: The Dynamics of Industrial Capitalism. Cambridge, MA: Belknap Press, 1990. Chatriot, Alain, Marie-Emmanuelle Chessel, and Matthew Hilton, eds. The Expert Consumer: Associations and Professionals in Consumer Society. Aldershot: Ashgate, 2006. Church, Roy. “New Perspectives on the History of Products, Firms, Marketing, and Consumers in Britain and the United States since the Mid-Nineteenth Century.” Economic History Review 52 (Aug. 1999): 405–35. Ciarlo, David. Advertising Empire: Race and Visual Culture in Imperial Germany. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2011. Cohen, Lizabeth. A Consumer’s Republic: The Politics of Mass Consumption in Postwar America. New York: Vintage, 2004. Confino, Alon, and Rudy Koshar. “Regimes of Consumer Culture: New Narratives in Twentieth Century German History.” German History 19, no. 2 (2001): 135–61. Connelly, John. “The Uses of Volksgemeinschaft: Letters to the NSDAP Kreis­ leitung Eisenach, 1939–1940.” Journal of Modern History 68, no. 4 (1996): 899– 930. Constantine, Stephen. “‘Bringing the Empire Alive’: The Empire Marketing Board and Imperial Propaganda, 1926–33.” In MacKenzie, ed. Imperialism and Popular Culture, 192–231. Constantine, Stephen. Buy and Build: The Advertising Posters of the Empire Marketing Board. London: Her Majesty’s Stationery Office, 1986. Crew, David F. ed. Nazism and German Society, 1933–1945. London: Routledge, 1994. d’Almeida, Fabrice. High Society in the Third Reich. Cambridge, UK: Polity, 2008. Daunton, Martin, and Matthew Hilton, eds. The Politics of Consumption: Material Culture and Citizenship in Europe and America. New York: Berg, 2001. Davis, Belinda J. Home Fires Burning: Food, Politics, and Everyday Life in World War I Berlin. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 2000. de Grazia, Victoria. Irresistible Empire: America’s Advance through Twentieth-Century Europe. Cambridge, MA: Belknap Press, 2005. Dingel, Tina. “Consumption in Nineteenth- and Twentieth-Century Germany: A Historiographical Essay.” Cultural and Social History 2 (2005): 247–56. Długoborski, Waclaw, ed. Zweiter Weltkrieg und sozialer Wandel. Göttingen: Vandenhoeck und Ruprecht, 1981. Eghigian, Greg, and Matthew Paul Berg, eds. Sacrifice and National Belonging in Twentieth-Century Germany. College Station: Texas A&M University Press, 2002. Eliasberg, Wladimir. Reklamewissenschaften. Ein Lehrbuch auf soziologischer, volkswirtschaftlicher und psychologischer Grundlage. Vienna: Rudolf M. Rohrer, 1936. Epstein, Catherine. Model Nazi: Arthur Greiser and the Occupation of Western Poland. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2010.



Works Cited

Eskilson, Stephen J. Graphic Design: A New History. New Haven: Yale University Press, 2007. Evans, Richard J. The Third Reich in Power. New York: Penguin, 2005. Feiter, Wolfgang. 90 Jahre Persil. Die Geschichte einer Marke. Düsseldorf: Henkel, 1997. Feldenkirchen, Wilfried. Siemens. Columbus: Ohio State University Press, 1999. Fiedler, Jeannine, and Peter Feierabend, eds. Bauhaus. Cologne: Könemann, 1999. Föllmer, Moritz. “Was Nazism Collectivistic? Redefining the Individual in Berlin, 1930–1945.” Journal of Modern History 82, no. 1 (March 2010): 61–100. Fontaine, Laurence. History of Pedlars in Europe. Vicki Whittaker, transl. Durham, NC: Duke University Press, 1996. Forbes, Neil. “Multinational Enterprises, ‘Corporate Responsibility’ and the Nazi Dictatorship: The Case of Unilever in Germany in the 1930s.” Contemporary European History 16, no. 2 (2007): 149–67. Frese, Reinhard. Die Massnahmen des Werberats der deutschen Wirtschaft und ihre Bedeutung für den Richter. Berlin: Franz Vahlen, 1939. Friebe, Holm. “Branding Germany: Hans Domizlaff ’s Markentechnik and Its Ideological Impact.” In Swett, Wiesen, and Zatlin, eds. Selling Modernity, 78–101. Friedman, Walter. Birth of a Salesman: The Transformation of Selling in America. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 2004. Fritzsche, Detlev. Erziehung zum Fischverbrauch. Hamburg: Hans A. Keune, 1943. Fritzsche, Peter. Life and Death in the Third Reich. Cambridge, MA: Belknap, 2008. Fritzsche, Peter. “Nazi Modern.” Modernism/Modernity 3, no. 1 (1996): 1–22. Fritzsche, Peter. Reading Berlin 1900. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1996. Fulda, Bernhard. Press and Politics in the Weimar Republic. New York: Oxford University Press, 2009. Führer, Karl Christian. “Pleasure, Practicality and Propaganda: Popular Magazines in Nazi Germany, 1933–1939.” In Swett, Ross, and d’Almeida, eds. Pleasure and Power in Nazi Germany, 132–53. Führer, Karl Christian. “Die Tageszeitung als wichtigstes Massenmedium der nationalsozialistischen Gesellschaft.” Zeitschrift für Geschichtswissenschaft 55 (2007): 411–34. Gall, Lothar. The Deutsche Bank, 1870–1995. London: Wiedenfeld and Nicholson, 1995. Gall, Lothar, and Manfred Pohl, eds. Unternehmen im Nationalsozialismus. Munich: C. H. Beck, 1998. Gellately, Robert, and Nathan Stoltzfus, eds. Social Outsiders in Nazi Germany. Princeton: Princeton University Press, 2001. Geratewohl, Fritz. Werben und Verkaufen im Kunstegewerbe und Hausrathandel, 2nd ed. Bamberg: Meissenbach and Co., 1938. Geyer, Michael. “The Stigma of Violence, Nationalism, and War in Twentieth-Century Germany.” German Studies Review, Special Issue, “German Identity” (1992): 75–110. Geyer, Michael. “‘There Is a Land Where Everything Is Pure: Its Name Is Land of Death’: Some Observations on Catastrophic Nationalism.” In Eghigian and

327

328

Works Cited Berg, eds. Sacrifice and National Belonging in Twentieth-Century Germany, 118– 47. Gossewinkel, Dieter, ed. Wirtschaftskontrolle und Recht in der nationalsozialistischen Diktatur. Frankfurt am Main: Klostermann, 2005. Gries, Rainer, Volker Ilgen, and Dirk Schindelbeck. “Ins Gehirn der Masse Kriechen!” Werbung und Mentalitätsgeschichte. Darmstadt: Wissenschaftlicher Buchgesellschaft, 1995. Gross, Stephen. Export Empire: German Soft Power in Southeastern Europe, 1920–1945. Berkeley: Dissertation, University of California Berkeley, 2010. Gross, Stephen. “Selling Germany in South-Eastern Europe: Economic Uncertainty, Commercial Information and the Leipzig Trade Fair, 1920–40.” Contemporary European History 21, no. 1 (2012): 19–39. Grossmann, Atina. Jews, Germans, and Allies: Close Encounters in Occupied Germany. Princeton: Princeton University Press, 2007. Guenther, Irene. Nazi Chic? Fashioning Women in the Third Reich. New York: Berg, 2004. Hardtwig, Wolfgang, ed. Ordnungen in der Krise: Zur politischen Kulturgeschichte Deutschlands, 1900–1933. Munich: Oldenbourg, 2007. Harrison, Mark, ed. The Economics of World War Two: Six Great Powers in International Comparison. New York: Cambridge University Press, 1998. Hausman, William J., Peter Hertner, and Mira Wilkins. Global Electrification. New York: Cambridge University Press, 2008. Heim, Susanne. Plant Breeding and Agrarian Research in Kaiser-Wilhelm Institutes, 1933–1945. Göttingen: Wallenstein, 2003. Herbert, Ulrich. “‘Die guten und die schlechten Zeiten’: Ueberlegungen zur diachronen Analyse lebensgeschichtlicher Interviews.” In Niethammer, ed. “Die Jahre weiss man nicht, wo man die heute hinsetzen soll,” 67–96. Herbst, Ludolf. Der Totale Krieg und die Ordnung der Wirtschaft: Die Kriegswirtschaft im Spannungsfeld, 1939–1945. Stuttgart: Deutsche Verlags-Anstalt, 1982. Herf, Jeffrey. The Jewish Enemy: Nazi Propaganda during World War II and the Holocaust. Cambridge, MA: Belknap Press, 2006. Herzig, Arno, ed. Die Juden in Hamburg 1590–1990. Hamburg: Dölling und Galitz, 1991. Herzog, Berthold. Vergleichende Reklame. Die Grenzen ihrer Zulässigkeit. Berlin: Franz Vahlen, 1932. Herzog, Dagmar. Sex after Fascism: Memory and Mortality in Twentieth-Century Germany. Princeton: Princeton University Press, 2005. Heßler, Martina. “Mrs. Modern Woman”: zur Sozial- und Kulturgeschichte der Haushaltstechnisierung. Frankfurt a. M.: Campus, 2001. Heuer, Gerd F. Entwicklung der Annoncen-Expeditionen in Deutschland. Berlin: Dissertation, 1937. Hilton, Matthew. Consumerism in 20th Century Britain: The Search for a Historical Movement. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2003. Hirt, Gerulf. Verkannte Propheten? Zur Expertenkultur (west-) deutscher Werbekommunikatoren bis zur Rezession 1966/67. Jena: Dissertation, Friedrich-Schiller Universität, 2012.



Works Cited

Hofheinz, E. Psychologische Grundlagen erfolgreicher Werbung. Munich: Janich, 1933. Höhn, Maria. GIs and Fräuleins: The German American Encounter in 1950s West Germany. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 2002. Hönig, Hans Otto. Das Aktuelle in der deutschen Presse. Dresden: M. Dittert, 1938. Hunke, Heinrich. “Die Grundfrage: Europa—ein geographischer Begriff oder eine politische Tatsache.” In Verein Berliner Kaufleute und Indutrielle, ed. Europäische Wirtschaftsgemeinschaft. Berlin: Haude and Spener, 1943, 209–29. Hunke, Heinrich. “Die Grundlagen der Zwischenstaatlichen Wirtschaftsbeziehungen.” In Reichskontor der nordischen Gesellschaft , ed. Wirtschaft im neuen Europa. Lübeck: Nordischen Gesellschaft, 1941, 38–44. Hunke, Heinrich. Die neue Wirtschaftswerbung: Eine Grundlegung der deutschen Werbepolitik. Hamburg: Hanseatische Verlagsanstalt, 1938. James, Harold. The Deutsche Bank and the Nazi Economic War against the Jews: The Expropriation of Jewish-Owned Property. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2003. Janssen, Hauke. Nationalokönomie und Nationalsozialismus: Die deutsche Volkswirtschaftslehre in den dreißiger Jahren. Marburg: Metropolis Verlag, 2000. Jarausch, Konrad. “The Perils of Professionalism: Lawyers, Teachers and Engineers in Nazi Germany.” German Studies Review 9, no. 1 (1986): 107–37. Jelavich, Peter. Berlin Alexanderplatz: Radio, Film and the Death of Weimar Culture. Berkeley: University of California Press, 2006. Johnson, Eric A., and Karl-Heinz Reuband. What We Knew: Terror, Mass Murder, and Everyday Life in Nazi Germany. An Oral History. New York: Basic Books, 2005. Jones, Geoffrey. Renewing Unilever: Transformation and Tradition. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2005. Kaminsky, Annette. Illustrierte Konsumgeschichte der DDR. Erfurt: Landeszentrale für politische Bildung Thüringen, 1999. Kaminsky, Annette. Wohlstand, Schönheit, Glück: Kleine Konsumgeschichte der DDR. Munich: C. H. Beck, 2001. Kaplan, Marion A. Between Dignity and Despair: Jewish Life in Nazi Germany. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1998. Karrasch, Max. Ich will durch Leistung Vorwärts: Der deutsche Kaufmann im Dienste der Betriebs- und Volksgemeinschaft. Berlin: F. W. Peters, n.d., ca. 1935. Kästner, Erich. Fabian: The Story of a Moralist. Cyrus Brooks, transl. Evanston: Northwestern University Press, 1993. Kershaw, Ian. The End: The Defiance and Destruction of Hitler’s Germany, 1944–1945. New York: Penguin, 2011. Kershaw, Ian. The “Hitler Myth”: Image and Reality in the Third Reich. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1987. Kessler, Hansi. Bahlsen: 1889–1964. Hannover: H. Bahlsens Keksfabrik KG, 1964. Kirkham, Pat. “Beauty and Duty: Keeping Up the (Home) Front.” In Kirkham and Thoms, eds. War Culture, 13–28. Kirkham, Pat, and David Thoms, eds. War Culture: Social Change and Changing Experience in World War Two. London: Lawrence and Wishart, 1995.

329

330

Works Cited Klein, Kurt. Die Werbung als Mittel der Exportförderung. Würzburg: Konrad Triltsch, 1939. Kleinschmidt, Christian. “Comparative Consumer Product Testing in Germany.” Business History Review 84, no. 1 (2010): 105–24. Kletzin, Birgit. Europa aus Rasse und Raum: Die nationalsozialistische Idee der Neuen Ordnung. Münster: Lit Verlag, 2000. Knapp, Alfred, ed. Reklame, Propaganda, Werbung. Ihre Weltorganisation. Berlin: Verlag für Presse, Wirtschaft und Politik, 1929. Kobrak, Christopher, and Andrea Schneider. “Varieties of Business History: Subject and Methods for the Twenty-first Century.” Business History 53, no. 3 (2011): 401–24. Kohut, Thomas A. A German Generation: An Experiential History of the Twentieth Century. New Haven: Yale University Press, 2011. König, Theodore. Psychologie der Werbung. Würzburg: Dissertation, 1922. König, Wolfgang. “Adolf Hitler vs. Henry Ford: The Volkswagen, the Role of America as a Model, and the Failure of a Nazi Consumer Society.” German Studies Review 27, no. 2 (2004): 249–68. König, Wolfgang. Geschichte der Konsumgesellschaft. Stuttgart: Franz Steiner, 2000. König, Wolfgang. Volkswagen, Volksempfänger, Volksgemeinschaft: ‘Volksprodukte’ im Dritten Reich. Vom Scheitern einer nationalsozialistischen Konsumgesellschaft. Padeborn: Schöningh, 2004. Krengel, Karl Heinz. Die Reklame in der Lehre von der Marktwirschaft. Nuremberg: Verlag der Hochschulbuchhandlung, 1936. Kreshel, Peggy J. “John B. Watson at J. Walter Thompson: The Legitimation of ‘Science’ in Advertising.” In Moeran, ed. Advertising: Critical Readings, Volume 2: Industry. Oxford: Berg, 2010, 129–44. Kroen, Sheryl. “A Political History of the Consumer.” Historical Journal 47, no. 3 (2004): 709–36. Kropff, Hans F. J. Psychologie in der Reklame als Hilfe zur Bestgestaltung des Entwurfs. Stuttgart: C. E. Poeschel, 1934. Kropff, Hans F. J. Totalität der Werbung: Ein Beitrag zur Vorbereitung ihrer Rationalisierung und zum Einbau in die neue Absatzlehre. Berlin: Carl Heymanns, 1939. Kühne, Thomas. Belonging and Genocide: Hitler’s Community, 1918–1945. New Haven: Yale University Press, 2010. Kupferberg, Christian A. Das Wissenschaftliche in der Reklame. Berlin: Hermann Paetel Verlag, 1914. Kurzer, Ulrich. Nationalsozialismus und Konsumgenossenschaften: Gleichschaltung, Sanierung, und Teilliquidation zwischen 1933 und 1936. Pfaffenweiler: Centaurus, 1997. Lamberty, Chistiane. Reklame in Deutschland, 1890–1914. Berlin: Dunker and Humblot, 2000. Lears, Jackson. Fables of Abundance: A Cultural History of Advertising in America. New York: Basic Books, 1994. Leder, Heinz. Gesetz und Werbung: Ein Ratgeber zu deutschgesinnter Werbung. Bonn: Stollfuß, 1937.



Works Cited

Lekan, Thomas. “‘A Noble Prospect’: Tourism, Heimat and Conservation on the Rhine, 1880–1914.” Journal of Modern History 81, no. 4 (2009): 824–58. Lerner, Paul. “Circulation and Representation: Jews, Department Stores and Cosmopolitan Consumption in Germany, c. 1880–1930s.” European Review of History—Revue européenne d’histoire 17, no. 3 (2010): 395–413. Lerner, Paul. “Consuming Pathologies: Kleptomania, Magazinitis, and the Problem of Female Consumption in Wilhelmine and Weimar Germany.” WerkstattGeschichte 42 (2006): 45–56. Lill, Ursula. Die Pharmazeutisch-Industrielle Werbung in der ersten Hälfte des 20. Jahrhunderts. Stuttgart: Deutscher Apotheker Verlag,1990. Loehlin, Jennifer A. From Rugs to Riches: Housework, Consumption and Modernity in Germany. Oxford: Berg, 1999. Lüdtke, Alf. “The ‘Honor of Labor’: Industrial Workers and the Power of Symbols under National Socialism.” In Crew, ed. Nazism and German Society, 1933–1945, 67–109. MacKenzie, John M. ed. Imperialism and Popular Culture. Manchester: Manchester University Press, 1986. Mallmann, Klaus-Michael, and Gerhard Paul. Herrschaft und Alltag. Bonn: Dietz, 1991. Marchand, Roland. Advertising the American Dream: Making Way for Modernity, 1920–1940. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1986. Mataja, Viktor. Die Reklame [1st edition 1910]. Munich: Duncker and Humblot, 1926. Mazower, Mark. Hitler’s Empire: How the Nazis Ruled Europe. New York: Penguin, 2008. Mergel, Thomas. “Der mediale Stil der ‘Sachlichkeit.’ Die gebremste Amerikanisierung des Wahlkampfs in der alten Bundesrepublik.” In Weisbrod, ed. Die Politik der Öffentlichkeit—die Öffentlichkeit der Politik, 29–54. Mergel, Thomas. Propaganda nach Hitler. Eine Kulturgeschichte des Wahlkampfs in der Bundesrepublik, 1949–1990. Göttingen: Wallstein, 2010. Merkel, Ina. Utopie und Bedürfnis: Die Geschichte der Konsumkultur in der DDR. Cologne: Böhlau, 1999. Merron, Jeff. “Putting Foreign Consumers on the Map: J. Walter Thompson’s Struggle with General Motors’ International Advertising Account in the 1920s.” Business History Review 73, no. 3 (1999): 465–503. Merziger, Patrick. “German Humour in Books: The Attractiveness and Political Significance of Laughter during the Nazi Era.” In Swett, Ross, and d’Almeida, eds. Pleasure and Power in Nazi Germany, 107–31. Miller, Michael. The Bon Marché: Bourgeois Culture and the Department Store, 1869– 1920. Princeton: Princeton University Press, 1981. Moeran, Brian, ed. Advertising: Critical Readings, Volume 2: Industry. Oxford: Berg, 2010. Mönnich, Horst. The BMW Story: A Company in Its Time. Anthony Bastow and William Henson, transl. London: Sidgwick and Jackson, 1991. Naue, Erich. Werbung! Zulässig oder Verboten? Vol. I. Berlin: Haude und Spener, 1937.

331

332

Works Cited Nerdinger, Winfried, ed. Bauhaus-Moderne im Nationalsozialismus: Zwischen Anbiederung und Verfolgung. Munich: Prestel, 1993. Neve, Monica. Sold! Advertising and the Bourgeois Female Consumer, 1900–1914. Stuttgart: Franz Steiner Verlag, 2010. Nicosia, Francis R., and Jonathan Huener, eds. Business and Industry in Nazi Germany. New York: Berghahn, 2004. Niemann, Hans-Werner. “‘Volksgemeinschaft’ als Konsumgemeinschaft?” In Schmiechen-Ackermann, Volksgemeinschaft, 87–110. Niethammer, Lutz, ed. “Die Jahre weiss man nicht, wo man die heute hinsetzen soll”: Faschismuserfahrungen im Ruhrgebiet. Vol. 1. Berlin: J. H. W. Dietz, 1986. Nolan, Mary. Visions of Modernity: American Business and the Modernization of Germany. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 1994. Overy, Richard J. The Nazi Economic Recovery, 1932–1938, 2nd ed. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1996. Paneth, Erwin. Grundriss der kaufmännischen Reklame und Reklamerechts in Deutschland und Österreich. Munich: R. Oldenbourg, 1927. Patterson, Patrick Hyder. Bought & Sold: Living and Losing the Good Life in Socialist Yugoslavia. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 2011. Paul, Gerhard. Aufstand der Bilder: die NS-Propaganda vor 1933. Bonn: Dietz, 1990. Peikow, Richard. Die soziale und wirtschaftliche Stellung der deutschen Frau in der Gegenwart. Berlin: Dissertation, Friedrich-Wilhelms Universität, 1937. Pence, Katherine. “Shopping for an ‘Economic Miracle’: Gendered Politics of Consumer Citizenship in Divided Germany.” In Chatriot, Chessel, and Hilton, eds. The Expert Consumer, 105–20. Penslar, Derek J. Shylock’s Children: Economics and Jewish Identity in Modern Europe. Berkeley: University of California Press, 2001. Perry, Joe. Christmas in Germany: A Cultural History. Chapel Hill: UNC Press, 2010. Poiger, Uta. “Beauty, Business and German International Relations.” WerkstattGeschichte 45 (2007): 53–71. Pouillard, Véronique. “American Advertising Agencies in Europe: J. Walter Thompson’s Belgian Business in the Inter-war Years.” Business History 47, no. 1 (2005): 44–58. Prinz, Michael. Vom neuen Mittelstand zum Volksgenossen. Die Entwicklung des sozialen Status der Angestellten von der Weimarer Republik bis zum Ende der NS-Zeit. Munich: Oldenburg, 1986. Proctor, Robert N. The Nazi War on Cancer. Princeton: Princeton University Press, 2000. Rabinbach, Anson. “The Aesthetics of Production in the Third Reich.” Journal of Contemporary History 11, no. 4 (1977): 43–74. Randall, Amy E. The Soviet Dream World of Retail Trade and Consumption in the 1930s. Houndmills: Palgrave Macmillan, 2008. Reagin, Nancy R. Sweeping the German Nation: Domesticity and National Identity in Germany, 1870–1945. New York: Cambridge, 2007. Recht, Carl. Die Grenzen der Reklame nach dem heutigen Wettbewerbsrecht. Cologne: Orthen, 1939.



Works Cited

Redlich, Fritz. “German Advertising and Its Regulation during the Last Three Years.” Harvard Business Review 15, no. 1 (1936): 95–104. Redlich, Fritz. Reklame: Begriff-Geschichte-Theorie. Stuttgart: Ferdinand, 1935. Reichel, Peter. Der schöne Schein des Dritten Reiches: Faszination und Gewalt des Faschismus. Vienna: Carl Hanser, 1992. Reinhardt, Dirk. Von der Reklame zum Marketing: Geschichte der Wirtschaftswerbung in Deutschland. Berlin: Akademie Verlag, 1993. Reinhardt, Dirk. “Zeitgenössische Ansätze der Marktkommunikation durch Werbung vom Kaiserreich zur Bundesrepublik.” In Wischermann, ed. Unternehmenskommunikation deutscher Mittel- und Groß-Unternehmen, 41–56. Reininghaus, Wilfried, ed. Wanderhandel in Europa. Dortmund: Gesellschaft für Westfälische Wirtschaftsgeschichte eV, 1993. Reuveni, Gideon. Reading Germany: Literature and Consumer Culture in Germany before 1933. New York: Berghahn, 2006. Riedemann, Rolf. Was ist erlaubt—was ist verboten? Werberecht von A bis Z. Reutlingen: Storch, 1938. Ritschl, Albrecht O. “Hat das Dritte Reich wirklich eine ordentliche Beschäftigungspolitik betrieben?” Jahrbuch für Wirtschaftsgeschichte 1 (2003): 125–40. Ritschl, Albrecht O. “Nazi Economic Imperialism and the Exploitation of the Small: Evidence from Germany’s Secret Foreign Exchange Balances, 1938–1940.” Economic History Review 54, no. 2 (2001): 324–45. Rollins, William H. A Greener Vision of Home: Cultural Politics and Environmental Reform in the German Heimatschutz Movement, 1904–1918. Ann Arbor: University of Michigan Press, 2007. Rollins, William H. “Whose Landscape? Technology, Fascism and the Environment on the National Socialist Autobahn.” Annals of the Association of American Geo­ graphers 85, no. 3 (1995): 494–520. Ross, Corey. “Mass Culture and Divided Audiences: Cinema and Social Change in Inter-War Germany.” Past and Present 193 (2006): 157–95. Ross, Corey. Media and the Making of Modern Germany. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2010. Ross, Corey. “Visions of Prosperity: The Americanization of Advertising in Interwar Germany.” In Swett, Wiesen, and Zatlin, eds. Selling Modernity, 52–77. Rossfeld, Roman. “Emergence of Traveling Salesmen in Switzerland.” Business History Review 82 (Winter 2008): 735–59. Roßwog, Viktor. Der Werberat als Mittel staatlicher Wirtschaftsführung. Heidelberg: Dissertation, Ruprecht-Karls Universität, 1937. Ruben, Paul, ed. Die Reklame: Ihre Kunst und Wissenschaft. Berlin: Verlag für Sozial­ politik, 1913. Rubin, Eli. Synthetic Socialism: Plastics and Dictatorship in the German Democratic Republic. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 2008. Ruecker, Matthias. Wirtschaftswerbung unter dem Nationalsozialismus. Frankfurt a. M.: Peter Lang, 2000. Rutz, Rainer. Signal: Eine deutsche Auslandsillustrierte als Propagandainstrument im Zweiten Weltkrieg. Essen: Klartext, 2007.

333

334

Works Cited Scheske, Martin, ed. In aller Munde. Einhundert Jahre Odol. Dresden: Deutsche Hygiene-Museum, 1993. Schildt, Axel. Moderne Zeiten: Freizeit, Massenmedien und ‘Zeitgeist’ in der Bundesrepublik der 50er Jahre. Hamburg: Christians, 2005. Schiller, Thomas. NS-Propaganda für den ‘Arbeitseinsatz.’ Hamburg: Lit, 1997. Schmiechen-Ackermann, Detlef, ed. Volksgemeinschaft: Mythos, wirkungsmächtige soziale Verheißung oder soziale Realität im ‘Dritten Reich’? Zwischenbalanz einer kontroversen Debatte. Paderborn: Ferdinand Schöningh, 2012. Schmiedchen, Johannes, ed. Neues Handbuch der Reklame. Berlin: Reinhold Wichert, 1929. Schmitt, Julius. Lingner-Werke AG Dresden. Berlin, 1931. Schmitt, Paul. Die Grenze der erlaubten Reklame. Würzburg: Konrad Triltsch Verlag, 1940. Schneider, Michael C. “Business Decision Making in National Socialist Germany: Machine Tools, Business Machines, and Punch Cards at the Wanderer-Werke AG.” Enterprise and Society 3 (September 2002): 396–428. Schrader, Halwart. BMW: A History. Ron Wakefield, transl. Princeton, NJ: Princeton Publishing, 1979. Schramm, Samuel. Konsum und regionale Identität im Sachsen, 1880–2000. Stuttgart: Steiner Verlag, 2000. Schug, Alexander. “Das Ende der Hochkultur? Äesthetische Strategien der Werbung, 1900–1933.” In Hardtwig, ed. Ordnungen in der Krise: Zur politischen Kulturgeschichte Deutschlands, 1900–1933, 503–29. Schug, Alexander. “Innovation und Kundenorientierung: Erfolgsfaktoren Amerikanischer Advertising Agencies auf dem deutschen Werbemarkt der 1920er Jahren.” In Schug and Sack, eds. Moments of Consistency, 66–71. Schug, Alexander. “Vom Newspaper space salesman zur integrierten Kommuni­ kationsagentur. Die 120-jährige Entwicklungsgeschichte der Werbeagentur Dorland.” Zeitschrift für Unternehmensgeschichte 49, no. 1 (2004): 5–25. Schug, Alexander, and Hilmar Sack. Moments of Consistency. Eine Geschichte der Werbung. Berlin: Dorland Werbeagentur, 2004. Schumann, Wolfgang, ed. Griff nach Südost-Europa. Berlin: VEB Deutscher Verlag, 1973. Schutts, Jeff. “‘Die Erfrischende Pause’: Marketing Coca-Cola in Hitler’s Germany.” In Swett, Wiesen, and Zatlin, eds. Selling Modernity, 151–81. Schwabenthan, Otto. Deutsche Werbefachzeitschriften. Ein Beitrag zur Entwicklung der deutschen Fachzeitschriften. Munich: Dissertation, Ludwig-Maximiliens-Univerisität, 1950. Schwarzkopf, Stefan. “Kontrolle statt Rausch? Markforschung, Produktwerbung und Verbraucherlenkung im Nationalsozialismus zwischen Phantasien von Masse, Angst und Macht.” In von Klimó and Rolf, eds. Rausch und Diktatur, 193–218. Seidel, Brigitta. MarkenWaren: Maggi, Odol, Persil & Co. erotern den ländlichen Haushault. Husum: Husum Verlag, 2003. Semmens, Kristin. Seeing Hitler’s Germany: Tourism in the Third Reich. Houndmills: Palgrave Macmillan, 2005.



Works Cited

Siegrist, Hannes, Hartmut Kaelble, and Jürgen Kocka, eds. Europäische Komsumgeschichte: Zur Gesellschafts- und Kulturgeschichte des Konsums. Frankfurt: Campus, 1997. Silverman, Daniel. Hitler’s Economy: Nazi Work Creation Programs, 1933–1936. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press, 1998. Sneeringer, Julia. “The Shopper as Voter: Women, Advertising, and Politics in PostInflation Germany.” German Studies Review 27, no. 3 (2004): 476–501. Sombart, Werner. The Jews and Modern Capitalism. M. Epstein, transl. New York: Burt Franklin, 1969. Sommer, Albrecht R. “Premium Advertising.” Harvard Business Review 10, no. 2 (1932): 203–12. Sösemann, Bernd. “Propaganda and Öffentlichkeit in der ‘Volksgemeinschaft.’” In Sösemann, ed. Der Nationalsozialismus und die deutsche Gesellschaft: Einführung und Überblick. Stuttgart: Deutsche Verlags-Anstalt, 2002, 114–54. Spears, Timothy B. One Hundred Years on the Road: The Traveling Salesman in American Culture. New Haven: Yale University Press, 1994. Speitkamp, Winfried. “Denkmalpflege und Heimatschutz in Deutschland zwischen Kulturkritik und Nationalsozialismus.” Archiv für Kulturgeschichte 70, no. 1 (1988): 149–93. Spiekermann, Uwe. Basis der Konsumgesellschaft: Enstehung und Entwicklung des modernen Kleinhandels in Deutschland, 1850–1914. Munich: C. H. Beck, 1999. Spiekermann, Uwe. “From Neighbour to Consumer: The Transformation of Retailer-Consumer Relationships in Twentieth-Century Germany.” In Trentmann, ed. The Making of the Consumer, 147–73. Spoerer, Mark. “Die Automobilindustrie im Dritten Reich: Wachstum um jeden Preis.” In Gall and Pohl, eds. Unternehmen im Nationalsozialismus, 61–68. Spoerer, Mark. Von Scheingewinn zum Rüstungsboom: Die Eigenkapitalrentabilität der deutschen Industrie-Aktiengesellschaft, 1925–1941. Stuttgart: Franz Steiner, 1996. Spoerer, Mark. Zwangsarbeit unter dem Hakenkreuz. Stuttgart: Deutsche VerlagsAnstalt, 2001. Steiner, André. “Von der Preisüberwachung zur staatlichen Preisbildung.” In Steiner, ed. Preispolitik und Lebensstandard: Nationalsozialismus, DDR und Bundesrepublik im Vergleich. Cologne: Böhlau, 2006, 23–49. Steinweis, Alan E. “Anti-Semitism and the Arts in Nazi Ideology and Policy.” In Heuner and Nicosia, The Arts in Nazi Germany, 15–30. Stephenson, Jill. Hitler’s Homefront: Württemberg under the Nazis. London: Hambledon Continuum, 2006. Stephenson, Jill. Women in Nazi Germany. Harlow: Pearson, 2001. Strasser, Susan. Satisfaction Guaranteed: The Making of the American Mass Market. New York: Pantheon Books, 1989. Sudrow, Anne. Der Schuh im Nationalsozialismus: Eine Produktgeschichte im deutschbritisch-amerikanishen Vergleich. Göttingen: Wallstein, 2010. Swett, Pamela E. Neighbors and Enemies: The Culture of Radicalism in Weimar Berlin, 1929–1933. New York: Cambridge University Press, 2004. Swett, Pamela E. “Preparing for Victory: Heinrich Hunke, the Nazi Werberat, and West German Prosperity.” Central European History 42 (2009): 675–707.

335

336

Works Cited Swett, Pamela E. “Selling Sexual Pleasure in 1930s Germany.” In Swett, Ross, and d’Almeida, eds. Pleasure and Power in Nazi Germany, 39–66. Swett, Pamela E., Corey Ross, and Fabrice d’Almeida, eds. Pleasure and Power in Nazi Germany. Houndmills: Palgrave Macmillan, 2011. Swett, Pamela E., S. Jonathan Wiesen, and Jonathan R. Zatlin, eds. Selling Modernity: Advertising in Twentieth Century Germany. Durham, NC: Duke University Press, 2007. Teichova, Alice, and Robert Waller. “Der tschechoslowakische Unternehmer am Vorabend und zu Beginn des Zweiten Weltkriegs.” In Długoborski, ed. Zweiter Weltkrieg und sozialer Wandel, 288–302. Tippach-Schneider, Simone. Messemänchen und Minol-Pirol. Werbung in der DDR. Berlin: Schwarzkopf and Schwarzkopf, 1999. Tooze, J. Adam. Statistics and the German State, 1900–1945: The Making of Modern Economic Knowledge. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2001. Tooze, Adam. The Wages of Destruction: The Making and Breaking of the Nazi Economy. New York: Viking, 2006. Torp, Claudius. Konsum und Politik in der Weimarer Republik. Göttingen: Vandenhoeck and Ruprecht, 2011. Trentmann, Frank, ed. The Making of the Consumer: Knowledge, Identity and Power in the Modern World. New York: Berg, 2006. Vershofen, Wilhelm. Handbuch der Verbrauchsforschung. Vol. I. Berlin: C. Heymanns, 1940. Vogel, Sabine. “Reiner Atem, frischer Kuß—Aspekte deutscher Reinlichkeit.” In Scheske, ed. In aller Munde. Einhundert Jahre Odol, 107–57. Volkman, Hans-Erich. “Zum Verhältnis von Großwirtschaft und NS-Regime im Zweiten Weltkrieg.” In Długborski, ed. Zweiter Weltkrieg und sozialer Wandel, 87–116. von Braunmühl, Carole. Das neue Werbegesetz: Leitfaden für den praktischen Gebrauch. Munich: Eher Verlag, 1934. von Braunmühl, Carole, ed. Die Regelung der Wirtschaftswerbung. Berlin: Carl Heymanns, 1936. von Klimó, Árpád, and Malte Rolf, eds. Rausch und Diktatur: Inszensierung, Mobilisierung und Kontrolle in Totalitären Systemen. Frankfurt a. M.: Campus, 2006. Ward, Janet. Weimar Surfaces: Urban Visual Culture in 1920s Germany. Berkeley: University of California Press, 2001. Weber, Thomas. Hitler’s First War. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 2010. Weidenmüller, Werbwart. “Der Tageslauf des Werbemannes.” In Schmiedchen, ed. Neues Handbuch der Reklame, 66–68. Weindling, Paul. Health, Race, and German Politics between National Unification and Nazism, 1870–1945. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press, 1989. Weisbrod, Bernd, ed. Die Politik der Öffentlichkeit—die Öffentlichkeit der Politik: Politische Medialisierung in der Geschichte der Bundesrepublik. Göttingen: Wallstein, 2003. Welch, David. The Third Reich: Politics and Propaganda. London: Routledge, 1995. Weltherrschaft im Vizier. Dokumente zu den Europa- und Weltherrschaftsplänen des deutschen Imperialismus von der Jahrhundertwende bis Mai 1945. East Berlin: VEB Deutscher Verlag der Wissenschaften, 1975.



Works Cited

Werner, Constanze. Kriegswirtschaft und Zwangsarbeit bei BMW. Munich: Oldenburg, 2006. Werner, Wolfgang Franz. “Bleib Übrig!” Deutsche Arbeiter in der nationalsozialistischen Kriegswirtschaft. Düsseldorf: Schwann, 1983. West, Douglas C. “From T-Square to T-Plan: The London Office of the J. Walter Thompson Advertising Agency, 1919–1970.” Business History 29, no. 2 (1987): 199–217. Westfälisches Landesmuseum für Kunst und Kulturgeschichte Münster. Die nützliche Moderne: Graphik und Produkt-Design in Deutschland, 1935–55. Münster: Landschaftsverband Westfalen-Lippe, 2000. Westphal, Uwe. Werbung im Dritten Reich. Berlin: Transit, 1989. Wienkötter, Helm, ed. Wienkötters Handbuch der deutschen Werbung, 2nd ed. Hamburg: Karl Eberwein, 1951/52. Wiesen, S. Jonathan. Creating the Nazi Marketplace: Commerce and Consumption in the Third Reich. New York: Cambridge University Press, 2011. Wiesen, S. Jonathan. “Driving, Shopping, and Smoking: The Society for Consumer Research and the Politics of Pleasure in Nazi Germany.” In Swett, Ross, and d’Almeida, eds. Pleasure and Power in Nazi Germany, 19–38. Wiesen, S. Jonathan. West German Industry and the Challenge of the Nazi Past, 1945– 1955. Chapel Hill: University of North Carolina Press, 2001. Wildt, Michael. Am Beginn der Konsumgesellschaft: Mangelerfahrung, Lebenshaltung, Wohlstandshoffnung in Westdeutschland in den fünfziger Jahren. Hamburg: Ergebnisse, 1994. Wilson, Charles. The History of Unilever: A Study in Economic Growth and Social Change. London: Cassell, 1954. Wischermann, Clemens, ed. Unternehmenskommunikation deutscher Mittel- und Groß-Unternehmen. Theorie und Praxis im historischer Perspektive. Dortmund: Gesellschaft für westfälische Wirtschaftsgeschichte, 2003. Wolff, W. H. “Mit der Kundschaft mitgehen.” In Johannes Schmiedchen, ed. Neues Handbuch der Reklame, 107–12. Wubs, Ben. International Business and National War Interests: Unilever between Reich and Empire, 1939–1945. New York: Routledge, 2008. Wundt, Wilhelm. Grundriß der Psychologie, 15th ed. Leipzig: Alfred Körner, 1922. Zeller, Thomas. Driving Germany: The Landscape of the German Autobahn, 1930–1970. Thomas Dunlap, transl. New York: Berghahn, 2007. Zierenberg, Malte. Stadt der Schieber: Der Berliner Schwarzmarket, 1939–1950. Göttingen: Vandenhoeck and Ruprecht, 2008. Zwahr, Hartmut, Günter Bentele, and Thomas Topfstedt, eds. Leipzigs Messen, 1497–1997, Teilband 2. Cologne: Böhlau, 1999.

337

Index

Ad Council for the German Economy. See Werberat Advertising: agencies, Anglo-American, see Full-service advertising agencies; cooperative, 36, 82–85, 102, 109, 212, 290n130; criticism of, 29–30; debate on worth of, 11, 13, 187, 263; debate within the profession, 11, 23, 26–27, 33, 110; humor in, 29, 100–102, 197, 276n60, 292n28; negative, 54, 73, 113, 147, 166, 168; outdoor, 52–53, 62, 65–68, 95, 112, 160, 251–52 (see also Heimatschutz; Signage); reminder, 191, 230, 241, 244. See also Full-service advertising agencies; Werberat AEG, 22, 104, 236, 254–57; and Siemens, 104 Alcohol: in advertisements, 112, 296n79, 296n81; postwar consumption of, 252. See also Kupferberg Aly, Götz, 186, 218, 264 Amann, Max, 57 America, German perceptions of, 11, 17–18, 23, 26–27, 31, 34–35, 44, 50, 84–85, 100, 102, 109, 197, 261 Anti-Semitism, 2, 21, 59, 92, 111, 164, 170, 176–77, 214, 261–64; in

advertisements, 13, 54, 62, 69–71; as basis for hatred of advertising, 22, 50; and salesmanship, 22, 49, 161, 164, 174–75, 179, 304n71. See also Aryanization; Boycotts Aryanization of Jewish businesses, 13, 68, 74, 99, 164, 171–82, 201, 248, 263 Audi. See Auto Union Auto Union, 72–73, 115 Automobiles. See Motorization Bahlsen brand biscuits, 178–79, 240–43, 251–52, 254 Bauhaus, 8, 80, 241, 256, 261 Bayer brand pharmaceutical products, 9, 85, 106, 147–48, 153–54, 244, 291n3 Beauty of Labor 130, 132–33, 299n136 Beiersdorf AG, 84, 142, 197, 262; denunciation of, 69–71, 73; during Second World War, 202, 237–40; and film, 100–101. See also HeussKnapp, Elly; Nivea Berlin: AEG, 22; Anglo-American agencies, 8–9, 28–30, 223; commercial culture, 26; and DRV, 43, 48; Henkel training site, 39; International Advertising Association Congress, 33–34; lighted signs, 24; Reichswerbeschule, 80–

81, 260; Salamander, 172; Sopade report from, 140, 145; Unilever, 245; and Werberat, 159 Berliner Illustrierte Zeitung, BIZ, 26, 78–79, 146, 149–50, 155–56, 198, 221 Bessel, Richard, 252–53 Black market, 14, 229, 246, 249, 252 BMW, 67–68, 115–18, 227–28, 265; denunciation of, 72; and rearmament, 215; Second World War, 229–37 Böhme Fettchemie, BFC, 67, 85, 155–59, 166, 209, 212. See also Fewa Boycotts of Jewish businesses, 49–50, 54, 71–72, 88, 141, 174, 262 Branding. See individual brands Braunmühl, Carole von, 225, 296n78 Bräutigam, Petra, 248 Brewer, John, 3–4 Brose, Hanns, 34–35, 37, 83–85, 189, 205–6 Butler, George, 28, 30, 314n116 “Buy German” campaigns, 37, 74 Carter, Erica, 136, 252, 256 Children, 129, 178, 234, 237–38, 241, 248; as subjects of advertisements, 38, 54, 95, 98–99, 130, 133, 147, 151, 213; as viewers of advertisements, 103, 173, 208 Chlorodont brand toothpaste, 99, 147, 149 Ciarlo, David, 7, 9, 93, 205 Cigarettes, 10, 21, 64, 75, 112, 200, 225, 252 Clausen, Juan, 99 Coffee, 12, 57, 64, 71, 75, 92, 105–6, 135, 142, 189, 215. See also Jacobs; Kaffee Hag Commercial culture, 3, 5, 11–14, 135, 139, 226, 250; Nazi era as flexible, 9, 130; postwar, 252; reform of, 48, 88 118, 166; as un-German, 68; in the Weimar Republic, 17. See also Salesmen

Index Companies, brand-name. See individual brands Connelly, John, 10 Consumers, female, 12, 85, 99, 143, 256, 263; attempts to regulate behavior; 141, 204–14, 264; and brand loyalty, 152–53, 180, 201–2; economic power of, 37, 136–38; as rational, 150–51, 154, 262; as vulnerable, 24 Consumers, young, 22, 61, 103, 223 Consumption, management of. See “Enlightenment” of consumers Consumption, “virtual,” 3, 5, 51, 108, 262 Continuity between Weimar and Nazi eras, 6, 84, 93, 103 Continuity with postwar, 255–60 Cooperation, international, among advertisers, 9, 17–18, 35, 37, 109 Cooperatives, consumer, 139–40 Coordination of advertising industry. See Werberat Corporations: exploitation of occupied territories, 224, 247; relations with Nazi regime, 2, 10, 54, 63, 92–93, 105, 181, 214, 257, 264, See also Ethics, business; individual brands Cosmetics, 23, 69, 136, 152–53. See also Nivea Currency reform, 252, 255, 257, 259 Daily Life: and advertisements, 3, 13, 18, 124, 135; and politics, 37; Second World War, 187, 191, 193 Daimler-Benz. See Mercedes-Benz De Grazia, Victoria, 18 Depression, Great, 4, 39, 115, 141; impact on advertising, 8, 11, 18, 27, 29–31, 49, 58, 118, 142, 147; and job creation, 37, 124–25, 154, 261 Denunciations. See Anti-Semitism; Boycotts Design, 11, 17, 18–20, 22, 26–28, 31, 35; calls for reform, 45, 49, 55, 61, 75; postwar, 256–57. See also Trademarks

339

340

Index Deutsche Arbeitsfront, DAF. See German Labor Front Deutsche Bank, 56, 283n34 Deutsche Reklame Verband, DRV. See German Advertisers Association Deutsche Werbe- und Anzeigen­ gesellschaft, DEWAG, 255 Deutsche Werbung, DW, 62, 80, 93 101, 157, 191 Deutsche Volkswirtschaft, DDV, 56, 59, 72, 196, 251 Deutsches Frauenwerk, 202, 206–8, 214 Domizlaff, Hans, 225 Dorland Werbeagentur, 8–9, 28–29, 34 Dr. Oetker brand, 202–3, 221 Dresden, 64, 147, 200 Düsseldorf, 32, 39, 67, 255. See also Henkel AG

Film, camera, 78, 193–94, 196 Forced Labor, 4, 249, 316n5; at BMW, 234–36; at Salamander, 172, 248 Foreign influence in ads, 9, 26, 28, 37, 40, 43–44, 49, 67, 109, 261; nonGerman words and phrases, 75, 110, 124, 216, 221, 230–31. See also America, German perceptions of; Typefaces Four-Year Plan, 12, 68, 87, 132, 134, 189, 204, 271n16, 308n4 France, 273n14; and advertising, 44, 75, 85, 109–10; forced laborers from, 235–36, 249; occupation zone, 248–49, 254 Fritzsche, Peter, 46, 123, 281n11 Full-service advertising agencies, 11, 19–20, 26–30, 223

East Germany, 252, 255–56, 265 Economy, civilian, 50–51, 114, 172, 215, 234, 248 Electricity: appliances, 108, 113, 136–37; producers and installers, 84, 102, 104, 112, 123–24; and regime goals, 92,102–3, 262. See also AEG; Osram Empire, Nazi: and advertising, 215, 225, 230; and Hunke, Heinrich, 59, 88, 186; plans for, 2, 13–14, 63, 188–89; Second World War, 219, 227–28, 264 “Enlightenment” of consumers, 101–2, 113, 148, 197, 204–5, 251. See also RMVP; RVA Ersatz goods. See Shortages Ethics, business, 48, 113, 161; Nazi model, 2, 13, 87, 168, 170

Gemeinschaftswerbung, see Advertising, cooperative German Advertisers Association, DRV, 32–39, 42, 47–48; and “National Group,” 43, 45 “German” Advertising, 9, 43–44, 47, 62, 75, 93, 205. See also Werberat General Motors, 28–30, 115 German Labor Front, 117–18, 130, 236. See also Beauty of Labor; Strength through Joy Goebbels, Joseph, 5, 45–46, 54–55; on advertising, 42–43, 93, 259; on consumption, 52; and outdoor advertising, 65, 67; and radio, 12, 64, 94; relationship with Werberat, 56, 86, 191, 207, 240, 261, 265; on Total War, 229 Göring, Hermann, 54, 57–58, 68–69, 132, 176, 178, 310n50. See also FourYear Plan Great Britain, 19, 31, 74, 83, 109, 265; Empire Marketing Board, 36–38; as German rival, 59, 115, 142, 225, 230. See also Full-service advertising agencies

Fantasy in ads, 42, 101–2, 135, 157; postwar, 255 Fewa brand detergent, 155–60, 165–66; collaboration with RVA, 204–5, 209–11; postwar, 256 Film, 12, 18–19, 35, 39, 70, 83, 92–108, 185, 257; and regime, 123, 169, 187, 221, 225; and RVA, 205, 207–8

Grossmann, Atina, 141, 253 Guenther, Irene, 75, 213, 302n51 Hannover, 39, 241 Hansaplast brand bandages, 99, 238–39 Health, national, 5, 38–39, 54, 62, 103, 105, 111–12, 130–33, 173, 197 Heimatschutz movement, 25, 52–53, 67–68. See also Signage Hitler, Adolf, 4–5, 93, 124, 174; and advertising, 11, 40, 45, 74, 166, 168, 272n24; on consumption, 50, 102, 114, 118; desire for war; 50, 219, 265; images of, 42, 52–54, 94, 105, 116, 120, 123, 233 Hoarding, 140–41, 217. See also Shortages Housewives. See Consumers, female; Deutsches Frauenwerk Hunke, Heinrich, 55–60; and aryanization, 56, 73–74; critics of, 57, 86; and defense of advertising, 83, 106, 112, 186–89, 191, 219, 250; on German Advertising, 87–88, 155, 170; on national symbols, 64–65, 192; postwar career, 260; postwar vision, 221–25, 251. See also Werberat Henkel AG & Co, 37–39, 163, 185, 204; collaboration with RVA, 204–15; family, 57, 123, 135; and film, 96–98, 106–7, 126; in the occupied territories, 218, 247; postwar, 255, 264; relationship with consumers, 151, 165–68, 181, 201; relationship with regime, 65–68, 95, 150, 169 Heuss-Knapp, Elly, 98–101; and nationalism, 110; and Theodor Heuss, 98, 292n19, 292n26; war-era advertisements, 200, 238–41 Hinks, Kenett, 28, 30 Image, corporate. See Advertising; Trademarks

Index International Advertising Association, 33 Italy, 27, 109, 116 Jacobs brand coffee, 71–72, 215, 287n102, 308n2 James, Harold, 174 Jews: as advertisers, 21, 171, 253; as consumers, 12–13; purges from advertising, 10, 58, 91, 161, 164; as salesmen, 169–70, 174–75, 247; and Second World War, 186–87, 214, 251. See also Anti-Semitism; Aryanization J. Walter Thompson, JWT, 28–31, 84–85, 223 Kaffee Hag brand coffee, 12, 57, 105–6, 110, 142 Knapp, Alfred, 35–36 König, Wolfgang, 114 Kropff, Hanns F. J., 17–18 Kupferberg, Christian A., 57; and ad strategy for Kupferberg brand sparkling wine, 84, 154–56, 170; and criticism of Germany advertising, 27, 109, 259; as early proponent of advertising, 22–24, 32 Law. See National Symbols; Werberat Leipzig, 142, 208; Leipzig Fair, 18–19 Lerner, Paul, 24 Lingner-Werke, 38–39, 84, 123 Loyalty, customer, 83, 93, 142, 151–54, 176, 262; during war, 189; among sales staff, 164, 173 Luxury, 4, 12, 51, 84, 92, 118–20, 152, 263 Marchand, Roland, 33, 142, 147, 276n57 Marketing, 5, 11, 133, 145, 173, 227, 250; in America, 19, 27, 141; postwar, 255, 260–61. See also Science of selling Mataja, Viktor, 32, 277n72 Matthess, Walter, 29 Mazower, Mark, 219, 264

341

342

Index Media, 11–12, 18–22, 24, 27–29, 92–93, 98; control by regime, 52, 54, 58; and gender roles, 256; postwar 259 Mercedes-Benz: brand image, 115, 118–23; and Second World War, 216, 257; star trademark, 123, 258 Ministry of economics, 57, 66, 70. See also Schacht, Hjalmar Motorization, 114–18. See also BMW; Mercedes-Benz Mundhenke, Paul, 38–39, 95, 205, 212, 214 National Socialism, 17, 60, 66, 101, 250, 259; attractions of, among advertisers, 45–46, 161, 261; and consumption, 2, 50, 52, 214, 226; and propaganda, 7 (see also RMVP). See also Volksgemeinschaft National Socialist Party, NSDAP: and Alliance of Middle-Class Businessmen, 69, 71, 74; as governing party, 42, 47, 49, 110, 127, 140, 181; and Heinrich Hunke, 55; party press, 40, 65 National Socialist Reich Association of German Advertisers, NSRDW, 47–48, 62, 69, 75, 80, 100–101, 251, 261 National Symbols, Law for the Protection of, 52, 62–64, 94, 104, 120, 134, 192–93 Nivea brand products, 84, 98–101, 147, 150, 262; anti-Semitic attacks on, 69–71; loyalty to, 143, 226, 238; postwar, 256–57; wartime ads, 197– 202, 237–38. See also Beiersdorf AG; Heuss-Knapp, Elly Odol brand mouthwash, 38, 84, 102, 289n119, Osram brand light bulbs, 51, 65, 92, 181; advertising, 123–35, 262; ethics, 112, 161–62; film, 102–4.

Peek und Cloppenburg brand clothiers, 201 People’s products, 54, 94, 114 Persil brand detergent, 39, 57, 65, 67, 159, 168; postwar, 265; and Second World War, 184, 204–5, 209–15, 218; “White Lady,” 66, 155, 211. See also Henkel AG Phoebus Cartel, 124, 298n112. See also Osram Placement services, 9, 11, 19, 30 Police and advertising, 53–54, 66–68 Poster art, 18, 20–22, 24–25, 53, 64–66, 75, 109 Postwar Germany: daily life, 14, 60, 114–15, 141, 143; and First World War, 23–24, 34, 139, 169; Nazi dreams for, 3, 6, 56, 59, 186, 219; reemergence of advertising industry, 9–10, 14, 29, 145, 214, 229, 255–60, 265. See also East Germany; West Germany Proctor, Robert N., 112, 288n117, 296n81 Propaganda, Reich Ministry of, see RMVP Prosperity, Nazi visions of, 51, 94, 135, 181, 224–25, 251, 260. See also Empire, Nazi; Postwar Germany, Nazi dreams for Psychology in advertising, 17, 19, 22–23, 31, 35, 80, 87, 145, 147, 261 Radio: advertising on, 12, 18–19, 92–94, 98–99, 103, 108, 124; People’s Radio, 54, 271n18; prohibition of advertising 52, 64, 75, 95–97, 100; during Second World War 187, 207–8, 233 Rathenau, Emil, 22, 237 Reagin, Nancy, 141, 213, 311n60 Regulation of advertising. See Werberat Reich Board for Economic Enlightenment, see RVA

Reich Ministry of Propaganda, see RMVP Reichard, Ernst, 55–58, 64–67 Reichardt brand cocoa, 31, 106, 108, 141 Reichswerbeschule, 75, 80–81, 88, 219, 250, 260 Reinhardt, Dirk, 57 Reisende, see Salesmen “Reklame,” as criticism of Weimar-era advertising, 20, 44, 51, 75, 205 Die Reklame, 27, 32–33, 38–43 Retail sector, 19, 38, 66, 97, 139, 141, 254; advertising for, 103–4, 108, 110, 113, 130; coordination of, 62–63, 111; in the countryside, 26, 167; and female shoppers, 12, 24, 136–37, 207; and Jews, 21, 174–75, 178, 247–48; and racial politics 74, 92, 161, 167– 68, 170–71, 179, 263; Second World War 200, 217–18, 246, 251. See also Salamander; Salesmen Ritschl, Albrecht, 4, 321n92 RMVP (Reich Ministry of Propaganda): authority over Werberat, 48, 57, 64–66, 206, 261, 265; creation of, 42, 53, 236; establishment of Werberat, 54–55; and film, 106; and radio, 94. See also Goebbels, Joseph RVA (Reich Board for Economic Enlightenment), 134, 223; conservation of textiles 205–14, 217–18 Salamander brand shoes, 72, 110, 142, 263; and Aryanization, 171–80; during Second World War, 247–48; under occupation, 248–50 Salesmen, 12, 91, 118, 139, 142, 263; as advertisers, 18–19, 23, 26, 62, 68, 73, 113; mistrust of, 31, 49–50, 87, 145; and salesmanship in “new” Germany, 150, 160–82, 250; during Second World War, 185, 204, 217–18,

Index 229, 246–47, 252; women as sales staff, 39, 136–39, 165, 185. See also Anti-Semitism Schacht, Hjalmar, 95 103 Schicht brand detergents, 207, 216–18, 245–47 Science of selling, 11, 17, 35, 101–2, 143; and Society for Consumer Research, GfK, 133, 143–45. See also Psychology Second World War: Beiersdorf in, 202, 237–40; BMW during, 229–37; daily life during, 187, 191, 193; empire, visions of, 219, 227–28, 264; Jews and, 186–87, 214, 251; MercedesBenz during, 216, 257; Persil during, 184, 204–5, 209–15, 218; and radio, 187, 207–8, 233; and retail sector, 200, 217–18, 246, 251; Salamander brand shoes during, 247–48; salesmen during, 185, 204, 217–18, 229, 246–47, 252; shortages during, 93, 141, 186, 188–89, 193, 197, 201, 203, 217, 241, 252; and Werberat, 185, 187–92, 219, 224–25, 229–30, 233, 237, 250–51; and Volksgemeinschaft, 192, 251 Seidels Reklame, SR, 27, 45, 53, 55, 60, 76, 87 Sex appeal in ads, 75, 79, 112, 288n17 Seyffert, Rudolf, 32, 143 Shortages of goods, 4, 58, 118, 172, 179– 80, 200; East Germany, 255; FourYear Plan, 12, 106, 262; and morale, 140, 202, 214; paper, 14, 229, 234, 256; during Second World War, 93, 141, 186, 188–89, 193, 197, 201, 203, 217, 241, 252. See also RVA Siemens & Halske, 103 Siemens-Schuckertwerke, 136–37 Signage, commercial, 24, 53, 62, 64–69, 74, 124, 172, 241, 250–52, 254 Signal, 220–223, 230, 284n51, 314n111 Social Democratic Party of Germany in Exile, Sopade, 140, 172

343

344

Index Soldiers in advertisements, 193, 197–98, 241 Solm, Fritz, 30–31, 223 Sombart, Werner, 22, 50 Southeast Europe, 223–24, 315n123 Steiner, André, 4 Strength through Joy, 114 Sudetenland, Reichsgau, advertisements in, 215, 217–18, 224 Sunlicht brand detergents, 205; advertising of, 165–67; and film, 135; and marketing, 143, 151–54; postwar, 256. See also RVA Tensions between cities and countryside, 25, 34, 67, 144, 167–68, 174. See also Heimatschutz Trademarks, 93, 123, 134, 144, 171, 192, 248. See also individual brands Trust, consumer: in advertisements, 11, 58, 88, 102, 147, 201–2; in brandname products, 39, 84, 106, 142 145, 151, 166, 264; in corporations, 135, 167, 170; in the daily press, 109; postwar, 256, 265; and regime. 181–82 Typefaces, debates about, 40, 75, 110–11, 261 Unilever, 152, 160, 164, 216, 245. See also Sunlicht United Nations Relief and Rehabilitation Administration, UNRRA, 250 Vershofen, Wilhelm, 143–45 Volksgemeinschaft, 2, 10, 59, 92, 108, 144, 186; and advertising, 43, 48, 61, 87–88, 130, 134–35; and consumption, 51–52, 60, 123, 127, 262; and salesmanship, 166, 171; and Second World War, 192, 251. See also Commercial culture

Volkswagen. See Motorization; People’s products Wehrmacht, 116, 132, 221, 230, 233. See also Soldiers in advertisements Weimar Republic: advertising industry during, 1, 11, 95, 115, 124, 164; criticism of, 44, 73, 127; political climate, 37, 140, 165. See also Continuity between Weimar and Nazi eras; “Reklame” Werberat der deutschen Wirtschaft, 11, 14; critics, 86; establishment of, 48, 54–57; mandate of, 58–62, 74, 106, 134, 205–7, 261; on outdoor advertising, 65–68; purging of industry, 68–69, 261; reforms, 57, 83, 88, 91, 101, 110–11, 145, 148, 168, 197, 260, 265; regulation of ad content, 62–66, 75, 93, 112, 155–59, 241; relationship to businesses, 71, 85–86, 106, 181, 214; during Second World War, 185, 187–92, 219, 224–25, 229–30, 233, 237, 250–51. See also Hunke, Heinrich West Germany, FRG, 4, 13, 60, 136, 147, 252, 260, 265 Wholesalers, 19, 68, 71–72, 92–93, 97, 160–61, 169, 185, 217, 246, 250 Wiesen, S. Jonathan, 9, 143, 205 Women: employed in advertising, 1, 21, 28, 80, 143–44, 165–66, 237, 276n57; elsewhere in the workforce, 19, 136–38, 153–54, 175–76, 197, 236, 302n53; as subjects of advertisements, 12–13, 75–78, 97–99, 110, 112, 116, 132–33, 173, 193. See also Consumers, female; Heuss-Knapp, Elly; Sex appeal Young, James Webb, 28, 84 Zeiss Ikon AG, 67, 221, 223